UNITED STATES

 

 

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

_______________________________________________

 

FORM 20-F

 

 

REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR (g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

OR

x  ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2013

 

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

OR

 

SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

Commission file number: 1-14624

 

RBS Holdings N.V.

 (Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

 

The Netherlands

(Jurisdiction of incorporation)

 

Gustav Mahlerlaan 10, 1082 PP Amsterdam, The Netherlands

(Address of principal executive offices)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                          

 


 

 

 

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of each class

 

 

Name of each exchange on which registered

Guarantee of 5.90% Non-cumulative Guaranteed Trust Preferred Securities of RBS Capital Funding Trust V

 

New York Stock Exchange*

 

 

 

Guarantee of 6.25% Non-cumulative Guaranteed Trust Preferred Securities of RBS Capital Funding Trust VI

 

New York Stock Exchange**

 

 

 

Guarantee of 6.08% Non-cumulative Guaranteed Trust Preferred Securities of RBS Capital Funding Trust VII

 

New York Stock Exchange***

 

 

 

5.90% Non-cumulative Guaranteed Trust Preferred Securities of RBS Capital Funding Trust V

 

New York Stock Exchange

 

 

 

6.25% Non-cumulative Guaranteed Trust Preferred Securities of RBS Capital Funding Trust VI

 

New York Stock Exchange

 

 

 

6.08% Non-cumulative Guaranteed Trust Preferred Securities of RBS Capital Funding Trust VII

 

New York Stock Exchange

 

 

 

4.65% Subordinated Notes due 2018

 

Euronext Amsterdam

 


 

 

__________________

* The guarantee is not listed for trading, but is listed only in connection with the registration of the corresponding Non-cumulative Guaranteed Trust Preferred Securities of RBS Capital Funding Trust V.

** The guarantee is not listed for trading, but is listed only in connection with the registration of the corresponding Non-cumulative Guaranteed Trust Preferred Securities of RBS Capital Funding Trust VI.

*** The guarantee is not listed for trading, but is listed only in connection with the registration of the corresponding Non-cumulative Guaranteed Trust Preferred Securities of RBS Capital Funding Trust VII.

 

 

 

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

 

None

 

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act:

 

None

 

Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each class of common stock of the close of the period covered by the annual report

 

(Title of each class)

 

 

(Number of outstanding shares)

Ordinary shares, par value €0.56 per share

 

89,287

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                          

 


 

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.

 

¨  Yes      x  No 

 

If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

 

¨  Yes      x  No 

 

Note – Checking the box above will not relieve any registrant required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 from their obligations under those Sections.

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.

 

x  Yes      ¨  No 

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).

 

¨  Yes      ¨  No 

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer. See definition of “accelerated filer and large accelerated filer” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

 

Large accelerated filer  ¨                            Accelerated filer  ¨                         Non-Accelerated filer  

 

Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing:

 

 

¨  U.S. GAAP

x  International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board

¨  Other 

 

If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to follow.

 

¨  Item 17       ¨  Item 18

 

  

 

 

 

If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).

 

¨  Yes       x  No 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                          

 


 

 

 

Form 20-F

 

 

SEC Form 20-F cross reference

 

Managing Board Report

4

 

Chairman's statement

4

 

Business review

5

 

Corporate governance

78

Financial Statements

90

 

Consolidated income statement

91

 

Consolidated statement of comprehensive income

92

 

Consolidated balance sheet

93

 

Consolidated statement of changes in equity

94

 

Consolidated cash flow statement

95

 

Accounting policies

96

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

106

 

1

Net interest income

106

 

2

Non-interest income

106

 

3

Operating expenses

107

 

4

Pensions

108

 

5

Auditor's remuneration

110

 

6

Tax

111

 

7

Dividends

111

 

8

Financial instruments - classification

112

 

9

Financial instruments - valuation

116

 

10

Financial instruments - maturity analysis

131

 

11

Financial assets - impairments

134

 

12

Derivatives

135

 

13

Debt securities

137

 

14

Equity shares

138

 

15

Prepayments, accrued income and other assets

139

 

16

Discontinued operations and assets and liabilities of disposal groups

139

 

17

Settlement balances and short positions

141

 

18

Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities

141

 

19

Deferred taxation

142

 

20

Subordinated liabilities

142

 

21

Share capital

145

 

22

Reserves

145

 

23

Structured entities and asset transfers

145

 

24

Capital resources

147

 

25

Memorandum items

148

 

26

Changes in operating assets and liabilities

153

 

27

Interest received and paid

153

 

28

Analysis of cash and cash equivalents

153

 

29

Segmental analysis

154

 

30

Remuneration of the Managing Board and Supervisory Board of RBS Holdings N.V.

157

 

31

Related parties

158

 

32

Post balance sheet events

159

 

33

Condensed consolidating financial information

159

 

 

Other information

166

Additional information

171

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                               1 

 


 

 

 

SEC Form 20-F cross reference

 

 

Form 20 F Item

Item caption

Page

PART I

 

 

1

Identity of Directors, Senior Management and Advisors

Not applicable

2

Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable

Not applicable

3

Key Information

 

 

Selected financial data

11-12, 172, 180, 185

 

Capitalisation and indebtedness

Not applicable

 

Reason for the offer and use of proceeds

Not applicable

 

Risk factors

10, 186-195

4

Information on the Company

 

 

History and development of the Company

4, 8-10, 96, 184-185, 204  

 

Business overview

4, 8-10, 36, 38, 73-77, 154-156, 184-185 

 

Organisational structure

4, 8-10, 154 

 

Property, plant and equipment

Not applicable

4A

Unresolved Staff Comments

Not applicable

5

Operating and Financial Review and Prospects

 

 

Operating results

11-24, 71, 73-77, 107, 135-136, 181-185

 

Liquidity and capital resources

25-77, 95, 112-138, 180, 181-185

 

Research and Development, Patent and Licenses, etc

Not applicable

 

Trend information

10, 36, 73-77, 186-195

 

Off-balance sheet arrangements

145-147, 185

 

Tabular disclosure of contractual obligations

38-39, 131-134, 147, 149, 180

6

Directors, Senior Management and Employees

 

 

Directors and senior management

79-84

 

Compensation

88, 107-109, 157

 

Board practices

26-27, 79-84, 86-88

 

Employees

17, 107

 

Share ownership

88, 157

7

Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions

 

 

Major shareholders

184

 

Related party transactions

158-159

 

Interest of experts and counsel

Not applicable

8

Financial Information

 

 

Consolidated statements and other financial information

90-165,167-168, 185

 

Significant changes

159

9

The offer and listing

 

 

Offer and listing details

Not applicable

 

Plan of distributions

Not applicable

 

Markets

184

 

Selling shareholders

Not applicable

 

Dilution

Not applicable

 

Expense of the issue

Not applicable

10

Additional Information

 

 

Share capital

Not applicable

 

Memorandum and Articles of Association

169-170

 

Material contracts

184-185

 

Exchange controls

Not applicable

 

Taxation

Not applicable

 

Dividends and paying agents

Not applicable

 

Statements by experts

Not applicable

 

Documents on display

197

 

Subsidiary information

Not applicable

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                               2 

 


 

 

 

SEC Form 20-F cross reference

 

 

11

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

25-77

12

Description of Securities other than Equity Securities

Not applicable

PART II

13

 

Defaults, Dividends, Arrearages and Delinquencies

Not applicable

14

Material Modifications to the Rights of Security Holders and use of Proceeds

Not applicable

15

Controls and Procedures

89

16A

Audit Committee Financial Expert

80,84,87

16B

Code of Ethics

84, 170

16C

Principal Accountant Fees and Services

88, 110

16D

Exemptions from the Listing Standards for Audit Committees

Not applicable

16E

Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated purchases

Not applicable

16F

Change in Registrant’s Certifying Accountant

Not applicable

16G

Corporate Governance

78-89

16H

Mine Safety Disclosure

Not applicable

PART III

17

 

Financial statements

 

Not applicable

18

Financial statements

90-165

19

Exhibits

205

         

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                               3 

 


 

 

 

Chairman's statement

 

Five years ago The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc (“RBSG”) embarked on a strategic restructuring designed to correct the aspects of its business that made it particularly vulnerable to the financial crisis of 2008. The execution of that restructuring has transformed the financial position of RBS Group: the balance sheet has been reduced by more than £1 trillion, and it has repaid hundreds of billions of Government funding support and removed the imminent threat that its size, risk and complexity posed to the UK economy.

 

In 2013, further steps were taken to resolve remaining legacy balance sheet issues by announcing the creation of RBS Capital Resolution Group, with the aim of accelerating the removal of these legacy assets and releasing the capital they are still tying up. With the creation of the RCR, RBS Group has announced its aspiration to remove all of these assets from its balance sheet in three years. RCR commenced on 1 January  2014 with an initial pool of c. £29 billion of assets, of which £1.5 billion related to RBSH Group. RBSH Group expects to further run down or dispose substantially of the remainder of the businesses, assets and portfolios previously managed under its Non-Core division and not transferred to the RBS Capital Resolution Group.

 

In February 2014, RBSG announced the results of a business review which was undertaken by Ross McEwan, Chief Executive Officer of RBS Group. The outcome was that RBSG needs a strategy that will address the weakness in performance for customers, so that it can provide acceptable returns to shareholders. The business review that has been conducted revealed the key challenges of RBSG, but it has also given a clear path to improve the bank. There is now a strategy to deliver a sustainable bank with a clear ambition: RBSG wants to be number one for customer service, trust and advocacy, in every one of its chosen business areas by 2020.

 

Seven operating divisions will be collapsed into three customer businesses that can understand customers’ needs and provide appropriate, consistent services far better than across current silos. The three customer businesses will cover Personal & Business Banking, Commercial & Private Banking, and Corporate & Institutional Banking.

 

Support functions will be smaller, more expert and dedicated to helping the businesses succeed for customers. Highly disciplined and well managed conduct and risk functions will maintain safety and soundness.

 

Only 30% of staff today deal directly with the customer. By 2017 more than half will deal directly with the customer and all staff will be measured against success in improving customer advocacy.

 

The announced restructure has no impact on RBS Holdings N.V.’s clients. The impact on the divisional structure of RBSH will be announced in due course.

 

On 19 April 2011, it was announced that a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. would transfer to RBS plc. The majority of the transfers were concluded in 2011 and 2012. In 2013, the assets and liabilities relating to businesses in Russia, Korea, Romania and North America were successfully transferred. A few businesses remain, including China, India, Thailand and Indonesia. The intention is to transfer the assets and liabilities of these locations to RBS plc as well. Furthermore, as announced on 19 April 2011, RBSG is committed to provide the necessary support to ensure that RBS N.V. continues to meet its commitments during and after the transfer’s.

 

At 31 December 2013, RBSG Group had 2,500 employees, of which 62 are employed in the Netherlands. 

 

Results of operations in 2013

Operating loss before tax was €142 million compared with a loss of €887 million in 2012. This was largely due to decreased expenses as a result of staff transferring as part of the business transfers to RBS plc and business divestments and partly offset by lower income due to the transfers of business.

 

Net interest income decreased due to further transfers to RBS plc and the continued low interest rate environment, while non-interest income increased due to the lower loss on own credit adjustments.

 

Total equity as at 31 December 2013 was €2.9 billion, an increase of €1.1 billion compared with 31 December 2012, mainly due to increased unrealised gains on available-for-sale assets.

 

Capital

The RBSH Group continues to be well capitalised.  At 31 December 2013, the RBSH Group’s Total capital ratio was 26.1%, the Tier 1 capital ratio was 23.2% and the Core Tier 1 capital ratio was 20.5%.

 

Outlook

The outlook for the global economy over the near to medium-term is for steady growth. Risks to growth and stability stem mainly from continued imbalances - among and within countries - and from uncertainty about how economies will respond as the extraordinary monetary policy measures implemented during the crisis are unwound.

 

Also in 2014, we will continue to de-risk RBS N.V. and transfer its assets and liabilities to RBS plc.

 

On behalf of my fellow Managing Board members, I would like to thank all our employees and clients for their continued commitment during 2013.

 

Jan de Ruiter

Chairman of the Managing Board of RBS Holdings N.V.

Amsterdam, 30 April 2014

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                               4 

 


 

 

 

Business review                                                                                                                                 

 

6

Presentation of information

7

Forward-looking statements

8

Description of business

9

Competition

10

Risk factors

11

Key financials

12

Summary consolidated income statement

13

Analysis of results

17

Divisional performance

22

Consolidated balance sheet

25

Risk and balance sheet management

26

Risk governance   

28

Risk appetite measures

33

Capital management

37

Liquidity and funding risk

40

Credit risk

47

Balance sheet analysis

57

Country risk

63

Market risk

72

Other risks

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                               5 

 


 

 

 

Presentation of information                                                                                                                                                

 

In this document and unless specified otherwise, the terms 'company' and 'RBS Holdings' mean RBS Holdings N.V.. RBS Holdings N.V. is the parent company of The Royal Bank of Scotland N.V. (RBS N.V.) consolidated group of companies and associated companies (RBSH Group). The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc (RBSG) is the ultimate holding company of RBSH Group. RBS Group refers to RBSG and its consolidated subsidiaries and associated companies. RBS plc refers to The Royal Bank of Scotland plc.  The terms 'Consortium' and 'Consortium Members' refer to RBSG, Stichting Administratiekantoor Beheer Financiële Instellingen (the Dutch State, successor to Fortis) and Banco Santander S.A. (Santander) who jointly acquired RBS Holdings on 17 October 2007 through RFS Holdings B.V. (RFS Holdings).

 

The company publishes its financial statements in 'euro', the European single currency. The abbreviations '€m' and '€bn' represent millions and thousands of millions of euros, respectively. Reference to '$' is to United States of America (US) dollars. The abbreviations '$m' and '$bn' represent millions and thousands of millions of dollars, respectively.

 

Certain information in this report is presented separately for domestic and foreign activities. Domestic activities consist of transactions within the Netherlands. Geographic analysis has been compiled based on location of office. 

 

The results, assets and liabilities of individual business units are classified as trading or non-trading based on their predominant activity. Although this method may result in some non-trading activity being classified as trading, and vice versa, any resulting misclassification is not material.

 

All annual averages in this report are based on month-end figures. Management does not believe that these month-end averages present trends materially different from those that would be presented by daily averages.

 

International Financial Reporting Standards

Unless otherwise indicated, the financial information contained in this Annual Report has been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as adopted by the European Union (EU) and IFRS as issued by the International Accounting Standard Board (IASB).

 

Glossary

A glossary of terms is detailed on pages 198 to 203.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                               6 

 


 

 

 

Forward-looking statements                                                                                                                                                  

 

Certain sections in this document contain ‘forward-looking statements’ as that term is defined in the United States Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995, such as statements that include the words ‘expect’, ‘estimate’, ‘project’, ‘anticipate’, ‘believe’, ‘should’, ‘intend’, ‘plan’, ‘could’, ‘probability’, ‘risk’, ‘Value-at-Risk (VaR)’, ‘target’, ‘goal’, ‘objective’, ‘will’, ‘endeavour’, ‘outlook’, ‘optimistic’, ‘prospects’ and similar expressions or variations on such expressions.


In particular, this document includes forward-looking statements relating, but not limited to: the RBS Group’s and the Group’s restructuring and new strategic plans, divestments, capitalisation, portfolios, net interest margin, capital ratios, liquidity, risk-weighted assets (RWAs), return on equity (ROE), profitability, cost:income ratios, leverage and loan:deposit ratios, funding and risk profile; discretionary coupon and dividend payments; implementation of legislation of ring-fencing and bail-in measures; sustainability targets; litigation, regulatory and governmental investigations; the Group’s future financial performance; the level and extent of future impairments and write-downs; and the Group’s exposure to political risks, including the impact on the RBS Group of the referendum on Scottish independence, credit rating risk and to various types of market risks, such as interest rate risk, foreign exchange rate risk and commodity and equity price risk.  These statements are based on current plans, estimates and projections, and are subject to inherent risks, uncertainties and other factors which could cause actual results to differ materially from the future results expressed or implied by such forward-looking statements. For example, certain market risk disclosures are dependent on choices about key model characteristics and assumptions and are subject to various limitations. By their nature, certain of the market risk disclosures are only estimates and, as a result, actual future gains and losses could differ materially from those that have been estimated.


Other factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those estimated by the forward-looking statements contained in this document include, but are not limited to: global economic and financial market conditions and other geopolitical risks, and their impact on the financial industry in general and on the Group in particular;  the ability to implement strategic plans on a timely basis, or at all, including the simplification of the RBS Group’s structure and the exiting of assets in RBS Capital Resolution;  the achievement of capital and costs reduction targets; RBSH group’s reliance on the RBS Group;  ineffective management of capital or changes to capital adequacy or liquidity requirements; organisational restructuring in response to legislation and regulation in the European Union (EU) and the United States (US); the implementation of key legislation and regulation including the proposed EU Recovery and Resolution Directive; the ability to access sufficient sources of capital, liquidity and funding when required; deteriorations in borrower and counterparty credit quality; litigation, government and regulatory investigations including investigations relating to the setting of LIBOR and other interest rates and foreign exchange trading and rate setting activities; costs or exposures borne by the RBS Group arising out of the origination or sale of mortgages or mortgage-backed securities in the US; the extent of future write-downs and impairment charges caused by depressed asset valuations;  unanticipated turbulence in interest rates, yield curves, foreign currency exchange rates, credit spreads, bond prices, commodity prices, equity prices and basis, volatility and correlation risks; changes in the credit ratings of the Group;  changes to the valuation of financial instruments recorded at fair value;  competition and consolidation in the banking sector; the ability of the Group to attract or retain senior management or other key employees; regulatory or legal changes (including those requiring any restructuring of the Group’s operations) in the US and other countries in which the Group operates;  changes to regulatory requirements relating to capital and liquidity; the execution of the approved transfers of a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. to RBS; changes to the legal recourse available to investors resulting from the legal demerger of ABN AMRO Bank N.V.; changes to the monetary and interest rate policies of central banks and other governmental and regulatory bodies; general operational risks; reputational risk; the conversion of the B Shares issued by the RBS Group in accordance with their terms; and the success of the Group in managing the risks involved in the foregoing.

 

The forward-looking statements contained in this document speak only as of the date of this announcement, and the RBSH Group does not undertake to update any forward-looking statement to reflect events or circumstances after the date hereof or to reflect the occurrence of unanticipated events.

 

The information, statements and opinions contained in this document do not constitute a public offer under any applicable legislation or an offer to sell or solicitation of any offer to buy any securities or financial instruments or any advice or recommendation with respect to such securities or other financial instruments.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                               7 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

Description of business

Introduction

RBS Holdings N.V. offers a range of banking products and financial services, principally in Europe and Asia. 

 

In 2007, RFS Holdings, which was jointly owned by RBSG, Fortis (succeeded by the Dutch State in 2008) and Santander (together, the 'Consortium Members') completed the acquisition of RBS Holdings. 

 

RBS Holdings has one direct subsidiary, RBS N.V., a fully operational bank within RBSH Group. RBS N.V. is independently rated and regulated by the Dutch Central Bank. Certain assets within RBS N.V. continue to be owned by the Dutch State or shared by the Consortium Members.

 

As at 31 December 2010, RBSG's shareholding in RFS Holdings was increased to 97.72%. RFS Holdings is controlled by RBSG, which is incorporated in the UK and registered at 36 St. Andrew Square, Edinburgh, Scotland. RBSG is the ultimate parent company of RBSH Group. The consolidated financial statements of RBSH Group are included in the consolidated financial statements of RBS Group.

   
 
 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 


*interest is held by Stichting Administratiekantoor Beheer Financiële Instellingen

 

RBSH Group had total assets of €39.8 billion and owners' equity of €2.9 billion at 31 December 2013. RBSH Group’s capital ratios were a Total capital ratio of 26.1%, a Core Tier 1 capital ratio of 20.5% and a Tier 1 capital ratio of 23.2%, as at 31 December 2013.

 

Organisational structure and business overview

RBSH Group’s activities are organised on a divisional basis as follows:

 

Markets is an origination, sales and trading business across debt finance, fixed income and currencies. The division offers a unified service to RBSH Group’s corporate and institutional clients. The Markets’ origination, sales and research teams build strong ongoing client partnerships, provide market perspective and access, and work with the division’s trading and structuring teams to meet the client’s objectives across financing, risk management, investment, securitisation and liquidity.

 

International Banking provides financing, transaction services and risk management. International Banking serves as the delivery channel for Markets’ products to corporate clients.

 

Central items comprises group and corporate functions, such as treasury, capital management and finance, risk management, legal, communications and human resources.

 

Non-Core manages separately assets that RBSH Group intends to run-off or dispose, in line with RBS Group strategy for Non-Core assets. It also includes the remaining assets and liabilities in RBS N.V. that have not yet been sold, wound down or transferred to the Consortium Members, referred to as 'Shared Assets', in which each of the consortium shareholders has a joint and indirect interest.

 

Transfers of a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. to RBS plc 

Following the announcements in April 2011 by the Boards of RBSG, RBS plc, RBS Holdings N.V. and RBS N.V., a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. have been successfully transferred to RBS plc (the “Transfers”).

 

During the last quarter of 2011 RBS N.V. transferred to RBS plc a large part of its UK activities including the Equities & Structured Retail, Markets, Lending and former GTS businesses as well as part of the UK Non-Core portfolio.

 

In the first half of 2012, assets and liabilities largely relating to businesses in Singapore, Hong Kong and Kazakhstan were transferred to RBS plc by a combination of local schemes of arrangement, novations and subsidiary share sales. 

 

In September 2012, through a statutory demerger and cross-border merger (the “Dutch Scheme”), RBS N.V. transferred net assets of €868 million to RBS plc, related largely to Transaction Services business and Lending deals. The transferred Markets business included most Dutch, German and Italian law governed securitised products and a number of over the counter transactions.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                               8 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

In the latter half of 2012, other eligible businesses in the Netherlands and certain EMEA countries, and businesses in Malaysia, Turkey and the United Arab Emirates were transferred via novations, market mechanisms and subsidiary share sales.

 

In 2013, assets and liabilities relating to businesses in Russia, Romania, Korea and North America were transferred to RBS plc by a combination of local schemes of arrangement, cross-border merger, novations and subsidiary share sales.

 

RBS NV US branches  

The RBS N.V. US branches will be closed once the remaining tail assets have been transferred and applicable regulatory approval has been received.

 

Competition

RBSH Group faces strong competition in all the markets it serves. Banks’ balance sheets have strengthened whilst loan demand has been subdued as many customers have sought to delever and the economy has remained weak.

 

Competition for corporate and institutional customers in the Netherlands and abroad is from Dutch banks and from large foreign universal banks that offer combined investment and commercial banking capabilities. In addition, RBSH Group’s Markets division faces strong competition from dedicated investment banks. In asset finance, RBSH Group competes with banks and specialist asset finance providers, both captive and non-captive. In European and Asian corporate and institutional banking markets RBSH Group competes with the large domestic banks active in these markets and with the major international banks.

 

Recent developments

Cap on variable remuneration

The fourth EU Capital Requirements Directive (CRD IV), implemented for banks in the UK by the Prudential Regulatory Authority, imposes a 1:1 cap on variable remuneration in relation to salary; however with shareholder approval it is possible to award variable remuneration up to 200% of fixed pay (i.e. a 2:1 cap).

 

All of the RBS Group’s major competitors have indicated that they will seek approval from their shareholders to introduce a 2:1 cap and the RBS Group Board believes the best commercial solution for RBS Group would be to have the flexibility on variable compensation which is now emerging as the sector norm. This would also allow RBS Group to maintain the maximum amount of compensation that could be subject to performance conditions including claw back for conduct issues that may emerge in future.

 

On 24 April UKFI informed the RBS Group board that it would vote against any resolution which proposes a 2:1 ratio. In these circumstances, the RBS Group Board expects that such a resolution would fail and will therefore not be brought to the Annual General Meeting. HM Treasury has commented that it considers an increase to the cap on variable remuneration cannot be justified whilst RBS Group has yet to complete its restructuring and remains a majority publicly-owned bank, and notes that as a result of its pay policy RBS Group will remain a ‘back-marker’  in its overall remuneration compared to other banks.

 

The RBS Group Board acknowledges that this outcome creates a commercial and prudential risk which it must try to mitigate within the framework of a 1:1 fixed to variable compensation ratio.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                               9 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

Risk factors

Set out below are certain risk factors which could affect RBSH Group's future results and cause them to be materially different from expected results. RBSH Group’s results are also affected by competition and other factors. These risk factors, discussed in more detail on pages 186 to 195, should not be regarded as a complete and comprehensive statement of all potential risks and uncertainties.

·         RBSH Group is reliant on the RBS Group.

 

·         RBSH Group is subject to a number of legal and regulatory actions and investigations. Unfavourable outcomes in such actions and investigations could have a material adverse effect on RBSH Group’s operating results or reputation.

 

·         RBSH Group could fail to attract or retain senior management, which may include members of RBSH Group’s Supervisory Board and Managing Board, or other key employees, and it may suffer losses if it does not maintain good employee relations.

 

·         The execution and/or any delay in the execution (or non-completion) of the approved transfers of a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. to RBS plc may have a material adverse effect on RBSH Group.

 

·         Operational risks are inherent in RBSH Group’s businesses.

 

·         RBSH Group operates in markets that are highly competitive and its business and results of operations may be adversely affected.

 

·         RBSH Group’s businesses and performance can be negatively affected by actual or perceived global economic and financial market conditions.

 

·         RBSH Group has significant exposure to a weakening of the nascent economic recovery in Europe.

 

·         RBSH Group is subject to other global risks.

 

·         RBSH Group’s business performance could be adversely affected if its capital is not managed effectively or as a result of changes to capital adequacy and liquidity requirements.

 

·         An extensive restructuring and balance sheet reduction programme of the RBS Group is ongoing and may adversely affect RBSH Group’s business, results of operations, financial condition, capital ratios and liquidity.

 

·         RBSH Group’s ability to meet its obligations including its funding commitments depends on RBSH Group’s ability to access sources of liquidity and funding.

 

·         RBSH Group’s borrowing costs, its access to the debt capital markets and its liquidity depend significantly on its credit ratings.

 

·         Each of RBSH Group’s businesses is subject to substantial regulation and oversight. Significant regulatory developments and changes in the approach of RBSH Group’s key regulators could have a material adverse effect on how RBSH Group conducts its business and on its results of operations and financial condition.

 

·         RBSH Group’s operations are highly dependent on its information technology systems.

 

·         RBSH Group’s operations have inherent reputational risk.

 

·         RBSH Group may suffer losses due to employee misconduct.

 

·         The financial performance of RBSH Group has been, and continues to be, materially affected by deteriorations in borrower and counterparty credit quality and further deteriorations could arise due to prevailing economic and market conditions and legal and regulatory developments.

 

·         Changes in interest rates, foreign exchange rates, credit spreads, bond, equity and commodity prices, basis, volatility and correlation risks and other market factors have significantly affected and will continue to affect RBSH Group’s business and results of operations.

 

·         The value of certain financial instruments recorded at fair value is determined using financial models incorporating assumptions, judgements and estimates that may change over time or may ultimately not turn out to be accurate.

 

·         RBSH Group’s earnings and financial condition have been, and its future earnings and financial condition may continue to be, materially affected by depressed asset valuations resulting from poor market conditions.

 

·         The regulatory capital treatment of certain deferred tax assets recognised by RBSH Group depends on there being no adverse changes to regulatory requirements.

 

·         The recoverability of certain deferred tax assets recognised by RBSH Group depends on RBSH Group’s ability to generate sufficient future taxable profits and there being no adverse changes to tax legislation or accounting standards.

 

·         The legal demerger of ABN AMRO Bank N.V. (as it was then named) has resulted in a cross liability that changes the legal recourse available to investors.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             10 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

 

Key financials

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

for the year ended 31 December

€m 

€m 

€m 

Total income

437 

708 

4,006 

(Loss)/profit before impairment losses

(100)

(822)

1,579 

Operating loss before tax

(142)

(887)

(186)

 

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

at 31 December

€m 

€m 

€m 

Total assets

39,808 

70,954 

146,776 

Funded balance sheet (1) 

35,026 

63,399 

127,638 

Loans and advances to customers

3,784 

6,380 

29,578 

Deposits

23,094 

37,103 

86,121 

Equity attributable to controlling interests

2,942 

1,799 

3,395 

Capital ratios        - Core Tier 1

20.5% 

11.7% 

8.6% 

                             - Tier 1

23.2% 

13.9% 

12.0% 

                             - Total

26.1% 

19.8% 

17.5% 

 

Note:

(1)       Funded balance sheet represents total assets less derivatives.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             11 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

 

Summary consolidated income statement

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

Net interest income

238 

605 

688 

Fees and commissions receivable

119 

469 

1,039 

Fees and commissions payable

(49)

(198)

(367)

Other non-interest income

129 

(168)

2,646 

Non-interest income

199 

103 

3,318 

Total income

437 

708 

4,006 

Operating expenses

(537)

(1,530)

(2,427)

(Loss)/profit before impairment losses

(100)

(822)

1,579 

Impairment losses

(42)

(65)

(1,765)

Operating loss before tax

(142)

(887)

(186)

Tax charge

(12)

(129)

(449)

Loss from continuing operations

(154)

(1,016)

(635)

Profit from discontinued operations, net of tax

19 

17 

40 

Loss for the year attributable to controlling interests

(135)

(999)

(595)

 

2013 compared with 2012

Operating loss before tax was €142 million compared with a loss of €887 million in 2012. This decrease was due to lower operating expenses partially offset by lower income.

 

Total income decreased by €271 million to €437 million. This is mainly due to lower net interest income.

 

Net interest income decreased by €367 million to €238 million, reflecting further reductions in interest income, in particular in International Banking, due to further business transfers to RBS plc and the continued low interest rate environment.

 

Non-interest income increased by €96 million to €199 million compared with €103 million in 2012. This increase is mainly due to the €776 million lower loss on own credit adjustment resulting from the widening of credit spreads of UK banks. This was partially offset by lower net fees and commissions as a result of business transfers to RBS plc, and lower profit on sales of subsidiaries and associates and securities.

 

Operating expenses decreased by €993 million to €537 million due to reduced staff and non-staff costs as a result of staff transferring as part of business transfers to RBS plc and business divestments.

 

Impairment losses decreased by €23 million to €42 million the 2013 charge is driven by a small number of individual cases.  The reduction reflects business transfers to RBS plc. 

 

Tax

The tax charge for 2013 was €12 million compared with €129 million in 2012. The higher rate for 2012 was mainly the result of the reduction in carrying value of the deferred tax asset in respect of losses in Australia.

 

2012 compared with 2011

Operating loss before tax was €887 million compared with a loss of €186 million in 2011. This decrease was due to lower total income partially offset by lower operating expenses and lower impairment losses.

 

Total income decreased by €3,298 million to €708 million. This is mainly due to a lower own credit adjustment in non-interest income.

 

Net interest income decreased by €83 million to €605 million, reflecting further reductions in interest income, in particular in International Banking, mainly due to business transfers to RBS plc.

 

Non-interest income decreased by €3,215 million to €103 million compared with €3,318 million in 2011. This decrease is mainly due to the €2,155 million lower own credit adjustment resulting from to the tightening of credit spreads. In addition, fee and trading income were lower as a result of business transfers to RBS plc.

 

Operating expenses decreased by €897 million to €1,530 million due to reduced activities as a result of business transfers to RBS plc.

 

Impairment losses decreased by €1,700 million to €65 million this decrease mainly relates to Greek sovereign available-for-sale bond impairments and related interest rate hedge adjustments, which decreased by €1,428 million from €1,463 million.

 

Tax

The tax charge for 2012 was €129 million compared with €449 million in 2011. The higher charge for 2011 was mainly the result of losses on Greek sovereign available-for-sale bonds being not recoverable for tax purposes.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             12 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

 

Analysis of results

  

  

  

Net interest income

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

Interest receivable

768 

1,628 

2,352 

Interest payable (1) 

(493)

(1,023)

(1,664)

Net interest income

275 

605 

688 

  

  

  

  

Yields, spreads and margins of the banking business

Gross yield on interest-earning assets of the banking business (2) 

1.8 

2.1 

2.1 

Cost of interest-bearing liabilities of the banking business

(1.3)

(1.4)

(1.5)

Interest spread of the banking business (3) 

0.5 

0.7 

0.6 

Benefit from interest-free funds

0.2 

0.1 

Net interest margin of the banking business (4) 

0.7 

0.8 

0.6 

  

  

  

  

Gross yield (2) 

  

  

  

  - Group

1.8 

2.1 

2.1 

  - Domestic

1.1 

1.4 

1.8 

  - Foreign

3.2 

2.8 

2.4 

Interest spread (3) 

  

  

  

  - Group

0.5 

0.7 

0.6 

  - Domestic

0.4 

(0.1)

(0.1)

  - Foreign

1.0 

1.6 

1.2 

Net interest margin (4)

  

  

  

  - Group

0.7 

0.8 

0.6 

  - Domestic

0.5 

(0.2)

(0.1)

  - Foreign

1.0 

1.8 

1.2 

 

Notes:

(1)    Interest payable has been decreased by €37 million (2012 and 2011 - nil) in respect of non-recurring adjustments.

(2)    Gross yield is the interest rate earned on average interest-earning assets of the banking business.

(3)    Interest spread is the difference between the gross yield and the interest rate paid on average interest-bearing liabilities of the banking business.

(4)    Net interest margin is net interest income of the banking business as a percentage of average interest-earning assets of the banking business.

(5)    The analysis into Domestic and Foreign has been compiled on the basis of location of the entity in which the transaction takes place.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             13 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

 

Average balance sheet and related interest

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

  

2012 

  

  

Average 

  

  

  

Average 

  

  

  

  

balance 

Interest 

Rate 

  

balance 

Interest 

Rate 

  

  

€m 

€m 

  

€m 

€m 

Assets

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Loans and advances to banks

- Domestic

6,130 

51 

0.8 

  

7,779 

59 

0.8 

  

- Foreign

5,755 

49 

0.9 

  

15,615 

148 

0.9 

Loans and advances to customers

- Domestic

1,002 

32 

3.2 

  

6,691 

154 

2.3 

  

- Foreign

6,386 

307 

4.8 

  

16,677 

711 

4.3 

Amounts due from ultimate holding company

- Domestic

2,805 

183 

6.5 

  

2,091 

114 

5.5 

Debt securities

- Domestic

18,014 

53 

0.3 

  

24,274 

272 

1.1 

  

- Foreign

1,876 

93 

5.0 

  

4,086 

170 

4.2 

Interest-earning assets

- banking business

41,968 

768 

1.8 

  

77,213 

1,628 

2.1 

  

- trading business

2,021 

  

  

  

5,623 

  

  

Interest-earning assets

  

43,989 

  

  

  

82,836 

  

  

Non-interest-earning assets

  

17,493 

  

  

  

32,904 

  

  

Total assets

  

61,482 

  

  

  

115,740 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Percentage of assets applicable to overseas operations

41.0% 

  

  

  

50.5% 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Liabilities

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits by banks

- Domestic

20,711 

117 

0.6 

  

26,210 

283 

1.1 

  

- Foreign

7,064 

71 

1.0 

  

15,613 

129 

0.8 

Customer accounts: demand deposits

- Domestic

               —

— 

— 

  

7,090 

60 

0.8 

  

- Foreign

2,733 

11 

0.4 

  

12,900 

66 

0.5 

Customer accounts: savings deposits

- Foreign

554 

21 

3.8 

  

768 

28 

3.6 

Customer accounts: other time deposits

- Domestic

547 

16 

2.9 

  

1,372 

44 

3.2 

  

- Foreign

1,950 

82 

4.2 

  

3,767 

140 

3.7 

Debt securities in issue

- Domestic

115 

3.5 

  

4,258 

63 

1.5 

  

- Foreign

641 

13 

2.0 

  

1,038 

22 

2.1 

Subordinated liabilities

- Domestic

3,488 

41 

1.2 

  

4,375 

70 

1.6 

  

- Foreign

2,089 

125 

6.0 

  

2,776 

162 

5.8 

Internal funding of trading business

- Foreign

(779)

(8)

1.0 

  

(4,429)

(44)

1.0 

Interest-bearing liabilities

- banking business (1)   

39,113 

493 

1.3 

  

75,738 

1,023 

1.4 

  

- trading business

2,694 

  

  

  

11,934 

  

  

Interest-bearing liabilities

  

41,807 

  

  

  

87,672 

  

  

Non-interest-bearing liabilities:

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Demand deposits

- Domestic

311 

  

  

  

706 

  

  

  

- Foreign

861 

  

  

  

2,084 

  

  

Other liabilities

  

11,775 

  

  

  

21,466 

  

  

Owners' equity

  

6,728 

  

  

  

3,812 

  

  

Total liabilities and owners' equity

  

61,482 

  

  

  

115,740 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Percentage of liabilities applicable to overseas operations

40.1%

  

  

  

54.9%

  

  

 

For notes to this table refer to page 13.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             14 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

 

Average balance sheet and related interest continued 

  

  

  

  

  

2011 

  

  

Average 

  

  

  

  

balance 

Interest 

Rate 

  

  

€m 

€m 

Assets

  

  

  

  

Loans and advances to banks

- Domestic

4,707 

126 

2.7 

  

- Foreign

25,521 

207 

0.8 

Loans and advances to customers

- Domestic

9,234 

193 

2.1 

  

- Foreign

28,463 

1,058 

3.7 

Amounts due from ultimate holding company

- Domestic

238 

13 

5.5 

Debt securities

- Domestic

34,764 

560 

1.6 

  

- Foreign

6,610 

195 

3.0 

Interest-earning assets

- banking business

109,537 

2,352 

2.1 

  

- trading business

19,958 

  

  

Interest-earning assets

  

129,495 

  

  

Non-interest-earning assets

  

62,071 

  

  

Total assets

  

191,566 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Percentage of assets applicable to overseas operations

67.5% 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Liabilities

  

  

  

  

Deposits by banks

- Domestic

23,503 

440 

1.9 

  

- Foreign

30,657 

125 

0.4 

Customer accounts: demand deposits

- Domestic

9,853 

217 

2.2 

  

- Foreign

21,378 

270 

1.3 

Customer accounts: savings deposits

- Domestic

209 

— 

— 

  

- Foreign

197 

2.5 

Customer accounts: other time deposits

- Domestic

3,394 

64 

1.9 

  

- Foreign

5,796 

175 

3.0 

Debt securities in issue

- Domestic

9,613 

146 

1.5 

  

- Foreign

3,049 

53 

1.7 

Subordinated liabilities

- Domestic

3,335 

79 

2.4 

  

- Foreign

3,281 

151 

4.6 

Internal funding of trading business

- Foreign

(3,424)

(61)

1.8 

Interest-bearing liabilities

- banking business (1) 

110,841 

1,664 

1.5 

  

- trading business

34,431 

  

  

Interest-bearing liabilities

  

145,272 

  

  

Non-interest-bearing liabilities:

  

  

  

  

Demand deposits

- Foreign

4,503 

  

  

Other liabilities

  

37,266 

  

  

Owners' equity

  

4,525 

  

  

Total liabilities and owners' equity

  

191,566 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Percentage of liabilities applicable to overseas operations

68.8% 

  

  

 

For notes to this table refer to page 13.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             15 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

Analysis of change in net interest income – volume and rate analysis

Volume and rate variances have been calculated based on movements in average balances over the period and changes in interest rates on average interest-earning assets and average interest-bearing liabilities. Changes due to a combination of volume and rate are allocated pro rata to volume and rate movements.

  

2013 over 2012

  

2012 over 2011

  

Increase/(decrease) due to changes in:

  

Increase/(decrease) due to changes in:

  

Average 

Average 

Net  

  

Average 

Average 

Net  

 volume 

 rate 

 change 

  

 volume 

 rate 

 change 

  

€m  

€m 

€m 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

Interest-earning assets

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Loans and advances to banks

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Domestic

(13)

(8)

  

54 

(121)

(67)

  Foreign

(85)

(14)

(99)

  

(90)

31 

(59)

Loans and advances to customers

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Domestic

(166)

44 

(122)

  

(57)

18 

(39)

  Foreign

(485)

81 

(404)

  

(486)

139 

(347)

Amounts due from ultimate holding company

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  Domestic

44 

25 

69 

  

101 

— 

101 

Debt securities

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Domestic

(57)

(162)

(219)

  

(143)

(145)

(288)

  Foreign

(105)

28 

(77)

  

(89)

64 

(25)

Total interest receivable of the banking business

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Domestic

(192)

(88)

(280)

  

(45)

(248)

(293)

  Foreign

(675)

95 

(580)

  

(665)

234 

(431)

  

(867)

(860)

  

(710)

(14)

(724)

Interest-bearing liabilities

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits by banks

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Domestic

51 

115 

166 

  

(46)

203 

157 

  Foreign

82 

(24)

58 

  

82 

(86)

(4)

Customer accounts: demand deposits

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Domestic

30 

30 

60 

  

49 

108 

157 

  Foreign

43 

12 

55 

  

82 

122 

204 

Customer accounts: savings deposits

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Foreign

(1)

  

(20)

(3)

(23)

Customer accounts: other time deposits

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Domestic

24 

28 

  

50 

(30)

20 

  Foreign

75 

(17)

58 

  

70 

(35)

35 

Debt securities in issue

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Domestic

96 

(37)

59 

  

79 

83 

  Foreign

  

41 

(10)

31 

Subordinated liabilities

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Domestic

13 

16

29

  

(21)

30 

  Foreign

41 

(4)

       37 

  

26 

(37)

(11)

Internal funding of trading business

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Foreign

(37)

(36)

  

15 

(32)

(17)

Total interest payable of the banking business

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Domestic

214 

128 

342 

  

111 

315 

426 

  Foreign

220 

(32) 

188 

  

296 

(81)

215 

  

434 

96 

530 

  

407 

234 

641 

Movement in net interest income

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Domestic

22

40

62

  

66 

67 

133 

  Foreign

(455)

63 

(392)

  

(369)

153 

(216)

  

(433)

103 

(330)

  

(303)

220 

(83)

.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             16 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

Divisional performance

The results of each division are set out below. Business Services directly attributable costs have been allocated to the operating divisions, based on their service usage. Where services span more than one division an appropriate measure is used to allocate the costs on a basis which management considers reasonable. Business Services costs are fully allocated and there are no residual unallocated costs.

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

Operating profit/(loss) before tax

€m 

€m 

€m 

Markets

23 

(503)

1,342 

International Banking

(18)

182 

81 

Central items

(359)

(535)

(1,270)

Core

(354)

(856)

153 

Non-Core

212 

(31)

(339)

  

(142)

(887)

(186)

 

 

Employee numbers at 31 December

  

  

  

(full time equivalents rounded to the nearest hundred)

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

Markets

700 

2,900 

6,300 

International Banking

1,100 

5,500 

6,600 

Central items

100 

300 

600 

Core

1,900 

8,700 

13,500 

Non-Core

600 

2,600 

4,200 

  

2,500 

11,300 

17,700 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             17 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

 

Divisional performance continued 

  

  

  

Markets

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

  

€m 

€m 

€m  

Net interest income

35 

142 

66 

Non-interest income

239 

70 

2,589 

Total income

274 

212 

2,655 

Direct expenses

  

  

  

  - staff costs

(26)

(363)

(696)

  - other

(133)

(318)

(511)

Indirect expenses

(34)

(53)

Total expenses

(193)

(680)

(1,260)

Profit/(loss) before impairment losses

81 

(468)

1,395 

Impairment losses

(58)

(35)

(53)

Operating profit/(loss) before tax

23 

(503)

1,342 

  

  

  

  

  

€bn 

€bn 

€bn 

Balance sheet

  

  

  

Third party assets

15 

30 

72 

Third party liabilities

15 

36 

77 

 

2013 compared with 2012

Operating profit before tax was €23 million compared with a loss of €503 million in 2012. This improvement of €526 million was mainly due to lower operating expenses.

 

Total income increased by €62 million to €274 million mainly attributable to an increase in non-interest income.

 

Net interest income decreased by €107 million to €35 million compared with €142 million in 2012. This reflects the transfer of businesses to RBS plc.

 

Non-interest income increased by €169 million to €239 million in 2013 compared with €70 million in 2012, primarily due to lower losses in other operating income. This was offset by lower fee and trading income as a result of the transfer of businesses to RBS plc.

 

Total expenses decreased by €487 million to €193 million compared with €680 million in 2012. This reflects the continuing transfer of businesses to RBS plc.

 

Impairment losses increased by €23 million to €58 million compared with €35 million in 2012. The impairments in 2013 and 2012 reflect a small number of single name provisions.

 

2012 compared with 2011

Operating loss before tax was €503 million compared with a profit of €1,342 million in 2011. This decrease of €1,845 million was mainly due to lower total income partly offset by lower operating expenses.

 

Total income decreased by €2,443 million to €212 million mainly due to the decrease in non-interest income.

 

Net interest income increased by €76 million to €142 million compared with €66 million in 2011. This reflects lower funding costs after the transfer of businesses to RBS plc.

 

Non-interest income decreased by €2,519 million to €70 million in 2012 compared with €2,589 million in 2011, primarily due a €1,602 million decrease in other operating income. This is mainly due to the €1,390 million lower own credit adjustment attributable to the tightening of credit spreads. The remaining decrease in other operating income is largely due to a lower gain on the currency translation reserve release related to the transfer of businesses to RBS plc of €167 million compared with €404 million in 2011. In addition, fee and trading income were €893 million lower as a result of the transfer of businesses to RBS plc.

 

Total expenses decreased by €580 million to €680 million compared with €1,260 million in 2011. This reflects the continuing transfer of businesses to RBS plc.

 

Impairment losses decreased by €18 million to €35 million compared with €53 million in 2011. Impairments in both 2012 and 2011 reflect a small number of single name provisions.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             18 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

.

Divisional performance continued 

  

  

  

International Banking

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

Net interest income

77 

280 

490 

Non-interest income

87 

444 

548 

Total income

164 

724 

1,038 

Direct expenses

  

  

  

  - staff costs

(44)

(239)

(323)

  - other

(47)

(339)

(455)

Indirect expenses

(97)

12 

33 

Total expenses

(188)

(566)

(745)

(Loss)/profit before impairment losses

(24)

158 

293 

Impairment recoveries/(losses)

24 

(212)

Operating (loss)/profit before tax

(18)

182 

81 

  

  

  

  

  

€bn 

€bn 

€bn 

Balance sheet

  

  

  

Third party assets

24 

Third party liabilities

35 

 

2013 compared with 2012

Operating loss before tax was €18 million compared with a profit of €182 million in 2012. This decrease of €200 million was mainly due to lower total income partially offset by lower operating expenses.

 

Total income decreased by €560 million to €164 million due to decreases in both net interest income and non-interest income.

 

Net interest income decreased by €203 million to €77 million compared with €280 million in 2012. This reflects further reductions in lending mainly due to the transfer of businesses to RBS plc.

 

Non-interest income decreased by €357 million to €87 million compared with €444 million in 2012. This is mainly due to the transfer of businesses to RBS plc.

 

Total expenses decreased by €378 million to €188 million compared with €566 million in 2012 as a result of the transfer of businesses to RBS plc.

 

Impairment recoveries decreased by €18 million to €6 million compared with €24 million in 2012.

 

2012 compared with 2011

Operating profit before tax was €182 million compared with €81 million in 2011. This increase of €101 million was mainly due to lower operating expense and higher impairment recoveries partly offset by lower total income.

 

Total income decreased by €314 million to €724 million due to decreases in both net interest income and non-interest income.

 

Net interest income decreased by €210 million to €280 million compared with €490 million in 2011. This reflects further reductions in lending mainly due to the transfer of businesses to RBS plc.

 

Non-interest income decreased by €104 million to €444 million compared with €548 million in 2011. This is mainly due to the transfer of businesses to RBS plc.

 

Total expenses decreased by €179 million to €566 million compared with €745 million in 2011 as a result of the transfer of businesses to RBS plc.

 

Impairments improved by €236 million to a recovery of €24 million compared with a loss of €212 million in 2011. The impairments in 2011 were largely driven by a single name provision.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             19 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

 

Divisional performance continued 

  

  

  

Central items

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

Net interest income

(12)

(34)

(110)

Non-interest income

(233)

(396)

407 

Total income

(245)

(430)

297 

Direct expenses

  

  

  

  - staff costs

(74)

(62)

(69)

  - other

(145)

(17)

(49)

Indirect expenses

151 

(3)

14 

Total expenses

(68)

(82)

(104)

(Loss)/profit before impairment losses

(313)

(512)

193 

Impairment losses

(46)

(23)

(1,463)

Operating loss before tax

(359)

(535)

(1,270)

  

  

  

  

  

€bn 

€bn 

€bn 

Balance sheet

  

  

  

Third party assets

16 

29 

39 

Third party liabilities

14 

20 

25 

 

2013 compared with 2012

Operating loss before tax was €359 million compared with a loss of €535 million in 2012. The reduced loss is largely due to lower total income losses.

 

Total income losses improved by €185 million to a loss of €245 million, mainly reflecting lower non-interest income losses.

 

Net interest income improved by €22 million to a loss of €12 million. This mainly reflects the lower funding costs as a result of third party funding being replaced by funding from RBS plc as part of the transfer of businesses to RBS plc.

 

Non-interest income losses decreased by €163 million to a loss of €233 million compared with a loss of €396 million in 2012. This is mainly due to lower own credit adjustment attributable to the tightening of credit spreads.

 

Total expenses decreased by €14 million to €68 million compared with €82 million in 2012.

 

Impairment losses increased by €23 million to €46 million compared with €23 million in 2012.

 

2012 compared with 2011

Operating loss before tax was €535 million compared with a loss of €1,270 million in 2011. The reduced loss is largely due to lower impairment losses partly offset by lower total income.

 

Total income decreased by €727 million to a loss of €430 million, mainly reflecting lower non-interest income.

 

Net interest income increased by €76 million to a loss of €34 million. This mainly reflects the lower funding costs as a result of third party funding being replaced by funding from RBS plc as part of the transfer of businesses to RBS plc.

 

Non-interest income decreased by €803 million to a loss of €396 million compared with a gain of €407 million in 2011 primarily due to the decrease in other operating income. This is mainly due to the €765 million lower own credit adjustment attributable to the tightening of credit spreads.

 

Total expenses decreased by €22 million to €82 million compared with €104 million in 2011 due to a litigation recovery.

 

Impairment losses decreased by €1,440 million to €23 million compared with €1,463 million in 2011. This decrease mainly relates to Greek sovereign available-for-sale bonds impairment and related interest rate hedge adjustments, which decreased by €1,428 million, from €1,463 million in 2011 to €35 million in 2012.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             20 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

 

Divisional performance continued 

  

  

  

Non-Core

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

Net interest income

138 

217 

242 

Non-interest income

106 

(15)

(226)

Total income

244 

202 

16 

Direct expenses

  

  

  

  - staff costs

(31)

(77)

(122)

  - other

(38)

(115)

(197)

Indirect expenses

(19)

(10)

Total expenses

(88)

(202)

(318)

Profit/(loss) before impairment losses

156 

— 

(302)

Impairment losses

56 

(31)

(37)

Operating profit/(loss) before tax

212 

(31)

(339)

  

  

  

  

  

€bn 

€bn 

€bn 

Balance sheet

  

  

  

Third party assets

12 

Third party liabilities

 

2013 compared with 2012

Operating profit before tax was €212 million compared with a loss of €31 million in 2012, largely due to higher total income, lower expenses and impairment recoveries.

 

Total income increased by €42 million to €244 million compared €202 million in 2012 mainly due to higher non-interest income.

 

Net interest income decreased by €79 million to €138 million compared with €217 million in 2012 following continuing Non-Core disposals.

 

Non-interest income increased by €121 million to €106 million compared with a loss of €15 million in 2012.

 

Total expenses decreased by €114 million to €88 million compared with €202 million in 2012, reflecting continuing disposals.

 

Impairment recoveries were €56 million compared with losses of €31 million in 2012.

 

2012 compared with 2011

Operating loss before tax was €31 million compared with a loss of €339 million in 2011, largely due to higher total income and lower expenses.

 

Total income increased by €186 million to €202 million mainly due to a lower loss in non-interest income.

 

Net interest income decreased by €25 million to €217 million compared with €242 million in 201,1 following continuing disposals.

 

Non-interest income improved by €211 million to a loss of €15 million compared with a loss of €226 million in 2011. The increase is mainly due to lower losses on sale and revaluation of assets compared with 2011.

 

Total expenses decreased by €116 million to €202 million compared with €318 million in 2011. The decrease reflects continuing disposals.

 

Impairment losses decreased by €6 million to €31 million compared with €37 million in 2011.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             21 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

 

Consolidated balance sheet at 31 December 2013

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

  

€m 

  €m 

 €m 

Assets

  

  

  

Cash and balances at central banks

3,193 

2,294 

12,609 

Net loans and advances to banks

5,642 

12,138 

16,817 

Reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing

53 

68 

9,100 

Loans and advances to banks

5,695 

12,206 

25,917 

Net loans and advances to customers

3,782 

6,375 

29,295 

Reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing

283 

Loans and advances to customers

3,784 

6,380 

29,578 

Amounts due from ultimate holding company

2,820 

2,949 

1,136 

Debt securities

15,288 

22,655 

39,645 

Equity shares

295 

1,127 

3,093 

Settlement balances

10 

31 

2,608 

Derivatives

4,782 

7,555 

19,138 

Deferred tax

40 

420 

444 

Prepayments, accrued income and other assets

1,853 

1,533 

5,913 

Assets of disposal groups

2,048 

13,804 

6,695 

Total assets

39,808 

70,954 

146,776 

  

  

  

  

Liabilities

  

  

  

Bank deposits

7,233 

21,841 

29,988 

Repurchase agreements and stock lending

11,710 

12,624 

16,532 

Deposits by banks

18,943 

34,465 

46,520 

Customers deposits

4,118 

2,620 

38,842 

Repurchase agreements and stock lending

33 

18 

759 

Customer accounts

4,151 

2,638 

39,601 

Debt securities in issue

1,319 

2,602 

17,714 

Settlement balances and short positions

105 

107 

3,409 

Derivatives

5,862 

9,644 

19,868 

Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities

1,065 

1,782 

3,895 

Deferred tax

63 

40 

201 

Subordinated liabilities

4,951 

6,851 

6,859 

Liabilities of disposal groups

407 

11,026 

5,293 

Total liabilities

36,866 

69,155 

143,360 

  

  

  

  

Non-controlling interests

— 

— 

21 

Controlling interests

2,942 

1,799 

3,395 

Total equity

2,942 

1,799 

3,416 

  

  

  

  

Total liabilities and equity

39,808 

70,954 

146,776 

 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             22 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

Commentary on consolidated balance sheet

2013 compared with 2012

Total assets were €39.8 billion at 31 December 2013, a decrease of €31.2 billion, or 44%, when compared with €71.0 billion at 31 December 2012.

 

Cash and balances at central banks increased by €0.9 billion or 39% to €3.2 billion at 31 December 2013.

 

Loans and advances to banks decreased by €6.5 billion, or 53%, to €5.7 billion at 31 December 2013 principally due the transfer of businesses to RBS plc during the year.

 

Loans and advances to customers declined €2.6 billion, or 41%, to €3.8 billion. This reflected the transfer of businesses to RBS plc during the year, in particular within International Banking division.

 

Debt securities decreased by €7.4 billion to €15.3 billion, reflecting bond maturities, the transfer of businesses to RBS plc and the sale of part of the liquidity portfolio.

 

Equity shares decreased by €0.8 billion to €0.3 billion. This reflected the transfer of businesses to RBS plc.

 

Derivative assets decreased by €2.8 billion, or 37%, to €4.8 billion, and Derivative liabilities decreased by €3.8 billion, or 39%, to €5.9 billion, this was largely attributable to the transfer of businesses to RBS plc.

 

The decrease in assets and liabilities of disposal groups is due to the completion of transfers to RBS plc in 2013. These businesses were held for disposal as at 31 December 2012. 

 

Deposits by banks decreased by €15.5 billion, 45%, to €18.9 billion, with lower repurchase agreements and stock lending (repos), down €0.9 billion, 7%, to €11.7 billion. This reduction is mainly due to the transfer of businesses to RBS plc during the year. In addition the decrease is due to planned reductions in funding from RBS plc.

 

Customer accounts were up €1.5 billion, 57%, to €4.1 billion.

 

Debt securities in issue declined €1.3 billion, 49%, to €1.3 billion largely decreases in notes and commercial paper reflecting reduced positions in Markets and Group Treasury.

 

Owners equity increased by €1.1 billion, 64%, to €2.9 billion, largely due to favourable mark-to-market movements on available-for-sale debt securities, offset by the attributable loss in the year.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             23 

 


 

 

 

Business review

 

2012 compared with 2011

Total assets were €71.0 billion at 31 December 2012, a decrease of €75.8 billion, or 52%, compared with €146.8 billion at 31 December 2011.

 

Cash and balances at central banks decreased by €10.3 billion or 82% to €2.3 billion due to reduced liquidity requirements following the transfer of businesses to RBS plc during the year, in particular the Dutch Scheme. In addition the decrease is due to the 2013 Transfers being classified as assets of disposal groups (€3.5 billion).

 

Loans and advances to banks decreased by €13.7 billion, or 53%, to €12.2 billion principally due the transfer of businesses to RBS plc during the year, in particular the Dutch Scheme. In addition the decrease is due to the 2013 Transfers being classified as assets of disposal groups (€1.2 billion) and a decline in bank placings.

 

Loans and advances to customers declined €23.2 billion, or 78%, to €6.4 billion. This reflected the transfer of businesses to RBS plc during the year, in particular the International Banking businesses included within the Dutch Scheme. In addition the decrease is due to the 2013 Transfers being classified as assets of disposal groups (€2.3 billion).

 

Debt securities decreased by €17.0 billion to €22.7 billion, reflecting a reduction in holdings of eurozone government and financial institution bonds (€9.8 billion), the transfer of businesses to RBS plc as part of the Dutch Scheme and the 2013 Transfers being classified as assets of disposal groups (€2.7 billion).

 

Equity shares decreased by €2.0 billion to €1.1 billion. This reflected the transfer of businesses to RBS plc as part of the Dutch Scheme.

 

Derivative assets decreased by €11.6 billion, or 61%, to €7.6 billion, and Derivative liabilities decreased by €10.2 billion, or 52%, to €9.6 billion this was largely attributable to the transfer of businesses to RBS plc as part of the Dutch Scheme.

 

The increase in assets and liabilities of disposal groups is due to the inclusion of the 2013 Transfers. These businesses are part of the Transfers for 2013 that meet the IFRS 5 definition of being held for disposal as at 31 December 2012.

 

Deposits by banks decreased by €12.1 billion, or 26%, to €34.5 billion, with lower repurchase agreements and stock lending (repos), down €3.9 billion, 24%, to €12.6 billion. This reduction is mainly due to the transfer of businesses to RBS plc during the year, in particular the Dutch Scheme. In addition the decrease is due to the downsizing of the fiduciary business in Markets and planned reductions in funding from RBS plc. This was partially offset by an increase in funding provided by the European Central Bank’s Long Term Refinancing Operation (LTRO).

 

Customer accounts were down €37.0 billion, or 93%, to €2.6 billion, mainly due to the transfer of businesses to RBS plc during the year, in particular the Dutch Scheme. 

 

Debt securities in issue declined €15.1 billion, or 85%, to €2.6 billion, largely as a result of the transfer of businesses to RBS plc during the year, in particular the Dutch Scheme and a decrease in notes and commercial paper outstanding reflecting positions maturing in Markets and Group Treasury.

 

Owners equity decreased by €1.6 billion, or 47%, to €1.8 billion, largely driven by the Dutch Scheme.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             24 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

Risk and balance sheet management

26

Risk governance

28

Risk appetite

33

Capital management

37

Liquidity and funding risk

40

Credit risk

47

Balance sheet analysis

57

Country risk

63

Market risk

72

Other risks

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             25 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Introduction

Risk and balance sheet management are conducted on an overall basis within RBS Group. Therefore the discussion on risk and balance sheet management on pages 25 to 77 refers principally to policies and procedures in RBS Group that also apply to RBSH Group.

 

Risk governance*

Governance structure

Risk and balance sheet management strategies are owned and set by the Managing Board of RBSH Group and are implemented by the executive management. A number of committees and executives support the execution of the business plan and strategy. Two of these committees are dedicated to RBSH Group and report to the RBSH Group Managing Board. These are depicted and described in the structure chart and table below. Matters not specifically delegated are reserved for the Managing Board.

   
 
 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 


There are also risk functions and committees that cover RBS Group and (parts of) RBSH Group reflecting the integrated manner in which the business is managed within RBS Group. Service level agreements are in place between RBSH Group and RBS Group to accommodate this integrated risk management oversight, including escalation procedures to the RBSH Group Managing Board as appropriate.

 

The management of risk in RBS Group is carried out through two independent risk management functions - RBS Risk Management and Group Conduct and Regulatory Affairs - which manage risk through independent oversight and challenge of the customer-facing businesses and support functions. The functions provide an overarching risk control framework.

 

A number of key committees specifically consider risk across RBS Group including RBSH Group.

 

RBS Group Board - Sets and owns RBS Group’s risk appetite, which is cascaded across its divisions, functions and material legal entities. It also sets RBS Group’s strategic direction and carries out regular assessments to ensure that strategic plans are consistent with risk appetite.

 

RBS Board Risk Committee - Provides oversight and advice on current and potential risk exposures, risk strategy and tolerance. The Committee also promotes a risk awareness culture within RBS Group.

 

RBS Group Executive Committee - Operates under delegated authority from Group Board and considers emerging issues material to both the Group’s strategy and risk exposures. The Group Executive Committee also oversees control frameworks.

 

RBS Executive Risk Forum - Provides executive input to the Group Board and the Group Executive Committee on risk management issues such as risk appetite, risk policies and risk management strategies. It has full authority to act on all material and/or enterprise-wide risk and control matters across the Group and implements Group Board and Group Executive Committee risk management decisions.

 

Risk management

The RBS Group Chief Risk Officer leads the RBS Risk Management function through the strategic setting and execution of its responsibilities reports to the RBS Group Chief Executive and the RBS Group Board Risk Committee. The Group Chief Risk Officer also has a right of access to the RBSG Chairman.

 

RBS Risk Management is designed to align as closely as possible with the customer-facing businesses and support functions while maintaining an appropriate level of independence, which underpins RBS Group’s approach to risk management and is reinforced through RBS Group by appropriate reporting lines from divisions to RBS Risk Management and from RBS Risk Management to senior executives, boards and committees.

 

In RBS Risk Management, the following RBS Group functional heads report directly to the RBS Group Chief Risk Officer and are responsible for firm-wide risk appetite and standards under their respective disciplines:

 

·         RBS Group Head of Operational Risk;

·         RBS Group Chief Credit Officer;

·         Head of Enterprise Risk Management;

·         Head of Global Country Risk; and

·         Chief Operating Officer, RBS Risk Management;

 

The RBSH Group Chief Risk Officer also has a reporting line into the RBS Group Chief Risk Officer.

  

Risk management within RBSH Group focuses on all material risks including credit, market, operational, regulatory and country risk and business activities. Liquidity risk and the day-to-day management of liquidity and funding of the book are the responsibility of RBSH Group Treasury (refer to page 38).

 

For a summary of the main risk types faced by RBSH Group and how it manages each of them, refer to pages 30 to 32.

unaudited

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             26 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

The following table shows details of the key Boards and Committees and their responsibilities.

 

Board/Committee

Responsibilities

Supervisory Board

 

Membership

Consists of five members. Three are executives of RBS Group.

The Supervisory Board is responsible for supervising RBSH Group’s management and RBSH Group’s general affairs and the business connected with it and for advising the Managing Board.

 

Managing Board

 

Membership

RBSH Group Chairman, RBSH Group Chief Administrative Officer (CAO), RBSH Group Chief Financial Officer (CFO) and RBSH Group Chief Risk Officer (CRO).

The Managing Board reports to the Supervisory Board and is the principal decision-making forum for RBSH Group. It sets the policy framework, the operating structure and the yearly plan, including objectives and budgets. All members of the Managing Board have responsibility for RBSH Group. As well as their overall corporate responsibilities, the members of the Managing Board each manage one or more units, for which they have primary responsibility.

RBSH Group Risk and Control Committee (RCC)

 

Membership

Chaired by the RBSH Group CRO. Members include RBSH Group CFO, RBS NV Head of Risk Office/Senior NV Risk Manager, NV delegates of RBS Group Credit, Market, and Operational Risk, RBS NV Head of Conduct & Regulatory Affairs, CROs for RBS NV Asia Pacific and Americas.

 

 

The responsibilities of the RCC include:

·         Advising the Managing Board on the risk appetite of RBSH Group. They receive direction from the Managing Board on risk appetite;

·         Providing input to the RBSH Group risk-appetite-setting process in the context of the Group’s overall risk appetite;

·         Overseeing the risk framework within RBSH Group and reporting directly to the RBSH Group Managing Board on the performance of the framework and on issues arising from it;

·         Monitoring the actual risk profile of RBSH Group and ensure that this remains within the boundaries of the agreed risk appetite or escalate excesses to the RBSH Group Managing Board. Prior to escalation, the RCC can ask the appropriate risk committee in RBS Group or in the division that in the normal course of business monitors and controls the risk item that is in excess to address the excess; and

·         The remit of the Committee includes credit, market, operational and regulatory risk within RBS N.V. Any changes to the terms of reference of the RBSH Group RCC must be approved by the RBSH Group Managing Board. To execute its authority, the RCC has access to all relevant risk information relating to RBSH Group available within RBS Group including escalations from and to Group or divisional committees.

RBSH Group Asset and Liability Committee (ALCO)

 

Membership

Nine permanent voting members led by the RBSH Group Chairman of the Managing Board. The other Committee members are: RBSH Group CFO; RBSH Group CAO; RBSH Group CRO; RBS NV Treasurer; EMEA Treasurer; Markets Treasurer; International Banking Treasurer; and the Global Head of Equity and Liquidity Management.

 

 

 

 

The mandate of ALCO covers the following specific areas in respect of RBSH Group:

·         The overall governance responsibility for the strategic management of the RBSH Group balance sheet;

·         The review, approval and allocation of balance sheet, capital, liquidity and funding limits;

·         The liquidity, funding, foreign exchange and interest rate exposures of RBSH Group’s balance sheet;

·         The balance sheet structure and RWA position of RBSH Group;

·         Decisions on capital repatriation and loss coverage;

·         Compliance with all regulatory requirements at all times;

·         The implementation and maintenance of transfer pricing policies (although setting the liquidity spread curve remains the responsibility of the RBS Group  ALCO);

·         The approval and implementation within RBSH Group of RBS Group Treasury policies and procedures; and

·         Oversight of retained business (shared assets) and residual ABN AMRO business.

 

 

 

 

 

*unaudited  

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             27 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Conduct and Regulatory Affairs

Created in August 2013, by combining RBS Group Compliance (previously part of RBS Risk Management) and RBS Regulatory Affairs (formerly part of RBS Legal), RBS Group Conduct and Regulatory Affairs is led by the RBS Group Head of Conduct and Regulatory Affairs, who reports directly to the RBS Group Chief Executive and the RBS Board Risk Committee.

 

Three lines of defence

A strong three lines of defence model is an important element of a robust control environment. The model’s main purpose is to define accountabilities and responsibilities for managing risk across RBS Group.

 

1st line of defence - Business units including all business areas and functions are accountable for owning and managing the risks which exist in their business area within a defined risk appetite and framework.

 

2nd line of defence - Independent monitoring and control functions, as well as RBS Group policy standard owners, are accountable for owning and developing the risk and control frameworks and tools which the 1st line of defence uses to discharge its responsibilities. The 2nd line of defence must be appropriately independent from the business and accountable for overseeing and challenging the 1st line of defence on the effective management of its risks.

 

3rd line of defence - RBSH Group Internal Audit provides independent assurance on the appropriateness of the design and operational effectiveness of risk management and internal control processes that

mitigate RBSH Group’s key risks.

 

Risk appetite*

RBSH Group’s risk appetite identifies and establishes the level and type of risks that it is able and willing to take in executing its chosen business strategy, to protect itself against events that may have an adverse impact on its profitability or its capital base. RBSH Group has developed a framework that sets and implements an appropriate risk appetite supported by a regular monitoring and review process. A risk appetite statement setting out overall risk limits for different risk types is approved by the Supervisory Board. Risk appetite limits and risk exposures are reported monthly to the RCC, the Managing Board and the Supervisory Board. Any limit breach is reported to the Managing Board. The Managing Board may grant a temporary waiver or require the position to be adjusted to comply with the risk limit. For limits other than risk appetite limits authority has been delegated to the RCC, ALCO and, for certain market risk limits, the Head of Market Risk. The RBS NV RCC and ALCO each have three or more Managing Board members.

 

Strategic risk objectives

Risk management plays an integral role in the delivery of the RBS Group’s strategic goal to be a safe and secure banking group. The implementation of a stronger and more effective culture of risk management and control provides the platform necessary to address historical vulnerabilities, rebuild upon the RBS Group’s core strengths and position it on a sustainable and profitable path for future growth.

 

In 2009 the RBS Group Board set out four key strategic objectives, aligned with RBS Group’s Strategic Plan. These are to:

 

·         Maintain capital adequacy;

·         Deliver stable earnings growth;

·         Ensure stable and efficient access to funding and liquidity; and

·         Maintain stakeholder confidence.

  

Each objective is essential in its own right, but also mutually supportive of the others. The strategic risk objectives are the bridge between the RBS Group-level business strategy and the frameworks, limits and tolerances that are used to set risk appetite and manage risk in the business divisions on a day-to-day basis.

 

This is how we bring our Strategic Plan to life in our management of risk.

   
 
 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 


Risk appetite measures

A range of different but complementary tools have been developed to measure whether strategic plans are consistent with risk appetite, to test broader ‘what if’ questions and to assess the impact of changes in key assumptions:

·         Integrated stress testing - assesses how earnings, capital and funding positions change under an unfavourable, yet plausible, scenario. Stress scenarios can differ by theme, geographical location or severity.

·         Economic capital - provides complementary insights, with a breadth of understanding of risk profile changes and ‘tail risks’ generated by simulating millions of different scenarios.

·         Sensitivity analysis - provides ‘ready reckoners’ around changes in key variables. It provides a high-level view on questions such as ‘what if gross domestic product worsened by a further 1%’, identifying certain tipping points where the RBS Group’s risk profile moves outside appetite.

*unaudited  

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             28 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Risk control frameworks and limits

Risk control frameworks and their associated limits are an integral part of the risk appetite framework and a key part of embedding risk appetite targets in day-to-day risk management.

 

Risk appetite has its own policy standard within the RBS Group Policy Framework that sets out clear roles and responsibilities to measure, cascade and report performance against risk appetite, as well as to provide assurances that business is being conducted within approved risk limits and tolerances.

 

Culture, values and remuneration

Objectives for risk culture

Risk culture plays a key role in the RBS Group’s ambition to build ‘a really good bank’. A strong risk culture is a key part of ensuring risk appetite is effectively embedded across the RBS Group.

 

Risk culture policies

The RBS Group values - ‘serving customers well’, ‘working together’, ‘doing the right thing’ and ‘thinking long term’ - act as a clear starting point for a strong and effective risk culture. A wide range of communication and engagement activities (detailed below) has been undertaken to discuss the meaning of each value with employees and how they impact upon and guide day-to-day activities.

 

The embedding of the RBS Group’s values into a strong risk culture is supported by a revised and more focused Code of Conduct. The Code provides guidance on expected behaviour and sets out the standards of conduct that support the RBS Group’s values. It explains the effect of decisions that are taken and describes the principles that must be followed.

 

These business principles cover conduct-related issues as well as wider business activities. They focus on desired outcomes, with practical guidelines to align the RBS Group’s values with its commercial strategy and actions. The embedding of business principles facilitates sound decision making and a clear focus on good customer outcomes in ‘the moments that matter’. It is aligned with the people management and remuneration processes to support a positive and strong risk culture through appropriate incentive structures.

 

Training

Across the risk management function, a series of events and activities have been undertaken to ‘bring alive’ the Group’s values and culture for employees. This is supported by performance management processes that hold individuals to account for poor behaviour and that the behaviour that supports our purpose, visions and values is rewarded.

 

Challenge mechanisms

A simple decision-making guide (called the ‘YES check’) has been included within the Code of Conduct. It is a simple, intuitive set of five questions, designed to ensure the values guide day-to-day decisions:

 

·         Does what I am doing keep our customers and the Bank safe and secure?

·         Would customers and colleagues say I am acting with integrity?

·         Am I happy with how this would be perceived on the outside?

·         Is what I am doing meeting the standards of conduct required?

·         In five years time would others see this as a good way to work?

 

Each question contains a little prompt to think about the situation and how it fits with the values. It ensures that employees can think through decisions that don’t have a clear answer, guiding the way they think and the judgements behind their decisions and actions.

 

Risk-based key performance indicators

Our policy standards require all current Code Staff roles to use a balanced scorecard approach to performance management. This ensures a balance between financial and non-financial metrics, including an evaluation of adherence to internal controls and risk management. Since 2011, there has been an enhanced requirement for all Code Staff roles to have specific risk objectives within their performance plan.

 

Unvested awards are subject to clawback and may be reduced, or forfeited in full, at the discretion of the RBS Group Performance and Remuneration Committee.

 

Awards to employees under the RBS Group's long term incentive plan are subject to financial and operational measures and an underlying requirement for effective risk management during the performance period.

 

The Group Performance and Remuneration Committee has put in place a RBS Group-wide remuneration policy which is explicitly aligned to effective risk management. Performance is a key input into the determining of remuneration levels

 

Risk coverage

We continued to strengthen our approach to risk management amid a challenging and ever-changing external environment. Areas of progress included:

 

·         The completion of the phased roll-out of the RBS Group's conduct risk policies and of a more effective operating model, supported by the development and delivery of awareness initiatives and targeted training;

·         The introduction of a new integrated operating model for managing regulatory developments, which combines divisional and functional teams to leverage expertise more effectively; and

·         Further strengthening our credit risk and country risk appetite and management frameworks.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             29 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

The main risk types faced by the RBSH Group are presented below, together with a summary of the key areas of focus and how the RBSH Group managed these risks in 2013.

 

Risk type

Definition

Features

How RBSH Group manages risk and the focus in 2013

Capital adequacy risk

The risk that the RBSH Group has insufficient capital.

 

Arises from: Inefficient management of capital resources.

 

Character and impact: Characterised typically by credit risk losses.

 

It has the potential to disrupt the business model and stop normal business activities. It also has the potential to cause the RBSH Group to fail to meet regulatory requirements.

The RBSH Group’s Core Tier 1 ratio on a Basel 2.5 basis was 20.5%. RBSH Group plans for and maintains an adequate amount and mix of capital consistent with its risk profile. The amount of capital required is determined through risk assessments and stress testing.

 

Refer to pages 33 to 36.

Liquidity and funding risk

The risk that the RBSH Group is unable to meet its financial liabilities as they fall due.

Arises from: RBSH Group’s day-to-day operations.

 

Character and impact: Dependent on company-specific factors such as maturity profile and composition of sources and uses of funding, the quality and size of liquid asset buffer as well as broader market factors.

 

It can result in RBSH Group failing to meet regulatory liquidity requirements, unable to support normal banking activity or at worst ceasing to be a going concern. Adverse impact on customer and investor confidence in the RBSH Group and the wider financial system is also possible.

Refer to pages 37 to 39.

Credit risk

The risk that the RBSH Group will incur losses owing to the failure of a customer or counterparty to meet its obligation to settle outstanding amounts.

Arises from: Deterioration of the credit quality of Counterparties or customers of the RBSH Group, leaving them unable to meet their contractual obligations.

 

Character and impact: Losses can vary materially across portfolios and may include concentration risk - the risk of loss due to the concentration of credit risk related to a specific product, asset class, sector or counterparty.

 

It has the potential to affect adversely the RBSH Group’s financial performance and capital.

RBSH Group manages credit risk based on a suite of credit approval and risk concentration frameworks and associated risk management systems and tools. 

 

Refer to pages 40 to 46.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

*unaudited  

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             30 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Risk type

Definition

Features

How the RBSH Group manages risk and the focus in 2013

Country risk

The risk of material losses arising from significant country-specific events.

Arises from: Sovereign events, economic events, political events, natural disasters or conflicts.

 

Potential to affect parts of the RBSH Group’s credit portfolio that are directly or indirectly linked to the country in question.

RBS Group Country Risk manages country risk matters including risk appetite; risk management strategy and framework; risk exposure and policy; sovereign ratings; sovereign loss-given-default rates; and country Watchlist colours, with escalation where needed to the Managing Board and where appropriate to the Supervisory Board.

 

Regular, detailed reviews are carried out on all portfolios to ensure they remain in line with the country risk appetite and reflect evolving economic and political developments.

 

A country risk Watchlist process identifies emerging issues and assists in the development of mitigation strategies. In 2013, the scope of this process was widened to include all countries with RBS Group exposure.

 

Balance sheet exposure to the eurozone periphery countries continued to fall, and was down by 21% to €6.9 billion at the end of 2013.

 

Refer to pages 57 to 62.

Market risk

The risk arising from fluctuations in interest rates, foreign currency, credit spreads, equity prices, commodity prices and risk-related factors such as market volatilities that may lead to a reduction in earnings, economic value or both.

Arises from: Adverse movements in market prices.

 

Character and impact: Characterised by frequent small losses, which are material in aggregate, and infrequent large material losses due to stress events.

 

It has the potential to materially affect Group Treasury where RBSH Group has important exposures. RBSH Group’s non-trading activities in retail and commercial businesses can also be affected through interest rate risk and foreign exchange non traded exposures.

During 2013, RBSH Group continued to reduce its risk exposures. Average trading value-at-risk (VaR) decreased from €4.4 million to €2.0 million, reflecting risk reduction and capital management focus.

 

Refer to pages 63 to 71.

 

 

Pension risk

The risk to a firm caused by its contractual or other liabilities to, or with respect to, its pension schemes, whether established for its employees or for those of a related company or otherwise.

Arises from: Variation in market value of pension scheme assets owing to interest rates, inflation, credit spreads, and equity and property prices.

 

Character and impact: Pension schemes’ funding positions can be volatile due to the uncertainty of future investment returns and the projected value of schemes’ liabilities. RBSH Group might have to make financial contributions to, or with respect to, pension schemes.

Refer to pages 108 and 109.

 

 

 

 

 

*unaudited  

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             31 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Risk type

Definition

Features

How the RBSH Group managed risk and the focus in 2013

Regulatory risk

The risk arising from non-compliance with regulatory requirements, regulatory change or regulator expectations.

Arises from: Developments in the regulatory environment and RBSH Group’s responses to them.

 

Character and impact: Adverse impact on strategy, capital structure, business models and operational effectiveness.

 

Financial impact of adapting to changes in laws, rules or regulations or of penalties for non-compliance.

 

Financial impact and reputational damage in respect of penalties for non-compliance/breach of regulations.

The management of regulatory (as well as conduct) risks in the Bank is overseen by RBS Group’s Conduct and Regulatory Affairs function. 

 

RBS Group’s existing Compliance and Regulatory Affairs teams were brought together in the second half of 2013, following the creation of the role of Group Head of Conduct and Regulatory Affairs. The Conduct and Regulatory Affairs function has responsibility for setting RBS Group wide policy and standards, providing advice to the business and ensuring controls are effective for managing regulatory affairs, compliance and financial crime risks across all businesses.

 

Other enhancements were also made during 2013 included the creation of a more centralised approach to assurance activities and the introduction of a new ‘Centres of Excellence’ model for the management of regulatory developments, bringing together divisional and functional resources.

Reputational risk

The risk of brand damage and/or financial loss due to the failure to meet stakeholders’ expectations of RBSH Group.

Arises from: Actions taken (or, in some cases, not taken) by the RBSH Group, as well as its wider policies and practices.

 

Character and impact: Can result in an inability to build or sustain customer relationships, in low staff morale, in regulatory censure, or in reduced access to funding.

The Managing Board, supported by all businesses, is responsible for the reputation of RBSH Group. The reputational risk framework is aligned with RBS Group’s focus on serving customers well, its strategic objectives and the risk appetite goal of maintaining stakeholder confidence.

 

In 2013, the environmental, social and ethical risk management function was set up to address the reputational risk associated with the clients the RBS Group chooses to do business with.  It sets policy and provides guidance to avoid reputational risk relating to business engagements and lending to clients in sensitive industry sectors.

Business risk

The risk of losses as a result of adverse variance in the RBSH Group’s revenues and/or costs relative to its business plan and strategy.

Arises from: Internal factors such as volatility in pricing, sales volumes and input costs, and/or by external factors such as exposure to macroeconomic, regulatory and industry risks.

 

Character and impact: Can lead to adverse changes in revenues and/or costs.

Management of business risk is delegated to the CFO, with oversight from RBS Group Finance.

 

In 2013 the focus was on controlling RBSH Group’s exposure to business risk. RBSH Group’s rolling forecast process identified projected changes in, or risks to, operating profit and ensured appropriate action was taken.

 

 

Strategic risk

The risk that the RBSH Group will make inappropriate strategic choices.

Arises from: RBSH Group’s management of its strategy.

 

Character and impact: Varied losses affecting earnings, capital, liquidity and customer and stakeholder confidence.

Key strategies are scrutinised and approved by the RBSH Group Board.

 

 

 

Each risk type maps into RBSH Group’s risk appetite framework and contributes to the overall achievement of its strategic objectives with underlying frameworks and limits. The key frameworks and developments over the past year are described in the relevant sections of the pages that follow.

 

 

 

 

*unaudited

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             32 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Capital management*

Introduction

Capital adequacy risk is the risk that the Group has insufficient capital.  The Group aims to maintain an appropriate level of capital to meet its business needs and regulatory requirements, and operates within an agreed risk appetite.

 

The appropriate level of capital is determined based on the dual aims of: (i) meeting minimum regulatory capital requirements; and (ii) ensuring the Group maintains sufficient capital to uphold customer, investor and rating agency confidence in the organisation, thereby supporting the business franchise and funding capacity.

 

2013 overview

RBSH Group’s Tier 1 ratio of 23.2% is higher than the end of 2012, primarily reflecting transfers to RBS plc of businesses in Russia, Romania, Korea and North America. There were also further reductions in the Non-Core portfolio. The de-risking in RBSH Group has been effective in reducing the impacts of stress scenarios and at the same time the capital ratios have been improving, resulting in increased capital buffers. In the second half of 2013 RBSH Group has bought back from the external market a large amount of subordinated Tier 2 capital. As these instruments had a maturity of less than five years, the regulatory impact was limited.

 

The capital allocation approaches used in RBSH Group will be developed to become increasingly risk sensitive and align risk management and resource allocation more fully.

 

Governance

Governance and approach

RBSH Group Asset and Liability Management Committee (ALCO) is responsible for ensuring RBSH Group maintains adequate capital at all times. The RBS Group Capital and Stress Testing Committee (CAST) is a cross-functional body driving and directing integrated risk capital activities including determination of the amount of capital RBSH Group should hold, how and where capital is allocated and planning for actions that would ensure that an adequate capital position would be maintained in a stressed environment. These activities have linkages to capital planning, risk appetite and regulatory change. CAST reports through ALCO and comprises senior representatives from RBSH Group Risk, RBSH Group Finance and RBSH Group Treasury. 

 

Determining appropriate capital

The minimum regulatory capital requirements are identified by RBSH Group through the Internal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process and then agreed between Managing Board and the appropriate supervisory authority.

 

RBSH Group’s own determination of how much capital is sufficient is derived from the desired credit rating level, risk appetite and reflects the current and emerging regulatory requirements of RBSH Group.

 

It is evaluated through the application of both internally and externally defined stress tests that identify potential changes in capital ratios to a range of scenarios.

 

RBSH Group identifies the management and recovery actions that could be applied to stress environments. These form an important part of the capital management approach and the contingency planning arrangements, complementing the established buffers.

 

Monitoring and maintenance

Based on these determinations, which are continually reassessed, RBSH Group aims to maintain capital adequacy.

 

RBSH Group operates a rigorous capital planning process aimed at ensuring the capital position is controlled within the agreed parameters. This incorporates regular re-forecasts of the capital position of RBSH Group. In the event that the projected position deteriorates beyond acceptable levels, RBSH Group would revise business plans accordingly.

 

Stress testing approaches are used to continually determine the level of capital required to ensure RBSH Group remains adequately capitalised.

 

Capital allocation

Capital resources are allocated to RBSH Group’s businesses based on key performance parameters agreed by the Managing Board in the annual strategic planning process. Principal among these is a profitability metric, which assesses the effective use of the capital allocated to the business. Projected and actual return on equity is assessed against the target returns set by the Managing Board. The allocations also reflect strategic priorities, the intensity of regulatory capital use and the usage of other key RBSH Group resources such as balance sheet and liquidity and funding.

 

RBSH Group aims to deliver sustainable returns across the portfolio of businesses with projected business returns stressed to test key vulnerabilities.

 

RBSH Group has regard to the supervisory requirements of De Nederlandsche Bank (DNB). The DNB uses the capital ratio as a measure of capital adequacy in the Netherlands banking sector, comparing a bank’s capital resources with its risk-weighted assets (the assets and off-balance sheet exposures are weighted to reflect the inherent credit and other risks); by international agreement, the total capital ratio should be not less than 8% with a Tier 1 capital ratio of not less than 4%.

 

*unaudited  

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             33 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Capital management*

Capital ratios and risk-weighted assets (RWAs) based on Basel II (CRD III)

RBSH Group aims to maintain an appropriate level of capital to meet its business needs and regulatory requirements. RBSH Group’s capital ratios and RWAs are set out below.

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

Capital ratios

Core Tier 1

20.5 

11.7 

8.6 

Tier 1

23.2 

13.9 

12.0 

Total

26.1 

19.8 

17.5 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

Risk-weighted assets

€m 

€m 

€m 

Credit risk

15,094 

26,336 

50,197 

Market risk (1)

1,171 

3,389 

5,353 

Operational risk

1,088 

2,994 

3,163 

Settlement risk

32 

20 

  

17,385 

32,739 

58,713 

  

  

  

  

Note:

(1)    Market risk RWAs in 2011 were largely impacted by the new CRD III rules.

 

With effect from 30 June 2010, RBSH Group migrated to Basel II status. For the majority of credit risk, RBSH Group uses the advanced internal ratings based approach for calculating RWAs.

 

Risk-weighted assets for 2013 continued to reduce due to changes in the structure of the balance sheet following the Transfers to RBS plc and reductions in Non-Core.

 

For operational risk, RBSH Group uses the 2013 basic indicator approach to calculate the operational risk capital charge. The de-risked and reduced size of the RBSH Group has lead to a lower capital charge for operational risk.

 

The market risk capital charge has been reduced mainly due to further transfers of trading book activities.

 

Capital ratios are higher than at 31 December 2012, reflecting the reduction in risk-weighted assets discussed above. This is partly offset by lower Tier 2 capital provided from RBSH Group. The transfers have therefore had a more positive impact on Core Tier 1 and Tier 1.

 

RBSH Group is consolidated for regulatory reporting within RBS Group. Pillar 3 information for RBSH Group is included within the RBS Group Pillar 3 disclosures.

 

RBS Group publishes its Pillar 3 Disclosures on its website, providing a range of additional information relating to Basel II and risk and capital management across RBS Group. Pillar 3 disclosures provide additional analysis of exposure at default and credit risk measures such as credit risk mitigation, counterparty credit risk and provisions and their associated RWAs under the various Basel II approaches.

 

 

 

 

*unaudited

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             34 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

Capital management* continued

  

  

  

Capital resources and flow statement

  

  

  

RBSH Group's regulatory capital resources were as follows:

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

Composition of regulatory capital

€m 

€m 

€m 

Tier 1

  

  

  

Controlling interests

2,942 

1,799 

3,395 

Non-controlling interests

— 

— 

21 

Adjustments for

  

  

  

  - Goodwill and other intangible assets

(1)

(4)

(10)

  - Unrealised losses on available-for-sale debt securities

883 

2,492 

3,066 

  - Unrealised gains on available-for-sale equities

(3)

(19)

(148)

  - Other regulatory adjustments

(260)

(442)

(1,298)

Core Tier 1 capital

3,561 

3,826 

5,026 

Innovative/hybrid Tier 1 securities

2,365 

2,470 

2,511 

Less deductions from Tier 1 capital

(1,887)

(1,757)

(475)

Total Tier 1 capital

4,039 

4,539 

7,062 

  

  

  

  

Tier 2

  

  

  

Unrealised gains on available-for-sale equities

19 

148 

Subordinated debt

1,552 

3,218 

3,699 

Less deductions from Tier 2 capital

(1,061)

(1,303)

(639)

Total Tier 2 capital

494 

1,934 

3,208 

  

  

  

  

Total regulatory capital

4,533 

6,473 

10,270 

  

  

  

  

The table below analyses the movement in Core Tier 1 capital during the year.

  

  

2013 

Movement in Core Tier 1 capital

€m 

At 1 January 2013

3,826 

Regulatory adjustment - fair value changes in own credit spreads

(115)

Foreign currency reserves

(67)

Loss of non-controlling interest and reduction in goodwill

Attributable loss

(135)

Transfer resulting from cross border merger

(246)

Other

295 

At 31 December 2013

3,561 

         

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

*unaudited

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             35 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Capital management* continued 

Basel III

The rules issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (BCBS), commonly referred to as Basel III, are a comprehensive set of reforms designed to strengthen the regulation, supervision, risk and liquidity management of the banking sector.

 

In December 2010, the BCBS issued the final text of the Basel III rules, providing details of the global standards agreed by the Group of Governors and Heads of Supervision, the oversight body of the BCBS and endorsed by the G20 leaders at their November 2010 Seoul summit.

 

The new capital requirements regulation and capital requirements directive that implement Basel III proposals within the European Union (collectively known as CRD IV) are in two parts, Capital Requirements Directive (CRD) and the Capital Requirements Regulation. Further technical detail will be provided by the European Banking Authority through its Implementing Technical Standards (ITS) and Regulatory Technical Standards.

 

The CRD IV has been agreed in June 2013 with an implementation date of 1 January 2014. Though some ITS will follow only at a later stage, some only in 2015.

 

The changes in the definition of regulatory capital under CRD IV and the capital ratios will be subject to transitional rules:

 

·         The increase in the minimum capital ratios and the new buffer requirements will be phased in over the five years from implementation of the CRD IV;

 

·         The application of the regulatory deductions and adjustments at the level of common equity, including the new deduction for deferred tax assets, will also be phased in over the five years from implementation; the current adjustment for unrealised gains and losses on available-for-sale securities will be phased out; and

 

·         Subordinated debt instruments which do not meet the new eligibility criteria will be will be grandfathered on a reducing basis over ten years.

 

Other regulatory capital changes

RBSH Group is managing the changes to capital requirements from new regulation and model changes and the resulting impact on the Common Equity Tier 1 ratio, focusing on risk reduction and deleveraging. This is principally being achieved through the transfers to RBS plc, the continued run-off and disposal of Non-Core assets and deleveraging in Markets as the business focuses on the most productive returns on capital.

 

The overall impacts of the regulatory changes are fully factored into the capital plans of RBSH Group and its businesses.

 

 

 

 

*unaudited

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             36 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

Liquidity and funding risk

38

Liquidity risk

39

Funding risk

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             37 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Liquidity and funding risk

Definition

Liquidity and funding risk is the risk that the RBSH Group is unable to meet its financial obligations, including financing wholesale maturities or customer deposit withdrawals, as and when they fall due.

 

The risk arises through the maturity transformation role that banks perform. It is dependent on company specific factors such as maturity profile, composition of sources and uses of funding, the quality and size of the liquidity portfolio as well as broader market factors, such as wholesale market conditions alongside depositor and investor behaviour.

 

Liquidity risk

Policy, framework and governance

The RBSH Group’s liquidity policy reflects internal appetite, best market practice and complies with prevailing regulatory structures. These policies are designed to address three broad issues which ensure that:

 

·          The RBSH Group maintains adequate liquid resources at all times to meet liabilities as they fall due.

 

·          The RBSH Group maintains an adequate liquid asset portfolio appropriate to the business activities of the Group and its risk profile.

 

·          The RBSH Group has in place robust strategies, policies, systems, and procedures for identifying, measuring, monitoring and managing liquidity risk.

 

·          The RBSH Group has a comprehensive liquidity risk management framework in place to ensure the Group maintains an appropriate level of financial resources to meet its financial obligations as and when they fall due.

 

The risk management framework determines the sources of liquidity risk and the steps the RBSH Group can take when these risks exceed certain actively monitored limits. These actions include when and how to use the RBSH Group’s liquidity reserves and what other adjustments to the RBSH Group’s balance sheet should be undertaken to manage these risks within the RBSH Group’s risk appetite.

 

In setting risk limits the RBSH Board takes into account the nature of the RBSH Group’s various activities, the RBSH Group’s overall risk appetite, market best practice and regulatory compliance.

 

Regulatory oversight*

RBSH Group is subject to the De Nederlandsche Bank’s (DNB) supervisory regime for liquidity and each member of RBSH Group also complies with their local regulatory framework for the assessment and management of liquidity risk as well as meeting internal standards.

 

Measurement and monitoring

In implementing the RBSH Group’s liquidity risk management framework, a suite of tools are used to monitor, limit and stress test the risks within the balance sheet. The limits control the amount and composition of funding sources, asset and liability mismatches and funding concentrations, in addition to the level of liquidity risk.

 

Overall, RBSH Group’s liquidity risk appetite is set by the Managing Board. The RBSH Managing Board’s determination and quantification of the appetite for liquidity risk is primarily determined by reference to the Individual Liquidity Adequacy Assessment (ILAA) which includes a comparison of the size of liquidity portfolio to an assessment of stressed outflows. The ILAA also informs the RBSH Board and DNB of the RBSH Group’s liquidity risks, their mitigation and about the current and future liquidity profile.

 

Within the liquidity portfolio the Group holds cash at central banks (€2.4 billion), high quality government securities (€0.1 billion) and collateral eligible for use in central bank operations (€0.9 billion).

 

Stress testing and contingency planning*

Liquidity stress tests apply scenario-based behavioural and contractual assumptions to cash inflows and outflows to assess the level of liquidity reserves required under a particular scenario.

 

A stress event can occur when either firm-specific or market-wide factors or a combination of both lead to depositors and investors withdrawing or not renewing funding on maturity. This could be caused by many factors including fears over the viability of the firm. Additionally, liquidity stress can be brought on by customers choosing to draw down on loan agreements and facilities.

 

Simulated liquidity stress testing is performed at least quarterly for each division as well as the major operating subsidiaries in order to evaluate the strength of the RBSH Group’s liquidity risk management.

 

Stress tests are designed to examine the impact of a variety of firm-specific and market-wide scenarios on the future adequacy of the RBSH Group’s liquidity reserves. Stress test scenarios are designed to take into account the RBSH Group’s experiences during the financial crisis, recent market conditions and events. These scenarios can be run at any time in response to the emergence of firm-specific or market-wide risks that could have a material impact on the RBSH Group’s liquidity position. In the past these have included credit rating changes and political and economic conditions changing in particular countries.

 

In determining the adequacy of the RBSH Group’s liquidity resources the RBSH Group focuses on the outflows it anticipates as a result of any stress scenario occurring. These outflows are measured over certain time periods which extend from two weeks to three months. The RBSH Group is expected to be able to withstand these stressed outflows through its own resources (primarily through the use of the liquidity portfolio) without having to resort to extraordinary central bank or governmental assistance.

 

The RBSH Group’s liquidity risk appetite is measured by reference to the liquidity portfolio as a percentage of stressed contractual and behavioural outflows under the worst of three severe stress scenarios, as prescribed by the PRA. These are a market-wide stress, an idiosyncratic stress and a combination of both.

*unaudited

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             38 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Liquidity and funding risk continued

The RBSH Group has a Contingency Funding Plan (CFP), which is updated at least annually and as the balance sheet evolves and forms the basis of analysis and actions to remediate adverse events as and if they arise. The CFP provides a detailed description of the availability, size and timing of all sources of contingent liquidity available to the Group in a stress event. These are ranked in order of economic impact and effectiveness to meet the anticipated stress requirement. The CFP includes documented processes for actions that may be required to meet the outflows and specifies roles and responsibilities for the effective implementation of the CFP. RBSH Group’s CFP is fully integrated with the CFP of RBS Group.

 

Liquidity reserves

RBSH Group analyses its liquidity portfolio including its locally managed liquidity pools into primary and secondary liquidity groups. The primary liquidity group generally reflects core eligible liquid assets, such as cash and balances at central banks, treasury bills and other high quality government and agency bonds, and other local primary qualifying liquid assets for each of the significant operating subsidiaries that maintain a local liquidity pool. Secondary liquidity assets represent other qualifying liquid assets that are eligible for local central bank liquidity facilities but do not meet the core local regulatory definition. 

 

RBSH Group’s liquidity portfolio is managed by RBSH Group Treasury. In addition, local liquidity reserves are the responsibility of local Treasurers who report to the RBSH Group Treasurer functionally.

 

RBSH Group in consultation with the DNB and subject to the applicable limits can change the composition of its liquidity portfolio. The change in composition may relate to market specific factors, changes in internal liquidity risk appetite or regulatory guidance.

 

Funding risk

Funding sources

As part of the reduction in RBSH Group’s balance sheet, RBSH Group’s strategy has been to limit access to external funding sources across the globe, including short-term money markets, repurchase agreement markets and term debt investors through its secured and unsecured funding programmes. Funding is now concentrated with RBS Group, who given their active role in the money markets, along with access to global capital flows through its international client base provide funding to ensure RBSH Group’s funding is well diversified by currency, geography, maturity and type

 

RBSH Group may access various funding facilities offered by central banks from time to time. The use of such facilities can be both part of a wider strategic objective to support initiatives to help stimulate economic growth or as part of RBSH Group’s broader liquidity management and funding strategy. Overall usage and repayment of available central bank facilities will fit within RBSH Group’s overall liquidity risk appetite and concentration limits contained therein so as not to create outsized maturity exposures. During 2013, RBSH Group repaid the €3.5 billion drawn down under the European Central Banks’ Long Term Refinancing Operation.

 

The table below shows RBSH Group’s principal funding sources excluding repurchase agreements. 

 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

  

2012 

  

2011 

  

€m 

  

€m 

  

€m 

Deposits by banks

7,233 

41.0 

  

21,841 

64.4 

  

29,988 

32.1 

Debt securities in issue

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Commercial paper

— 

— 

  

— 

  

1,563 

1.7 

  Certificates of deposit

— 

— 

  

108 

0.3 

  

2,326 

2.5 

  Medium term notes and other bonds (including securitisations)

1,319 

7.5 

  

2,486 

7.4 

  

13,825 

14.8 

  

1,319 

7.5 

  

2,602 

7.7 

  

17,714 

19.0 

Subordinated liabilities

4,951 

28.1 

  

6,851 

20.2 

  

6,859 

7.3 

Wholesale funding

13,503 

76.6 

  

31,294 

92.3 

  

54,561 

58.4 

Customer deposits

4,118 

23.4 

  

2,620 

7.7 

  

38,842 

41.6 

Total funding

17,621 

100.0 

  

33,914 

100.0 

  

93,403 

100.0 

 

Key points

·         Wholesale funding decreased €17.8 billion to €13.5 billion principally reflecting strategic downsizing in Markets.

 

·         Of the €13.5 billion wholesale funding 44% or €6.0 billion (2012 - €15.9 billion and 50%) related to bank deposits from fellow subsidiaries.

 

·         Repurchase agreement funding from fellow subsidiaries was €11.7 billion at 31 December 2013 (2012 - €12.6 billion).

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             39 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

Credit risk

 

41

Risk management

43

Risk measurement

44

Lending

44

Early problem identification and problem debt management

45

RBSG Global Restructuring Group (GRG)

45

Wholesale forbearance

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             40 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Credit risk

Risk management is conducted on an overall basis within RBS Group. Therefore the discussion on pages 41 to 46 refer principally to policies and procedures in RBS Group that also apply to RBSH Group.

 

Definition

Credit risk is the risk of financial loss due to the failure of a customer or counterparty to meet its obligation to settle outstanding amounts.

 

Sources of credit risk

The RBSH Group is exposed to credit risk primarily as a result of debt securities held for liquidity management purposes. The RBSH Group is also exposed to credit risk through wholesale lending, derivatives and through off balance sheet products such as trade finance and guarantees.

 

Credit risk governance

A strong credit risk management function is vital to support the ongoing profitability of the RBS Group. The potential for loss is mitigated through a robust credit risk culture in the business units and through a focus on sustainable lending practices. The RBS Group’s credit risk management function is responsible for credit approval and managing concentration risk as well as credit risk control frameworks and acts as the ultimate authority for the approval of credit. This, together with strong independent oversight and challenge, enables the business to maintain a sound credit environment.

 

The RBS Group Chief Credit Officer (GCCO), through the RBS Group Credit Risk (GCR) function, is responsible for the development of, and ensuring compliance with, RBS Group-wide policies and credit risk frameworks as well as RBS Group-wide assessment of provision adequacy. The risk management functions, located in the RBS Group’s business divisions, are responsible for the execution of these policies.

 

The divisional credit risk management functions work together with GCR to ensure that the risk appetite set by the RBS Group Board is met. The credit risk function within RBSH Group is managed by the GCR function, through a RBSH Group credit risk delegate who reports to the GCCO. RBSH Group credit risk management activities include credit risk appetite setting, transaction and portfolio analysis, and ongoing credit risk monitoring and oversight.

 

The Executive Risk Forum (ERF) considers and approves material aspects of the Group’s credit risk management framework, such as credit risk appetite and limits for portfolios of strategic significance. The ERF has delegated approval authority to the Group Credit Risk Committee, a functional sub-committee of the Group Risk Committee, to act on credit risk matters. These include, but are not limited to, credit risk appetite and limits (within the overall risk appetite set by the Board and the ERF), credit risk strategy and frameworks, credit risk policy and the oversight of the credit profile across the Group. There are separate Group Credit Risk Committees for the retail and wholesale portfolios and these are chaired by the GCCO.

 

The RBS Group Audit Committee (GAC) provides oversight of the Group’s provision adequacy. The GCCO is accountable to the GAC for the adequacy of the Group’s provisions, both individual and collective.

The RBS Group Provisions Committee, which is chaired by either the RBS Group Chief Risk Officer or the GCCO, approves recommendations from the divisional provisions committees.

 

Key trends in the credit risk profile of RBSH Group, performance against limits and emerging risks are set out in the Risk Report provided to the RCC, the Managing Board and the Supervisory Board

 

Risk appetite and concentration framework

Risk appetite is set using specific quantitative targets under stress, including earnings volatility and capital adequacy. The RBSH Group’s credit risk framework has therefore been designed around the factors that influence the RBSH Group’s ability to meet those targets. These include product and asset class, industry sector, single name and country concentrations. Any of these factors could generate higher earnings volatility under stress and, if not adequately controlled, could undermine capital adequacy. Tools such as stress testing and economic capital are used to measure credit risk volatility and develop links between RBSH Group risk appetite targets and the credit risk control framework. The frameworks are supported by a suite of RBS Group-wide and divisional policies that set out the risk parameters within which divisions must operate. The RBS Group also manages its exposures to counterparty credit risk closely, using portfolio limits and specific tools to control more volatile or capital intensive business areas.

 

Wholesale

Four formal frameworks are used to manage wholesale credit concentration risk. The RBS Group continually reassesses its frameworks to ensure that they remain appropriate for its varied business franchises and current economic conditions as well as to reflect further refinements in the RBS Group’s risk measurement models.

 

Through the overlay model, RBSH Group’s concentration risks are captured in and primarily governed by, the divisional and RBSG Group risk control frameworks. However, concentration risks are actively monitored from an RBSH Group perspective through monthly reporting and appropriate action is taken if necessary

 

Risk management*

Product/asset class concentration framework

The RBS Group manages certain lines of business where the nature of credit risk assumed could result in a concentration or a heightened risk in some other form. This includes specific credit risk types such as settlement or wrong-way risk and products such as long-dated derivatives or securitisations. These product and asset classes may require formal policies and expertise as well as tailored monitoring and reporting measures. In some cases specific limits and thresholds are deployed to ensure that the credit risk inherent in these lines of business and products is adequately controlled. Product and asset classes are reviewed regularly. The reviews consider the risks inherent in each product or asset class, the risk controls applied, monitoring and reporting of the risk, the client base, and any emerging risks to ensure risk appetite remains appropriate.

 

*unaudited  

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             41 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

Credit risk continued 

Sector concentration

Exposures are assigned to, and reviewed in the context of, a defined set of industry sectors. Risk appetite and portfolio strategies are set at either the sector or sub-sector level, depending on where exposures may result in excessive concentration, or where trends in both external factors and internal portfolio performance give cause for concern. Regular formal reviews are undertaken at RBS Group or divisional level depending on materiality. Reviews may include an assessment of the RBS Group’s franchise in a particular sector, an analysis of the outlook, identification of key vulnerabilities or stress testing.

 

Single name concentration

A single name concentration framework addresses the risk of outsized exposure to a borrower or borrower group. The framework includes elevated approval authority, additional reporting and monitoring, and the requirement for plans to address exposures in excess of appetite.

 

Several credit risk mitigation techniques are available to reduce single name concentrations. If the RBS Group decides that its exposure is too high, it may decide to sell excess exposures. Alternatively, it may decide to take additional security or guarantees such as cash, bank or government guarantees or enter into credit default swaps. Credit risk mitigants must be effective in terms of legal certainty and enforceability. In addition, maturity or expiry dates must be the same, or later, than the underlying obligations.

 

Country concentration

The country concentration framework is described in the Country risk section on pages 57 to 62.

 

Credit risk assessment

Wholesale

The credit risk function assesses, approves and manages the credit risk associated with a borrower or group of related borrowers.

 

The GCCO has established a framework of individual delegated authorities, which are set out in the RBS Group Credit Risk Policy. The framework requires at least two individuals to approve each credit decision, one from the business and one from the credit risk function. Both must hold appropriate delegated authority, which is dependent on their experience and expertise. Only a small number of senior executives hold the highest authority provided under the framework. While both parties are accountable for the quality of each decision taken, the credit risk approver holds ultimate sanctioning authority.

 

In all circumstances the risks associated with any proposal to provide, increase, review or change the terms or conditions of credit facilities must be assessed prior to a credit decision being made. Assessments of credit risk must, at a minimum, specifically address the following elements:

 

·         The amount, terms, tenor, structure, conditions, purpose and appropriateness of all credit facilities;

 

·         Compliance with applicable RBS Group and/or divisional credit policies;

 

·         The customer’s ability to meet obligations, based on an analysis of financial information and a review of payment and covenant compliance history;

 

·         The source of repayment and the customer’s risk profile, including sector analysis and sensitivity to economic and market developments, and credit risk mitigation

 

·         Refinancing risk - that is the risk of loss arising from the failure of a customer to settle an obligation on expiry of a facility through the drawdown of another credit facility provided by the RBSH Group or by another lender;

 

·         Consideration of all other risks such as environmental, social and ethical, regulatory and reputational risks; and

 

·         The portfolio impact of the transaction, including the impact on any credit risk concentration limits or agreed divisional risk appetite.

 

At a minimum, credit relationships are reviewed and re-approved annually. The renewal process addresses borrower performance, including reconfirmation or adjustment of risk parameter estimates; the adequacy of security; compliance with terms and conditions; and refinancing risk.

 

Controls and assurance

The RBS Group’s credit control and assurance framework has three key components: credit policy, policy compliance assurance and independent assurance. These apply to both wholesale and retail credit risk at both portfolio and individual customer level.

 

The first component is the RBS Group Credit Policy Standard, which is part of the RBS Group Policy Framework. It sets out the rules the RBS Group’s businesses must follow to ensure that credit risks are identified and effectively managed through the credit lifecycle.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             42 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Credit risk continued   

The second component is a policy assurance activity that GCR undertakes to provide the GCCO with evidence of the effectiveness of credit risk management controls in place across the RBS Group. The results of these reviews are presented to the GCRC on a regular basis in support of the self-certification that GCR must complete from time to time.

 

The third component of the RBS Group’s credit assurance framework is the Credit Quality Assurance (CQA) function. CQA independently reviews the RBS Group’s lending activities to identify control breaches, assess portfolio quality and recommend process improvements. These findings are escalated to senior management and plans to address shortcomings are recorded and tracked in the RBS Group’s operational risk system. CQA’s activities are overseen by GAC and the results of its reviews are regularly shared with the Group’s main regulators

 

Risk measurement*

Credit risk models

The Group uses credit risk models in the credit approval process, ongoing credit risk management, monitoring and reporting and portfolio analytics. These may be divided into three categories:

 

Probability of default (PD)

PD models assess the probability of a customer failing its credit obligations over a one year period.

 

·         Wholesale models - A number of credit grading models are in place that consider risk characteristics relevant to different customer types. These models use a combination of quantitative inputs, such as recent financial performance, and qualitative inputs such as management performance or sector outlook. As part of the credit assessment process, the Group assigns each customer an internal credit grade based on its PD.

 

Exposure at default (EAD)

EAD models provide estimates of the level of use of a credit facility at the time of a customer's default, recognising that customers may make further drawings on unused credit facilities prior to default. Regulatory requirements determine that EAD is always equal to or higher than current utilisation. Exposure can be reduced by a netting agreement, subject to meeting standards of legal enforceability.

 

Loss given default (LGD)

LGD models estimate the amount that cannot be recovered in the event of customer default. When estimating LGD, the Group’s models assess both borrower and facility characteristics, as well as various credit risk

mitigants. The cost of collections and a time discount factor for the delay in cash recovery are also incorporated.

 

Changes to credit models

The Group reviews and updates models on an ongoing basis, reflecting more recent data, changes to products and portfolios, and updated regulatory requirements. Extensive changes were made to wholesale models in 2012 and 2013. This process continues with further changes, notably in banks and corporate exposure classes, planned for 2014.

 

As in 2012, the impact of the model changes implemented in 2013 largely affected the lower risk segments of the Group’s portfolios, mostly to customers bearing the equivalent of investment-grade ratings.

 

Economic capital

The credit economic capital model is an extensive framework that allows for the calculation of portfolio credit loss distributions and associated metrics over a given risk horizon for a variety of business purposes.

 

The model takes into account migration risk (risk that credit assets will deteriorate in credit quality across multiple years), factor correlation (the assumption that groups of obligors share a common factor) and contagion risk (for example, the risk that the weakening of the sovereign’s credit worthiness has a significant impact on the credit worthiness of a business operating in that country).

 

Risk mitigation

Risk mitigation techniques are used in the management of credit portfolios across the Group, typically to mitigate credit concentrations in relation to an individual customer, a borrower group or a collection of related borrowers. Where possible, the Group nets customer credit balances against obligations.

 

Mitigation tools applied can include: structuring a security interest in a physical or financial asset; use of credit derivatives, including credit default swaps, credit-linked debt instruments and securitisation structures; and use of guarantees and similar instruments (for example, credit insurance) from related and third parties.

 

When seeking to mitigate risk, at a minimum the Group considers the following:

 

·         The suitability of the proposed risk mitigation, particularly if restrictions apply;

·         The means by which legal certainty is to be established, including required documentation, supportive legal opinions and the steps needed to establish legal rights;

·         Acceptable methodologies for initial and subsequent valuation of collateral, the frequency of valuation and the advance rates given;

·         The actions it can take if the value of collateral or other mitigants is less than needed;

·         The risk that the value of mitigants and counterparty credit quality may deteriorate simultaneously;

·         The need to manage concentration risks arising from collateral types; and

·         The need to ensure that any risk mitigation remains legally effective and enforceable.

 

The Group’s business and credit teams are supported by specialist in-house documentation teams. The Group uses industry-standard loan and security documentation wherever possible. However, when the Group uses non-standard documentation, external lawyers are employed on a case-by-case basis.

*unaudited  

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             43 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Credit risk continued   

Lending

The types of collateral the Group takes to mitigate the credit risk arising from wholesale lending varies according to the nature of the counterparty and its assets. The most common types are:

 

·         Physical assets - These may include stock, plant, equipment, machinery, vehicles, ships and aircraft. Such assets are suitable collateral only if the Group can identify, locate, and segregate them from other assets on which it does not have a claim. The Group values physical assets in a variety of different ways, depending on the type of asset concerned and may rely on balance sheet valuations in certain cases. In the US, the Group also takes collateral in the form of motor vehicles to mitigate the credit risk arising from automobile lending. The Group values new vehicles at cost and used ones at the relevant average trade-in value.

·         Receivables - These are amounts owed to the Group’s counterparties by their own customers. The Group values them after taking into account the quality of its counterparty’s receivable management processes and excluding any that are past due.

·         Real estate - The market value of the collateral typically exceeds the loan amount at origination date. The market value is defined as the estimated amount for which the asset could be sold in an arm’s length transaction by a willing seller to a willing buyer.

 

All collateral is assessed case-by-case to ensure that it will retain its value independently of the provider. The Group monitors the value of the collateral and, if there is a shortfall, will take appropriate action.

 

Counterparty credit risk

The Group mitigates counterparty credit risk arising from both derivatives and repurchase agreements through the use of netting, collateral and the use of market standard documentation.

 

The Group mitigates counterparty credit risk by netting amounts it owes to a counterparty against amounts the same counterparty owes to it, in accordance with relevant regulatory and internal policies. It generally does so only if it has a netting agreement in place as well as a legal opinion to the effect that the agreement is enforceable in the relevant jurisdictions.

 

Collateral generally takes the form of cash. In the case of repurchase agreements, collateral usually takes the form of debt and equity securities at the outset but if the value of collateral falls relative to that of the obligation, the Group may require additional collateral in the form of cash (variation margin). Industry standard documentation, such as master repurchase agreements and credit support annexes accompanied by legal opinion, is used for financial collateral taken as part of trading activities.

 

The Group limits counterparty credit exposures by setting limits which take into account the potential adverse movement of a counterparty credit exposure after adjusting the impact of netting and collateral where applicable.

 

Early problem identification and problem debt management

Early warning indicators are in place to identify customers experiencing financial difficulty and to increase monitoring if required. These indicators may be internal, such as a customer’s account activity, or external such as a publicly-listed customer’s share price. If these indicators show a customer is experiencing potential, or actual, difficulty then the customer may be placed on the Watchlist.

 

Watchlist*

There are three Watch classifications - Amber, Red and Black - reflecting progressively deteriorating conditions. Watch Amber customers are performing customers who show early signs of potential financial difficulty, or have other characteristics that warrant closer monitoring. Watch Red customers are performing customers who show signs of declining credit worthiness which requires active management usually by the RBSG Global Restructuring Group (GRG). Watch Black customers include risk elements in lending and potential problem loans.

 

Once on the Watchlist, customers are subject to heightened scrutiny. Depending on the severity of the financial difficulty and the size of the exposure, the customer relationship strategy is reassessed by credit officers, by specialist units in divisions or by GRG. In more material cases, a forum of experienced credit, portfolio management and remedial management specialists in the divisions or GRG may reassess the customer relationship strategy. In accordance with Group-wide policies, a number of mandatory actions are taken, including a review of the customer’s credit grade and facility and security documentation.

 

Other appropriate corrective action is taken when circumstances emerge that may affect the customer’s ability to service its debt. Such circumstances include deteriorating trading performance, imminent breach of covenant, challenging macroeconomic conditions, a late payment or the expectation of a missed payment.

 

For all Watch Red cases, the division is required to consult with GRG on whether the relationship should be transferred to GRG (for more information on GRG, refer to below). Watch Red customers that continue to be managed by the divisions tend to be those requiring subject matter expertise that is available in the divisions rather than in GRG.

 

At 31 December 2013, exposures to customers reported as Watchlist Red and managed in the divisions totalled €0.2 billion (2012 - €0.6 billion).

 

Remediation strategies available in the divisions include granting a customer various types of concessions. Any decision to approve a concession will be a function of the division’s specific country and sector appetite, the key metrics of the customer, the market environment and the loan structure and security.

 

Other potential outcomes of the relationship review are to: take the customer off the Watchlist; offer additional lending and continue monitoring; transfer the relationship to GRG if appropriate; or exit the relationship altogether.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             44 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Credit risk continued   

The following table shows a sector breakdown of credit risk assets of Watchlist Red counterparties under GRG management:

 

Watchlist Red credit risk assets under GRG management

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m

€m

€m

Property

436 

Transport

113 

212 

210 

Retail and leisure

99 

91 

Services

145 

Other

198 

122 

423 

Total

322 

441 

1,305 

 

RBSG Global Restructuring Group (GRG)

GRG manages the Group’s wholesale problem debt portfolio in cases where its exposure to the customer exceeds £1 million. In addition, GRG provides a specialist credit function, the Strategy Management Unit, for distressed bilateral lending where the exposure is between £250,000 and £1 million. The primary function of GRG is to restore customers to an acceptable credit condition and minimise losses to the Group.

The factor common to all customers managed by GRG is that the Group’s exposure is outside risk appetite. Customers transferred to GRG typically show symptoms of significant financial difficulty, such as cash flow pressures, or show evidence that the management team has limited experience of managing a business in difficulty. In addition, a customer may be transferred to GRG if the Group is not provided with sufficient or reliable information on which to make decisions.

 

GRG relationship managers use their skill, experience and judgement to support customers through these difficulties while seeking to minimise losses to protect the Group’s capital

 

When the relationship is transferred, GRG conducts a detailed assessment of the viability of the business as well as the ability of management to deal with the causes of financial difficulty. Following GRG’s initial file assessment and, if appropriate, wider due diligence with input from independent experts (sector experts, accountants and surveyors), various options are presented to the customer. A strategy is then agreed with the customer for dealing with the distressed loan.

 

The objective is to find a mutually acceptable solution, including repayment, refinancing or transfer to another bank if that is the customer’s preferred option. Once a solution is found, management of the loans may be transferred back to the performing divisions. If the business is not viable and a turnaround is not possible, insolvency may be an option.

 

Wholesale forbearance

Definition

Forbearance takes place when a concession is made on the contractual terms of a loan in response to a customer’s financial difficulties.

 

Concessions granted where there is no evidence of financial difficulty, or where any changes to terms and conditions are within the Group’s usual risk appetite (for a customer new to the Group), or reflect improving credit market conditions for the customer, are not considered forbearance.

 

A number of options are available to the Group. Such actions are tailored to the customer’s individual circumstances. The aim of such actions is to restore the customer to financial health and to minimise risk to the Group. To ensure that forbearance is appropriate for the needs and financial profile of the customer, the Group applies minimum standards when assessing, recording, monitoring and reporting forbearance. At 31 December 2013, loans totalling €44 million (2012 - €173 million) were subject to forbearance procedures but had not reached legal completion, the forbearance completed in 2013 was nil (2012 - € 70 million)

 

Types of wholesale forbearance

Wholesale forbearance may involve the following types of concessions:

 

·         Payment concessions and loan rescheduling, including extensions in contractual maturity, may be granted to improve the customer’s liquidity. Concessions may also be granted on the expectation that the customer’s liquidity will recover when market conditions improve. In addition, they may be granted if the customer will benefit from access to alternative sources of liquidity, such as an issue of equity capital. These options are commonly used in commercial real estate transactions, particularly where a shortage of market liquidity rules out immediate refinancing and makes short-term collateral sales unattractive.

·         Debt may be forgiven, or exchanged for equity, where the customer’s business or economic environment means that it cannot meet obligations and where other forms of forbearance are unlikely to succeed. Debt forgiveness is commonly used for stressed leveraged finance transactions. These are typically structured on the basis of projected cash flows from operational activities, rather than underlying tangible asset values. Provided that the underlying business model, strategy and debt level are viable, maintaining the business as a going concern is the preferred option, rather than realising the value of the underlying assets.

 

A temporary covenant waiver, a recalibration of covenants or a covenant amendment may be used to cure a potential or actual covenant breach. In return for this relief, the Group would seek to obtain a return commensurate with the risk that it is required to take. The increased return for the increased risk can be structured flexibly to take into account the customer’s circumstances for example increased margin on a cash or payment in kind basis, and/or deferred return instruments.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             45 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Credit risk continued   

The contractual margin may be amended to bolster the customer’s day-to-day liquidity to help sustain the customer’s business as a going concern. This would normally be a short-term solution. As set out above, the Group would seek to obtain a return commensurate to the risk that it is required to take and this can be structured in the same ways set out above. 

 

Loans may be forborne more than once, generally where a temporary concession has been granted and circumstances warrant another temporary or permanent revision of the loan’s terms. All customers are assigned a PD and related facilities an LGD. These are re-assessed prior to finalising any forbearance arrangement in light of the loan’s amended terms. Where forbearance is no longer viable, the Group will consider other options such as the enforcement of security and/or insolvency proceedings.

 

The ultimate outcome of a forbearance strategy is unknown at the time of execution. It is highly dependent on the cooperation of the borrower and the continued existence of a viable business. The following are generally considered to be options of last resort:

 

·         Enforcement of security or otherwise taking control of assets - Where the Group holds collateral or other security interest and is entitled to enforce its rights, it may enforce its security or otherwise take ownership or control of the assets. The Group’s preferred strategy is to consider other possible options prior to exercising these rights.

·         Insolvency - Where there is no suitable forbearance option or the business is no longer regarded as sustainable, insolvency will be considered. Insolvency may be the only option that ensures that the assets of the business are properly and efficiently distributed to relevant creditors.

 

Impact of forbearance on provisioning

Wholesale loans granted forbearance are individually assessed in most cases and are not therefore segregated into a separate risk pool.

 

Forbearance may result in the value of the outstanding debt exceeding the present value of the estimated future cash flows. This may result in the recognition of an impairment loss or a write-off.

 

Provisions for forborne wholesale loans are assessed in accordance with the Group’s normal provisioning policies (refer to Impairment loss provision methodology on page 99). The customer’s financial position and prospects as well as the likely effect of the forbearance, including any concessions granted, are considered in order to establish whether an impairment provision is required. Individual impairment assessments for wholesale loans are reassessed in the light of any revisions to the loan's terms.

 

All wholesale customers are assigned a PD and related facilities an LGD. These are re-assessed prior to finalising any forbearance arrangement in light of the loan’s amended terms and any revised grading incorporated in the calculation of the impairment loss provisions for the Group’s wholesale exposures.

 

For performing counterparties, credit metrics are an integral part of the latent provision methodology and therefore the impact of covenant concessions will be reflected in the latent provision. For non-performing loans, covenant concessions will be considered in the overall provision adequacy for these loans.

 

In the case of non-performing loans that are forborne, the loan impairment provision assessment almost invariably takes place prior to forbearance being granted. The quantum of the loan impairment provision may change once the terms of the forbearance are known, resulting in an additional provision charge or a release of the provision in the period the forbearance is granted.

 

Provisions and AFS reserves

The transfer of wholesale loans subject to forbearance from impaired to performing status follows assessment by relationship managers in GRG. When no further losses are anticipated and the customer is expected to meet the loan’s revised terms, any provision is written off and the balance of the loan returned to performing status.

 

Available-for-sale financial assets are initially recognised at fair value plus directly related transaction costs and are subsequently measured at fair value with changes in fair value reported in shareholders’ equity until disposal, at which stage the cumulative gain or loss is recognised in profit or loss. When there is objective evidence that an available-for-sale financial asset is impaired, any decline in its fair value below original cost is removed from equity and recognised in profit or loss.

 

RBSH Group reviews its portfolios of available-for-sale financial assets for evidence of impairment, which includes: default or delinquency in interest or principal payments; significant financial difficulty of the issuer or obligor; and it becoming probable that the issuer will enter bankruptcy or other financial reorganisation. However, the disappearance of an active market because an entity’s financial instruments are no longer publicly traded is not evidence of impairment. Furthermore, a downgrade of an entity’s credit rating is not, of itself, evidence of impairment, although it may be evidence of impairment when considered with other available information. A decline in the fair value of a financial asset below its cost or amortised cost is not necessarily evidence of impairment. Determining whether objective evidence of impairment exists requires the exercise of management judgment. The unrecognised losses on RBSH Group’s available-for-sale debt securities are concentrated in its portfolios of mortgage-backed securities. The losses reflect the widening of credit spreads as a result of the reduced market liquidity in these securities and the current uncertain macroeconomic outlook in the US and Europe. The underlying securities remain unimpaired.

  

Analyses of AFS debt securities and related AFS reserves are set out on page 56.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             46 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

Balance sheet analysis

48

Sector and geographic concentration

49

Loans and advances to banks and customers by geographical region

50

Asset quality

52

Debt securities

53

Asset-backed securities (ABS)

55

Sector and geographical regional analyses

56

Available-for-sale debt securities and reserves

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             47 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Balance sheet analysis

Sector and geographic concentration

The analyses in this section are provided to support the discussion on credit risk on pages 40 to 46.  All disclosures are audited. Additional information can also be found in Notes 8 to 14 of the financial statements.

 

The following tables provide an analysis of credit concentration of financial assets by sector and geography. Geographical regions are based on the location of the office. 

 

  

Loans and 

  

  

  

  

Netting and

 advances 

Securities 

Derivatives

Other (1) 

Total  

offset (2)

2013 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Central and local government

85 

5,937 

45 

6,073 

27 

Financial institutions (3) 

9,826 

9,412 

4,385 

3,197 

26,820 

888 

Residential mortgages

223 

  

  

  

223 

  

Personal lending

  

  

  

  

Property

48 

11 

  

67 

  

Construction

23 

  

29 

  

Manufacturing

863 

54 

64 

  

981 

  

Service industries and business activities

1,315 

35 

264 

  

1,614 

  

Agriculture, forestry and fishing

  

10 

10 

  

20 

  

Finance lease and instalment credit

101 

  

  

  

101 

  

Interest accruals

136 

  

  

142 

  

Total gross of provisions

12,494 

15,595 

4,782 

3,203 

36,074 

915 

Provisions

(195)

(12)

  

  

(207)

  

Total

12,299 

15,583 

4,782 

3,203 

35,867 

915 

 

2012 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Central and local government

891 

7,783 

55 

8,731 

11 

Financial institutions (3) 

16,424 

15,347 

6,657 

2,312 

40,740 

1,072 

Residential mortgages

283 

— 

— 

— 

283 

— 

Property

76 

— 

63 

— 

139 

Construction

20 

— 

— 

29 

— 

Manufacturing

1,370 

182 

18 

— 

1,570 

Service industries and other business activities

2,708 

305 

753 

11 

3,777 

— 

Agriculture, forestry and fishing

— 

— 

— 

— 

Finance lease and instalment credit

109 

— 

— 

— 

109 

— 

Interest accruals

(9)

270 

— 

— 

261 

— 

Total gross of provisions

21,876 

23,887 

7,555 

2,325 

55,643 

1,085 

Provisions

(341)

(105)

— 

— 

(446)

— 

Total

21,535 

23,782 

7,555 

2,325 

55,197 

1,085 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

 

For the notes to this table refer to the following page.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             48 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

Balance sheet analysis continued 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Loans and 

  

  

  

  

Netting and

 advances 

Securities 

Derivatives

Other (1)

Total  

offset (2)

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Central and local government

1,062 

11,405 

103 

50 

12,620 

— 

Financial institutions (3) 

32,187 

28,493 

16,774 

13,782 

91,236 

3,064 

Residential mortgages

1,125 

— 

— 

— 

1,125 

— 

Personal lending

318 

— 

— 

— 

318 

— 

Property

701 

— 

125 

— 

826 

— 

Construction

1,049 

25 

109 

— 

1,183 

— 

Manufacturing

7,200 

21 

554 

— 

7,775 

— 

Service industries and business activities

14,144 

2,313 

1,373 

224 

18,054 

43 

Agriculture, forestry and fishing

123 

— 

98 

— 

221 

— 

Finance lease and instalment credit

102 

— 

— 

104 

— 

Interest accruals

192 

583 

— 

— 

775 

— 

Total gross of provisions

58,203 

42,840 

19,138 

14,056 

134,237 

3,107 

Provisions

(1,572)

(102)

— 

— 

(1,674)

— 

Total

56,631 

42,738 

19,138 

14,056 

132,563 

3,107 

 

Notes:

(1)    Includes settlement balances.

(2)    This shows the amount by which RBSH Group's credit risk exposure is reduced through arrangements, such as master netting agreements, which give RBSH Group a legal right to set off the financial asset against a financial liability due to the same counterparty. In addition, RBSH Group holds collateral in respect of individual loans and advances to banks and customers. This collateral includes mortgages over property (both personal and commercial); charges over business assets such as plant, inventories and trade debtors; and guarantees of lending from parties other than the borrower. RBSH Group obtains collateral in the form of securities in reverse repurchase agreements. Cash and securities are received as collateral in respect of derivative transactions.

(3)    Includes reverse repurchase agreements of €0.1 billion (2012 - €0.1 billion; 2011 - €9.4 billion).

 

Loans and advances to banks and customers by geographical region

  

  

  

The table below analyses loans and advances net of provisions by geographical region (location of office).

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

Loans and advances to banks

  

  

  

Netherlands

1,673 

3,565 

7,512 

US

117 

391 

1,458 

Rest of world (1) 

3,905 

8,250 

16,947 

  

5,695 

12,206 

25,917 

Loans and advances to customers

  

  

  

Netherlands

638 

1,518 

6,164 

US

37 

  

874 

Rest of world (2) 

3,109 

4,862 

22,540 

   

3,784 

6,380 

29,578 

Balances with ultimate holding company

  

  

  

Netherlands

2,820 

2,949 

1,136 

Total

12,299 

21,535 

56,631 

 

Notes:

(1)    Includes UK balances of €1,774 million (2012 - €6,655 million).

(2)    Includes UK balances of €1,164 million (2012 - €848 million).

 

 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             49 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

Balance sheet analysis continued 

Asset quality

The asset quality analysis presented below is based on RBS Group’s internal asset quality ratings which have ranges for the probability of default, as set out below. Customers are assigned credit grades, based on various credit grading models that reflect the key drivers of default for the customer type. All credit grades across RBS Group map to both a RBS Group level asset quality scale, used for external financial reporting, and a master grading scale for wholesale exposures used for internal management reporting across portfolios. Debt securities are analysed by external ratings agencies and are therefore excluded from the following table and are set out on page 52.

 


Asset quality band

Probability of default range

AQ1

0% - 0.034%

AQ2

0.034% - 0.048%

AQ3

0.048% - 0.095%

AQ4

0.095% - 0.381%

AQ5

0.381% - 1.076%

AQ6

1.076% - 2.153%

AQ7

2.153% - 6.089%

AQ8

6.089% - 17.222%

AQ9

17.222% - 100%

AQ10

100%

 

 

 

 

Loans and advances

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and 

Banks

 

Customers

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

balances 

 

Derivative 

 

 

 

Derivative 

 

Balances with 

 

 

 

 

 

 

at central 

Reverse 

 cash 

 

 

Reverse 

 cash 

 

ultimate holding 

Settlement  

 

 

Contingent 

 

  

 banks 

 repos 

 collateral 

Other 

 

 repos 

collateral 

Other 

company 

balances 

Derivatives 

Commitments 

liabilities 

Total 

2013 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

AQ1

2,907 

113 

595 

 

116 

567 

— 

— 

573 

135 

260 

5,269 

AQ2

— 

— 

120 

164 

 

— 

— 

204 

— 

— 

136 

14 

1,189 

1,827 

AQ3

269 

— 

434 

105 

 

— 

103 

546 

— 

— 

627 

288 

4,285 

6,657 

AQ4

17 

80 

1,024 

 

— 

58 

961 

— 

10 

825 

207 

768 

3,951 

AQ5

— 

— 

57 

133 

 

— 

31 

322 

— 

— 

24 

135 

213 

915 

AQ6

— 

— 

— 

 

— 

— 

416 

— 

— 

27 

25 

483 

AQ7

— 

— 

— 

— 

 

— 

12 

58 

— 

— 

10 

92 

AQ8

— 

— 

— 

 

— 

— 

44 

— 

— 

15 

22 

84 

AQ9

— 

— 

— 

— 

 

— 

— 

177 

— 

— 

105 

323 

611 

AQ10

— 

— 

— 

— 

 

— 

— 

— 

— 

10 

38 

— 

57 

Balances with

  

  

  

  

 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  RBS Group

— 

51 

— 

2,808 

 

— 

— 

42 

2,820 

— 

2,568 

— 

1,361 

9,650 

Impaired

— 

— 

— 

 

— 

— 

310 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

311 

Impairment provision

— 

— 

— 

(1)

 

— 

— 

(194)

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

(195)

Total

3,193 

53 

804 

4,838 

 

320 

3,462 

2,820 

10 

4,782 

972 

8,456 

29,712 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             50 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

Balance sheet analysis continued 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

 

 

 

Loans and advances

 

 

 

 

 

 

  

Cash and 

Banks

  

Customers

Balances 

 

  

  

  

  

  

balances 

 

Derivative 

  

  

  

Derivative 

  

with ultimate 

 

  

  

  

  

  

at central 

Reverse

 cash 

  

  

Reverse 

 cash 

  

holding 

Settlement 

  

  

Contingent 

  

  

 banks 

 repos  

 collateral 

Other 

  

 repos 

collateral 

Other 

company 

balances 

Derivatives 

Commitments 

liabilities 

Total 

2012 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

AQ1

2,068 

737 

961 

  

246 

1,144 

— 

26 

330 

1,486 

6,276 

13,278 

AQ2

— 

— 

264 

  

— 

— 

192 

— 

— 

577 

1,321 

431 

2,791 

AQ3

226 

— 

119 

97 

  

— 

143 

860 

— 

175 

1,154 

966 

3,741 

AQ4

— 

— 

310 

334 

  

— 

40 

1,713 

— 

— 

1,365 

802 

695 

5,259 

AQ5

— 

— 

80 

173 

  

— 

27 

553 

— 

— 

401 

184 

218 

1,636 

AQ6

— 

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

839 

— 

11 

103 

135 

1,092 

AQ7

— 

— 

137 

  

— 

— 

201 

— 

— 

12 

68 

112 

533 

AQ8

— 

— 

— 

26 

  

— 

75 

— 

— 

31 

43 

187 

AQ9

— 

— 

— 

17 

  

— 

— 

138 

— 

— 

273 

500 

929 

AQ10

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

27 

— 

— 

28 

35 

91 

Balances with

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  RBS Group

— 

62 

— 

8,876 

  

— 

— 

— 

2,949 

4,624 

237 

1,737 

18,486 

Past due

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

12 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

12 

Impaired

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

506 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

506 

Impairment provision

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

(341)

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

(341)

Total

2,294 

68 

1,510 

10,628 

  

456 

5,919 

2,949 

31 

7,555 

5,706 

11,079 

48,200 

 

  

Cash and 

  

  

Balances with  

  

  

Other 

  

  

  

  

balances at 

Loans and advances

ultimate holding  

Settlement 

  

financial 

  

Contingent 

  

  

 central banks 

Banks 

Customers 

company  

balances 

Derivatives 

instruments 

Commitments 

liabilities 

Total 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

AQ1

12,184 

9,982 

7,257 

— 

81 

4,267 

— 

8,565 

9,529 

51,865 

AQ2

157 

322 

2,533 

— 

— 

1,091 

— 

4,052 

2,543 

10,698 

AQ3

206 

407 

3,760 

— 

614 

1,032 

— 

2,895 

2,853 

11,767 

AQ4

— 

406 

6,811 

— 

801 

— 

3,657 

3,155 

14,838 

AQ5

55 

498 

3,039 

— 

45 

461 

— 

1,280 

1,865 

7,243 

AQ6

— 

84 

2,061 

— 

— 

55 

— 

383 

404 

2,987 

AQ7

— 

382 

1,965 

— 

99 

— 

328 

519 

3,294 

AQ8

12 

356 

— 

— 

236 

— 

20 

28 

659 

AQ9

— 

91 

842 

— 

— 

— 

857 

1,003 

2,797 

AQ10

— 

218 

— 

30 

— 

276 

26 

556 

Balances with RBS Group

— 

13,722 

— 

1,136 

1,855 

11,062 

— 

65 

1,272 

29,112 

Past due

— 

385 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

387 

Impaired

— 

52 

1,878 

— 

— 

— 

494 

— 

— 

2,424 

Impairment provision

— 

(45)

(1,527)

— 

— 

— 

(31)

— 

— 

(1,603)

Total

12,609 

25,917 

29,578 

1,136 

2,608 

19,138 

463 

22,378 

23,197 

137,024 

 

Updates, primarily of models used for the corporate counterparties, took place in 2013. The AQ composition of the corporate portfolio has improved slightly during the year.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             51 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

Balance sheet analysis continued 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Debt securities

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

The table below analyses debt securities by issuer and external ratings. Ratings are based on the lower of Standard & Poor’s (S&P), Moody’s and Fitch.

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Central and local government

  

Other financial 

  

  

  

Of which 

2013 

US 

Other 

Banks 

 institutions 

Corporate 

Total 

Total 

ABS (1)

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

AAA

— 

96 

128 

1,091 

15 

1,330 

8.7 

1,219 

AA to AA+

1,718 

1,496 

179 

1,819 

30 

5,242 

34.3 

1,946 

A to AA-

— 

1,034 

111 

315 

10 

1,470 

9.6 

372 

BBB- to A-

— 

1,411 

3,524 

1,353 

— 

6,288 

41.1 

4,679 

Non-investment grade

— 

237 

211 

275 

— 

723 

4.7 

428 

Unrated

— 

— 

189 

44 

235 

1.6 

— 

Total

1,718 

4,274 

4,342 

4,897 

57 

15,288 

100.0 

8,644 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2012 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

AAA

— 

1,383 

143 

3,791 

18 

5,335 

23.5 

3,772 

AA to AA+

1,871 

1,657 

525 

1,542 

124 

5,719 

25.3 

2,026 

A to AA-

— 

1,761 

150 

595 

15 

2,521 

11.1 

561 

BBB- to A-

— 

972 

4,012 

3,084 

13 

8,081 

35.7 

7,077 

Non-investment grade

— 

290 

316 

25 

636 

2.8 

341 

Unrated

— 

— 

179 

182 

363 

1.6 

— 

Total

1,871 

6,063 

5,325 

9,039 

357 

22,655 

100.0 

13,777 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2011 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

AAA

— 

5,564 

2,821 

6,285 

175 

14,845 

37.4 

8,755 

AA to AA+

3,521 

1,882 

1,215 

1,633 

57 

8,308 

21.0 

2,347 

A to AA-

— 

4,846 

2,398 

1,839 

9,087 

22.9 

3,727 

BBB- to A-

— 

2,504 

2,213 

484 

82 

5,283 

13.3 

2,383 

Non-investment grade

— 

803 

477 

349 

205 

1,834 

4.7 

150 

Unrated

— 

93 

30 

163 

288 

0.7 

— 

Total

3,521 

15,601 

9,217 

10,620 

686 

39,645 

100.0 

17,362 

 

Note:

(1)      Asset-backed securities.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             52 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Balance sheet analysis continued

Asset-backed securities (ABS)

All securities are classified as available-for-sale. The following tables summarise RBSH Group’s carrying values of these securities by geography of the underlying assets at 31 December 2013, 2012 and 2011.

 

Government sponsored or similar RMBS comprises securities that are: (a) guaranteed or effectively guaranteed by the US government, by way of its support for US federal agencies and government sponsored enterprises, or (b) guaranteed by the Dutch government.

 

RBSH Group’s credit market activities gave rise to risk concentrations in ABS. RBSH Group has exposures to ABS which are predominantly debt securities but can also be held in derivative form. ABS have an interest in an underlying pool of referenced assets. The risks and rewards of the referenced pool are passed onto investors by the issue of securities with varying seniority, by a special purpose entity.

 

ABS include residential mortgage-backed securities (RMBS), commercial mortgage-backed securities (CMBS), collateralised debt obligations (CDOs), collateralised loan obligations (CLOs) and other ABS. In many cases the risk on these assets is hedged by way of credit derivative protection purchased over the specific asset or relevant ABS indices. The counterparties to some of these hedge transactions are monoline insurers.

 

Residential mortgage-backed securities

RMBS are securities that represent an interest in a portfolio of residential mortgages. Repayments made on the underlying mortgages are used to make payments to holders of the RMBS. The risk of the RMBS will vary primarily depending on the quality and geographic region in which the underlying mortgage assets are located and the credit enhancement of the securitisation structure. Several tranches of notes are issued, each secured against the same portfolio of mortgages, but providing differing levels of seniority to match the risk appetite of investors. The most junior (or equity) notes will suffer early capital and interest losses experienced by the referenced mortgage collateral, with each more senior note benefiting from the protection provided by the subordinated notes below. Additional credit enhancements may be provided to the holder of senior RMBS notes, including provided by monoline insurers.  The main category of mortgages that serve as collateral to RMBS held by RBSH Group with related vintages is set out on page 54.

 

Asset-backed securities by product, geography and IFRS measurement classification

  

  

  

  

  

  

Other  

  

  

US 

UK 

 Europe 

RoW (1)

Total 

Carrying value

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

2013 

  

  

  

  

  

RMBS: government sponsored or similar

— 

— 

2,886 

— 

2,886 

MBS: covered bond

57 

243 

5,183 

— 

5,483 

Other ABS

— 

— 

275 

— 

275 

  

57 

243 

8,344 

— 

8,644 

  

  

  

  

  

  

2012

  

  

  

  

  

RMBS: government sponsored or similar

— 

— 

5,985 

— 

5,985 

MBS: covered bond

59 

250 

6,720 

— 

7,029 

CDOs

— 

— 

149 

— 

149 

Other ABS

— 

— 

614 

— 

614 

  

59 

250 

13,468 

— 

13,777 

  

  

  

  

  

  

2011

  

  

  

  

  

RMBS: government sponsored or similar

— 

— 

6,635 

— 

6,635 

MBS: covered bond

162 

250 

8,578 

— 

8,990 

CDOs

— 

— 

165 

— 

165 

Other ABS

— 

— 

1,547 

25 

1,572 

 

162 

250 

16,925 

25 

17,362 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             53 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Balance sheet analysis continued

Asset-backed securities (ABS) continued 

Asset-backed securities by product, geography and IFRS measurement classification continued

The table below summarises the rating levels of ABS carrying values. Credit ratings are based on those from rating agencies Standard & Poor’s (S&P), Moody’s and Fitch and have been mapped onto the S&P scale.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  

  

  

  

Non-investment 

  

AAA 

AA to AA+ 

A to AA- 

BBB- to A- 

grade 

Total 

2013 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

RMBS: government sponsored or similar

1,045 

1,630 

190 

15 

2,886 

MBS: covered bond

174 

259 

57 

4,571 

422 

5,483 

CDOs

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Other ABS

— 

57 

125 

93 

— 

275 

  

1,219 

1,946 

372 

4,679 

428 

8,644 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2012 

  

  

  

  

  

  

RMBS: government sponsored or similar

2,988 

1,512 

246 

1,214 

25 

5,985 

MBS: covered bond

784 

125 

190 

5,763 

167 

7,029 

CDOs

— 

— 

— 

— 

149 

149 

Other ABS

— 

389 

125 

100 

— 

614 

  

3,772 

2,026 

561 

7,077 

341 

13,777 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2011 

  

  

  

  

  

  

RMBS: government sponsored or similar

4,979 

1,474 

157 

— 

25 

6,635 

MBS: covered bond

3,102 

454 

3,069 

2,365 

— 

8,990 

CDOs

— 

— 

22 

18 

125 

165 

Other ABS

674 

419 

479 

— 

— 

1,572 

  

8,755 

2,347 

3,727 

2,383 

150 

17,362 

 

Key points

·         Carrying value of the available-for-sale asset-backed securities decreased by €5.1 billion during 2013 due to maturities and sales.

 

·         The RMBS government sponsored or similar positions are backed by mortgages covered by the Dutch mortgage guarantee scheme.

 

·         The MBS covered bond positions originated largely in Europe and related mostly to Spanish securities.

 

For the composition of the AFS portfolio by country refer to page 56.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             54 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Balance sheet analysis continued 

Sector and geographical regional analyses

The following tables analyse gross loans and advances to customers and the related debt management measures and ratios by sector and geography (by location of office). Gross loans, REIL and provisions exclude amounts relating to businesses held for disposal, consistent with the balance sheet presentation required by IFRS.

 

  

2013 

  

  

  

  

REIL 

Provisions 

Provisions 

  

  

Gross 

  

  

 as a % of 

  as a % 

as a % of 

Impairment 

Amounts

loans 

REIL 

Provisions 

gross loans 

of REIL 

 gross loans 

charge 

written-off 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m

Central and local government

85 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Financial institutions

1,310 

72 

16 

5.5 

22 

1.2 

38 

— 

Residential mortgages

223 

22 

22 

9.9 

100 

9.9 

— 

— 

Personal lending

— 

— 

— 

— 

Property

48 

46 

39 

95.8 

85 

81.3 

Construction

23 

17.4 

100 

17.4 

Manufacturing

863 

45 

30 

5.2 

67 

3.5 

31 

Service industries and other business

1,315 

121 

70 

9.2 

58 

5.3 

(16)

64 

  activities

Agriculture, forestry and fishing

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Finance leases and instalment credit

101 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Interest accruals

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Latent

— 

— 

13 

— 

— 

— 

(72)

— 

Total

3,978 

310 

194 

7.8 

63 

4.9 

(38)

103 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

of which:

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

 - Netherlands

726 

178 

88 

24.5 

49 

12.1 

(35)

70 

 - Overseas

3,252 

132 

106 

4.1 

80 

3.3 

(3)

33 

Total

3,978 

310 

194 

7.8 

63 

4.9 

(38)

103 

 

2012 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Central and local government

891 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Financial institutions

1,269 

61 

14 

4.8 

23 

1.1 

43 

213 

Residential mortgages

283 

41 

12 

14.5 

29 

4.2 

17 

34 

Property

76 

54 

35 

71.1 

65 

46.1 

(21)

46 

Construction

20 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

10 

Manufacturing

1,370 

138 

72 

10.1 

52 

5.3 

33 

64 

Service industries and other business

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  activities

2,708 

209 

171 

7.7 

82 

6.3 

26 

64 

Agriculture, forestry and fishing

75.0 

67 

50.0 

— 

Finance leases and instalment credit

109 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Interest accruals

(9)

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Latent

— 

— 

35 

— 

— 

— 

(86)

— 

Total

6,721 

506 

341 

7.5 

67 

5.1 

15 

432 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

of which:

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

 - Netherlands

1,672 

253 

155 

15.1 

61 

9.3 

50 

 - Overseas

5,049 

253 

186 

5.0 

74 

3.7 

382 

Total

6,721 

506 

341 

7.5 

67 

5.1 

15 

432 

 

Key point

·         Risk elements in lending decreased €196 million in the year to €310 million mainly due to repayments and write-offs outpacing new defaulting balances by €143 million, and €70 million of transfers to RBS plc.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             55 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

Balance sheet analysis continued

2011 

  

  

  

  

REIL

Provisions 

Provisions 

  

  

Gross 

  

  

 as a % of 

  as a % 

as a % of 

Impairment 

Amounts 

loans 

REIL

Provisions

gross loans 

of REIL 

 gross loans 

charge 

written-off 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Central and local government

1,062 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Financial institutions

5,143 

734 

554 

14.3 

75 

10.8 

183 

41 

Residential mortgages

1,125 

101 

59 

9.0 

58 

5.2 

35 

Personal lending

102 

75 

69 

73.5 

92 

67.6 

(10)

125 

Property

701 

112 

105 

16.0 

94 

15.0 

— 

Construction

1,049 

14 

13 

1.3 

93 

1.3 

— 

Manufacturing

7,200 

395 

239 

5.5 

61 

3.3 

20 

41 

Service industries and other business

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  activities

14,144 

612 

380 

4.3 

62 

2.7 

68 

187 

Agriculture, forestry and fishing

123 

1.7 

100 

1.7 

(5)

Finance leases and instalment credit

318 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Interest accruals

138 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Latent

— 

— 

106

— 

— 

— 

(11)

— 

Total

31,105 

2,045 

1,527 

6.6 

75 

4.9 

302 

397 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

of which:

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

 - Netherlands

6,403 

417 

242 

6.5 

58 

3.8 

(20)

43  

 - Overseas

24,702 

1,628 

1,285 

7.0 

79 

5.2 

322 

354 

Total

31,105 

2,045 

1,527 

6.6 

75 

4.9 

302 

397 

 

Available-for-sale debt securities and reserves

The table below analyses available-for-sale (AFS) debt securities by issuer and related AFS reserves net of tax, relating to securities issued by governments and other entities by country.

  

2013 

  

2012 

  

2011 

  

Govern- 

  

  

  

AFS 

  

Govern- 

  

  

  

AFS 

  

Govern- 

  

  

  

AFS 

ment 

ABS 

Other 

Total 

Reserve 

ment 

ABS 

Other 

Total 

Reserve 

ment 

ABS 

Other 

Total 

Reserve 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Netherlands

668 

2,938 

67 

3,673 

(113)

  

714 

6,039 

172 

6,925 

(602)

  

746 

6,764 

170 

7,680 

(399)

Spain

52 

4,944 

— 

4,996 

(573)

  

45 

5,871 

— 

5,916 

(1,491)

  

39 

7,623 

— 

7,662 

(1,858)

Germany

400 

— 

50 

450 

(2)

  

1,812 

300 

54 

2,166 

(3)

  

4,739 

791 

131 

5,661 

(13)

United   

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  States

1,711 

57 

— 

1,768 

(25)

  

1,872 

59 

1,940 

(44)

  

2,485 

162 

41 

2,688 

63 

France

431 

137 

— 

568 

(42)

  

529 

635 

1,173 

(60)

  

1,967 

623 

2,599 

(104)

Italy

514 

— 

— 

514 

(60)

  

501 

149 

— 

650 

(116)

  

842 

190 

— 

1,032 

(292)

Belgium

531 

— 

— 

531 

(41)

  

1,006 

— 

— 

1,006 

(54)

  

879 

— 

— 

879 

(139)

India

487 

— 

198 

685 

(5)

  

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

699 

— 

109 

808 

(4)

Austria

340 

182 

31 

553 

(30)

  

367 

184 

110 

661 

(39)

  

329 

178 

156 

663 

(71)

Denmark

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

504 

— 

— 

504 

— 

China

187 

— 

— 

187 

— 

  

214 

— 

27 

241 

— 

  

471 

— 

— 

471 

Hong Kong

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

467 

— 

— 

467 

— 

Greece

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

373 

— 

— 

373 

— 

Sweden

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

35 

— 

39 

— 

  

34 

289 

— 

323 

(2)

Ireland

168 

56 

— 

224 

(10)

  

156 

209 

— 

365 

(35)

  

122 

176 

— 

298 

(95)

United

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Kingdom

— 

243 

— 

243 

(2)

  

— 

250 

11 

261 

(5)

  

— 

250 

258 

(27)

Romania

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

207 

— 

— 

207 

— 

Malaysia

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

194 

— 

— 

194 

— 

Portugal

— 

86 

— 

86 

(7)

  

88 

81 

— 

169 

(41)

  

68 

109 

— 

177 

(116)

Other

86 

43 

130 

26 

  

90 

— 

10 

100 

(2)

  

911 

207 

331 

1,449 

(9)

Total

5,575 

8,644 

389 

14,608 

(884)

  

7,429 

13,777 

406 

21,612 

(2,492)

  

16,076 

17,362 

955 

34,393 

(3,065)

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             56 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

Country risk

58

Definition

58

External environment

58

Outlook

58

Sources of risk

58

Governance

59

Risk management

59

Risk measurement

59

Risk mitigation

60

Basis of reporting

60

Definitions

61

Country exposure

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             57 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Country risk

Definition

Country risk is the risk of losses occurring as a result of either a country event or unfavourable country operating conditions. As country events may simultaneously affect all or many individual exposures to a country, country event risk is a concentration risk.

 

External environment*

Macroeconomic conditions stabilised in 2013 with signs of improvement in most mature economies. The US showed the strongest improvement, with private investment picking up, the housing sector continuing to strengthen, and unemployment falling. This led the Federal Reserve to announce in May plans to begin normalising monetary policy. In December it announced it would start reducing quantitative easing. This resulted in some volatility in higher-yield asset markets, particularly emerging markets, where those with the largest external financing needs saw capital outflows, currency depreciation and stock market losses.

 

In the second half of the year, investor concerns were heightened by the risk that the US federal debt ceiling increase would not be passed on time and that the government might delay debt payments. Short-term political solutions to these issues were found, though with further progress needed in 2014.

 

The eurozone region as a whole remained in recession throughout the year, but signs of recovery were evident by the second half. Germany led, but the periphery also showed notable signs of stabilisation, with Ireland, Spain, and Portugal all growing in quarter-on-quarter terms in the last quarter of 2013. Eurozone monetary policy support underpinned investor confidence, while progress was made in developing a banking union that should reduce the risk of a repeat of the crisis over the longer term. Nevertheless, France and Italy underperformed peers.

 

In Japan, an economic reform strategy combined with large monetary stimulus contributed to currency depreciation, a reduction in deflationary expectations and strong growth in the first half. However, momentum slowed in the second half.

 

Many emerging market economies entered 2013 with high growth rates. While most were in substantially better shape than in previous crises, some had built up significant imbalances during years of strong capital inflows. As economic conditions in mature markets, particularly the US, improved in the course of the year, markets began to anticipate that monetary policies would normalise.

 

This led to a sharp round of capital outflows, particularly from equity markets, in the second quarter of 2013. Currency depreciations in a number of large emerging economies followed, especially in those with significant current account deficits. Among the better-rated economies, India, Brazil, Indonesia, South Africa and Turkey, were particularly affected. To stem the outflow of foreign capital and limit the impact on domestic asset markets, some countries, including India, started tightening monetary policy and accelerated financial sector reforms. Some countries with sizeable accumulated reserve assets, including China and Russia, were able to use their reserves to ease the pressure on their currencies.

 

Outlook

Further strengthening of economic growth in advanced economies is likely in 2014, but uncertainty over the impact of “tapering” is likely to contribute to further volatility in asset prices across most regions. The US is expected to perform quite strongly, with the eurozone also likely to continue its uneven recovery, although in both cases key areas of the economy will remain fragile. A more challenging year for emerging economies is expected as net capital inflows decline, resulting in more pronounced market volatility and differentiation. Further policy tightening is likely and growth rates are set to slow, especially in the weakest markets.

 

Sources of risk

Country risk has the potential to affect all parts of RBSH Group’s portfolio that are directly or indirectly linked to the country in question.

 

It arises from possible economic or political events in each country to which RBSH Group has exposure, and from unfavourable conditions affecting daily operations in a country.

 

Country events may include a sovereign default, political conflict, banking crisis or deep and prolonged recession leading to possible counterparty defaults. Transfer or convertibility restrictions imposed by a country’s government to stem the loss of foreign currency reserves may temporarily prevent counterparties from meeting their payment obligations. Major currency depreciation may also affect a customer’s income or debt burden, leading to default.

 

Unfavourable operating conditions may include the risk that a weak or creditor-unfriendly legal system within a country makes it difficult for RBSH Group to recover its claims in the event of customer default. An unreliable or unstable political system may lead to sudden compliance or reputational issues for RBSH Group, or even expropriation without proper compensation.

 

Governance*

All country exposures in RBSH Group are covered by RBS Group’s country risk framework and a further set of specific RBSH Group country limits.

 

RBS Group’s country risk framework is set by the RBS Group Executive Risk Forum (ERF). This body delegates authority to the RBS Group Country Risk Committee (GCRC) to decide on country risk matters, including risk appetite, risk management strategy and framework, risk exposure and policy, as well as sovereign ratings, sovereign loss-given-default rates and country Watchlist colours. The GCRC, which is chaired by the Head of Global Country Risk (GCoR) and includes representatives of divisions with country risk exposures, can escalate issues when necessary to the ERF.

 

For further information on governance, refer to the Risk governance section on page 26.

*unaudited  

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             58 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Country risk continued

Risk management*

Risk appetite setting

RBS Group country risk appetite was re-set for all countries based on the enhanced country risk appetite framework, introduced in late 2012. This framework has “top-down” and “bottom-up” components.

 

The “top-down” component is guided by RBS Group’s global risk appetite; each country’s internal sovereign rating and its strategic importance to RBS Group; the composition of RBS Group’s portfolio, as defined by tenors and clients; the funding profile and an assessment of the potential for losses arising from possible key country risk events. This component provides a clear structure for the consideration of downside scenarios, the identification of countries that pose material concentration risks to RBS Group, as well as possible management actions.

 

“Bottom-up” analysis includes risk/return performance together with reputational and regulatory risk.

 

Countries Watchlisted Amber (refer to Risk monitoring below) are monitored closely. Appetite for countries Watchlisted Red is limited to short-term business in areas such as trade finance and derivatives, unless the country is deemed a strategic priority country.

 

The actual country limits and medium-term sub-limits, with allocations to each division, are set by the GCRC (or the ERF above certain benchmark levels). The divisions manage their exposures within their country limit allocations. Divisions may agree re-allocations between themselves, and may further assign sub-allocations to business units or product groups in the division.

 

RBS Group country limits are set for almost all countries. The UK (and related European special territories of Guernsey, Jersey, the Isle of Man and Gibraltar) is an exception, given its home country status. The US is the other exception because of the specific local risk management structure, the size of the local portfolio and corresponding role in RBS Group-wide risk management, together with the country's strong ratings.

 

Specific RBSH Group country limits (capped by the overall RBS Group limits) are set by the RBSH Group Risk and Control Committee, which reports to the RBSH Group Board. Significant migrations of exposure from RBSH Group to RBS plc on a country-by-country basis, which started in 2012, continued during 2013. The RBSH Group country limits leave only limited headroom for countries to which most of the RBSH exposure has migrated and that are on run-off, while allowing sufficient room for a small number of ‘active’ countries where exposure is still awaiting migration. Exposures to the Netherlands (the RBSH Group home country), the UK and the US are exempt from RBSH Group country limits.

 

Risk monitoring, reporting and control

GCoR monitors and reports on RBSH Group-level exposures to all countries, and follows up in the event of excesses.

 

A country risk Watchlist process identifies emerging issues and facilitates the development of mitigation strategies. Coverage of the country Watchlist process was extended in 2013 to include all countries to which the RBS Group has exposure.

 

Regular reports that summarise and discuss RBSH Group’s key country risks and trends as well as changes in sovereign ratings or Country Watchlist status are sent to senior RBSH management.

 

Detailed portfolio reviews are conducted to ensure that country portfolio compositions remain aligned with RBS Group’s country risk appetite in light of economic and political developments.

 

Risk measurement*

In this section, country exposure includes wholesale and retail on-balance sheet exposure (drawn amounts under lending facilities, mark-to-market derivatives positions and issuer-risk debt securities positions in the banking book and trading book) together with off-balance sheet exposure (contingent obligations and undrawn commitments).

 

The scope of this country exposure concept is broader than the scope of the credit risk assets concept used in the Credit risk section, as the latter does not include debt securities or securities financing transactions.

 

RBS Group also estimates its funding mismatches at risk of redenomination in vulnerable eurozone countries. These mismatches are estimated in terms of potential for additional loss rather than amounts owed and are thus determined starting from the balance sheet exposure as defined on page 60 and excluding relevant offsetting positions. The latter include exposures at low risk of redenomination, as identified through consideration of the relevant documentation, particularly the currency of exposure, governing law, court of jurisdiction, precise definition of the contract currency (for euro facilities), and location of payment. RBS Group also deducts offsets for provisions taken and liabilities that would be expected to re-denominate at the same time. Similar estimates are made for RBSH Group. It is noted that RBS Group has publicly stated it will support RBSH Group in case of need.

 

Risk mitigation*

Part of RBS Group’s exposure is mitigated by guarantors or insurers (including export credit agencies), credit default swap (CDS) protection providers, or cash or non-cash collateral (such as commercial real estate) in third countries, which will not be directly affected by a country event in the obligor’s country.

 

*unaudited  

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             59 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Country risk continued

Basis of reporting

The tables in this section show RBSH Group’s exposure at 31 December 2013, 2012 and 2011. The numbers are reported by country of operation of the obligor, except exposures to governments and individuals which are shown by country of residence.

 

The country of operation is the country where the main operating assets of a legal entity are held, or where its main cash flows are generated, taking account of the entity’s dependency on subsidiaries' activities. Previously, exposures in this section were reported by country of incorporation. The new basis provides a better reflection of the country risks taken by RBSH Group and is more in line with internal risk management. Prior period information has been revised.

 

Countries shown are those which had ratings of A+ or below from Standard and Poor’s, Moody’s or Fitch at 31 December 2013, where RBSH Group’s balance sheet exposure (as defined in this section) to counterparties operating (or individuals residing) in them exceeded €1 billion). Also included are selected eurozone countries.

 

The exposures are stated before taking into account risk mitigants such as guarantees, insurance or collateral (with the exception of reverse repos) which may have been put in place to reduce or eliminate exposure to country risk events. The tables do separately show RBSH Group’s CDS positions, as RBSH Group may be either a net buyer or a net seller of protection. The CDS positions for 2013 and 2012 are by country of operation, those for 2011 are by country of incorporation.

 

Exposures relating to ocean-going vessels are not included as they cannot be meaningfully assigned to specific countries from a country risk perspective.

 

Definitions

Lending - Comprises gross loans and advances, including cash balances and risk elements in lending

 

Debt securities - Comprise securities classified as available-for-sale (AFS), loans and receivables (LAR), held-for-trading (HFT) and designated as at fair value through profit or loss (DFV). All debt securities other than LAR securities are carried at fair value. LAR debt securities are carried at amortised cost less impairment. HFT debt securities are presented as gross long positions (including DFV securities) and short positions per country. Impairment losses and exchange differences relating to AFS debt securities, together with interest, are recognised in the income statement. Other changes in the fair value of AFS securities are reported in AFS reserves, which are presented gross of tax.

 

Derivatives (net) - Comprise the mark-to-market (mtm) value of such contracts after the effect of legally enforceable netting agreements in line with the corresponding regulatory capital models, but before the effect of collateral.

 

Securities financing transactions (SFT) (net) - Comprise the mtm value of the cash and securities that are due to RBSH Group at a future date under repurchase agreements, reverse repurchase agreements, stock borrowing, stock lending and equity financing transactions, after the effect of collateral intrinsic to the transaction and legally enforceable netting agreements. Counterparty netting is applied as per the corresponding regulatory capital approach. Additional collateral called to offset mtm positions (variation margin) is not included.

 

Balance sheet - Comprises lending, debt securities, derivatives (net) and SFT (net) exposures, as defined above.

 

Off-balance sheet - Comprises letters of credit, guarantees, other contingent obligations and legally committed undrawn facilities.

 

Total exposure - Comprises balance sheet and off-balance sheet exposure, as defined above.

 

Credit default swaps (CDSs) - Under a CDS contract, the credit risk on the reference entity is transferred from the buyer to the seller. The column ‘fair value’ (or ‘mtm value’) represents the balance sheet carrying value of the resulting exposure. The mtm value of CDSs is included in derivatives against the counterparty of the trade, as opposed to the reference entity. The notional is the par value of the credit protection bought or sold and is included against the reference entity of the CDS contract.

 

The column ‘CDS notional less fair value’ represents the net effect on exposure should the CDS contracts be triggered by a credit event, assuming a zero recovery rate on the reference exposure. This net effect would be the increase in exposure arising from sold positions netted against the decrease arising from bought positions. For a sold position, the change in exposure equals the notional less the fair value amount; this represents the amount RBSH Group would owe to its CDS counterparties if the reference entity defaulted. Positive recovery rates would tend to reduce the gross components (increases and decreases) of those numbers.

 

Exposures relating to credit derivative product companies and related hedges as well as Nth-to-default basket swaps have been excluded, as they cannot be meaningfully attributed to a particular reference entity or country.

 

Government - Comprises central, regional and local government.

 

Eurozone periphery - Ireland, Spain, Italy, Portugal, Greece and Cyprus.

 

Other eurozone - Austria, Estonia, Finland, Malta, Slovakia and Slovenia.

The Netherlands, while being a eurozone country, has been excluded in these country risk tables as RBSH Group is based in the Netherlands.

 

 

 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             60 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Country risk

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Country exposure

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Derivatives

  

  

  

CDS

  

  

  

 (gross of

Balance

  

  

 (notional  

  

Debt

collateral)

 sheet  

Off-balance

  

less fair

Lending

securities

and repos

exposures

 sheet 

Total

 value) 

2013 

€m

€m

€m

€m

€m

€m

€m

Eurozone

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Spain

13 

4,996 

— 

5,009 

61 

5,070 

(5)

Italy

166 

514 

711 

1,391 

1,396 

(192)

Ireland

— 

225 

— 

225 

— 

225 

— 

Portugal

— 

85 

41 

126 

— 

126 

— 

Cyprus

43 

— 

— 

43 

— 

43 

— 

Greece

— 

— 

14 

16 

— 

Eurozone periphery

224 

5,820 

752 

6,796 

80 

6,876 

(197)

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Belgium

168 

531 

142 

841 

14 

855 

(1)

France

568 

— 

569 

269 

838 

(26)

Germany

83 

450 

10 

543 

204 

747 

(14)

Luxembourg

— 

53 

54 

— 

54 

(4)

Other Eurozone

— 

553 

— 

553 

25 

578 

(2)

Total eurozone

476 

7,923 

957 

9,356 

592 

9,948 

(244)

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Other countries

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

China

2,019 

210 

85 

2,314 

800 

3,114 

— 

India

818 

842 

77 

1,737 

417 

2,154 

— 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2012 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Eurozone

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Spain

55 

5,916 

— 

5,971 

99 

6,070 

(5)

Italy

154 

715 

724 

1,593 

72 

1,665 

(180)

Ireland

25 

433 

467 

47 

514 

— 

Portugal

— 

169 

135 

304 

37 

341 

— 

Cyprus

52 

— 

— 

52 

— 

52 

— 

Greece

— 

— 

15 

20 

— 

Eurozone periphery

286 

7,233 

873 

8,392 

270 

8,662 

(185)

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Belgium

299 

1,006 

180 

1,485 

88 

1,573 

(1)

France

119 

1,173 

175 

1,467 

551 

2,018 

(27)

Germany

169 

2,166 

154 

2,489 

521 

3,010 

(13)

Luxembourg

16 

— 

18 

34 

134 

168 

(2)

Other Eurozone

— 

687 

— 

687 

43 

730 

(2)

Total eurozone

889 

12,265 

1,400 

14,554 

1,607 

16,161 

(230)

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Other countries

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

China

1,551 

314 

45 

1,910 

422 

2,332 

(11)

India

1,716 

1,137 

63 

2,916 

676 

3,592 

— 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             61 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Country risk continued 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Country exposure continued

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Derivatives

  

  

  

CDS

  

  

  

 (gross of

Balance

  

  

 (notional  

  

Debt

collateral)

 sheet  

Off-balance

  

less fair

Lending

securities

and repos

exposures

 sheet 

Total

 value) 

2011 

€m

€m

€m

€m

€m

€m

€m

Eurozone

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Spain

830 

7,663 

8,496 

1,536 

10,032 

(39)

Italy

1,456 

1,102 

697 

3,255 

935 

4,190 

(115)

Ireland

106 

368 

50 

524 

325 

849 

192 

Portugal

40 

176 

75 

291 

136 

427 

(4)

Cyprus

61 

— 

— 

61 

27 

88 

— 

Greece

320 

373 

694 

39 

733 

— 

Eurozone periphery

2,813 

9,682 

826 

13,321 

2,998 

16,319 

34 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Belgium

730 

879 

196 

1,805 

768 

2,573 

(12)

France

1,012 

2,600 

(898)

2,714 

1,989 

4,703 

(252)

Germany

908 

5,675 

882 

7,465 

3,125 

10,590 

(140)

Luxembourg

337 

(47)

751 

1,041 

250 

1,291 

(87)

Other Eurozone

199 

722 

922 

342 

1,264 

(12)

Total eurozone

5,999 

19,511 

1,758 

27,268 

9,472 

36,740 

(469)

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Other countries

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

China

2,714 

— 

104 

2,818 

1,528 

4,346 

— 

India

4,057 

— 

231 

4,288 

869 

5,157 

— 

 

 

Key points*

·         During 2013, the US dollar depreciated by 2.3% against sterling, whereas the euro appreciated by 2.2%, impacting exposures.

 

·         Balance sheet and off-balance sheet exposures to nearly all countries declined significantly over 2013, reflecting further exposure migrations to RBS plc. In addition, RBSH Group maintained a cautious stance and many clients reduced debt levels. The reductions were seen in all broad product categories and in all client groups.  Most of RBSH Group’s remaining country risk exposure is in International Banking (primarily trade facilities, other lending and off-balance sheet exposure to corporates and financial institutions); Group Treasury (largely cash balances at central banks and AFS debt securities including Spanish cedulas); and Markets (principally derivatives and securities financing transactions with financial institutions).

 

·         Total eurozone net bought protection in terms of CDS notional less fair value was €0.2 billion.

 

·         Eurozone periphery - balance sheet exposure decreased to €6.8 billion, a reduction of €1.6 billion or 19%, in all countries, despite the appreciation of the euro against sterling, as below:

 

°          Spain - Group Treasury’s holdings of covered bonds (cedulas) decreased by €0.9 billion due to sales in improved market              conditions.

 

°          Italy - AFS bonds exposure decreased by €0.2 billion.

 

°          Ireland - AFS bonds exposure decreased by €0.2 billion.

 

°          Portugal - derivatives and AFS debt securities exposure declined by €0.1 billion each.

 

·         China - lending and off-balance sheet exposure to financial institutions increased by €0.5 billion and €0.4 billion respectively.

 

·         Funding mismatches - the estimated funding mismatch at risk of redenomination at 31 December 2013 was €5.0 billion for Spain (largely related to AFS bond holdings in RBSH Group’s liquidity portfolio) and €0.5 billion for Italy. The net positions for Ireland, Portugal, Cyprus and Greece were all minimal. Overall, perceived risks of redenomination events in the eurozone declined considerably in 2013.

 

*unaudited  

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             62 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

Market risk

64

Sources of risk

64

Governance

64

Risk appetite and limit framework

66

Traded market risk

69

Market risk analyses

70

Non-traded interest rate risk

71

Structural foreign currency exposure

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             63 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Market risk

Definition

Market risk is the risk of losses arising from fluctuations in interest rates, credit spreads, foreign currency rates, equity prices, commodity prices and other factors, such as market volatilities, that may lead to a reduction in earnings, economic value or both.

 

Sources of risk

RBSH Group is exposed to traded market risk through its trading activities and to non-traded market risk as a result of its banking activities. In many respects, it manages its traded and non-traded market risk exposures separately, as described in this section, largely in line with the regulatory definitions of the trading and non-trading books.

 

Traded market risk

The majority of RBSH Group’s traded market risk exposure arises in Markets and Non-Core.

 

The primary objective of RBSH Group’s trading activities is to provide a range of financing, risk management and investment services to its customers, including major corporations and financial institutions around the world. From a market risk perspective, RBSH Group’s trading activities are included within the following markets: currencies; emerging markets; rates; asset-backed products; and traded credit.

 

RBSH Group undertakes transactions in financial instruments including debt securities, loans, deposits and equities, as well as securities financing and derivative transactions.

 

Some of these transactions involve trading or clearing financial instruments on an exchange, including interest rate swaps, futures and options. Holders of exchange-traded instruments provide margin on a daily basis with cash or other security at the exchange.

 

Other transactions involve trading financial instruments over-the-counter rather than on an exchange. Transactions with standard terms are cleared through central counterparties, while complex transactions are cleared directly with the counterparty. These range from commoditised transactions in derivative markets to trades tailored to meet specific customer requirements. Such transactions also give rise to counterparty credit risk, which RBSH Group manages actively.

 

Non-traded market risk

The majority of RBSH Group’s non-traded market risk exposure arises from retail and commercial banking activities in all divisions from assets and liabilities that are not classified as held-for-trading.

 

RBSH Group’s management of non-traded market risk is largely organised in line with the following two key categories: non-traded interest rate risk (NTIRR) and non-traded foreign exchange risk. RBSH Group has no material exposure to non-traded equity risk.

 

Interest rate risk

NTIRR arises from the provision to customers of a range of banking products that have differing interest rate characteristics. Therefore, when aggregated, these products form portfolios of assets and liabilities with varying degrees of sensitivity to changes in market interest rates. Mismatches in these sensitivities can give rise to volatility in net interest income as interest rates rise and fall.

 

Foreign exchange risk

Non-traded foreign exchange risk exposures for RBSH Group arise from two main sources:

·         the capital deployed in foreign subsidiaries, branches and associates and related currency funding where it differs from sterling (these exposures are known as structural foreign exchange exposures); and

·         customer transactions and profits and losses in a currency that differs from the functional currency of the underlying balance sheet on which activity occurs.

 

Equity risk

RBSH Group has no material exposure to non-traded equity.

 

Governance

Business structure

The RBS Group Chief Risk Officer (CRO) delegates responsibility for day-to-day control of market risk to the traded and non-traded market risk functions. Responsibility for controlling market risk in divisions is delegated to divisional market risk functions, the heads of which are accountable to divisional CROs, who in turn are accountable to the Group CRO.

 

Organisation structure

Independent oversight and support is provided to the business by the RBS Group Market Risk teams. The head of each business assisted by the business risk management team is accountable for all market risks associated with its activities.

 

The RBS Group Global Market Risk Committee reviews and makes recommendations concerning the market risk profile across RBSH Group, including risk appetite, risk policy, models, methodology and market risk development issues. Attendees include respective divisional risk managers and RBS Group Market Risk.

 

Risk appetite and limit framework*

Market risk appetite is the level of market risk that RBSH Group accepts when pursuing its business objectives, taking into account both projected and stressed scenarios. RBSH Group has a comprehensive structure and controls in place aimed at ensuring that this appetite is not exceeded. RBSH Group’s risk appetite is aligned with that of RBS Group.

 

RBS Group’s qualitative market risk appetite is set out in policy statements. These define the governance, responsibilities, control framework and requirements for the identification, measurement, analysis, management and reporting of market risk arising from RBSH Group’s trading and non-trading activities.  

 

RBS Group’s market risk limits that express its market risk appetite in quantitative terms for trading and non-trading activities are proposed by, respectively, the heads of traded and non-traded market risk. Once approved by the RBS Group Executive Risk Forum (ERF), these limits establish a set of comprehensive boundaries within which business activities are conducted and monitored. The heads of traded and non-traded market risk cascade the RBSG Group market risk limits down to the legal entities and divisions. The divisional market risk functions are responsible for cascading divisional and legal entity market risk limits to lower levels as appropriate.

*unaudited

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             64 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Market risk continued

Risk appetite and limit framework continued 

RBSH Group’s limit framework comprises value-at-risk (VaR), stressed value-at-risk (SVaR), sensitivity and stress limits. The limit framework at divisional and lower levels also comprises additional metrics that are specific to the market risk exposures within its scope. These additional metrics aim to control various risk dimensions such as product type, exposure size, aged inventory, currency and tenor.

 

The limits are reviewed to reflect changes in risk appetite, business plans, portfolio composition and the market and economic environments.

 

Limit breaches require escalation by the head of the relevant divisional market risk function to the head of traded market risk or the head of non-traded market risk, as appropriate.

 

Valuation and independent price verification

Traders are responsible for marking-to-market their trading book positions daily, ensuring that assets and liabilities in the trading book are measured at their fair value. Any profits or losses on the revaluation of positions are recognised daily.

 

Business unit controllers are responsible for ensuring that independent price verification processes are in place covering all trading book positions held by their business. Independent price verification is the key control over front office marking of positions.

 

The validation of pricing models is discussed below.

 

Model validation

This sub-section discusses the independent model validation framework governing both pricing models and risk models (including Value-at-Risk).

 

RBSH Group uses a variety of models to manage and measure market risk, as described below. These models comprise pricing models (used for valuation of positions) and risk models (for risk measurement and capital calculation purposes). They are developed in both divisional units and RBS Group functions and are subject to independent review and sign-off.

 

RBS Group has a dedicated independent model review and challenge function, Group Risk Analytics (GRA), which performs reviews of RBSH Group relevant models in two instances: (i) for new models or amendments to existing models and (ii) as part of its ongoing programme to assess the performance of these models.

 

A new model is typically introduced when an existing model is no longer fit for purpose or a new product requires a new methodology or model to quantify the risk appropriately. Amendments are usually made when a weakness is identified during use of a model or following analysis either by the model developers in the divisions or by GRA.

 

GRA also reassesses the appropriateness of approved models following significant market or regulatory developments or portfolio changes. The mechanics of the review process are the same as those for new models.

 

Pricing models*

Pricing models are developed by a dedicated front office team, in conjunction with the trading desk. They are used for the valuation of positions for which prices are not directly observable and for the risk management of the portfolio.

 

Any pricing models that are used as the basis for valuing books and records are subject to approval and oversight by asset-level modelled product review committees.

 

These committees comprise representatives of the major stakeholders in the valuation process - trading, finance, market risk, model development and model review functions.

 

The review process comprises the following steps:

·         The committees prioritise models for GRA review, considering the materiality of the risk booked against the model and an assessment of the degree of model risk, that is the valuation uncertainty arising from the choice of modelling assumptions.

·         GRA quantifies the model risk by comparing front office model outputs with those of alternative models independently developed by GRA.

·         The sensitivities derived from the pricing models are validated.

·         The conclusions of the review are used by Market Risk to inform risk limits and by Finance to inform model reserves.

 

Risk models*

All new risk models are subject to GRA review and sign-off.

 

All model changes are approved through model governance at the divisional level. Changes to existing models that have an impact on VaR exceeding 5% at legal entity level or 15% at a major business level are also subject to GRA review and sign-off as are all model changes that require regulator approval before implementation.

 

The traded market risk team in Markets also performs regular VaR model testing, which is discussed in more detail under Risk Measurement - Value at Risk on page 66.

 

GRA’s independent review comprises some or all of the following steps, as appropriate:

·         Testing and challenging the logical and conceptual soundness of the methodology;

·         Testing the assumptions underlying the model, where feasible, against actual behaviour. In its validation report, GRA will opine on the reasonableness and stability of the assumptions and specify which assumptions, if any, should be routinely monitored in production;

 

*unaudited

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             65 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Market risk continued

Risk models continued

·         Testing whether all key market risks have been sufficiently captured;

·         Re-applying the proposed approach to verify that the same outcome is achieved;

·         Comparing outputs with results from alternative methods;

·         Testing parameter selection and calibration;

·         Ensuring model outputs are sufficiently conservative in areas where there is significant model uncertainty;

·         Confirming the applicability of tests for accuracy and stability; recalculating and ensuring that results are robust; and

·         Ensuring appropriate sensitivity analysis has been performed and documented.

 

Based on the review and findings from GRA, an internal model governance committee with appropriate delegated authority considers whether a model can be approved for use and whether any conditions need to be imposed, including those relating to the remediation of material issues raised through the review process. Once approved through internal governance, the new or amended model is implemented. Meetings are held with the DNB as required to discuss the traded market risk, including changes in models, management, back-testing results and other model performance statistics.

 

GRA also reassesses the appropriateness of approved risk models annually.

 

Traded market risk

Risk management

The governance framework, risk management principles and appetite and limit framework applicable to RBSH Group’s management of market risk are covered by the discussion under the Governance section. More specific information on RBSH Group’s management of traded market risk is provided below.

 

Identification and assessment

Identification and assessment of traded market risk is achieved through gathering, analysing, monitoring and reporting market risk information by business line or at a consolidated level. Industry expertise, continued system developments and techniques such as stress testing are also used to enhance the effectiveness of the identification of all material market risks.

 

This is complemented by the New Product Risk Assessment process, which requires market risk teams to assess and quantify market risk associated with all proposed new products.

 

Reporting and monitoring

RBSH Group’s traded market risk exposures are monitored against limits and analysed daily by market risk reporting and control functions. A daily report that summarises RBSH Group’s market risk exposures against the limits is sent to the RBSH Group Head of Market Risk.

 

Divisional market risk functions also prepare daily risk reports that detail exposures against a more granular set of limits and triggers.

 

Finally, a market risk update is included in the monthly risk management report sent to RBSH Group Risk and Control Committee (RCC).

 

Counterparty Exposure Management

Management of the over-the-counter derivative counterparty credit risk and funding risk is carried out by the Counterparty Exposure Management (CEM) desk in Markets. CEM actively manages risk exposures and concentrations on behalf of both Markets and Non-Core. The hedging transactions CEM enters into are booked in the trading book and therefore contribute to the Group’s market risk VaR exposure and capital.

 

Risk measurement

VaR

VaR is a technique that produces estimates of the potential change in the market value of a portfolio over a specified time horizon at given confidence level. For internal risk management purposes, RBS Group’s VaR assumes a time horizon of one trading day and a confidence level of 99%. RBS Group's VaR model is based on a historical simulation model, utilising data from the previous two years.

 

At RBSH Group level, a different VaR model is employed. It remains based on a historical simulation model and assumes a time horizon of one trading day and a confidence level of 99%. However, it uses 401 observations of historical market data exponentially weighted with a weighted average history of six months.

 

VaR limitations*

Historical simulation VaR and RBSH Group’s implementation have a number of known limitations, as summarised below, and RBSH Group’s VaR should be interpreted in light of these.

 

·         Historical simulation VaR may not provide the best estimate of future market movements. It can only provide a forecast of portfolio losses based on events that occurred in the past. The RBSH Group model uses the previous 401 days of data; this period represents a balance between model responsiveness to recent shocks and risk factor data coverage.

·         The use of a 99% confidence level VaR statistic does not provide information about losses beyond this level, usually referred to as ‘tail’ risks. These risks are more appropriately assessed using measures such as Stressed VaR and stress testing.

·         The use of a one-day time horizon will not fully capture the profit and loss implications of positions that cannot be liquidated or hedged within one day. This may not fully reflect market risk at times of severe illiquidity in the market when a one-day period may be insufficient to liquidate or hedge positions fully. Thus, the regulatory VaR that is used for modelled market risk capital uses a ten-day time horizon.

 

*unaudited  

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             66 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Market risk continued

VaR limitations continued

·         RBSH Group computes the VaR of trading positions at the close of business. Positions may change substantially during the course of the trading day and so intra-day price volatility and trading may not be captured by the model.

 

·         Risk factors relevant to a specific portfolio may be omitted, due to a lack of reliable data, or the use of proxy risk factors, for example. RBSH Group has developed the Risks not in VaR (RNIV) framework to address these issues.

 

·         RBSH Group’s approach is to supplement VaR with other metrics that addresses the above limitations to ensure appropriate coverage of all material risks.

 

VaR validation*

In addition to the independent VaR model reviews carried out by GRA, a dedicated model-testing team within RBS Group Market Risk works with the risk managers to:

 

·         Test the accuracy of the valuation methods used in the VaR model on appropriately chosen test portfolios and trades.

·         Apply in-house models to perform advanced internal back-testing to complement the regulatory back-testing.

·         Ensure that tests capture the effect of using external data proxies where these are used.

·         Identify risks not adequately captured in VaR, and ensure that such risks are addressed via the RNIV framework.

·         Identify any model weaknesses or scope limitations and their impact.

·         Identify and give early warning of any market or portfolio weakness that may become significant.

 

As well as being an important market risk measurement and control tool, the VaR model is also used to determine a significant component of the market risk capital requirement. Therefore, it is subject to not only ongoing internal review and validation but also regulator-prescribed back-testing.

 

VaR back-testing*

The main approach employed to assess the ongoing model performance is back-testing, which counts the number of days when a loss exceeds the corresponding daily VaR estimate, measured at a 99% confidence level. There are two types of profit and loss (P&L) used in back-testing comparisons: Clean P&L and Hypothetical (Hypo) P&L.

 

The Clean P&L figure for a particular business day is the firm’s actual P&L for that day in respect of the trading activities within the scope of the firm’s regulatory VaR model, adjusted by stripping out:

 

·         Fees and commissions;

·         Brokerage; and

·         Additions to, and releases from, reserves that are not directly related to market risk.

 

The Hypo P&L reflects the firm’s Clean P&L excluding any intra-day activities.

 

A portfolio is said to produce a back-testing exception when the Clean or Hypo P&L exceeds the VaR level on a given day. Such an event may be caused by a large market movement or may highlight issues such as missing risk factors or inappropriate time series. Any such issues identified are analysed and addressed through taking appropriate remediation or development action. RBSH Group monitors both Clean and Hypo back-testing exceptions.

 

Regulatory back-testing is performed and reported on a daily basis. Divisional market risk teams also perform back-testing at the lower levels as part of the internal ongoing VaR model validation.

 

The VaR model is categorised as green, amber or red. A green model is consistent with a good working model and is achieved for models that have four or fewer back-testing exceptions in a 12 month period. For RBSH Group’s trading book, a green model status was maintained throughout 2013.

 

SVaR*

As with VaR, the SVaR technique produces estimates of the potential change in the market value of a portfolio, over a specified time horizon, at a given confidence level. SVaR is a VaR-based measure using historical data from a one-year period of stressed market conditions.

 

A simulation is run daily for 99% VaR on the current portfolio for each 260-day period from 1 January 2005 to the current VaR date, moving forward one day at a time. The SVaR is the worst VaR outcome of the simulated results.

 

This is in contrast with VaR, which is based on a rolling 401-day historical data set. For the purposes of both internal risk management and regulatory SVaR calculation, a time horizon of ten trading days is assumed with a confidence level of 99%.

*unaudited  

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             67 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Market risk continued

Risks not in VaR (RNIV)*

The RNIV approach is used for market risks that fall within the scope of VaR and SVaR but that are insufficiently captured by the model methodology, for example due to a lack of suitable historical data. The RNIV framework has been developed to quantify these market risks and to ensure that RBSH Group holds adequate capital.

 

The need for an RNIV is typically identified in one of the following two circumstances: (i) as part of the New Product Risk Assessment process, when a risk manager assesses that the associated risk is not adequately captured by the VaR model; or (ii) as a result of a recommendation made by GRA or the model validation team when reviewing the VaR model.

 

The RNIVs provide a capital estimate of risks not captured in the VaR model and are regularly reported and discussed with senior management and the regulator. The methodology used in the RNIV calculation is internally reviewed by the model-testing team. Where appropriate, risk managers set sensitivity limits to control specific risk factors giving rise to the RNIV. RNIVs form an integral part of RBSH Group’s ongoing model and data improvement efforts to capture all market risks in scope for model approval in VaR and SVaR. Since the introduction of the RNIV framework, RBSH Group has made significant progress in transitioning RNIVs into the VaR model.

 

RBSH Group adopts two approaches for the quantification of RNIVs:

 

·         A standalone VaR approach. Under this approach, two values are calculated: (i) the VaR RNIV; and (ii) the SVaR RNIV.

·         A stress-scenario approach. Under this approach an assessment of ten-day extreme, but plausible, market moves is used in combination with position sensitivities to give a stress-type loss number – the stressed RNIV value.

 

For each legal entity covered by RBS Group’s PRA VaR model waiver, RNIVs above a regulatory defined threshold are aggregated to obtain the following three measures: (i) Total VaR RNIV; (ii) Total SVaR RNIV; and (iii) Total stressed RNIV. A similar process is followed for the market risk in RBSH Group. In each case, no allowance is made for potential diversification in respect of material RNIVs.

 

Stress testing*

RBSH Group undertakes daily market risk stress testing to identify vulnerabilities and potential losses in excess of or not captured in VaR. The calculated stresses measure the impact of changes in risk factors on the fair values of the RBSH Group’s trading and available-for-sale portfolios.

 

RBSH Group conducts scenario-based sensitivity analysis and historical, macroeconomic and bottom-up stress testing.

 

Scenario-based sensitivity analysis measures the sensitivity of the current portfolio to defined movements in market risk factors. These risk factor movements and the resulting valuation changes are typically smaller than those considered in other stress tests.

 

Historical stress testing is a measure that is used for internal management. Using a similar technical framework to VaR, the current portfolio is stressed using historical data since 1 January 2005. The methodology simulates the impact of the worst loss that would be incurred by historical risk factor movements over the period, assuming a holding period specific to the risk factors and the businesses. At present, a holding period of 60 business days is applied for credit risk factors (including in the case of ABS) and for the AFS portfolios that are held by Markets Treasury and generally a period of ten business days for other risk factors. RBS Group reviews the holding periods annually and is considering introducing greater distinction between the liquidity assumptions associated with each risk factor.

 

The main strength of this methodology is that it is founded on objective data and the potential loss is directly informed by real-life examples. As with all historically based methodologies, an obvious limitation is that the approach it is not forward-looking. However, this weakness is materially addressed by the other stress testing approaches that constitute the RBS stress testing framework.

 

Historical stress tests form part of the RBSH Group market risk limit framework and stress test exposures are discussed with senior management and relevant information is reported to the RBSH Group Risk and Control Committee (RCC), the RBS Group Board and the RBSH Group Managing Board. Breaches in RBSH Group’s market risk stress testing limits are monitored and reported.

 

Bottom-up stress testing begins with the analysis of a portfolio and expresses the key vulnerabilities of the portfolio in terms of plausible, so-called vulnerability scenarios under which the portfolio would suffer material losses. These scenarios can be historical, forward-looking, macroeconomic or hypothetical. Bottom-up stress testing is used for internal management information and is not subject to limits. However, relevant scenarios are reported to senior management.

 

Regulatory treatment* 

The market risks subject to capital requirements under Pillar 1 are primarily interest rate, credit spread and equity risks in the trading book. Interest rate and equity risks are split between general and specific risks. General risks represent market risks due to a move in a market as a whole, such as a main index or yield curve, while specific risks represent market risks arising from events particular to an underlying issuer.

 

Firms can choose from two broad methodologies to calculate their market risk capital charge: (i) the standard rules, whereby regulator-prescribed rules must be applied, and (ii) the internal model approach, where, subject to regulatory approval, a model such as VaR is used to calculate the capital charge.

 

*unaudited  

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             68 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Market risk continued

Regulatory treatment continued 

The VaR model has been approved by the DNB to calculate regulatory capital for the trading book via a scaling approach of ten days. RBSH Group’s SVaR model has also been approved by the DNB for use in the capital requirement calculation. 

 

The regulatory VaR and SVaR differ from internal VaR and SVaR as they cover only regulator approved products, locations and legal entities. VaR and SVaR capture general and specific risks but not risks arising from the impact of defaults and rating changes associated with traded credit products and their derivatives. For these risks, two product-dependent approaches are used:

 

·         Incremental risk charge* - The Incremental Risk Charge (IRC) model captures risks arising from defaults and rating changes for the more liquid traded credit instruments and their derivatives held in the trading book. It is calculated over a one year horizon to a 99.9% confidence level, and therefore represents a 1-in-1,000 loss over the following year.

 

·         All price risk* - The All Price Risk (APR) model covers the generally lower-liquidity correlation trades and their liquid hedges (such as first-to-default basket trades). During 2013 there was no APR charge for RBSH Group.

 

Market risk analyses

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Trading VaR

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

The table below analyses VaR for RBSH Group’s trading portfolios segregated by type of market risk exposure.

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

 

  

2013

 

2012

 

2011

Trading VaR summary

Average 

Period end 

Maximum 

Minimum 

  

Average

Period end 

Maximum 

Minimum 

 

Average 

Period end 

Maximum 

Minimum 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Interest rate

1.7 

1.1 

3.4 

0.7 

  

3.0 

2.0 

7.4 

1.8 

 

4.5 

4.0 

9.6 

3.0 

Credit spread

0.2 

0.1 

0.9 

— 

  

1.4 

0.8 

3.9 

0.8 

 

2.4 

1.7 

4.3 

1.1 

Currency

1.1 

0.8 

2.6 

0.4 

  

1.7 

1.3 

11.3 

0.6 

 

3.1 

1.4 

15.3 

1.1 

Equity

0.3 

0.1 

1.1 

0.1 

  

2.1 

0.7 

9.7 

0.5 

 

6.5 

2.5 

15.8 

1.8 

Commodity

0.2 

— 

1.5 

— 

  

0.9 

0.6 

3.1 

0.4 

 

0.8 

1.1 

6.7 

— 

Diversification (1) 

  

(0.5)

  

  

  

  

(2.8)

  

  

 

  

6.2 

  

 

Total

2.0 

1.6 

3.4 

0.9 

  

4.4 

2.6 

11.3 

2.1 

 

8.5 

4.5 

18.3 

4.0 

 

Note:

(1)    RBSH Group benefits from diversification, which reflects the risk reduction achieved by allocating investments across various financial instrument types, industry counterparties, currencies and regions. The extent of diversification benefit depends on the correlation between the assets and risk factors in the portfolio at a particular time.

 

Key point

·         The average total VaR utilisation fell in 2013 compared with 2012 and 2011, largely as a result of a reduction in trading book exposure due to transfers of businesses to RBS Group.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

*unaudited  

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             69 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Market risk continued

Non-traded market risk*

Risk management

RBSH Group manages non-traded market risk separately for non-traded interest rate risk and non-traded foreign exchange risk.

 

Interest rate risk

RBSH Group policy is to manage interest rate sensitivity in banking book portfolios within defined risk limits. Interest rate risk is transferred from the banking divisions to RBSH Group Treasury. Aggregate positions are then hedged externally using cash and derivative instruments, primarily interest rate swaps, to manage exposures within RBSH Group Asset and Liability Management Committee (ALCO) approved limits. RBSH Group is required to manage non-traded interest rate risk (NTIRR) through transactions with RBS plc to the greatest extent possible. Residual risk positions are routinely reported to ALCO, the Managing and Supervisory Boards and the RCC.

 

Key measures used to evaluate NTIRR are subjected to approval granted by the ALCO. Limits on NTIRR are set according to the Non-Trading Interest Rate and Foreign Currency Risk Policy Statement and are subject to RBSH Group ALCO approval.

 

NTIRR is measured using a version of the same VaR methodology that is used by RBS Group. VaR metrics are based on interest rate repricing gap reports as at the reporting date. These incorporate customer products and associated funding and hedging transactions as well as non-financial assets and liabilities such as property, equipment, capital and reserves. Behavioural assumptions are applied as appropriate.

 

NTIRR one-day VaR at 99% confidence level for RBSH Group's retail and commercial banking activities was as follows. The figures exclude the banking books of Short Term Markets and Finance (STMF) which are managed by the traded market risk function.

 

·         RBSH Group's exposure to interest rate risk continued to fall in 2013 as a result of further business transfers to RBS plc. However, given changes to modelled assumptions around reserves, reported VaR increased from €5.2 million at the end of 2012 to €10.1 million at the end of 2013, reflecting exposure to falling short-term rates.

 

  

Average 

Period end 

Maximum 

Minimum 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

2013 

5.4 

10.1 

10.6 

2.0 

2012 

6.0 

5.2 

9.6 

4.4 

2011 

10.0 

8.3 

15.2 

7.4 

  

  

  

  

  

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

*unaudited  

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             70 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Market risk continued

Structural foreign currency exposures

RBSH Group does not maintain material non-trading open currency positions, other than the structural foreign currency translation exposures arising from its investments in foreign subsidiaries and associated undertakings and their related currency funding.

  

The table below sets out RBSH Group structural foreign currency exposures.

  

Net 

  

Structural 

investments 

Net 

 foreign 

 in foreign 

 investment 

 currency 

operations (1) 

 hedges 

 exposures 

2013 

€m 

 €m 

€m 

US dollar

1,176 

(533)

643 

Sterling

(15)

15 

— 

Other non-euro

1,768 

(1,660)

108 

  

2,929 

(2,178)

751 

  

  

  

  

2012 

  

  

  

US dollar

1,259 

(960)

299 

Sterling

(397)

75 

(322)

Other non-euro

2,558 

(2,034)

524 

  

3,420 

(2,919)

501 

  

  

  

  

2011 

  

  

  

US dollar

1,334 

(1,129)

205 

Sterling

721 

(715)

Other non-euro

3,749 

(2,310)

1,439 

  

5,804 

(4,154)

1,650 

 

Note:

(1)       Includes minority participations.

 

Key points

·         RBSH Group's structural foreign currency exposure at 31 December 2013 was €0.8 billion, an increase of €0.3 billion on 2012. Net investments in foreign operations decreased by €0.5 billion, primarily as a result of the disposals of overseas business units. This was partly offset by capital injections into businesses whose functional currency is Sterling.

 

·         Changes in foreign currency exchange rates will affect equity in proportion to structural foreign currency exposure. A 10% movement in foreign currencies against the euro would result in a gain/(loss) of €75 million (2012 - €45 million strengthening, €55 million weakening; 2011- €162 million strengthening, €165 million weakening) in equity.

 

 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             71 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

 

Other risks

73

Conduct risk

73

Operational risk

75

Regulatory risk

76

Reputational risk

77

Business risk

77

Strategic risk

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             72 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Other risks*

Conduct risk

Definition

Conduct risk is the risk that the behaviour of RBSH Group and its staff towards its customers, or in the markets in which it operates, leads to reputational damage or financial loss or both. The damage or loss could be as a result of breaches of regulatory rules or laws, or of failing to meet customers’ or regulators’ expectations of RBSH Group.

 

Sources of risk

Activities through which conduct risk may arise include: product design, marketing and sales; complaint handling; staff training and competence; and handling of confidential and non-public price sensitive information.

 

Governance structure

Effective conduct risk management is a commercial imperative for RBS Group: customers, clients and counterparties demand it as a precursor to building trust. It also reflects the developing regulatory environment in the UK, with the establishment of the Financial Conduct Authority, and the increasing focus of overseas regulators on conduct risk.

 

RBS Group’s compliance functions are responsible for the appropriate management of conduct risk, including Anti-Money Laundering (AML); Sanctions and Terrorist Financing (STF); and Anti-Bribery and Corruption (ABC). In doing so, they design, implement and maintain a management framework, the objective of which is the consistent identification, assessment, monitoring, and reporting of conduct risk.

 

A conduct risk governance structure, within which all divisions are represented by senior business leaders, provides clarity on roles, responsibilities and accountabilities for conduct risk. Key elements of the governance structure are set out below.

 

The Conduct Risk Committee: Operating under delegated authority from the Executive Risk Forum (ERF), it has responsibility for the governance, leadership and strategic oversight of the RBS Group-wide conduct agenda. It can escalate significant issues to the ERF and the Board Risk Committee.

 

The Compliance Management Team: a sub-committee of the Conduct Risk Committee, it has the authority to act on conduct risk matters such as: risk appetite; risk management strategy and framework; and risk profile and policy.

 

The RBS Group Board receives updates on conduct risk via monthly risk reports.

 

Risk management and measurement

RBS Group has established a defined and measurable appetite for conduct risk to ensure commercial decisions take into account any conduct risk implications.

 

Placing conduct risk at the centre of the RBS Group’s philosophy promotes a customer-oriented culture that informs and challenges business strategy, delivers fair outcomes, and promotes behaviours consistent with regulatory and legal standards across its retail and wholesale markets.

 

Throughout 2013, the foundations of RBS Group’s conduct risk framework continued to be delivered. Key milestones included:

 

·         The completion of the phased roll-out of RBS Group’s conduct risk policies, using policy chapters to explain Group-wide conduct responsibilities;

·         The development and delivery of awareness initiatives and targeted conduct risk training for each policy to assist businesses and executives in embedding the understanding of conduct risk, and to provide the necessary clarity for staff on their conduct risk requirements;

·         Completion of RBS Group-wide gap analysis and benchmarking exercise with respect to each of the conduct risk policy chapters, recording identified issues and developing and implementing remediation plans;

·         Establishing a central assurance function RBS Group Conduct and Regulatory Affairs, covering all elements of RBS Group’s conduct risk policies, including AML, STF and ABC; and

·         Establishing effective leadership and a supporting governance framework, with the participation of all divisions, to oversee RBS Group’s conduct agenda.

 

In 2013, RBS Group continued to focus on strengthening the capabilities of its compliance functions, at both Group and divisional level through investment in training. To do so, it facilitated training on conduct risk, primarily through computer-based Group Policy Learning modules. Each module addresses the regulatory content of relevant RBS Group Policy Standards.

 

Risk mitigation

Assurance and monitoring activities are essential to ensure that RBSH Group can demonstrate compliance with existing rules and regulations, assess whether it is managing its conduct risks appropriately, and determine whether key controls are effective. In 2013, the RBS Group Conduct and Regulatory Affairs assurance function provided RBS Group-wide assurance over specific compliance topics, as well as thematic process reviews.

 

Operational risk

Definition

Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems, or external events.

 

It arises from day-today operations and is relevant to every aspect of RBS Group’s business.

 

Sources of risk

Operational risk may arise from a failure to manage appropriately RBSH Group's operations, transactions and security. It may arise from other forms of human error, an inability to deliver change on time or adequately, or from the unavailability of technology services, the loss of customer data.  It could also result from a liability or a loss arising from a defective transaction.  A failure to take appropriate measures to protect assets or to take account of changes in law, are sources of risk.  Fraud and theft are important sources of operational risk, as is the impact of natural and man-made disasters.

 

*unaudited

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             73 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Other risks* continued

Operational risk  continued

Governance structure

RBS Group operates with an independent Operational Risk Second Line of Defence function comprising both a central team and teams based in each business.

 

The Operational Risk function is responsible for the design and maintenance of the operational risk framework. The Operational Risk Policy and associated standards are incorporated in the RBS Group Policy Framework and provide direction for the consistent identification, assessment, management, monitoring and reporting of operational risk.

 

The RBSH Group Risk and Control Committee acts on all operational risk matters. It is responsible for identifying and managing emerging operational risks, and for reviewing and monitoring operational risk profile strategies and frameworks across the Group, ensuring they are in line with risk appetite. It escalates and reports necessary items to the Managing Board.

 

Risk management

Risk appetite

RBSH Group’s operational risk appetite statement is agreed by the

RBSH Managing and Supervisory Board. It comprises a number of

specific measures of risk.

 

To confirm that RBSH Group operates within the set risk appetite, the high-level statement is supplemented by specific tolerances for different types of operational risk.

 

Operational risk appetite measures and frameworks are reviewed regularly and approved by the Supervisory Board. 

 

The objective of operational risk management is not to remove operational risk altogether, but to manage it to an acceptable level, taking into account the cost of minimising the risk against the resultant reduction in exposure. Strategies to manage operational risk include avoidance, transfer, acceptance and mitigation by controls.

 

The operational risk cycle comprises four stages:

·         Identification of risks;

·         Assessment or measurement of the scale of risks;

·         Management or control of risks to prevent their recurrence or minimise the potential impact; and

·         Monitoring and reporting of risks.

 

Although the operational risk tools encompass all stages of the risk cycle, they can be broadly categorised as follows:

 

Identification and assessment

Risk assessments are used to identify and assess material operational risks and key controls across all business areas. To provide a consistent categorisation of risks and controls across RBSH Group and to support identification of risk concentrations, all risks and controls are mapped to the RBSH Group-wide risk taxonomy and the control catalogue.

 

The process is designed to confirm that risks are effectively managed and prioritised in line with the stated risk appetite. Controls are tested frequently to verify and validate that they remain fit for purpose and operate effectively. Risk assessments are typically conducted in a workshop environment, bringing together subject matter experts and key stakeholders from across the divisions and key functions.

 

New product risk assessment

RBSH Group’s new product risk assessment process is used to ensure that risks for all new products (and material variations to existing products) are adequately identified and assessed before their launch. The assessment documentation and review includes the requirement to demonstrate that the product provides fair outcomes for customers.

 

Enhancements were made during 2013 to strengthen the process and reporting.

 

Risk measurement

Scenario analysis is used to assess the impact of extreme but plausible operational risks. It provides a forward-looking basis for managing risk exposures, with a structured and consistent approach to scenario scoping and measurement. In 2013, the portfolio of scenarios was further enhanced

 

Event and loss data management

Event and loss data management covers a set of standard requirements for the management of operational risk events and loss data. It also provides for clear and consistent communication of operational risk events that meet defined threshold criteria to the RBSH Group’s senior management. The RBSH Group has continued to focus on the timely and accurate capture of operational risk losses; the use of a single Group-wide repository; and the escalation of material operational risk events.

 

Monitoring and reporting

Monitoring and reporting form an integral part of all of the RBSH Group’s operational risk management processes, which are designed to ensure that risks and issues are identified, escalated and managed on a timely basis. Exposures for each division are communicated through monthly risk and control reports, which provide detail on the risk exposures and action plans. In 2013 the linkages between different components of the operational risk framework were improved. This has allowed better aggregation, using both qualitative and quantitative inputs from all framework elements to underpin improvements in reporting to senior committees.

 

Risk mitigation

RBSH Group purchases insurance to provide the business with financial protection against specific losses and to comply with statutory or contractual requirements, providing protection against financial loss once a risk has crystallised.

*unaudited

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             74 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Other risks* continued

Regulatory risk

Definition

Regulatory risk is the risk of material loss or liability, legal or regulatory sanctions, or reputational damage, resulting from the failure to comply with (or adequately plan for changes to) relevant official sector policy, laws, regulations, or major industry standards, in any location in which RBSH Group operates.

 

Sources of risk

The sources of regulatory risk arise from RBSH Group’s regulatory, business or operating environment and from how the Group responds to them.

 

Governance structure

RBS Group’s Regulatory Affairs team (“Regulatory Affairs”) maintains well-established policies and supporting processes to ensure timely identification of, and effective responses to, changes in official requirements affecting the Group. The function also maintains a structured and open engagement with the Group’s regulators. Regulatory Affairs underpin a range of other policies and processes that address on-going compliance with regulatory obligations (refer to the section on Conduct Risk for further information).

 

RBS Group Board and Executive Committee oversight of changes to regulatory requirements is supported by a Prudential Regulatory Developments Executive Steering Group (ESG), which was formed in early 2010 to provide focus on a range of key regulatory developments and the Group’s responses.

 

The ESG is augmented by more specialised groups which cover prudential, wholesale market and retail conduct issues. These bodies identify and manage regulatory developments, by cascading information and coordinating activity.  Their activity includes: prioritisation, allocation of responsibility, short-term tactical mitigants, longer-term strategic responses, sharing best practice, discussion of policy views, and escalation of the need for implementation projects.

 

A divisional Heads of Regulatory Developments Committee supports the maintenance and continuous development of the relevant policy, known as the Political, Legislative and Regulatory Environment Policy Standard, and supporting documents, together with associated processes, tools and governance. It also oversees the Group’s regulatory developments operating framework to ensure it meets the needs of all divisions and functions, as well as the maintenance of the policy known as the RBS Group Relationships with Regulators Policy Standard.

 

Similarly, the Regulatory Relations Forum, chaired by Regulatory Affairs, has global coverage with representatives from all divisions and regions. It facilitates the sharing of key regulatory engagements and trends across RBS Group’s operations.

 

In addition, Regulatory Affairs ensures appropriate governance and reporting of all material regulatory reviews and other regulatory developments worldwide to relevant RBS Group committees. These committees include the RBS Group Board, RBS Group Audit Committee, and the RBS Group Board Risk Committee.

 

*unaudited

Risk management and measurement

RBS Group believes that maintaining a strong regulatory risk framework is fundamental to ensuring sustainable growth, rebuilding its reputation and maintaining stakeholder confidence.

 

Regulatory Affairs’ two policies are supported by risk appetite statements and by relevant benchmarking activity against the Group's peer banks.

 

These are framed by RBS Group’s stated regulatory risk and compliance risk appetite, which says there is no appetite for material or widespread breaches of rules, expectations, regulations or laws, individually or in aggregate. It recognises, however, that genuine errors occur, and so RBS Group accepts limited, non material regulatory risk and subsequent loss.

 

This is reflected in the Political, Legislative and Regulatory Environment Policy Standard, which requires that all likely changes in official policy, legislation, regulation or other requirements must be identified, and assessed for potential impact, using an internal classification system. 

 

The regulatory risk and compliance risk appetite is also reflected in the Group Relationships with Regulators Policy Standard, which states that all significant /material contacts with regulators must be identified and managed effectively and that all information provided to the regulators must be accurate, consistent and delivered within agreed timescales.

 

The level of regulatory risk remained high during 2013, as policymakers and regulators continued to strengthen regulation and supervision in response to the events of 2007/2008. This can be measured in high levels of interaction with supervisory authorities such as meetings, requests for information, visits and investigations, as well as in policy developments and proposals for new rules

 

Against the backdrop of intensified regulatory pressure, Regulatory Affairs has increased the size of its team, as well as improved and refined its operating model, tools, systems and processes.

 

A “Centres of Excellence” model was adopted in July 2013. This has brought together divisional and functional resources to manage issues more efficiently, using specialisms in existing teams and managing issues cross-divisionally.

 

Internal communications on regulatory issues were strengthened. This involved staff seminars and the publication of key information on internal websites, including the weekly Regulatory Affairs Flash Report, covering  key regulatory developments and supervisory interactions.

 

Quarterly reporting to RBS Group Audit Committee captures all material regulatory reviews and investigations as well as other regulatory developments worldwide. The reporting also tracks the status of, and trends in, key regulatory relationships.

 

Risk mitigation

The early identification and effective management of changes in legislation and regulation, as well as other requirements that may affect RBS Group, are critical to the successful mitigation of regulatory risk.

 

*unaudited

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             75 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Other risks* continued 

Regulatory risk continued 

All regulatory and compliance changes are managed so as to ensure timely compliance readiness. Those assessed as having a “High” or “Medium-High” impact are managed especially closely with the aim of mitigating the impact through, for instance, changes to strategy or business activities, or external engagement.

 

RBS Regulatory Affairs also communicates information on regulatory developments and follow-up engagement with client-facing businesses and functions, helping them identify and execute any required mitigating changes to strategy or business models.  The key regulatory policies are kept under annual review. 

 

Reputational risk

Definition

Reputational risk is the risk of brand damage and/or financial loss owing to a failure to meet stakeholders’ expectations of RBSH Group’s conduct and performance. Stakeholders include customers, investors, rating agencies, employees, suppliers, government, politicians, regulators, special interest groups, consumer groups, media and the general public. Brand damage can be detrimental to the business in a number of ways. It can hamper efforts to build or sustain business relationships with customers, affect staff morale, and reduce access to funding sources.

 

Sources of risk

Reputational risk can arise across a range of actions taken (or, in some cases, not taken) by RBSH Group and individuals, as well as its wider conduct, policies and practices.

 

Governance structure

The RBS Group Board has the ultimate responsibility for managing the Group's reputation, although all parts of RBS Group have responsibility for any reputational impact arising from their operations, including relationships with customers. The RBS Group Board has set the Group’s Purpose, Vision and Values (PVV), which outline a desired reputation for RBS Group “to be trusted, respected and valued by our customers, shareholders and communities”.

 

Directors and senior executives are actively engaged in key strategic and transactional decisions that can have a reputational impact, for example

 

·         Key reputational issues associated with the Group’s strategic plans are discussed at Board level.

·         The RBS Group Board Risk Committee (BRC) oversees reputational issues and is directly engaged in strategic reputational management decisions (e.g. the customer redress policy following the Group’s IT incident).

·         The RBS Group Sustainability Committee (GSC) reviews reputational issues from a customer or sector perspective. It is responsible for reviewing the Group’s sustainability strategy, values and policies and aligning the Group’s approach to environmental, social and ethical (ESE) issues.

 

RBS Group Board’s oversight of reputational issues is supported by structures and committees to ensure that key reputational issues are discussed at appropriate levels across the Group:

 

·         Each division has reputational filters to provide the “first line of defence” for sensitive transactions or customers. Divisions have also established committees or forums to deliberate on customers, transactions or issues that may present a reputational risk for the division. For example, the remit of RBS Group’s International Banking Global Capital & Sighting Committee includes a requirement to assess key reputational sensitivities associated with client transactions against defined risk appetite.

·         The ESE risk management function provides guidance and sets policy to avoid reputational risk to the bank related to the Group’s business engagements and lending to customers in some sensitive industry sectors, such as mining. The function is supported by additional resource in the business divisions.

·         RBS Group Risk Committee (GRC) reviews reputational issues from an organisational perspective. Its remit covers material and/or enterprise-wide risk and control matters across the Group, including reputational risk, as well as a review of the overall risk culture, capability and commitment across the Group.

 

Risk management and measurement

The reputational risk management framework is aligned with RBS Group’s strategic objectives, its risk appetite its focus on serving customers well, its risk appetite and the Group’s PVV. It is designed to embed, at different points of decision-making processes, a series of reputational filters and controls that examine products, services and activities through the lens of sustainability, transparency and fairness.

 

RBS Group has put the focus on “serving customers well” at the heart of its strategic objectives that, combined with a safe and sound bank, will build a culture and reputation in line with the Group’s stakeholder expectations. By serving customers well, RBS Group aims to be trusted, respected and valued – a sustainable model of how banks serve society. Legacy issues remain to be worked through, but dealing with them in a transparent manner is a necessary part of the ability to move forward.

 

The RBS Group’s four corporate values (serving customers, working together, thinking long-term and doing the right thing) build on the advances made so far (e.g. strengthened governance and controls) to deliver the required cultural and behavioural change for the long term, with a set of supporting tangible measures. Key tools designed to embed the values include a revised code of conduct, a simple “yes-check” guide to decisions that need to be taken every day by employees and various training and accreditation programmes. Values will also be a core part of performance measures to endorse behaviours that benefit customers, manage risk and deliver long-term shareholder value.

 

*unaudited

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             76 

 


 

 

 

Business review Risk and balance sheet management 

 

Other risks* continued 

Reputational risk continued 

The monthly risk report to the RBS Group Board contains a view of key risks, including a reputational risk impact assessment of each key risk. In addition, the divisions report on relevant barometers of reputational risk and actions to manage reputational events according to the source. The annual RBS Group Sustainability report also covers progress on RBS Group’s sustainability principles. Emerging reputational issues are identified and assessed by a dedicated cross-divisional reputational risk working group, and escalated through the appropriate governance channels where necessary.

 

Risk mitigation

Several RBS Group policies address key sources of reputational risk. These policies are implemented in accordance with the Group Policy Framework through divisional and functional policy standard owners. The effectiveness of these policies within each business unit is reported through the Control Environment Certification process semi-annually. Reputational aspects also form a core part of the RBS conduct risk framework, with a series of enhanced policies being developed in line with the Group’s conduct risk appetite.

 

Business risk

Definition

Business risk is the risk that RBSH Group suffers losses as a result of adverse variance in its revenues and/or costs relative to its business plan and strategy.

 

Sources of risk

Business risk exists at all levels of the organisation and is generated at the transaction level. It is affected by other risks RBSH Group faces, which could contribute to any adverse changes in RBSH Group's revenues or costs. They include funding risk, volatility in the cost of funding, non-traded interest rate risk, inflation risk, operational risk, strategic risk, regulatory risk, conduct risk and reputational risk.

 

Governance structure 

The Managing Board has ultimate responsibility for the impact of any volatility in revenues and costs on RBSH Group’s performance.

 

Risk management, measurement and mitigation

RBSH Group seeks to minimise its exposure to business risk, subject to its wider strategic objectives. Business risk is identified, measured and managed through RBSH Group’s planning cycles and performance management processes. Expected profiles for revenues and costs are determined, on a bottom-up basis, through plans reflecting expectations of the external environment and RBSH Group’s strategic priorities. These profiles are tested against a range of stress scenarios and factors to identify the key risk drivers behind any potential volatility, along with management actions to address and manage them. The Managing Board has ultimate responsibility for the impact of any volatility in revenues and costs on RBSH Group’s performance.

 

Strategic risk

Definition

The risk that RBSH Group will make inappropriate strategic choices, or that there will be changes in the external environment to which RBSH Group fails to adapt its strategies.  Failure to mange strategic risk could have a wide-ranging impact on RBSH Group.

 

Sources of risk

Strategic risk arises from three principal sources:

 

·         Inadequate or inaccurate analysis of current and prospective operating conditions in RBSH Group’s markets including macroeconomic performance, customer and competitor behaviours and actions, regulatory developments and technological impacts;

·         Inadequate or inaccurate understanding of RBSH Group’s existing capabilities and positioning and ability to implement chosen strategies; and

·         Significant unanticipated changes in RBSH Group’s operating environment.

 

Governance structure

Responsibility for the management of the bank’s strategic risks resides ultimately with the Managing Board of RBSH Group.

 

Risk management, measurement and mitigation

Strategic progress is monitored through regular performance reviews and deviations from the expected values are analysed to determine drivers. Also sensitivity analysis of the strategic plan is undertaken to assess the robustness of the plan under stressed conditions represented by a variety of scenarios. In certain cases RBS Group may decide on alternatives strategies as a result of a perceived strategic risk.

 

Developments in 2014

In late 2013, RBS Group announced its intention to undertake a comprehensive business review. Over the remainder of 2013 and into the early months of 2014, it completed the review and developed a strategic plan, the objective of which is to position the Group as a UK-focused retail and corporate bank, that earns its customers’ trust by serving them better than any other bank. Key to achieving this is combining customer groups with similar needs into three new businesses and reducing significantly the Group’s costs and complexity. While RBS Group is confident that the plan is appropriate, it may have underestimated the risks arising from concentrating its activities in the UK or misunderstood the needs of its customers or the strength of its competitive position and this could impact RBSH Group.

 

*unaudited

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             77 

 


 

 

 

Corporate governance 

 

 

79

Introduction

79

Corporate Governance in the Netherlands

79

Corporate Governance in the United States

79

Approval of Annual Report

79

Boards and Committees

80

The report of the Supervisory Board

83

The report of the Managing Board

84

Risk & Control Committee

84

Asset & Liability Management Committee

84

Disclosure Committee

84

Code of conduct

85

Sustainability

85

Relations with shareholders

85

Employees

86

The Dutch Banking Code

89

Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             78 

 


 

 

 

Corporate governance 

 

Introduction

RBSH Group continues to maintain high corporate governance standards. RBSH Group’s operations are guided by its code of conduct.

 

In order to achieve good corporate governance RBSH Group organises the business in a way that promotes first-class stewardship by the Managing Board and effective supervision by the Supervisory Board. Integrity, transparency and accountability are key elements of RBSH Group’s corporate governance, as they are embedded in RBSH Group’s business as a whole. These key elements ensure that the controls and oversight necessary for effective risk management, compliance with regulations, and accurate and complete disclosure of information to the market are effective.

 

The Supervisory Board of RBSH has prepared its annual report which is published on pages 80 to 82 of this report. The report provides an overview of its activity during 2013.

 

Corporate governance in the Netherlands

Dutch Corporate Governance Code

As a result of the delisting in 2008, the Company is no longer required to adhere to Dutch Corporate Governance Code. RBSH Group ensures proper corporate governance by focusing on the Dutch Banking Code (Code Banken) which caters for specific corporate governance rules for banks. However as the Dutch Corporate Governance Code is of great standing within the Netherlands, RBSH Group adheres where possible.

 

The Dutch Banking Code (Code Banken)

The Code Banken came into force on 1 January 2010 and requires banks to either comply with the Code Banken or explain any deviation from it. The Code Banken is applicable to RBS N.V. as it has a banking licence issued under the Dutch Financial Supervision Act. A further explanation on compliance with the Code Banken is provided on page 87 of this report.

 

Capital Requirement Directive III (CRD III)

CRD III contains certain provisions on capital requirements for trading portfolios and securitisations. It also contains principles on sound compensation policies. Each member state of the European Union has the requirement to implement the directive in their national legislation.

 

RBSH Group adheres fully to the principles of CRD III that were implemented in the Netherlands. 

 

Capital Requirement Directive IV (CRD IV)

On 1 January 2014, CRD IV came into force in the European Union. The Directive contains several Corporate Governance related requirements, which are expected to be implemented in Dutch law during 2014.

 

European Banking Authority (EBA) guidelines on internal governance

The EBA has issued guidelines relating to internal governance arrangements of credit institutions. These take into account weaknesses identified in the financial crisis and build upon the CEBS Guidelines.

 

The EBA guidelines are implemented by the local competent authorities, which is the Dutch Central Bank. RBSH Group adheres to the implemented guidelines.

 

DNB Principles on Sound Remuneration

The principles of sound compensation policies were implemented by the publication of the Regulation by the Dutch Central Bank on Sound Compensation Policies for Financial Institutions, which came into effect on 1 January 2011. RBSH Group adheres fully to these principles.

 

Further details of RBSG’s remuneration policy can be found in the RBS Group’s 2013 Annual Report & Accounts, available on www.rbs.com.

 

Corporate governance in the United States

As a SEC registered company, RBSH Group is subject to US securities laws, including the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, as well as certain corporate governance rules in connection with RBSH Group’s listing of NYSE Alternext debt.

 

To meet the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, RBSH Group established a Disclosure Committee that formalised the roles, tasks and disciplines that were already in place for ensuring the accuracy and completeness of information disclosed to the market.

 

RBSH Group’s report on internal control over financial reporting under Section 404 of the US Sarbanes-Oxley Act is included herein.

 

Approval of Annual Report

The Managing Board approved the Annual Report at its meeting on 30 April 2014. The Supervisory Board approved the Annual Report at its meeting on 30 April 2014. RBSH Group has proposed to its Shareholders that it adopts the 2013 financial statements, as included in this Annual Report, and discharge the Managing Board and Supervisory Board in respect of their management and supervision respectively.

 

Boards and Committees

RBS Holdings and RBS N.V. are both companies with limited liability incorporated under the laws of the Netherlands. Both companies have a two-tier system of corporate governance; consisting of a Supervisory Board and a Managing Board. The day to day management of the companies vests with the Managing Board. The Supervisory Board provides oversight and advice to the Managing Board.

 

There is a personal union in place between the Managing Boards of RBS Holdings and RBS N.V. and between the Supervisory Boards of RBS Holdings and RBS N.V. This entails that the members of the Managing Board and Supervisory Board of RBS Holdings and RBS N.V. are the same.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             79 

 


 

 

 

Corporate governance 

 

The report of the Supervisory Board

Dear Reader,

 

It is with great pleasure that I present to you the 2013 report of the Supervisory Board. The report provides you with an overview of the tasks and the activities of the Board during 2013.

 

2013 was an important year for RBS Holdings during which the bank made excellent progress towards realising the transfers of businesses and assets to RBS plc. It was the year in which RBS Holdings completed the majority of its integration activities.

 

The Supervisory Board closely monitored this integration process in the past years and is pleased that this enormous operation was completed successfully and on schedule, clearing the road for the one-bank strategy of RBS plc.

 

The Supervisory Board has oversight of the execution of this strategy, working together with the Managing Board through its meetings and conference calls. The Supervisory Board challenged the Managing Board on client focus, the timing and speed at which transfers were taking place and the potential impact on the bank’s international network. The corporate strategy was regularly discussed at Supervisory Board meetings.

 

Succession planning for the Managing Board and senior management was another important subject addressed by the Supervisory Board through the execution of the integration activities.

 

The tasks of the Supervisory Board

The main task of the Supervisory Board is to supervise the Managing Board, as well as the general affairs of RBS Holdings and the enterprises connected to it. Furthermore, it assists and advises management and supervises the corporate governance structure of RBS Holdings.

 

In performing their duties, the members of the Supervisory Board are guided by the interests of RBSH Group and the businesses connected to it and shall take into account the relevant interests of RBSH Group's stakeholders. Certain powers vest in the Supervisory Board, including the approval of certain resolutions by the Managing Board. A complete overview of the powers vested with the Supervisory Board can be found in the Rules governing the Supervisory Board’s Principles and best Practices, which are published on the RBSH Group’s website at www.rbs.nl. These rules are also applicable to the Supervisory Board of RBS N.V. and include provisions on Risk & Audit items that were previously discussed in the separate Risk & Audit Committee of the Supervisory Board

 

Members of the Supervisory Board

The Supervisory Board is an independent corporate body. Members of the Supervisory Board are appointed at the General Meeting of Shareholders. For each vacant seat the Supervisory Board nominates one or more candidates. Under the Dutch Corporate Governance Code, which is mandatory for listed companies and which the RBSH Group adheres to where possible, all members of the Supervisory Board must be independent with the exception of not more than one person. RBSH Group is not compliant with that standard. RBSH Group has three Supervisory Board members who can not be considered as independent within the scope of the Dutch Corporate Governance Code.  Also, the Chairman and Vice-Chairman of the Supervisory Board are appointed by the Supervisory Board from among its members.

 

On 1 October 2013, Mr Bruce Van Saun stepped down as the Chairman of the Supervisory Board. On that same date, Mr Ron Teerlink retired as Vice-Chairman of the Supervisory Board. Mr Nathan Bostock, the RBS Group Chief Financial Officer, was appointed as the replacement for Mr Van Saun. Furthermore, Mr John Cummins, currently the RBS Group Treasurer, was appointed to the Supervisory Board as the replacement for Mr Teerlink.

 

The Supervisory Board confirms that its current composition has the necessary experience, expertise and independence to ensure that its members are able to properly execute their duties. All appointments were made in accordance with the Supervisory Board profile resulting in the current composition of the board. The Supervisory Board is of the opinion that the addition of a female Supervisory Board member would be beneficial to its functioning and would then align with the RBSG Group policy on diversity and inclusion. The Supervisory Board will therefore commit to identifying and nominating a female candidate on the company’s Supervisory Board if a vacancy would arise.

 

Supervisory Board members are appointed for a term of four years and may be re-appointed after that term, with a maximum term of 12 years from the date of their first appointment. In addition, each member is required to resign at the first General Meeting of Shareholders after reaching the age of 70.

 

Candidates recommended for appointment or re-appointment to the Supervisory Board must meet the criteria of the membership profile, which are set out in the Rules Governing the Supervisory Board’s Principles and Best Practices of RBSH Group, which are also applicable to the Supervisory Board of RBS N.V.

 

Newly appointed Supervisory Board members undertake an induction programme. The new Supervisory Board members receive relevant documentation necessary for their role in RBSH Group and undertake a series of meetings with the management of RBSH Group to gain insight and understanding of RBSH Group and its enterprises. The programme is tailor-made and is adjusted to the specific needs of the new Supervisory Board member.

 

In case of a (potential) conflict of interest of material significance between a member of the Supervisory Board and RBS Holdings, the Chairman of the Supervisory Board shall be notified. If the Chairman of the Supervisory Board has a (potential) conflict of interest of material significance, the Vice-Chairman is notified. The Supervisory Board member concerned will not take part in the assessment by the Supervisory Board where a conflict of interest exists. During 2013, no conflicts of interest have arisen.

 

Details of the remuneration of the Supervisory Board’s can be found on page 157.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             80 

 


 

 

 

Corporate governance 

 

Activities of the Supervisory Board

As of the 4th quarter of 2013, the operations of the Risk & Audit Committee, a separate sub committee to the Supervisory Board, were integrated into the operations of the Supervisory Board. As a result, going forward the Supervisory Board does not have a separate sub-committee. The members of the Supervisory Board collectively have sufficient accounting and financial management expertise to understand RBSH Group’s business, financial statements and risk profile.

 

Also, the Supervisory Board works alongside RBS Group Remuneration Committee to ensure the implementation of a restrained and long-term remuneration policy which is aligned with the organisation's strategy and risk appetite, whilst also catering for an evermore globalizing industry. The Supervisory Board extensively discussed remuneration at a number of its meetings, highlighting the focus that this topic continues to receive in the organisation.

 

The Supervisory Board met on five occasions during 2013, either via a meeting in person or via telephone / video conference. On a few occasions the members were also asked to give their approval on a few matters via email procedure.

 

The assessment of the functioning of the Managing Board members and Supervisory Board, their members and the committee of the Supervisory Board has taken place in the fourth quarter of 2013.

 

The Chairman of the Supervisory Board and the Company Secretary prepared the agenda for the meetings of the Supervisory Board in close co-operation with the Chairman of the Managing Board.

 

The Supervisory Board reviewed and adopted the full year 2012 results at its meeting on 27 March 2013 and reviewed and adopted the half-year financial report 2013 on 28 August 2013. The Board reviewed in these meetings regulatory, control and audit issues, including Sarbanes-Oxley Act 404 compliance.

 

Throughout 2013, the Supervisory Board received regular updates on the proposed transfers of assets and liabilities to RBS plc. The financial performance of RBSH Group was extensively discussed during a number of Supervisory Board meetings, which were attended by a number of Managing Board members who gave an explanation of the results. Also, relevant members discussed findings of internal and external auditors.

 

On four occasions in 2013, the meeting of the Supervisory Board was preceded by a meeting of the Risk & Audit Committee, which advised the Supervisory Board, amongst others, on the adoption of the financial results. Comprehensive information provided by the Managing Board and reviewed by the Risk & Audit Committee gave the Supervisory Board a clear picture of RBSH Group’s risks, results, capital and liquidity position. The Risk & Audit committee continued to report their deliberations and findings to the Supervisory Board for further discussion and, where appropriate, decision. As of the fourth quarter 2013, the operations of the Risk & Audit committee were integrated into the Supervisory Board with the Risk & Audit Committee being discontinued as a separate committee.

 

The strategy of RBSH Group was determined in conjunction with the divisional strategy of RBS Group and was adopted by the Supervisory Board during its meeting on 9 April 2010 and further updated in their meeting of 8 April 2011. Regular updates were provided during 2013.

 

The Shareholder reappointed Deloitte Accountants B.V. as the external auditors of RBS Holdings N.V. for the statutory reporting of the 2013 financial year. Deloitte LLP was appointed as the auditor for the 2013 20-F filing. All members of the Supervisory Board have complied with the requirement to attend meetings on a frequent basis.

 

Composition of the Supervisory Board

The members of the Supervisory Board as at 30 April 2014 are as follows:

 

 

 

 

Date of first appointment

Date for re-election

 

Nathan Bostock (Chairman)

(53, British, male)

1 October 2013

1 October 2017

Christopher Campbell (Vice-Chairman)

(55, British, male)

23 June 2011

23 June 2015

Henk Rottinghuis

(58, Dutch, male)

1 September 2010

1 September 2014

John Cummins

(52, British, male)

1 October 2013

1 October 2017

Sietze Hepkema

(60, Dutch, male)

1 September 2010

1 September 2014

 

Mr Bostock has confirmed his resignation from the RBS Group although his leaving date is still to be agreed.

 

Mr Hepkema and Mr Rottinghuis will resign from the Supervisory Board with effect from 1 May 2014.

 

Furthermore, the Supervisory Board has determined that Nathan Bostock possesses the necessary relevant expertise in financial administration and accounting for listed companies and other large companies and therefore qualifies as a financial expert within the meaning of the Dutch Corporate Governance Code. It has also been determined that Nathan Bostock qualifies as an audit committee financial expert in accordance with Section 407 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             81 

 


 

 

 

Corporate governance 

 

Nathan Bostock - Chairman of the Supervisory Board

Mr Bostock re-joined RBS in June 2009 from Santander UK plc, where he was Chief Financial Officer and a main board director. Prior to this he held a number of senior positions heading both functional and business units including Financial Markets, Insurance and Products & Marketing.

His previous spell with RBS spanned a decade between 1992 and 2001, during which time he held a number of senior roles including Chief Operating Officer for Treasury & Capital Markets, and Group Risk Director. He spent his early career as a Chartered Accountant with Coopers & Lybrand and Chase Manhattan.

 

Christopher Campbell - Vice-Chairman of the Supervisory Board

Mr Campbell was appointed as a member of the Supervisory Board on 23 June 2011. Mr Campbell joined RBS Group in August 2005 as Deputy General Counsel and Director, Group Legal and became Group General Counsel in May 2010. Prior to joining RBS, Mr Campbell was a partner for 18 years in Scotland’s largest law firm, Dundas & Wilson, and was Managing Partner from 1996 until he joined RBS Group in 2005. In his role as Group General Counsel, Mr Campbell has overall responsibility for advising the RBS Group Board and Executive Committee and for the provision of legal support to all of RBS’s businesses globally. His responsibilities also include RBS Group Secretariat.

 

John Cummins

In 2007, Mr Cummins joined the Royal Bank of Scotland as Group Treasurer.  As Group Treasurer, Mr Cummins manages the treasury function for The Royal Bank of Scotland Group. He is responsible for the management of the Group’s capital, liquidity, and structural FX & interest rate risk and his role also includes responsibility for funding the Group balance sheet, and the management of the Group’s capital and resources policies.

 

In his previous role Mr Cummins managed the Treasury function for Standard Life Assurance Group.  He also filled the role of Finance Director, Standard Life Bank on an interim basis.

 

2006 - 2012 Mr Cummins was appointed Director of IFFIm, a AAA rated development institution.  The IFFIm Board is responsible for the management of the International Finance Facility for Immunisation Company (IFFIm), registered as a UK Charity. IFFIm has raised over $4bn for vaccines in the developing world.

 

2013 - Mr Cummins was appointed a Trustee for the Sabin Foundation Europe, a UK-registered charity founded in 2011 to support vaccine research and development, advocacy efforts and treatment programs for vaccine - preventable and neglected tropical disease.

 

Mr Cummins holds an MA in Modern History from Oxford University and an MBA from Bradford University. He completed the Corporate Finance Course at London Business School and attended the Risk Management in Banking programme at INSEAD.

 

Henk Rottinghuis

Mr Rottinghuis was appointed to the Supervisory Board on 1 September 2010. Mr Rottinghuis has been a Member of the Executive Board of Pon Holdings B.V. since 1999 and was appointed CEO in 2001, a position he held for nearly ten years. Before joining the Board, he worked as the Managing Director of Pon's Automobielhandel, the importer of Volkswagen, Audi and Porsche in The Netherlands and Poland, and was responsible for all import activities in the automotive arm of Pon Holdings. Mr Rottinghuis started his career in 1982 at the Royal Nedlloyd Group, a shipping and transport group, where he held various management positions for a period of ten years. He holds a Master of Laws from the Rijksuniversiteit Groningen, and has followed an executive programme at Harvard Business School. He holds several Board positions with larger family companies. He is Chairman of the Supervisory Board of Stork Technical Services.

 

Sietze Hepkema

Mr Hepkema was appointed as a member of the Supervisory Board on 1 September 2010. Mr Hepkema currently is a member of the Management Board (RvB) of SBM Offshore N.V. He is responsible for compliance, governance, legal and insurance. Until 2012 Mr Hepkema was a corporate and M&A lawyer at Allen & Overy LLP. He was Senior Partner of the Amsterdam office from 1999 to 2009 and a member of the firm’s Board from 2000 to 2010. Before joining Allen & Overy, Mr Hepkema was Partner at Loeff Claeys Verbeke for 12 years, where he was appointed to the Managing Board in 1989. Between 1981 and 1987 he worked at Graham & James in San Francisco and Singapore. He holds a Master of Laws from the Erasmus University Rotterdam and an LLM from Harvard Law School.

 

 

 

Nathan Bostock

Chairman of the Supervisory Board

 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             82 

 


 

 

 

Corporate governance 

 

 

The report of the Managing Board

The members of the Managing Board of RBS Holdings collectively manage RBS Holdings and are responsible for the general affairs of RBS Holdings business and general affairs of all its subsidiaries. The members are appointed by the General Meeting of Shareholders.

 

The Supervisory Board of RBS Holdings nominates one or more candidates for each vacant seat. If the Supervisory Board nominates two or more candidates for a vacant seat in the Managing Board, the nomination list is binding. The members of the Managing Board are accountable both collectively and individually for all decisions taken by the Managing Board.

 

The Chairman of the Managing Board leads the Managing Board in its overall management of RBSH Group to achieve its performance goals and ambitions. The Chairman of the Managing Board is the main point of liaison with the Supervisory Board. The Chief Financial Officer is responsible for the financial affairs of RBSH Group, and the Chief Risk Officer is responsible for RBSH Group’s risk management and operational risk control. Alongside their overall corporate responsibilities, the members of the Managing Board are responsible for the management of the divisions and control and support functions. The Managing Board has delegated certain tasks to a number of Managing Board committees which are described on page 84 of this report.

 

On 18 July 2013, Mr Van der Harst stepped down from the Managing Board and was succeeded by Mr Cornelis Visscher.

 

On 1 September 2013, Mr Richard Hemsley stepped down from the Managing Board with his responsibilities being distributed amongst the remaining Managing Board members.

 

On 1 April 2014, Mr Jeroen Kremers stepped down from the Managing Board and will be succeeded by Mr I Van Eeghen.

 

 

The members of the Managing Board as at 30 April 2014 are as follows:

 

 

 

 

Date of first appointment

Date for re-election

Jan de Ruiter (Chairman)

(52, Dutch, male)

1 April 2010

1 April 2014

Cornelis Visscher

(48, Dutch, male)

18 July 2013

18 July 2017

Michael Geslak

(50, American, male)

1 April 2010

1 April 2014

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             83 

 


 

 

 

Corporate governance 

 

Jan de Ruiter

Chairman Managing Board and Head of Markets RBS N.V. - RBS Group Netherlands Country Executive

Mr de Ruiter started his career at the Dutch Credit Insurance (NCM) in 1984 and moved to ABN Bank in 1987. During his 21 years with ABN AMRO, he held various positions in the wholesale division of the bank. From 1987 until 1993 he was a team member of the Institutional Equity Sales team in Amsterdam and from 1993 until 1998 Head of the European Equity sales team, based in London. In 1998 he became the Head of Equity Capital Markets for the Netherlands (Managing Director ABN AMRO Rothschild). Mr de Ruiter was appointed Corporate Managing Director of ABN AMRO in 2000. In 2003 he became one of the two joint CEO’s of ABN AMRO Rothschild. In 2004 he also became responsible for the global Merger & Acquisitions franchise of ABN AMRO. He held both positions until the end of 2007. At the beginning of 2008, following the successful consortium bid for ABN AMRO, he became the country executive of RBS N.V. in the Netherlands. Mr de Ruiter graduated from the HEAO in Utrecht in 1983 (Economics/Law) and also holds an MBA degree from Webster University.

 

Cornelis Visscher

Chief Financial Officer, RBS N.V. - RBS Group Netherlands Chief Financial Officer

Mr Visscher graduated from the Vrije Universiteit in Amsterdam with a degree in Business Economics, specialising in Financial Accounting and Management Accounting. He started his career at ABN AMRO in 1988, where, after several functions in divisional and Group Finance, he ultimately became responsible for the collecting, analysing and reporting of ABN AMRO’s Group Management Information. Following the acquisition of (parts of) ABN AMRO by The Royal Bank of Scotland, Mr Visscher became the head of Group Consolidation, in which he was responsible for the split of the accounts and consolidation departments between the Consortium members. Furthermore, in 2011 Mr Visscher became the Head of Group Finance Services for the Retail & Wealth, Corporate and Business Services divisions of RBS Group. In this role, he was responsible for the Shared Service programme. Currently, in addition to his role as CFO of RBS NV, he serves as CFO for RBS Group Netherlands and in this role is part of the Country Management team.

 

Michael Geslak

Chief Administrative Officer - RBS N.V.

Mr Geslak joined ABN AMRO in New York in 1988 as an accountant, in 1992 he formed the Market Risk function in New York, and after moving to Chicago in 1993 became Head of Market Risk for North America. In 1995 he became Head of Investment Banking Operations and Product Control in Chicago, which was later expanded to cover all Investment Banking Operations for North America. In 2000 he was promoted to Chief Administrative Officer for Wholesale Banking in the Americas.

 

Mr Geslak then moved to London as Global Chief Information Officer for ABN AMRO Wholesale Banking and managed the provision of all technology to the Global Markets and Global Transaction Services businesses. In 2006 he became Head of Services for Global Markets and EMEA. From 2009 to 2012 he became the RBS Group COO for EMEA. His current roles are CAO and Managing Board member for RBS N.V. and Business Services Business Partner for Non-Core and APS. 

 

In addition to these responsibilities, for the past two years Mr Geslak has been leading the programme to de-risk RBS N.V. by transferring businesses to RBS plc.

 

Information, induction and professional development

As part of the Code Banken, both the Managing Board and the Supervisory Board participate in a programme of Life Long Learning. The programme consists of a modular approach, addressing matters that are mentioned in the Code Banken, including relevant developments in the financial sector in general and the banking sector in specific, corporate governance in general the duty of care towards clients, integrity, risk management, financial reporting and audits.Subject matter experts are invited, both from within RBSH Group and from outside RBSH Group, to deliver education modules on the above mentioned matters.

 

Performance evaluation

The members of the Managing Board participate in the annual performance management process of RBS Group.

 

Managing Board committees

In order to provide effective oversight and leadership, the Managing Board has established four sub-committees, the Risk & Control Committee, the Asset & Liability Management Committee (ALCO), the Disclosure Committee. The Power of Attorney Committee (PoA) has been discontinued as of Q4 2013 and its operations were integrated into the day to day operations of the Managing Board.

 

Risk & Control Committee (RCC)

The Risk & Control Committee (RCC) oversees the risk framework within RBSH Group, monitors the actual risk profile and advises the Managing Board on these matters. Its scope is, amongst others, credit, market, operational and regulatory risk within RBSH Group.

 

Asset & Liability Management Committee (ALCO)

The Managing Board has delegated to the ALCO the responsibility for the management of capital, liquidity, interest rate risk and foreign exchange risk. This includes responsibility for reviewing, approving and allocating balance sheet, capital, liquidity and funding limits.

 

Disclosure Committee

The Disclosure Committee advises and assists the Managing Board in fulfilling its responsibilities for overseeing the accuracy and timeliness of public disclosures made by RBSH Group. This inter alia includes advising the Managing Board on the disclosure of financial information.

 

Code of conduct

The code of conduct applies to everyone who works for RBS. It promotes honest and ethical conduct, including the handling of actual or apparent conflicts of interest between personal and professional relationships. RBSH Group recognises that personal conduct, business integrity and RBSH Group’s security are crucial, and the code of conduct serves to inform those who work for us of RBSH Group’s expectations of their behaviour and practices.

 

The code of conduct is available on RBS Group’s website www.rbs.com

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             84 

 


 

 

 

Corporate governance 

 

Sustainability

Sustainability is central to the way RBSH Group is managed. Sustainability is not just about the many responsibilities and obligations that RBSH Group has in a legal sense, but about specific issues that need to be addressed to ensure that RBSH Group is a business operating on a sustainable basis. There is a clear governance structure for RBS Group Sustainability that oversees and aligns RBS Group's approach to the range of ethical, social and environmental issues which confront the business on a daily basis.

 

RBS Group continues to do significant work and address challenges across five key themes: Fair banking, Supporting enterprise, Employee engagement, Safety and security and Citizenship and environmental sustainability. Its oversight includes RBSH.

 

RBS Group Sustainability Committee

The RBS Group Sustainability Committee comprises of independent non-executive directors and is chaired by the Senior Independent Director.

 

During 2013, the Group Sustainability Committee focused on reviewing the Group’s overall sustainability strategy, values and policies and aligning. The Committee’s scope also includes:-

 

·         sustainability and reputational issues related to customer and  citizenship activities;

·         oversight of the delivery of the Purpose, Vision and Values cultural and behavioural change; and

·         oversight of the sustainability aspects of the people agenda.

 

In addition, the Committee is responsible for overseeing and challenging how management is addressing sustainability and reputation issues relating to all stakeholder groups, except where such issues have already been dealt with by other Board Committees.

 

Relations with shareholders

Rights of shareholders

Any resolution to amend the Articles of Association of RBS Holdings may only be passed by the General Meeting of Shareholders following a proposal by the Managing Board which has been approved by the Supervisory Board. A copy of the proposal containing the literal text of the proposed amendments shall be made available for inspection by the holders of shares of RBS Holdings at the offices of RBS Holdings and at the offices stated in the convocation to the meeting, from the day of convocation to the end of the Meeting. Each Shareholder may obtain a full copy of the proposal free of charge.

 

Meetings of shareholders and convocation

The general meetings of shareholders shall be held in Amsterdam, or in The Hague, Rotterdam, Utrecht or Haarlemmermeer (Schiphol). Annual General Meeting of Shareholders must be held within six months of the end of each financial year. In addition, general meetings of shareholders shall be held as frequently as deemed necessary by the Managing Board or the Supervisory Board and when required by law or by the Articles of Association. General meetings of shareholders shall be convened by the Managing Board or the Supervisory Board, without prejudice to the provisions of Sections 110, 111 and 112 of Book 2 of the Netherlands Civil Code. Convocation shall take place not later than on the fifteenth day prior to the day of the meeting. Convocation shall state the items to be discussed or alternatively notice shall be given that such items may be inspected at the company’s offices. Proposals to amend the Articles of Association or proposals relating to a reduction of the company’s capital shall always be included in the actual convocation.

 

Employees

As at 31 December 2013, RBSH Group employed approximately 2,500 employees (full-time equivalent basis) throughout the world. Details of employee related costs are included in Note 3 on the accounts.

 

Employee learning and development

RBSH Group maintains a strong commitment to providing all its employees with the opportunity to grow through learning and development, which in turn helps to achieve business objectives and drive excellent customer service. This helps our employees deliver the best service to our customers whilst working towards a recognised professional standard. Employee volunteering schemes make it easy for individuals and teams to give something back to their communities and make a real difference.

 

Employee communication

Employee engagement is encouraged through a range of communication channels, at both divisional and Group level. These channels provide access to news and information in a number of ways, including the intranet, magazines, video, team meetings led by line managers, briefings held by senior managers and regular dialogue with employees and employee representatives.

 

The Managing Board and other senior RBSH Group executives regularly communicate with, and encourage feedback from, employees across a range of channels.

 

Employee feedback

Every year since 1999, through the Your Feedback survey, employees in all our businesses have shared their thoughts about what it’s like working for RBS. These insights inform what RBSH Group needs to do to improve the way it works, whether it’s a local issue or something that affects everyone.

 

Apart from an opportunity to listen to employees, the survey also enables RBSH Group to monitor levels of employee satisfaction and engagement and how these compare with other companies.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             85 

 


 

 

 

Corporate governance 

 

Employee consultation

RBSH Group recognises employee representative organisations such as trade unions and work councils in a number of businesses and countries.

 

RBS Group has a European Employee Council that provides elected representatives with an opportunity to understand better RBS Group’s European operations.

 

Diversity and inclusion

During 2013, RBS Group executive were commited to making workplace policies, processes and experiences inclusive for staff, customers and stakeholders; in support of this, RBS Group HR set Equality, Diversity & Inclusion within its top priorities for 2013.

 

Inclusion is built into the recruitment process, positive action programmes developing talent, flexible working policies and support for dependent care,  ill-health and disability-related absence. RBS Group continues to support disabled people ensuring they have equal opportunities to recruitment, employment, promotion and training.

 

RBS Group also supports employee led networks such as Focused Women and Rainbow who provide personal and career development opportunities through networking and training events.

 

This commitment to inclusion extends to supporting and participating in positive action programmes outside of RBS Group aimed at cultivating future leaders including, ‘An Inspirational Journey’, the FTSE-100 cross-company mentoring and Glass Ladder programmes. RBS Group continues to maintain its involvement with external charitable networks and events such as Manchester Pride.

 

This approach to inclusion extends to the marketplace with the RBS Group Women in Business Specialists supporting and guiding more and more women to take the step of starting their own business.

 

Further details on the Board diversity policy can be found at www.rbs.com

 

This year RBS Group has been recognised for its work on Equality, Diversity and Inclusion by retaining our Gold standard ranking from Opportunity Now (gender), achieving Silver for Race for Opportunity (Race), attaining the Top Employers award for employee engagement from workingmums.co.uk as well as securing a position in the Working families Top 10.

 

Safety, health and wellbeing

Ensuring the safety, health and wellbeing of employees and customers is an important responsibility for RBSH Group.

 

RBSH Group is committed to ensuring legal compliance and managing health and safety risks. During 2013, continued focus on leadership, governance and the effectiveness of controls delivered improvements in health and safety performance. 

 

A wide range of health benefits and services are in place to help employees maintain good physical and psychological health, and support them if they do become unwell. A number of these services have been enhanced and promoted in response to the impact of the economic environment. For example, this year we launched an online toolkit which provides easy access to a range of resources, provided through our Employee Assistance Programme, to help employees deal with stress, build resilience and manage personal finances.

 

Pre-employment screening

RBSH Group has a comprehensive pre-employment screening process to guard against possible infiltration and employee-related fraud for all direct and non-direct staff engaged on Group business.

 

The Dutch Banking Code (Code Banken)

Introduction

The Code Banken was drawn up by the Netherlands Bankers' Association (NVB) in response to the report entitled 'Restoring Trust' (Naar herstel van vertrouwen), which was published by the Advisory Committee on the Future of Banks (Adviescommissie Toekomst Banken) on 7 April 2009. The recommendations of the Advisory Committee’s report have been used as the basis for this Code Banken. The Code Banken is mandatory for RBSH Group as stated in Book 2 of the Civil Code as from 1 January 2010.

 

The Code Banken offers specific provisions, but underlying these provisions, its aim is to instil learning in the banking sector following the financial crisis. Drawing lessons and implementing change with the aim to restore trust among all our stakeholders, clients, staff, investors and society at large. RBS Group, including RBSH Group has undergone and continues to undergo profound change following the crisis and is committed to high standards of corporate governance, business integrity and professionalism in all its activities.

 

Corporate Governance codes and the global footprint of RBS Group

RBSH Group is ultimately owned by RBS Group. When implementing the Code Banken, the Managing Board and Supervisory Board of RBSH Group will take into account the effects of similar codes of conduct implemented in the RBS Group with the aim to align all businesses with RBS Group.

 

Clients First

RBSH Group is aware of the fact that its long term success fully depends on how successful RBSH Group is in servicing its clients. To that extent, RBSH Group has taken additional measures to further embed ‘a client led culture’ in the organization. Over the past few years certain themes in this area have been fleshed out in detail, resulting in the ‘Customer Charter’ and the ‘Treating Customers Fairly Policy’. The Customer Charter describes 14 ‘customer commitments’ divided into the following four categories:

 

·         Make banking easy

·         Help when you need us

·         Support the communities in which we work

·         Listen to you

 

More information about the Customer Charter can be found on the website: www.rbs.com.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             86 

 


 

 

 

Corporate governance 

 

In the Netherlands, RBSH Group primarily serves wholesale customers. The products and services which RBSH Group provides to these customers have been tailored accordingly and the mentioned Treating Customers Fairly Policy is applicable, where appropriate. With respect to the products and services offered to retail investors through intermediaries we use methods including market research to gauge the requirements and opinions of (potential) customers.

 

Compliance with the Code Banken

RBSH Group considers the Code Banken as an important yardstick for the way banks draw lessons from the crisis. RBSH Group takes account of all relevant remuneration regulatory regimes, including the Code Banken in designing and implementing its remuneration policy as well as RBSH Group’s corporate governance structure.

 

Supervisory Board

The required expertise and experience are well embedded in the Supervisory Board providing for an independent board with a diverse composition. The board consists of executives of RBS Group with broad banking experience, and external members with extensive legal (corporate governance) and international business experience. A clearly defined process for the engagement and recruitment of a Supervisory Board member has been established. If a vacancy for a new member exists, a new member is sought based on an established supervisory board profile to ensure that the knowledge and expertise obtained when filling the vacancy is fully complementing the composition of the board.

 

If the position of Chairman of the Supervisory Board became vacant, a separate individual profile would be drawn up based on an established Chairman’s profile to ensure alignment with the specific socio-economic and political culture and the social environment of the bank’s main markets.

 

All Supervisory Board members have committed themselves to fulfil their responsibilities as board members to the best of their ability. Their attendance at meetings is recorded. The board furthermore operates according to a set of rules governing the Supervisory Board’s principles and best practices. These have been agreed by all board members and are published on the internet site of the bank, www.rbs.nl. The remuneration received as Supervisory Board members is not dependent on RBSH Group’s results.

 

A programme covering aspects as stated in the Code Banken is ongoing to accommodate for life long learning of Supervisory Board members and such programme is assessed on an annual basis. 

 

Furthermore the functioning of the Supervisory Board, including its life long learning programme, has been assessed by an independent party in 2012. Their conclusion was that the Supervisory Board members discharge their roles and responsibilities in a satisfying way. The independent assessment is in accordance with the Code Banken which requires such independent assessment at least once every three years.

 

Managing Board

The composition of the Managing Board of RBSH Group ensures that all business areas and all control and support functions are well represented in the board. The board comprises a Chairman, also responsible for Markets and International Banking, a Chief Risk Officer (CRO), a Chief Financial Officer (CFO) and a Chief Administrative Officer (CAO). To further clarify the specifics of each role on the board and to ensure adherence to agreements made on procedure and governance, a set of rules governing the Managing Board’s principles and best practices has been agreed.

 

A programme covering aspects as stated in the Code Banken is ongoing to accommodate for life long learning of Managing Board members and such programme has been assessed on an annual basis.

 

The Managing Board will continuously ensure a prudent risk appetite, based on the risk appetite framework approved by the Supervisory Board. The Risk appetite framework shall be approved by the Supervisory Board at least once a year. Any material changes in the interim shall also require the Supervisory Board’s approval. The Managing Board takes the interests of all stakeholders (e.g. employees, clients, shareholders) into account in their decision making. The Managing Board recognises that duty of care for clients is an important component in doing business.

 

In line with the requirement of the Code Banken, Managing Board members sign a moral and ethical declaration. Each Board member of RBS N.V. has signed such declaration.

 

The principles in the moral and ethical declaration are incorporated into the RBS Group’s code of conduct which is issued to all new employees joining RBSH Group.

 

Risk Management

The Managing Board has arranged Risk Management in an adequate manner in order to ensure the Managing Board is aware in good time of any material risks run by the bank and to enable the Managing Board to manage these risks properly.

 

The Managing Board, through its sub committees, the Risk & Control Committee (RCC) and the Asset & Liability Management Committee (ALCO) takes any decision that is of material significance to the risk profile, the capital position or the liquidity impact.

 

As from legal separation on 1 April 2010, the Supervisory Board decided to create a combined Risk and Audit Committee, ensuring that the risk component in the bank is thoroughly reviewed and assessed on a regular basis.

 

The Risk & Audit Committee ensures by means of a regular high level assessment whether capital allocation and liquidity impact are in line with the approved risk appetite. The Risk & Audit Committee shall, following such assessment, advise the Supervisory Board on the matter. An assessment at strategic level by the Supervisory Board on whether the commercial activities are in line with agreed risk appetite takes place regularly to enable the board to form a sound opinion.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             87 

 


 

 

 

Corporate governance 

 

In the 4th quarter of 2013, it was decided to integrate the operations of the Risk & Audit Committee into the Supervisory Board. As of that period, the items of the Risk & Audit Committee are discussed during the meetings of the Supervisory Board.

 

Audit

RBSH Group has a New Product Approval Process in place to ensure that all products are launched only after careful consideration of the risks and any other relevant factor applicable to such product. Group Internal Audit checks RBSH Group New Product Approval Process on design and effectiveness at least once per annum and reports its findings to both the Managing Board and Supervisory Board.

 

To ensure the function’s independence, the Head of RBSH Group Internal Audit reports into the Chairman of the Managing Board and the Chairman of the Supervisory Board. RBSH Group Internal Audit also reports its opinion and findings on the quality of the control framework, the system of governance and the risk management of the bank to the Supervisory Board on a bi-annual basis and provides the Supervisory Board with their audit review in the remaining quarters of the year. RBSH Group Internal Audit furthermore presents their annual audit plan to the Supervisory Board. The Managing Board shall ensure that a systemic audit is conducted of the risks managed in relation to the business activities of the bank.

 

The external auditors are invited to share their findings and opinion concerning the quality and effectiveness of the system of governance, risk management and the banks’ control procedures with the Supervisory Board on a quarterly basis. The external auditors present the annual audit plan to the Supervisory Board and both RBSH Group Internal Audit and the external auditors take part in a tri-partite meeting with DNB to share their audit plans, analysis and findings at least once per annum. There is a clear escalation process by which the external auditors can raise, with management, any significant concerns.

 

Remuneration Policy

The remuneration policy for RBS Group, which is also applicable to RBSH Group supports the RBS Group's business strategy and is designed to:

 

·         attract, retain, motivate and reward high calibre employees to deliver superior long-term business performance; and

 

·         ensure that RBSH Group's metrics, reward structures and governance processes as a whole provide coverage of the key risks in an appropriate way.

 

The Supervisory Board is responsible for the implementation and evaluation of the remuneration policy adopted.

 

All members of the Managing Board are remunerated through RBS plc. The full year remuneration of the Managing Board members in office as at 31 December 2013, continues to comply with the Code Banken.

 

RBS Group has had claw back provisions in place since 2009. This allows the Remuneration Committee to retrospectively limit any compensation at the time of vesting if it considers that the performance factors on which reward decisions were based have later turned out not to reflect the corresponding performance in the longer term.

 

The intention is to allow RBS Group to adjust historic remuneration for unforeseen issues arising during the deferral period, particularly those that do not easily lend themselves to quantitative measurement.

 

Summary Code Banken

All of the principles in the Code Banken are adhered to by RBSH Group, except for two items. The Code Banken has a ‘comply’ or ‘explain’ requirement. If a bank is (partially) not compliant, the bank will have to explain the reason for non-compliance in its Annual Report. Sanctions or penalties are not part of the Code Banken. Compliance with the Code Banken is monitored annually by an independent monitoring committee, appointed by the NVB in close consultation with the Minister of Finance. There is no penalty, financial or otherwise, associated with RBSH Group’s non-compliance with the principles.

 

Principle 2.2.1 notes that a separate committee, consisting of Supervisory Board members, should be set up to deal with discussions on risk matters. As stated earlier, RBSH Group had such a committee until Q4 2013. During this quarter, the committee itself was discontinued and its operations were integrated into the Supervisory Board.  All members were previously part of the Risk & Audit Committee and will continue to discuss Risk & Audit matters.

 

Under principle 6.3.4, there is the requirement for shares granted to Managing Board members without financial consideration to be retained for at least five years or to the end of employment, whichever is sooner. Shares are released after a period of three years, which follows the RBS Group remuneration policy.

 

Under the RBS Group-wide deferral arrangements a significant proportion of annual incentive awards for the more senior employees are deferred over a three year period. In line with the requirements of the PRA remuneration Code, a proportion of deferred remuneration is subject to an appropiate retention period.

 

RBSH Group is part of RBS Group and therefore adheres to the global RBS Group remuneration framework and policy which is compliant with the UK Prudential Regulation Authority (PRA) remuneration Code and the Capital Requirements Directive III (CRD III) as implemented in both the United Kingdom and the Netherlands.

 

RBS Group also provides long-term incentives which are designed to link reward with the long-term success of RBSH Group and recognise the responsibility participants have in driving its future success and delivering value for shareholders. Long-term incentive awards are structured as performance-vesting shares. For the most senior roles, vesting will be based partly on divisional or functional performance and partly on performance across RBS Group.

 

For details of remuneration of the Managing Board and Supervisory Board see Note 30 to the Financial Statements.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             88 

 


 

 

 

Corporate governance 

 

Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting                                                                                                                        

Internal Control

The Managing Board is responsible for RBSH Group’s system of internal control that is designed to facilitate effective and efficient operations and to ensure the quality of internal and external reporting and compliance with applicable laws and regulations. In devising internal controls, RBSH Group has regard to the nature and extent of the risk, the likelihood of it crystallising and the cost of controls. A system of internal control is designed to manage, but not eliminate, the risk of failure to achieve business objectives and can only provide reasonable, and not absolute, assurance against the risk of material misstatement, fraud or losses.

 

Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

The Managing Board is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for RBSH Group.

 

RBSH Group’s internal control over financial reporting is a component of an overall system of internal control. RBSH Group’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the preparation, reliability and fair presentation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards ('IFRS') as adopted by the EU-members and issued by the International Accounting Standards Board ('IASB') and it includes:

 

·

Policies and procedures that relate to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, fairly and accurately reflect the transactions and disposition of assets.

 

·

Controls providing reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit the preparation of financial statements in accordance with IFRS, and that receipts and expenditures are being made only as authorised by management.

 

·

Controls providing reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorised acquisition, use or disposition of assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

 

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. In addition, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions or because the degree of compliance with policies or procedures may deteriorate.

 

Management assessed the effectiveness of RBSH Group’s internal control over financial reporting as of 31 December 2013 based on the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in the 1992 publication of 'Internal Control – Integrated Framework'.

 

Based on its assessment, management believes that, as of 31 December 2013, RBSH Group’s internal control over financial reporting is effective.

 

Disclosure controls and procedures

Management, including our Chairman of the Managing Board and our Chief Financial Officer, conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness and design of the disclosure controls and procedures (as such term is defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(e)). Based on this evaluation, our  Chairman of the Managing Board and our Chief Financial Officer concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of the end of the period covered by this annual report.

 

Changes in Internal Controls

There was no change in RBSH Group's internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by this report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, RBSH Group's internal control over financial reporting.

 

Independent verification

External auditors are not required to provide an opinion on the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting for RBSH Group. This is because the company qualifies as a ‘non-accelerated filer’ as defined by the US Securities & Exchange Commission. Following a change to US legislation during 2010, such companies are permanently exempted from an independent verification by the external auditor.

 

Jan de Ruiter

Chairman of the Managing Board

 

Cornelis Visscher

Chief Financial Officer

 

 

Amsterdam, 30 April 2014

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             89 

 


 

 

 

Financial statements                                                                    

 

 

91

Consolidated income statement             

92

Consolidated statement of comprehensive income

93

Consolidated balance sheet

94

Consolidated statement of changes in equity

95

Consolidated cash flow statement

96

Accounting policies

106

Notes on the consolidated accounts

 

1

Net interest income

106

 

2

Non-interest income

106

 

3

Operating expenses

107

 

4

Pensions

108

 

5

Auditor’s remuneration

110

 

6

Tax

111

 

7

Dividends

111

 

8

Financial instruments - classification

112

 

9

Financial instruments - valuation

116

 

10

Financial instruments - maturity analysis

131

 

11

Financial assets - impairments

134

 

12

Derivatives

135

 

13

Debt securities

137

 

14

Equity shares

138

 

15

Prepayments, accrued income and other assets

139

 

16

Discontinued operations and assets and liabilities of disposal groups

139

 

17

Settlement balances and short positions

141

 

18

Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities

141

 

19

Deferred taxation

142

 

20

Subordinated liabilities

142

 

21

Share capital

145

 

22

Reserves

145

 

23

Structured entities and asset transfers

145

 

24

Capital resources

147

 

25

Memorandum items

148

 

26

Changes in operating assets and liabilities

153

 

27

Interest received and paid

153

 

28

Analysis of cash and cash equivalents

153

 

29

Segmental analysis

154

 

30

Remuneration of the Managing Board and Supervisory Board of RBS Holdings N.V.

157

 

31

Related parties

158

 

32

Post balance sheet events

159

 

33

Condensed consolidating financial information

159

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             90 

 


 

 

 

Consolidated income statement for the year ended 31 December 2013                        

 

 

 

Note

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

       €m 

Interest receivable

  

768 

1,628 

2,352 

Interest payable

  

(530)

(1,023)

(1,664)

Net interest income

238 

605 

688 

Fees and commissions receivable

  

119 

469 

1,039 

Fees and commissions payable

  

(49)

(198)

(367)

Income from trading activities

  

46 

49 

646 

Other operating income

  

83 

(217)

2,000 

Non-interest income

199 

103 

3,318 

Total income

  

437 

708 

4,006 

Staff costs

  

(175)

(741)

(1,210)

Premises and equipment

  

(50)

(186)

(451)

Other administrative expenses

  

(291)

(550)

(598)

Depreciation and amortisation

  

(21)

(49)

(139)

Write-down of goodwill and other intangible assets

  

— 

(4)

(29)

Operating expenses

(537)

(1,530)

(2,427)

(Loss)/profit before impairment losses

  

(100)

(822)

1,579 

Impairment losses

11 

(42)

(65)

(1,765)

Operating loss before tax

  

(142)

(887)

(186)

Tax charge

(12)

(129)

(449)

Loss from continuing operations

  

(154)

(1,016)

(635)

Profit from discontinued operations, net of tax

16 

19 

17 

40 

Loss for the year

  

(135)

(999)

(595)

  

  

  

  

  

Loss attributable to:

  

  

  

  

Controlling interests

  

(135)

(999)

(595)

 

The accompanying notes on pages 106 to 165, the accounting policies on pages 96 to 104 and the audited sections of the Business review: Risk and balance sheet management on pages 25 to 77 form an integral part of these financial statements.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             91 

 


 

 

 

Consolidated statement of comprehensive income for the year ended 31 December 2013    

 

 

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

       €m 

Loss for the year

  

(135)

(999)

(595)

Items that qualify for reclassification

  

  

  

  

Available-for-sale financial assets

  

1,591 

448 

274 

Cash flow hedges

  

— 

22 

Currency translation

  

(67)

(192)

(473)

Tax

  

(3)

(776)

Other comprehensive income/(loss) after tax

  

1,525 

275 

(966)

Total comprehensive income/(loss) for the year

  

1,390 

(724)

(1,561)

  

  

  

  

  

Total comprehensive income/(loss) is attributable as follows:

  

  

  

  

Non-controlling interests

  

— 

— 

(3)

Controlling interests

  

1,390 

(724)

(1,558)

  

  

1,390 

(724)

(1,561)

 

The accompanying notes on pages 106 to 165, the accounting policies on pages 96 to 104 and the audited sections of the Business review: Risk and balance sheet management on pages 25 to 77 form an integral part of these financial statements.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             92 

 


 

 

 

Consolidated balance sheet as at 31 December 2013

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

 

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

  

Note 

€m 

  €m 

 €m 

Assets

  

  

  

  

Cash and balances at central banks

3,193 

2,294 

12,609 

Net loans and advances to banks

  

5,642 

12,138 

16,817 

Reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing

53 

68 

9,100 

Loans and advances to banks

  

5,695 

12,206 

25,917 

Net loans and advances to customers

  

3,782 

6,375 

29,295 

Reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing

  

283 

Loans and advances to customers

3,784 

6,380 

29,578 

Amounts due from the ultimate holding company 

2,820 

2,949 

1,136 

Debt securities

13 

15,288 

22,655 

39,645 

Equity shares

14 

295 

1,127 

3,093 

Settlement balances

10 

31 

2,608 

Derivatives

12 

4,782 

7,555 

19,138 

Deferred tax

19 

40 

420 

444 

Prepayments, accrued income and other assets

15 

1,853 

1,533 

5,913 

Assets of disposal groups

16 

2,048 

13,804 

6,695 

Total assets

  

39,808 

70,954 

146,776 

  

  

  

  

  

Liabilities

  

  

  

  

Bank deposits

  

7,233 

21,841 

29,988 

Repurchase agreements and stock lending

  

11,710 

12,624 

16,532 

Deposits by banks

18,943 

34,465 

46,520 

Customers deposits

  

4,118 

2,620 

38,842 

Repurchase agreements and stock lending

  

33 

18 

759 

Customer accounts

4,151 

2,638 

39,601 

Debt securities in issue

1,319 

2,602 

17,714 

Settlement balances and short positions

17 

105 

107 

3,409 

Derivatives

12 

5,862 

9,644 

19,868 

Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities

18 

1,065 

1,782 

3,895 

Deferred tax

19 

63 

40 

201 

Subordinated liabilities

20 

4,951 

6,851 

6,859 

Liabilities of disposal groups

16 

407 

11,026 

5,293 

Total liabilities

  

36,866 

69,155 

143,360 

  

  

  

  

  

Non-controlling interests

  

— 

— 

21 

Controlling interests

  

2,942 

1,799 

3,395 

Total equity

  

2,942 

1,799 

3,416 

  

  

  

  

  

Total liabilities and equity

  

39,808 

70,954 

146,776 

 

The accompanying notes on pages 106 to 165, the accounting policies on pages 96 to 104 and the audited sections of the Business review: Risk and balance sheet management on pages 25 to 77 form an integral part of these financial statements.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             93 

 


 

 

 

Consolidated statement of changes in equity for the year ended 31 December 2013

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

 

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

 €m 

Called-up share capital

  

  

  

  

At 1 January

  

— 

1,852 

1,852 

Transfer to share premium

  

— 

(1,852)

— 

At 31 December

  

— 

— 

1,852 

  

  

  

  

  

Share premium account

At 1 January

  

3,171 

2,187 

2,187 

Transfer from share capital

  

— 

1,852 

— 

Transfer resulting from Dutch Scheme

  

  

(868)

— 

Transfer resulting from cross border merger

  

(247)

— 

— 

At 31 December

  

2,924 

3,171 

2,187 

  

  

  

  

  

Available-for-sale reserve

At 1 January

  

(2,473)

(2,918)

(2,419)

Unrealised gains/(losses) in the year

  

1,538 

420 

(1,155)

Realised losses in the year

  

53 

28 

1,429 

Tax

  

(3)

(773)

At 31 December

  

(881)

(2,473)

(2,918)

  

  

  

  

  

Cash flow hedging reserve

At 1 January

  

— 

(22)

(28)

Amount recognised in equity during the year

  

— 

— 

Amount transferred from equity to earnings in the year

  

— 

22 

— 

Tax

  

— 

— 

(3)

At 31 December

  

— 

— 

(22)

  

  

  

  

  

Foreign exchange reserve

At 1 January

  

(235)

(43)

427 

Losses arising during the year

  

(46)

(25)

(67)

Reclassification of foreign currency gains included in the income statement (1) 

  

(21)

(167)

(403)

At 31 December

  

(302)

(235)

(43)

  

  

  

  

  

Retained earnings

At 1 January

  

1,336 

2,339 

2,939 

(Loss)/profit attributable to controlling interests

  

  

  

  

  - continuing operations

  

(154)

(1,016)

(635)

  - discontinuing operations

  

19 

17 

40 

Other changes

  

— 

(4)

(5)

At 31 December

  

1,201 

1,336 

2,339 

  

  

  

  

  

Non-controlling interests

  

  

  

  

At 1 January

  

— 

21 

24 

Comprehensive loss in the year

  

— 

— 

(3)

Recycled to profit or loss on disposal of business

  

— 

(21)

— 

At 31 December

  

— 

— 

21 

Owner’s equity at 31 December

  

2,942 

1,799 

3,416 

 

 

Note:

(1)       Includes €20 million relating to gains recycled to profit and loss due to transfers to RBS plc during 2013 (2012 -  €174 million; 2011 - €404 million).

 

The accompanying notes on pages 106 to 165, the accounting policies on pages 96 to 104 and the audited sections of the Business review: Risk and balance sheet management on pages 25 to 77 form an integral part of these financial statements.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             94 

 


 

 

 

Consolidated cash flow statement for the year ended 31 December 2013

 

 

 

Note

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

       €m 

Operating activities

  

  

  

  

Operating loss before tax from continuing operations

  

(142)

(887)

(186)

Operating profit before tax from discontinued operations

  

31 

28 

53 

Adjustments for:

  

  

  

  

Interest on subordinated liabilities

  

203 

232 

230 

Elimination of foreign exchange differences

  

56 

(30)

476 

Impairment losses on debt securities

  

34 

48 

1,463 

Other non-cash items

  

267 

(1,343)

428 

Net cash inflow/(outflow) from operating activities

  

449 

(1,952)

2,464 

Changes in operating assets and liabilities

26 

(8,273)

(15,176)

(11,547)

Net cash flows from operating activities before tax

  

(7,824)

(17,128)

(9,083)

Income taxes paid

  

(35)

(196)

(65)

Net cash flows from operating activities

  

(7,859)

(17,324)

(9,148)

Investing activities

  

  

  

  

Sale and maturity of securities

  

8,896 

12,946 

58,845 

Purchase of securities

  

(305)

(2,360)

(49,319)

Disposal of subsidiaries/businesses (1)

  

(3,362)

(10,188)

(117)

Other investments/(divestments)

  

37 

256 

(60)

Net cash flows from investing activities

  

5,266 

654 

9,349 

Financing activities

  

  

  

  

Repayment/settlement of subordinated liabilities

  

(1,907)

(85)

(79)

Interest on subordinated liabilities

  

(212)

(240)

(261)

Other

  

— 

(21)

— 

Net cash flows from financing activities

  

(2,119)

(346)

(340)

Effects of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

  

40 

125 

Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents

  

(4,672)

(17,014)

(14)

Cash and cash equivalents at 1 January

  

10,030 

27,044 

27,058 

Cash and cash equivalents at 31 December

28 

5,358 

10,030 

27,044 

 

Note:

(1)       Relates to the transfer of subsidiaries and businesses to RBSG plc and RBS plc during the year.

 

The accompanying notes on pages 106 to 165, the accounting policies on pages 96 to 104 and the audited sections of the Business review: Risk and balance sheet management on pages 25 to 77 form an integral part of these financial statements.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             95 

 


 

 

 

Accounting policies                                                                                                                                               

 

1. Corporate information

RBS Holdings N.V. (the Company) is a public limited liability company, incorporated under Dutch law on 30 May 1990 and registered at Gustav Mahlerlaan 350, 1082 ME Amsterdam, the Netherlands. RBSH Group offers a wide range of banking products and financial services principally in Europe and Asia.

 

The Company is wholly owned by RFS Holdings B.V., itself 97.7% owned by RBS Group. RBS Group is incorporated in the UK and registered at 36 St. Andrew Square, Edinburgh, Scotland. RBS Group is the ultimate parent company of RBS Holdings N.V. The consolidated financial statements of RBS Holdings N.V. are included in the consolidated financial statements of RBS Group.

 

The consolidated financial statements of RBSH Group for the year ended 31 December 2013 incorporate financial information of the Company, its controlled entities and interests in associates and joint ventures. The consolidated financial statements were signed and authorised for issue by the Managing Board on 30 April 2014 and by the Supervisory Board on 30 April 2014. The right to request an amendment of the financial statements is embedded in the Netherlands Civil Code. Interested parties have the right to ask the Enterprise Chamber of the Amsterdam Court of Appeal for a revision of the financial statements.

 

2. Presentation of accounts

The Managing Board, having made such enquiries as they considered appropriate, including a review of RBSH Group’s forecasts, projections and other relevant evidence regarding the continuing availability of sufficient resources from the RBS Group, have prepared the financial statements on a going concern basis.

 

As announced on 19 April 2011, RBS Group is committed to providing the necessary support to ensure that RBS N.V. continues to meet its commitments after the Transfers.

 

The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) and interpretations as issued by the IFRS Interpretations Committee (IFRIC) of the IASB and IFRS as adopted by the European Union (EU) (together IFRS). The EU has not adopted the complete text of IAS 39 ‘Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement', it has relaxed some of the standard's hedging requirements.

 

RBSH Group has not taken advantage of this relaxation and has adopted IAS 39 as issued by the IASB: RBSH Group's financial statements are prepared in accordance with IFRS as issued by the IASB.

 

The RBSH Group adopted a number of new and revised IFRSs effective 1 January 2013:

 

IFRS 11 ‘Joint Arrangements’, which supersedes IAS 31 ‘Interests in Joint Ventures’, distinguishes between joint operations and joint ventures. Joint operations are accounted for by the investor recognising its assets and liabilities including its share of any assets held and liabilities incurred jointly and its share of revenues and costs. Joint ventures are accounted for in the investor’s consolidated accounts using the equity method. IFRS 11 requires retrospective application.

 

IAS 27 ‘Separate Financial Statements’ comprises those parts of the existing IAS 27 that deal with separate financial statements. IAS 28 ‘Investments in Associates and Joint Ventures’ covers joint ventures as well as associates; both must be accounted for using the equity method. The mechanics of the equity method are unchanged.

 

IFRS 12 ‘Disclosure of Interests in Other Entities’ mandates the disclosures in annual financial statements in respect of investments in subsidiaries, joint arrangements, associates and structured entities that are not controlled by the Group.

 

IFRS 13 ‘Fair Value Measurement’ sets out a single IFRS framework for defining and measuring fair value. It defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. It also requires disclosures about fair value measurements.

 

‘Disclosures - Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities (Amendments to IFRS 7)’ amended IFRS 7 to require disclosures about the effects and potential effects on an entity’s financial position of offsetting financial assets and financial liabilities and related arrangements.

  

Amendments to IAS 1 ‘Presentation of Items of Other Comprehensive Income’ require items that will never be recognised in profit or loss to be presented separately in other comprehensive income from those items that are subject to subsequent reclassification.

 

IAS 19 ‘Employee Benefits’ (revised) requires: the immediate recognition of all actuarial gains and losses; interest cost to be calculated on the net pension liability or asset at the long-term bond rate, such that an expected rate of return will no longer be applied to assets; and all past service costs to be recognised immediately when a scheme is curtailed or amended.

  

IFRS 10 ‘Consolidated Financial Statements’ replaces SIC-12 ‘Consolidation - Special Purpose Entities’ and the consolidation elements of the existing IAS 27 ‘Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements’. IFRS 10 adopts a single definition of control: a reporting entity controls another entity when the reporting entity has the power to direct the activities of that other entity so as to vary returns for the reporting entity. IFRS 10 requires retrospective application. Following implementation of IFRS10, certain entities that have trust preferred securities in issue are no longer consolidated by RBSH Group.  As a result RBSH Group recognises the loan capital issued by the Company to the entities previously consolidated. There is no change to total subordinated liabilities reported by RBSH Group.

 

‘Annual Improvements 2009-2011 Cycle’ also made a number of minor changes to IFRSs.

 

Implementation of the standards above has not had a material effect on the financial statements of the Group or the company

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             96 

 


 

 

 

Accounting policies                                                                                                                                               

 

The accounts are prepared on a historical cost basis of measurement except for certain financial instruments that are measured at fair value as described in Accounting Policies 11, 13 and 15 below. The company’s financial statements and RBSH Group's consolidated financial statements are presented in euro which is the functional currency of the company.

 

3. Basis of consolidation

The consolidated financial statements incorporate the financial statements of the company and entities (including certain structured entities) that are controlled by RBSH Group. The RBSH Group controls another entity (a subsidiary) when it is exposed, or has rights, to variable returns from its involvement with that entity and has the ability to affect those returns through its power over the other entity; power generally arises from holding a majority of voting rights. On acquisition of a subsidiary, its identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities are included in the consolidated accounts at their fair value. A subsidiary is included in the consolidated financial statements from the date it is controlled by the RBSH Group until the date the RBSH Group ceases to control it through a sale or a significant change in circumstances. Changes in the RBSH Group’s interest in a subsidiary that do not result in the RBSH Group ceasing to control that subsidiary are accounted for as equity transactions.

 

All intergroup balances, transactions, income and expenses are eliminated on consolidation. The consolidated accounts are prepared under uniform accounting policies.

 

4. Revenue recognition

Interest income on financial assets that are classified as loans and receivables, available-for-sale or held-to-maturity and interest expense on financial liabilities other than those measured at fair value are determined using the effective interest method. The effective interest method is a method of calculating the amortised cost of a financial asset or financial liability (or group of financial assets or liabilities) and of allocating the interest income or interest expense over the expected life of the asset or liability. The effective interest rate is the rate that exactly discounts estimated future cash flows to the instrument's initial carrying amount. Calculation of the effective interest rate takes into account fees payable or receivable that are an integral part of the instrument's yield, premiums or discounts on acquisition or issue, early redemption fees and transaction costs. All contractual terms of a financial instrument are considered when estimating future cash flows.

 

Financial assets and financial liabilities held-for-trading or designated as at fair value through profit or loss are recorded at fair value. Changes in fair value are recognised in profit or loss.

 

Commitment and utilisation fees are determined as a percentage of the outstanding facility. If it is unlikely that a specific lending arrangement will be entered into, such fees are taken to profit or loss over the life of the facility otherwise they are deferred and included in the effective interest rate on the advance.

 

Fees in respect of services are recognised as the right to consideration accrues through the provision of the service to the customer. The arrangements are generally contractual and the cost of providing the service is incurred as the service is rendered. The price is usually fixed and always determinable. The application of this policy to a significant fee type is outlined below.

 

Investment management fees - fees charged for managing investments are recognised as revenue as the services are provided. Incremental costs that are directly attributable to securing an investment management contract are deferred and charged as expense as the related revenue is recognised.

 

5. Assets held for sale and discontinued operations

A non-current asset (or disposal group) is classified as held for sale if RBSH Group will recover its carrying amount principally through a sale transaction rather than through continuing use. A non-current asset (or disposal group) classified as held for sale is measured at the lower of its carrying amount and fair value less costs to sell. If the asset (or disposal group) is acquired as part of a business combination, it is initially measured at fair value less costs to sell. Assets and liabilities of disposal groups classified as held for sale and non-current assets classified as held for sale are shown separately on the face of the balance sheet.

 

The results of discontinued operations – comprising the post-tax profit or loss of discontinued operations and the post-tax gain or loss recognised either on measurement to fair value less costs to sell or on the disposal of the discontinued operation are shown as a single amount on the face of the income statement.

 

6. Pensions and other post-retirement benefits

RBSH Group provides post-retirement benefits in the form of pensions and healthcare plans to eligible employees under defined contribution plans.

 

Contributions to defined contribution pension schemes are recognised in profit or loss when payable.

 

For defined benefit schemes, the defined benefit obligation is measured on an actuarial basis using the projected unit credit method and discounted at a rate determined by reference to market yields at the end of the reporting period on high quality corporate bonds of equivalent term and currency to the scheme liabilities. Scheme assets are measured at their fair value. The difference between scheme assets and scheme liabilities – the net defined benefit asset or liability - is recognised in the balance sheet. A defined benefit asset is limited to the present value of any economic benefits available to the Group in the form of refunds from the plan or reduced contributions to it.

 

The charge to profit or loss for pension costs (recorded in operating expenses) comprises:

·         the current service cost.

·         interest, computed at the rate used to discount scheme liabilities, on the net defined benefit liability or asset.

·         past service cost resulting from a scheme amendment or curtailment.

·         gains or losses on settlement.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             97 

 


 

 

 

Accounting policies                                                                                                                                               

 

A curtailment occurs when the Group significantly reduces the number of employees covered by a plan. A plan amendment occurs when the Group introduces, or withdraws, a defined benefit plan or changes the benefits payable under an existing defined benefit plan. Past service cost may be either positive (when benefits are introduced or changed so that the present value of the defined benefit obligation increases) or negative (when benefits are withdrawn or changed so that the present value of the defined benefit obligation decreases). A settlement is a transaction that eliminates all further obligation for part or all of the benefits.

 

Actuarial gains and losses (i.e. gains or and losses on re-measuring of the net defined benefit asset or liability) are recognised in full in the period in which they arise in other comprehensive income.

 

7. Foreign currencies

Group entities record transactions in foreign currencies in their functional currency - the currency of the primary economic environment in which they operate at the foreign exchange rate ruling at the date of the transaction. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are translated into the relevant functional currency at the foreign exchange rates ruling at the balance sheet date. Foreign exchange differences arising on the settlement of foreign currency transactions and from the translation of monetary assets and liabilities are reported in income from trading activities except for differences arising on cash flow hedges and hedges of net investments in foreign operations (see Accounting policy 20).

 

Non-monetary items denominated in foreign currencies that are stated at fair value are translated into the relevant functional currency at the foreign exchange rates ruling at the dates the values are determined. Translation differences arising on non-monetary items measured at fair value are recognised in profit or loss except for differences arising on available-for-sale non-monetary financial assets, for example equity shares, which are recognised in other comprehensive income unless the asset is the hedged item in a fair value hedge.

 

Assets and liabilities of foreign operations are translated into euro at foreign exchange rates ruling at the balance sheet date. Income and expenses of foreign operations are translated into euro at average exchange rates unless these do not approximate to the foreign exchange rates ruling at the dates of the transactions. Foreign exchange differences arising on the translation of a foreign operation are recognised in other comprehensive income. The amount accumulated in equity is reclassified from equity to profit or loss on disposal or partial disposal of a foreign operation.

 

8. Leases

As lessor

Contracts with customers to lease assets are classified as finance leases if they transfer substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership of the asset to the customer; all other contracts with customers to lease assets are classified as operating leases.

 

Rental income from operating leases is recognised in income on a straight-line basis over the lease term unless another systematic basis better represents the time pattern of the asset’s use. Operating lease assets are included within Property, plant and equipment and depreciated over their useful lives. Operating lease rentals receivable are included in Other operating income.

 

As lessee

RBSH Group’s contracts to lease assets are principally operating leases. Operating lease rental expense is included in Premises and equipment costs and recognised as an expense on a straight-line basis over the lease term unless another systematic basis better represents the benefit to RBSH Group.

 

9. Provisions

RBSH Group recognises a provision for a present obligation resulting from a past event when it is more likely than not that it will be required to transfer economic benefits to settle the obligation and the amount of the obligation can be estimated reliably.

 

Provision is made for restructuring costs, including the costs of redundancy, when RBSH Group has a constructive obligation to restructure. An obligation exists when RBSH Group has a detailed formal plan for the restructuring and has raised a valid expectation in those affected by starting to implement the plan or announcing its main features.

 

If RBSH Group has a contract that is onerous, it recognises the present obligation under the contract as a provision. An onerous contract is one where the unavoidable costs of meeting RBSH Group’s contractual obligations exceed the expected economic benefits. When RBSH Group vacates a leasehold property, a provision is recognised for the costs under the lease less any expected economic benefits (such as rental income).

 

Contingent liabilities are possible obligations arising from past events whose existence will be confirmed only by uncertain future events or present obligations arising from past events that are not recognised because either an outflow of economic benefits is not probable or the amount of the obligation cannot be reliably measured. Contingent liabilities are not recognised but information about them is disclosed unless the possibility of any outflow of economic benefits in settlement is remote.

 

10. Tax

Income tax expense or income, comprising current tax and deferred tax, is recorded in the income statement except income tax on items recognised outside profit or loss which is credited or charged to other comprehensive income or to equity as appropriate.

 

Current tax is income tax payable or recoverable in respect of the taxable profit or loss for the year arising in income or in equity. Provision is made for current tax at rates enacted or substantively enacted at the balance sheet date.

 

Deferred tax is the tax expected to be payable or recoverable in respect of temporary differences between the carrying amount of an asset or liability for accounting purposes and its carrying amount for tax purposes. Deferred tax liabilities are generally recognised for all taxable temporary differences and deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that it is probable that they will be recovered.

 

Deferred tax is not recognised on temporary differences that arise from initial recognition of an asset or a liability in a transaction (other than a business combination) that at the time of the transaction affects neither accounting nor taxable profit or loss. Deferred tax is calculated using tax rates expected to apply in the periods when the assets will be realised or the liabilities settled, based on tax rates and laws enacted, or substantively enacted, at the balance sheet date. 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             98 

 


 

 

 

Accounting policies                                                                                                                                               

 

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset where RBSH Group has a legally enforceable right to offset and where they relate to income taxes levied by the same taxation authority either on an individual RBSH Group company or on RBSH Group companies in the same tax group that intend, in future periods, to settle current tax liabilities and assets on a net basis or on a gross basis simultaneously.

 

11. Financial assets

On initial recognition, financial assets are classified into held-to-maturity investments; held-for-trading; designated as at fair value through profit or loss; loans and receivables; or available-for-sale financial assets. Regular way purchases of financial assets classified as loans and receivables are recognised on settlement date; all other regular way transactions in financial assets are recognised on trade date.

 

Held-to-maturity investments - a financial asset may be classified as a held-to-maturity investment only if it has fixed or determinable payments, a fixed maturity and RBSH Group has the positive intention and ability to hold to maturity. Held-to-maturity investments are initially recognised at fair value plus directly related transaction costs. They are subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method (see

Accounting policy 4) less any impairment losses.

 

Held-for-trading - a financial asset is classified as held-for-trading if it is acquired principally for sale in the near term, or forms part of a portfolio of financial instruments that are managed together and for which there is evidence of short-term profit taking, or it is a derivative (not in a qualifying hedge relationship). Held-for-trading financial assets are recognised at fair value with transaction costs being recognised in profit or loss. Subsequently they are measured at fair value. Gains and losses on held-for-trading financial assets are recognised in profit or loss as they arise.

 

Designated as at fair value through profit or loss - financial assets may be designated as at fair value through profit or loss only if such designation (a) eliminates or significantly reduces a measurement or recognition inconsistency; or (b) applies to a group of financial assets, financial liabilities or both, that RBSH Group manages and evaluates on a fair value basis; or (c) relates to an instrument that contains an embedded derivative which is not evidently closely related to the host contract. Financial assets that RBSH Group designates on initial recognition as being at fair value through profit or loss are recognised at fair value, with transaction costs being recognised in profit or loss, and are subsequently measured at fair value. Gains and losses on financial assets that are designated as at fair value through profit or loss are recognised in profit or loss as they arise.

 

Loans and receivables - non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable repayments that are not quoted in an active market are classified as loans and receivables, except those that are classified as available-for-sale or as held-for-trading, or designated as at fair value through profit or loss. Loans and receivables are initially recognised at fair value plus directly related transaction costs. They are subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method (see Accounting  policy 4) less any impairment losses.

 

Available-for-sale financial assets - financial assets that are not classified as held-to-maturity; held-for-trading; designated as at fair value through profit or loss; or loans and receivables are classified as available-for-sale.

 

Financial assets can be designated as available-for-sale on initial recognition. Available-for-sale financial assets are initially recognised at fair value plus directly related transaction costs. They are subsequently measured at fair value. Unquoted equity investments whose fair value cannot be measured reliably are carried at cost and classified as available-for-sale financial assets. Impairment losses and exchange differences resulting from retranslating the amortised cost of foreign currency monetary available-for-sale financial assets are recognised in profit or loss together with interest calculated using the effective interest method (see Accounting policy 4), as are gains and losses attributable to the hedged risk on available-for-sale financial assets that are hedged items in fair value hedges (see Accounting policy 20).

 

Other changes in the fair value of available-for-sale financial assets and any related tax are reported in other comprehensive income until disposal, when the cumulative gain or loss is reclassified from equity to profit or loss.

 

Reclassifications - held-for-trading and available-for-sale financial assets that meet the definition of loans and receivables (non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments that are not quoted in an active market) may be reclassified to loans and receivables if RBSH Group has the intention and ability to hold the financial asset for the foreseeable future or until maturity. RBSH Group typically regards the foreseeable future as twelve months from the date of reclassification. Additionally, held-for-trading financial assets that do not meet the definition of loans and receivables may, in rare circumstances, be transferred to available-for-sale financial assets or to held-to-maturity investments. Reclassifications are made at fair value. This fair value becomes the asset's new cost or amortised cost as appropriate. Gains and losses recognised up to the date of reclassification are not reversed.

 

Fair value for a net open position in a financial asset that is quoted in an active market is the current bid price times the number of units of the instrument held. Fair values for financial assets not quoted in an active market are determined using appropriate valuation techniques including discounting future cash flows, option pricing models and other methods that are consistent with accepted economic methodologies for pricing financial assets.

 

12. Impairment of financial assets

RBSH Group assesses at each balance sheet date whether there is any objective evidence that a financial asset or group of financial assets classified as held-to-maturity, available-for-sale or loans and receivables is impaired. A financial asset or portfolio of financial assets is impaired and an impairment loss incurred if there is objective evidence that an event or events since initial recognition of the asset have adversely affected the amount or timing of future cash flows from the asset.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                             99 

 


 

 

 

Accounting policies                                                                                                                                               

 

Financial assets carried at amortised cost - if there is objective evidence that an impairment loss on a financial asset or group of financial assets classified as loans and receivables or as held-to-maturity investments has been incurred, RBSH Group measures the amount of the loss as the difference between the carrying amount of the asset or group of assets and the present value of estimated future cash flows from the asset or group of assets discounted at the effective interest rate of the instrument at initial recognition.  For collateralised loans and receivables, estimated future cash flows include cash flows that may result from foreclosure less the costs of obtaining and selling the collateral, whether or not foreclosure is probable. Where, in the course of the orderly realisation of a loan, it is exchanged for equity shares or property, the exchange is accounted for as the sale of the loan and the acquisition of equity securities or investment property. Where RBSH Group’s interest in equity shares following the exchange is such that RBSH Group controls an entity, that entity is consolidated.

 

Impairment losses are assessed individually for financial assets that are individually significant and individually or collectively for assets that are not individually significant. 

 

Impairment losses are recognised in profit or loss and the carrying amount of the financial asset or group of financial assets reduced by establishing an allowance for impairment losses. If, in a subsequent period, the amount of the impairment loss reduces and the reduction can be ascribed to an event after the impairment was recognised, the previously recognised loss is reversed by adjusting the allowance. Once an impairment loss has been recognised on a financial asset or group of financial assets, interest income is recognised on the carrying amount using the rate of interest at which estimated future cash flows were discounted in measuring impairment.

 

Impaired loans and receivables are written off, i.e. the impairment provision is applied in writing down the loan's carrying value partially or in full, when RBSH Group concludes that there is no longer any realistic prospect of recovery of part or all of the loan. For loans that are individually assessed for impairment, the timing of write-off is determined on a case-by-case basis. Such loans are reviewed regularly and write-offs will be prompted by bankruptcy, insolvency, renegotiation and similar events. The typical time frames from initial impairment to write-off for RBSH Group’s collectively-assessed portfolios of €9 million as at 31 December 2013 (2012 - €15 million; 2011 - €167 million) are set out below.

 

Retail mortgages: write-off occurs within 5 years, and is accelerated where accounts are closed earlier. Credit cards: write-off of the irrecoverable amount takes place at 12 months; the rest is expected to be recovered over a further 3 years following which any remaining amounts outstanding are written off. Overdrafts and other unsecured loans: write-offs occur within 6 years; Business and commercial loans: write-offs of commercial loans are determined in the light of individual circumstances; the period does not exceed 5 years.  Business loans are generally written off within 5 years. Amounts recovered after a loan has been written off are credited to the loan impairment charge for the period in which they are received.

 

Financial assets carried at fair value - when a decline in the fair value of a financial asset classified as available-for-sale has been recognised directly in other comprehensive income and there is objective evidence that it is impaired, the cumulative loss is reclassified from equity to profit or loss. The loss is measured as the difference between the amortised cost of the financial asset and its current fair value. Impairment losses on available-for-sale equity instruments are not reversed through profit or loss, but those on available-for-sale debt instruments are reversed, if there is an increase in fair value that is objectively related to a subsequent event.

 

13. Financial liabilities

On initial recognition, financial liabilities are classified into held-for-trading; designated as at fair value through profit or loss; or amortised cost. Issues of financial liabilities measured at amortised cost are recognised on settlement date; all other regular way transactions in financial liabilities are recognised on trade date.

 

Held-for-trading - a financial liability is classified as held-for-trading if it is incurred principally for repurchase in the near term, or forms part of a portfolio of financial instruments that are managed together and for  which there is evidence of short-term profit taking, or it is a derivative (not in a qualifying hedge relationship).

 

Held-for-trading financial liabilities are recognised at fair value with transaction costs being recognised in profit or loss. Subsequently they are measured at fair value. Gains and losses are recognised in profit or loss as they arise.

 

Designated as at fair value through profit or loss - financial liabilities may be designated as at fair value through profit or loss only if such designation (a) eliminates or significantly reduces a measurement or recognition inconsistency; or (b) applies to a group of financial assets, financial liabilities or both that RBSH Group manages and evaluates on a fair value basis; or (c) relates to an instrument that contains an embedded derivative which is not evidently closely related to the host contract.

 

Financial liabilities that RBSH Group designates on initial recognition as being at fair value through profit or loss are recognised at fair value, with transaction costs being recognised in profit or loss, and are subsequently measured at fair value. Gains and losses on financial liabilities that are designated as at fair value through profit or loss are recognised in profit or loss as they arise.

 

Financial liabilities designated as at fair value through profit or loss principally comprise structured liabilities issued by RBSH Group: designation significantly reduces the measurement inconsistency between these liabilities and the related derivatives carried at fair value.

 

Amortised cost - all other financial liabilities are measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method (see Accounting policy 4).

 

Fair value - fair value for a net open position in a financial liability that is quoted in an active market is the current offer price times the number of units of the instrument issued. Fair values for financial liabilities not quoted in an active market are determined using appropriate valuation techniques including discounting future cash flows, option pricing models and other methods that are consistent with accepted economic methodologies for pricing financial liabilities.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           100 

 


 

 

 

Accounting policies                                                                                                                                               

 

14. Financial guarantee contracts

Under a financial guarantee contract, RBSH Group, in return for a fee, undertakes to meet a customer’s obligations under the terms of a debt instrument if the customer fails to do so. A financial guarantee is recognised as a liability; initially at fair value and, if not designated as at fair value through profit or loss, subsequently at the higher of its initial value less cumulative amortisation and any provision under the contract measured in accordance with Accounting policy 9. Amortisation is calculated so as to recognise fees receivable in profit or loss over the period of the guarantee.

 

15. Loan commitments

Provision is made for loan commitments, other than those classified as held-for-trading, if it is probable that the facility will be drawn and the resulting loan will be recognised at a value less than the cash advanced. Syndicated loan commitments in excess of the level of lending under the commitment approved for retention by RBSH Group are classified as held-for-trading and measured at fair value.

 

16. Derecognition

A financial asset is derecognised when the contractual right to receive cash flows from the asset has expired or when it has been transferred and the transfer qualifies for derecognition. A transfer requires that RBSH Group either (a) transfers the contractual rights to receive the asset's cash flows; or (b) retains the right to the asset's cash flows but assumes a contractual obligation to pay those cash flows to a third party. After a transfer, RBSH Group assesses the extent to which it has retained the risks and rewards of ownership of the transferred asset. The asset remains on the balance sheet if substantially all the risks and rewards have been retained. It is derecognised if substantially all the risks and rewards have been transferred. If substantially all the risks and rewards have been neither retained nor transferred, RBSH Group assesses whether or not it has retained control of the asset. If it has not retained control, the asset is derecognised. Where RBSH Group has retained control of the asset, it continues to recognise the asset to the extent of its continuing involvement; if RBSH Group has not retained control of the asset, it is derecognised.

 

A financial liability is removed from the balance sheet when the obligation is discharged, or cancelled, or expires. On the redemption or settlement of debt securities (including subordinated liabilities) issued by RBSH Group, RBSH Group derecognises the debt instrument and records a gain or loss being the difference between the debt's carrying amount and the cost of redemption or settlement. The same treatment applies where the debt is exchanged for a new debt issue that has terms substantially different from those of the existing debt. The assessment of whether the terms of the new debt instrument are substantially different takes into account qualitative and quantitative characteristics including a comparison of the present value of the cash flows under the new terms with present value of the remaining cash flows of the original debt issue discounted at the effective interest rate of the original debt issue.

 

17. Sale and repurchase transactions

Securities subject to a sale and repurchase agreement under which substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership are retained by RBSH Group continue to be shown on the balance sheet and the sale proceeds recorded as a financial liability.

 

Securities acquired in a reverse sale and repurchase transaction under which RBSH Group is not exposed to substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership are not recognised on the balance sheet and the consideration paid is recorded as a financial asset.

 

Securities borrowing and lending transactions are usually secured by cash or securities advanced by the borrower. Borrowed securities are not recognised on the balance sheet or lent securities derecognised. Cash collateral given or received is treated as a loan or deposit; collateral in the form of securities is not recognised. However, where securities borrowed are transferred to third parties, a liability for the obligation to return the securities to the stock lending counterparty is recorded.

 

18. Netting

Financial assets and financial liabilities are offset and the net amount presented in the balance sheet when, and only when, RBSH Group currently has a legally enforceable right to set off the recognised amounts and it intends either to settle on a net basis or to realise the asset and settle the liability simultaneously. RBSH Group is party to a number of arrangements, including master netting agreements, that give it the right to offset financial assets and financial liabilities but where it does not intend to settle the amounts net or simultaneously and therefore the assets and liabilities concerned are presented gross.

 

19. Capital instruments

RBSH Group classifies a financial instrument that it issues as a liability if it is a contractual obligation to deliver cash or another financial asset, or to exchange financial assets or financial liabilities on potentially unfavourable terms and as equity if it evidences a residual interest in the assets of RBSH Group after the deduction of liabilities. The components of a compound financial instrument issued by RBSH Group are classified and accounted for separately as financial assets, financial liabilities or equity as appropriate.

 

Incremental costs and related tax that are directly attributable to an equity transaction are deducted from equity.  The consideration for any ordinary shares of the company purchased by RBSH Group (treasury shares) is deducted from equity. On the cancellation of treasury shares their nominal value is removed from equity and any excess of consideration over nominal value is added to shareholders’ equity. On the sale or reissue of treasury shares the consideration received is credited to equity, net of any directly attributable incremental costs and related tax.

 

20. Derivatives and hedging

Derivative financial instruments are initially recognised, and subsequently measured, at fair value. The RBSH Group’s approach to determining the fair value of financial instruments is set out in the section of Critical accounting policies and key sources of estimation uncertainty entitled Fair value - financial instruments; further details are given in Note 9.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           101 

 


 

 

 

Accounting policies                                                                                                                                               

 

A derivative embedded in a contract is accounted for as a stand-alone derivative if its economic characteristics are not closely related to the economic characteristics of the host contract; unless the entire contract is measured at fair value with changes in fair value recognised in profit or loss. Gains and losses arising from changes in the fair value of derivatives that are not the hedging instrument in a qualifying hedge are recognised as they arise in profit or loss. Gains and losses are recorded in Income from trading activities except for gains and losses on those derivatives that are managed together with financial instruments designated at fair value; these gains and losses are included in Other operating income.

 

RBSH Group enters into three types of hedge relationship: hedges of changes in the fair value of a recognised asset or liability or firm commitment (fair value hedges); hedges of the variability in cash flows from a recognised asset or liability or a highly probable forecast transaction (cash flow hedges); and hedges of the net investment in a foreign operation.

 

Hedge relationships are formally designated and documented at inception. The documentation identifies the hedged item and the hedging instrument and details the risk that is being hedged and the way in which effectiveness will be assessed at inception and during the period of the hedge. If the hedge is not highly effective in offsetting changes in fair values or cash flows attributable to the hedged risk, consistent with the documented risk management strategy, hedge accounting is discontinued. Hedge accounting is also discontinued if RBSH Group revokes the designation of a hedge relationship.

 

Fair value hedge - in a fair value hedge, the gain or loss on the hedging instrument is recognised in profit or loss. The gain or loss on the hedged item attributable to the hedged risk is recognised in profit or loss and, where the hedged item is measured at amortised cost, adjusts the carrying amount of the hedged item. Hedge accounting is discontinued if the hedge no longer meets the criteria for hedge accounting; or if the hedging instrument expires or is sold, terminated or exercised; or if hedge designation is revoked. If the hedged item is one for which the effective interest rate method is used, any cumulative adjustment is amortised to profit or loss over the life of the hedged item using a recalculated effective interest rate.

 

Cash flow hedge - in a cash flow hedge, the effective portion of the gain or loss on the hedging instrument is recognised in other comprehensive income and the ineffective portion in profit or loss. When the forecast transaction results in the recognition of a financial asset or financial liability, the cumulative gain or loss is reclassified from equity to profit or loss in the same periods in which the hedged forecast cash flows affect profit or loss. Otherwise the cumulative gain or loss is removed from equity and recognised in profit or loss at the same time as the hedged transaction. Hedge accounting is discontinued if the hedge no longer meets the criteria for hedge accounting; if the hedging instrument expires or is sold, terminated or exercised; if the forecast transaction is no longer expected to occur; or if hedge designation is revoked. On the discontinuance of hedge accounting (except where a forecast transaction is no longer expected to occur), the cumulative unrealised gain or loss is reclassified from equity to profit or loss when the hedged cash flows occur or, if the forecast transaction results in the recognition of a financial asset or financial liability, when the hedged forecast cash flows affect profit or loss. Where a forecast transaction is no longer expected to occur, the cumulative unrealised gain or loss is reclassified from equity to profit or loss immediately.

 

Hedge of net investment in a foreign operation - in the hedge of a net investment in a foreign operation, the portion of foreign exchange differences arising on the hedging instrument determined to be an effective hedge is recognised in other comprehensive income. Any ineffective portion is recognised in profit or loss. Non-derivative financial liabilities as well as derivatives may be the hedging instrument in a net investment hedge. On disposal or partial disposal of a foreign operation, the amount accumulated in equity is reclassified from equity to profit or loss.

 

21. Cash and cash equivalents

In the cash flow statement, cash and cash equivalents comprises cash and demand deposits with banks together with short-term highly liquid investments that are readily convertible to known amounts of cash and subject to insignificant risk of change in value.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           102 

 


 

 

 

Accounting policies                                                                                                                                               

 

Critical accounting policies and key sources of estimation uncertainty

The reported results of RBSH Group are sensitive to the accounting policies, assumptions and estimates that underlie the preparation of its financial statements. Dutch company law and IFRS require the management, in preparing RBSH Group's financial statements, to select suitable accounting policies, apply them consistently and make judgements and estimates that are reasonable and prudent. In the absence of an applicable standard or interpretation, IAS 8 ‘Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting Estimates and Errors’, requires management to develop and apply an accounting policy that results in relevant and reliable information in the light of the requirements and guidance in IFRS dealing with similar and related issues and the IASB's ‘Framework for the Preparation and Presentation of Financial Statements’. The judgements and assumptions involved in RBSH Group's accounting policies that are considered by management to be the most important to the portrayal of its financial condition are discussed below. The use of estimates, assumptions or models that differ from those adopted by RBSH Group would affect its reported results.

 

Provisions for liabilities

Provisions are liabilities of uncertain timing or amount, and are recognised when there is a present obligation as a result of a past event, the outflow of economic benefit is probable and the outflow can be estimated reliably. Judgement is involved in determining whether an obligation exists, and in estimating the probability, timing and amount of any outflows.  Professional expert advice is taken on litigation provisions, taxation provisions, property provisions including onerous contracts and similar liabilities. Where RBSH Group can look to another party such as an insurer to pay some or all of the expenditure required to settle a provision, any reimbursement is recognised when, and only when, it is virtually certain that it will be received.

 

Provisions for litigation - RBSH Group is party to legal proceedings in the Netherlands, the United States and other jurisdictions, arising out of their normal business operations. The measurement and recognition of liabilities in respect of litigation involves a high degree of management judgement.  Before the existence of a present obligation as a result of a past event a liability can be confirmed, numerous facts may need to be established, involving extensive and time-consuming discovery, and novel or unsettled legal questions addressed. Once it is determined there is an obligation, assessing the probability of economic outflows and estimating the amount of any liability can be very difficult. In many proceedings, it is not possible to determine whether any loss is probable or to estimate the amount of any loss.  Furthermore, for an individual matter, there can be a wide range of possible outcomes and often it is not practicable to quantify a range of such outcomes. RBSH Group’s outstanding litigation is periodically assessed in consultation with external professional advisers, where appropriate, to determine the likelihood of RBSH Group incurring a liability.  A detailed description of RBSH Group’s material legal proceedings and a discussion of the nature of the associated uncertainties are given in Note 25.

 

Loan impairment provisions

RBSH Group's loan impairment provisions are established to recognise incurred impairment losses in its portfolio of loans classified as loans and receivables and carried at amortised cost. A loan is impaired when there is objective evidence that events since the loan was granted have affected expected cash flows from the loan.

 

Such objective evidence, indicative that a borrower’s financial condition has deteriorated can include for loans that are individually assessed:

 

·         the non-payment of interest or principal; debt renegotiation; probable bankruptcy or liquidation; significant reduction in the value of any security; breach of limits or covenants; and deteriorating trading performance and, for collectively assessed portfolios: the borrowers’ payment status and observable data about relevant macroeconomic measures.

 

The impairment loss is the difference between the carrying value of the loan and the present value of estimated future cash flows at the loan's original effective interest rate.

 

At 31 December 2013, loans and advances to customers classified as loans and receivables totalled €3,406 million (2012 - €5,932 million; 2011 - €28,612 million) and customer loan impairment provisions amounted to €194 million (2012 - €341 million; 2011 - €1,527 million).

 

There are two components to RBSH Group's loan impairment provisions: individual and collective.

 

Individual component - all impaired loans that exceed specific thresholds are individually assessed for impairment. Individually assessed loans principally comprise RBSH Group's portfolio of commercial loans to medium and large businesses. Impairment losses are recognised as the difference between the carrying value of the loan and the discounted value of management's best estimate of future cash repayments and proceeds from any security held. These estimates take into account the customer's debt capacity and financial flexibility; the level and quality of its earnings; the amount and sources of cash flows; the industry in which the counterparty operates; and the realisable value of any security held.

 

Estimating the quantum and timing of future recoveries involves significant judgement. The size of receipts will depend on the future performance of the borrower and the value of security, both of which will be affected by future economic conditions; additionally, collateral may not be readily marketable. The actual amount of future cash flows and the date they are received may differ from these estimates and consequently actual losses incurred may differ from those recognised in these financial statements.

 

Collective component - this is made up of two elements: loan impairment provisions for impaired loans that are below individual assessment thresholds (collectively assessed provisions) and for loan losses that have been incurred but have not been separately identified at the balance sheet date (latent loss provisions). Collectively assessed provisions are established on a portfolio basis using a present value methodology taking into account the level of arrears, security, past loss experience, credit scores and defaults based on portfolio trends. The most significant factors in establishing these provisions are the expected loss rates and the related average life. These portfolios include credit card receivables and other personal advances including mortgages.

 

The future credit quality of these portfolios is subject to uncertainties that could cause actual credit losses to differ materially from reported loan impairment provisions. These uncertainties include the economic environment, notably interest rates and their effect on customer spending, the unemployment level, payment behaviour and bankruptcy trends.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           103 

 


 

 

 

Accounting policies                                                                                                                                               

 

Critical accounting policies and key sources of estimation uncertainty continued 

Latent loss provisions are held against estimated impairment losses in the performing portfolio that have yet to be identified as at the balance sheet date. To assess the latent loss within its portfolios, RBSH Group has developed methodologies to estimate the time that an asset can remain impaired within a performing portfolio before it is identified and reported as such.

 

Fair value – financial instruments

Financial instruments classified as held-for-trading or designated as at fair value through profit or loss and financial assets classified as available-for-sale are recognised in the financial statements at fair value. All derivatives are measured at fair value. Gains or losses arising from changes in the fair value of financial instruments classified as held-for trading or designated as at fair value through profit or loss are included in the income statement. Unrealised gains and losses on available-for sale financial assets are recognised directly in equity unless an impairment loss is recognised.

 

Financial instruments measured at fair value include:

 

Loans and advances (held-for-trading and designated as at fair value though profit or loss) - principally comprise reverse repurchase agreements (reverse repos) and cash collateral.

 

Debt securities (held-for-trading, designated as at fair value though profit or loss and available-for-sale) - debt securities include those issued by governments, municipal bodies, mortgage agencies and financial institutions as well as corporate bonds, debentures and residual interests in securitisations.

 

Equity securities (held-for-trading, designated as at fair value though profit or loss and available-for-sale) - comprise equity shares of companies or corporations both listed and unlisted.

 

Deposits by banks and customer accounts (held-for-trading and designated as at fair value though profit or loss) - deposits measured at fair value principally include repurchase agreements (repos), cash collateral and investment contracts issued by RBSH Group's life assurance businesses.

 

Debt securities in issue (held-for-trading and designated as at fair value though profit or loss) - principally comprise medium term notes.

 

Short positions (held-for-trading) - arise in dealing and market making activities where debt securities and equity shares are sold which RBSH Group does not currently possess.

 

Derivatives - these include swaps (currency swaps, interest rate swaps, credit default swaps, total return swaps and equity and equity index swaps), forward foreign exchange contracts, forward rate agreements, futures (currency, interest rate and equity) and options (exchange-traded options on currencies, interest rates and equities and equity indices and OTC currency and equity options, interest rate caps and floors and swaptions).

 

Fair value is the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date.

 

Fair values are determined from quoted prices in active markets for identical financial assets or financial liabilities where these are available. Fair value for a net open position in a financial instrument in an active market is the number of units of the instrument held times the current bid price (for financial assets) or offer price (for financial liabilities). In determining the fair value of derivative financial instruments, gross long and short positions measured at current mid market prices are adjusted by bid-offer reserves calculated on a portfolio basis. Credit valuation adjustments are made when valuing derivative financial assets to incorporate counterparty credit risk. Adjustments are also made when valuing financial liabilities to reflect RBSH Group’s own credit standing. Where the market for a financial instrument is not active, fair value is established using a valuation technique. These valuation techniques involve a degree of estimation, the extent of which depends on the instrument’s complexity and the availability of market-based data. More details about RBSH Group’s valuation methodologies and the sensitivity to reasonably possible alternative assumptions of the fair value of financial instruments valued using techniques where at least one significant input is unobservable are given in Note 9.

 

Deferred tax

RBSH Group makes provision for deferred tax on temporary differences where tax recognition occurs at a different time from accounting recognition.  RBSH Group has recognised deferred tax assets in respect of losses and short-term timing differences. Deferred tax assets are recognised in respect of unused tax losses to the extent that it is probable that there will be future taxable profits against which the losses can be utilised. Business projections prepared for impairment reviews indicate that sufficient future taxable income will be available against which to offset these recognised deferred tax assets. The number of years into the future for which forecast profits should be considered when assessing the recoverability of a deferred tax asset is a matter of judgment.  Tax losses in the Netherlands can be carried forward for up to nine years. A period of six years is underpinned by RBSH Group's business projections, its history of profitable operation and the continuing strength of its core business franchises.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           104 

 


 

 

 

Accounting policies                                                                                                                                               

 

Accounting developments

International Financial Reporting Standards

A number of IFRSs and amendments to IFRS were in issue at 31 December 2013 that had effective dates of 1 January 2014 or later.

 

Effective for 2014

‘Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities (Amendments to IAS 32)’ adds application guidance to IAS 32 to address inconsistencies identified in applying some of the standard’s criteria for offsetting financial assets and financial liabilities.

 

‘Investment Entities (amendments to IFRS 10, IFRS 12 and IAS 27)’ applies to investment entities; such entities should measure their subsidiaries (other than those that provide services related to the entity’s investment activities) at fair value through profit or loss.

 

IFRIC 21 ‘Levies’ provides guidance on accounting for levies payable to public authorities if certain conditions are met on a particular date.

 

IAS 36 ‘Recoverable Amount Disclosures for Non-Financial Assets (Amendments to IAS 36)’ align IAS 36’s disclosure requirements about recoverable amounts with IASB’s original intentions.

 

IAS 39 ‘Novation of Derivatives and Continuation of Hedge Accounting (Amendments to IAS 39)’ provides relief from discontinuing hedge accounting when novation of a derivative designated as a hedging instrument meets certain criteria.

 

The implementation of these requirements is not expected to have a material effect on the Group’s financial statements.

 

Effective after 2014

IAS 19 ‘Defined Benefit Plans: Employee Contributions’ was issued in November 2013.  This amendment distinguishes the accounting for employee contributions that are related to service from those that are independent of service.  It is effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2014.

 

Annual Improvements to IFRS 2010 - 2012 and 2011 - 2013 cycles were issued in December 2013. There are a number of minor changes to IFRS that will not have a material effect on the Group’s financial statements.  All amendments are effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2014.

 

In November 2009, the IASB issued IFRS 9 ‘Financial Instruments’ simplifying the classification and measurement requirements in IAS 39 in respect of financial assets. The standard reduces the measurement categories for financial assets to two: fair value and amortised cost. A financial asset is classified on the basis of the entity's business model for managing the financial asset and the contractual cash flow characteristics of the financial asset. Only assets with contractual terms that give rise to cash flows on specified dates that are solely payments of principal and interest on principal and which are held within a business model whose objective is to hold assets in order to collect contractual cash flows are classified as amortised cost. All other financial assets are measured at fair value. Changes in the value of financial assets measured at fair value are generally taken to profit or loss.

 

In October 2010, IFRS 9 was updated to include requirements in respect of the classification and measurement of liabilities. These do not differ markedly from those in IAS 39 except for the treatment of changes in the fair value of financial liabilities that are designated as at fair value through profit or loss attributable to own credit; these must be presented in other comprehensive income.

 

In November 2013, the IASB published IFRS 9 ‘Financial Instruments (Hedge Accounting and amendments to IFRS 9, IFRS 7 and IAS 39)’.  These amendments introduce a new hedge accounting model. The classification of hedges into fair value, cash flow and net investment hedges has been retained.  The changes to the current hedge accounting framework include:

 

·         Hedge effectiveness testing is prospective only based on the hedging objective.

·         A risk component can be designated as the hedged item, for financial items and non-financial items, provided it is separately identifiable and reliably measureable.

·         The time value of an option, the forward element of a forward contract and any foreign currency basis spread can be excluded from the designation of a financial instrument as the hedging instrument and accounted for as hedging costs.

 

The amendments also:

 

·         revised IFRS 9 to allow an entity to elect to apply its requirement to present changes in the fair value of liabilities designated as at fair value through profit or loss attributable to own credit risk in other comprehensive income without applying the other requirements of the standard; otherwise all phases of IFRS 9 must be applied from the same effective date.

·         removed from IFRS 9 the effective date of 1 January 2015.

 

At its February 2014 meeting the IASB tentatively agreed on 1 January 2018 as the effective date for IFRS 9.

 

IFRS 9 makes major changes to the framework for financial instrument accounting. The Group is assessing its effect which will depend on the results of IASB's reconsideration of classification and measurement and the final requirements for the impairment of financial assets expected to be published in 2014.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           105 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

1 Net interest income

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

   €m 

  €m 

     €m 

Loans and advances to customers

339 

865 

1,251 

Loans and advances to banks

100 

207 

333 

Amounts due from ultimate holding company

183 

114 

13 

Debt securities

146 

442 

755 

Interest receivable

768 

1,628 

2,352 

  

  

  

  

Customer accounts

130 

338 

731 

Deposits by banks

188 

412 

565 

Debt securities in issue

17 

85 

199 

Subordinated liabilities

203 

232 

230 

Internal funding of trading businesses

(8)

(44)

(61)

Interest payable

530 

1,023 

1,664 

  

  

  

  

Net interest income

238 

605 

688 

 

2 Non-interest income

  

  

  

 

2013 

2012 

2011 

   €m 

   €m 

     €m 

Fees and commissions receivable

 

 

 

Lending (credit facilities), trade finance and payment services

66 

268 

612 

Investment management

— 

68 

85 

Brokerage

53 

133 

342 

  

119 

469 

1,039 

  

  

  

  

Fees and commissions payable

(49)

(198)

(367)

  

  

  

  

Income from trading activities (1) 

  

  

  

Foreign exchange

(50)

(560)

308 

Interest rate

331 

364 

1,655 

Credit

(271)

(349)

(202)

Equities and commodities

36 

594 

(1,115)

  

46 

49 

646 

Other operating income

  

  

  

Changes in the fair value of own debt designated as at fair value through profit or loss attributable

  

  

  

  to own credit net of the effect of economic hedges (2) 

(89)

(865)

1,290 

Changes in the fair value of financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

(13)

94 

(31)

(Loss)/profit on sale of securities

(53)

72 

24 

Profit on sale of property, plant and equipment

— 

13 

Profit on sale of subsidiaries and associates

37 

187 

413 

Dividend income

— 

Share of profit of associated entities

59 

104 

84 

Other income

142 

182 

205 

Other operating income

83 

(217)

2,000 

  

199 

103 

3,318 

Notes:

(1)       The analysis of income from trading activities is based on how the business is organised and the underlying risks managed. Income from trading activities comprises gains and losses on financial instruments held-for-trading, both realised and unrealised, interest income and dividends and the related funding costs.
The types of instruments include:
- Foreign exchange: spot foreign exchange contracts, currency swaps and options, emerging markets and related hedges and funding.
- Interest rate: interest rate swaps, forward foreign exchange contracts, forward rate agreements, interest rate options, interest rate futures and related hedges and funding.
- Credit: asset-backed securities, corporate bonds, credit derivatives and related hedges and funding.
- Equities and commodities: equities, equity derivatives and related hedges and funding, commodities, commodity contracts and related hedges and funding.

(2)       Measured as the change in fair value from movements in the year in the credit risk premium payable by RBSH Group.

(3)       In July 2013, RBSH Group redeemed certain unsecured subordinated debt securities resulting in a gain of €15 million.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           106 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

3 Operating expenses

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

   €m 

   €m 

     €m 

Wages, salaries and other staff costs

131 

 508 

 1,082 

Social security costs

 39 

 74 

Pension costs

17 

 31 

 4 

Restructuring costs

18 

 163 

 50 

Staff costs

175 

 741 

 1,210 

  

  

  

  

Premises and equipment

50 

 186 

 451 

Other administrative expenses

291 

 550 

 598 

  

  

  

  

Property, plant and equipment

13 

 31 

 64 

Intangible assets

 18 

 75 

Depreciation and amortisation

21 

 49 

 139 

  

  

  

  

Write-down of goodwill and other intangible assets

— 

 4 

 29 

  

537 

 1,530 

 2,427 

 

Restructuring costs included in operating expenses comprise:

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

   €m 

   €m 

     €m 

Staff costs

18 

163 

50 

Premises and equipment

18 

15 

21 

Other administrative expenses

43 

36 

33 

  

79 

214 

104 

 

Employee numbers at 31 December

  

  

  

(full time equivalents rounded to the nearest hundred)

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

Markets

700 

2,900 

6,300 

International Banking

1,100 

5,500 

6,600 

Central items

100 

300 

600 

Core

1,900 

8,700 

13,500 

Non-Core

600 

2,600 

4,200 

Total

2,500 

11,300 

17,700 

 

The average number of persons employed, rounded to the nearest hundred, in the continuing operations of RBSH Group during the year was 5,900 (2012 - 14,500; 2011 - 18,500). No persons were employed in discontinued operations at 31 December 2013 (2012 and 2011- nil).

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           107 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

4 Pensions

RBSH Group sponsors a number of pension schemes overseas. These schemes include both defined contribution and defined benefit plans, whose assets are independent of RBSH Group’s finances. RBSH Group’s defined benefit schemes generally provide pensions that are based on average or final salary with annual price evaluation of vested rights. In general, employees do not make contributions for basic pensions but may make voluntary contributions to secure additional benefits.

 

RBSH Group has no material post-retirement benefit obligations other than pensions.

During 2012, the main pension scheme, the Netherlands pension scheme, transferred to RBS plc as part of the Dutch Scheme. As at the year end the majority of the beneficiaries of the RBSH Group pension plans are located in India. All schemes were classified as disposal groups as at the 2012 year end. As at the 2013 year end the schemes were no longer classified as disposal groups.

 

Interim valuations of RBSH Group’s schemes under IAS 19 ‘Employee Benefits‘ were prepared to 31 December with the support of independent actuaries, using the following assumptions:

 

  

All schemes

Principal actuarial assumptions at 31 December (weighted average)

2013 

2012 

2011 

%  

Discount rate

9.4

— 

5.8

Expected return on plan assets (weighted average)

9.4

— 

4.7

Rate of increase in salaries

4.0

— 

3.0

Inflation assumption

  

— 

2.0

 

  

All schemes

Major classes of plan assets as a percentage of total plan assets

2013 

2012 

2011 

%  

Equity interests

— 

  

24.9

Government fixed interest bonds

48.1

  

43.1

Corporate and other bonds

50.1

  

18.0

Property

— 

  

0.7

Cash and other assets

1.8

  

13.3

 

The expected return on plan assets at 31 December is based upon the weighted average of the following assumed returns on the major classes of plan assets:

 

All schemes

 

 

Present value 

 

  

 

of defined 

Net pension 

  

Fair value of 

benefit 

(surplus)/ 

  

plan assets 

obligations 

  deficit 

Changes in value of net pension (surplus)/deficit

 €m 

€m 

 €m 

At 1 January 2012

371 

353 

(18)

Transfers to disposal groups

(23)

(53)

(30)

Disposals

(416)

(330)

86 

Currency translation and other adjustments

12 

— 

(12)

Expected return

12 

— 

(12)

Interest cost

— 

15 

15 

Current service cost

— 

16 

16 

Actuarial gains and losses

— 

Contributions by employer

46 

(2)

(48)

Benefits paid

(2)

— 

At 1 January 2013

— 

— 

— 

Transfer from disposal groups

13 

37 

24 

Currency translation and other adjustments

(1)

(2)

(1) 

Expected return

— 

(1)

Interest cost

— 

Current service cost

— 

Actuarial gains and losses

— 

(4)

 (4) 

Contributions by employer

— 

 (4) 

Benefits paid

(7)

(7)

— 

At 31 December 2013

10 

30 

20 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           108 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

4 Pensions continued

Net pension deficit/(surplus) comprises:

2013 

2012 

2011 

 €m 

€m 

 €m 

Net assets of schemes in surplus (included in Note 15)

— 

— 

(80)

Net liabilities of schemes in deficit (included in Note 18)

20 

— 

62 

  

20 

— 

(18)

 

 

All schemes

History of defined benefit schemes

2013 

2012 

2011 

2010 

2009 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Fair value of plan assets

10 

— 

371 

1,247 

10,211 

Present value of defined benefit obligations

30 

— 

353 

1,240 

10,566 

Net

20 

— 

(18)

(7)

355  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Experience gains/(losses) on plan liabilities

— 

(46)

212 

Experience gains on plan assets

— 

— 

33 

203 

Actual return on pension schemes assets

— 

92 

71 

649 

Actual return on pension schemes assets - %

10% 

— 

7.40% 

6.20% 

6.80% 

 

The table below sets out the sensitivities of the pension cost for the year and the present value of defined benefit obligations at the balance sheet dates to a change in the principal actuarial assumptions.

  

All schemes

  

Increase/(decrease)

  

in pension cost  for year

  

in obligation at 31 December

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

 

2013 

2012 

2011 

  

€m 

€m 

 €m 

  

€m 

€m 

 €m 

0.25% increase in the discount rate

  

(2)

  

— 

  

0.25% increase in inflation

  

  

  

— 

  

14 

0.25% additional rate of increase in pensions in payment

(1)

  

 

— 

  

  

0.25% additional rate of increase in deferred pensions

  

  

  

— 

  

0.25% additional rate of  increase in salaries

  

  

  

— 

  

Longevity increase of 1 year

(1)

  

  

— 

  

 

Pension risk

RBSH Group is exposed to risk from its defined benefit pension schemes to the extent that the assets of the schemes do not fully match the timing and amount of the schemes’ liabilities. Pensions scheme liabilities vary with changes to long-term interest rates, inflation, pensionable salaries and the longevity of scheme members as well as changes in legislation. Ultimate responsibility for RBSH Group’s pension scheme is separate from RBSH Group management. RBSH Group is exposed to the risk that the market value of the schemes’ assets, together with future returns and any additional future contributions could be considered insufficient to meet the liabilities as they fall due. In such circumstances, RBSH Group could be obliged, or may choose, to make additional contributions to the schemes.

 

The pension funds in India are the main source of pension risk. The Trustees or Pension Boards of these schemes are solely responsible for the investment of the schemes’ assets which are held separately from the assets of RBSH Group.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           109 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

5 Auditor’s remuneration

Amounts charged to the income statement relating to RBSH Group's auditors for statutory audit and other services are set out below. All audit-related and other services are approved by RBSH Group Supervisory Board and are subject to strict controls to ensure external auditor’s independence is unaffected by the provision of other services. The Committee recognises that for certain assignments the auditors are best placed to perform the work economically. For other work RBSH Group selects the supplier best placed to meet its requirements. RBSH Group's auditors are free to tender for such work in competition with other firms where the work is permissible under audit independence rules.

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Fees for the audit of RBSH Group's annual accounts (1) 

5.0 

8.5 

11.1 

Audit related services (2) 

0.8 

0.9 

0.6 

Total audit and audit-related services

5.8 

9.4 

11.7 

  

  

  

  

Fees to the auditors and their associates for other services

  

  

  

  - Services relating to taxation (3) 

— 

0.1 

0.6 

  - All other services

0.1 

— 

0.1 

Total other services

0.1 

0.1 

0.7 

Total

5.9 

9.5 

12.4 

 

Notes:

(1)       2011 fees include €1.8 million in relation to statutory audits.

(2)       Includes fees of €0.1 million in relation to statutory audits and €0.6 million in respect of regulatory audits.

(3)       2011 fees include €0.3 million in relation to tax advisory services.

 

Deloitte Accountants B.V. provided audit and audit-related services amounting to €1.2 million (2012 - €3.5 million; 2011 - €4.8 million). The remaining amounts relate to services provided by other Deloitte Member Firms. The amount paid to Deloitte LLP in 2013 in respect of audit fees was €2.0 million.

 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           110 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

6 Tax

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Current tax

  

  

  

Charge for the year

(49)

(85)

(96)

Over/(under) provision in respect of prior years

162 

(105)

— 

  

113 

(190)

(96)

  

  

  

  

Deferred tax

  

  

  

(Charge)/credit for the year

(45)

95 

(341)

Under provision in respect of prior years

(80)

(34)

(12)

Tax charge for the year

(12)

(129)

(449)

 

The actual tax charge differs from the expected tax credit computed by applying the statutory tax rate of the Netherlands of 25% as follows:

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m

Expected tax credit

36 

222 

46 

Sovereign debt impairment where no deferred tax asset recognised

— 

— 

(365)

Non-deductible items

(18)

(5)

(34)

Non-taxable items (including recycling of foreign exchange reserve)

35 

87 

105 

Foreign profits taxed at other rates

(5)

(33)

Reduction in deferred tax asset following change in the rate of UK corporation tax (1) 

— 

(32)

(22)

Losses in year not recognised

(163)

(277)

(145)

Losses brought forward and utilised

26 

68 

11 

Reduction in carrying value of deferred tax asset in respect of losses in Australia

— 

(235)

— 

(Increase)/reduction in carrying value of deferred tax liability in respect of associates

(29)

50 

— 

Adjustments in respect of prior years (2) 

111 

(2)

(12)

Other

(15)

— 

— 

Actual tax charge

(12)

(129)

(449)

 

Notes:

(1)       In recent years the UK Government has steadily reduced the rate of UK corporation tax, with the latest enacted rate standing at 21% with effect from 1 April 2014 and 20% with effect from 1 April 2015. The closing deferred tax assets and liabilities have been calculated in accordance with rates enacted at the balance sheet date.

(2)       Prior period tax adjustments include the release of tax provisions on investment disposals and adjustments to reflect submitted tax computations in the Netherlands and overseas.

 

7 Dividends

RBS Holdings N.V. made no dividend distributions during the years ended 31 December 2013, 2012 or 2011.

 

 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           111 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

8 Financial instruments - classification

The following tables show RBSH Group’s financial assets and liabilities in accordance with the categories of financial instruments in IAS 39 with assets and liabilities outside the scope of IAS 39 shown separately.

 

  

  

Designated as    

  

  

  

Other financial  

  

  

  

  

at fair value

   

  

  

instruments  

Non financial  

  

  

Held-for-    

 through  

Hedging  

Available  

Loans and  

 (amortised   

 assets/ 

   

trading  

profit or loss  

derivatives  

-for-sale  

receivables  

cost)  

liabilities  

Total  

2013 

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

Assets

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Cash and balances at central banks

— 

— 

  

— 

3,193 

  

  

3,193 

Loans and advances to banks (1,8) 

801 

— 

  

— 

4,894 

  

  

5,695 

Loans and advances to customers (2,8)

378 

— 

  

— 

3,406 

  

  

3,784 

Amounts due from ultimate holding company

  

  

  

  

2,820 

  

  

2,820 

Debt securities (3) 

511 

130 

  

14,608 

39 

  

  

15,288 

Equity shares

229 

49 

  

17 

  

  

  

295 

Settlement balances

— 

— 

  

— 

10 

  

  

10 

Derivatives (8) 

4,641 

  

141 

  

  

  

  

4,782 

Deferred taxation

  

  

  

  

  

  

40 

40 

Prepayments, accrued income and other assets

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

  

1,853 

1,853 

Assets of disposal groups

  

  

  

  

  

  

2,048 

2,048 

  

6,560 

179 

141 

14,625 

14,362 

— 

3,941 

39,808 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Liabilities

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits by banks (4,8)

1,024 

— 

  

  

  

17,919 

  

18,943 

Customer accounts (5,8) 

694 

— 

  

  

  

3,457 

  

4,151 

Debt securities in issue (6,7)

  

830 

  

  

  

489 

  

1,319 

Settlement balances and short positions

22 

— 

  

  

  

83 

  

105 

Derivatives (8) 

4,470 

  

1,392 

  

  

  

  

5,862 

Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities

— 

— 

  

  

  

65 

1,000 

1,065 

Deferred taxation

  

  

  

  

  

  

63 

63 

Subordinated liabilities

— 

612 

  

  

  

4,339 

  

4,951 

Liabilities of disposal groups

  

  

  

  

  

  

407 

407 

  

6,210 

1,442 

1,392 

  

  

26,352 

1,470 

36,866 

Equity

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2,942 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

39,808 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

For the notes to this table refer to page 114.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           112 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

8 Financial instruments – classification continued 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Designated as  

  

  

  

Other financial  

  

  

  

  

at fair value

   

  

  

instruments  

Non financial  

  

  

Held-for-  

 through  

Hedging  

Available  

Loans and  

 (amortised   

 assets/ 

   

trading  

profit or loss  

derivatives  

-for-sale  

receivables  

cost)  

liabilities  

Total  

2012 

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

Assets

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Cash and balances at central banks

— 

— 

  

— 

2,294 

  

  

2,294 

Loans and advances to banks (1,8)

1,521 

— 

  

— 

10,685 

  

  

12,206 

Loans and advances to customers (2,8) 

448 

— 

  

— 

5,932 

  

  

6,380 

Amounts due from ultimate holding company

  

  

  

  

2,949 

  

  

2,949 

Debt securities (3) 

845 

65 

  

21,612 

133 

  

  

22,655 

Equity shares

1,029 

53 

  

45 

— 

  

  

1,127 

Settlement balances

— 

— 

  

— 

31 

  

  

31 

Derivatives (8) 

7,369 

  

186 

  

  

  

  

7,555 

Deferred taxation

  

  

  

  

  

  

420 

420 

Prepayments, accrued income and other assets

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

  

1,533 

1,533 

Assets of disposal groups

  

  

  

  

  

  

13,804 

13,804 

  

11,212 

118 

186 

21,657 

22,024 

  

15,757 

70,954 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Liabilities

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits by banks (4,8) 

1,305 

— 

  

  

  

33,160 

  

34,465 

Customer accounts (5,8) 

666 

— 

  

  

  

1,972 

  

2,638 

Debt securities in issue (6, 7)

73 

1,501 

  

  

  

1,028 

  

2,602 

Settlement balances and short positions

34 

— 

  

  

  

73 

  

107 

Derivatives (8) 

7,246 

  

2,398 

  

  

  

  

9,644 

Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities

— 

— 

  

  

  

— 

1,782 

1,782 

Deferred taxation

  

  

  

  

  

  

40 

40 

Subordinated liabilities

— 

724 

  

  

  

6,127 

  

6,851 

Liabilities of disposal groups

  

  

  

  

  

  

11,026 

11,026 

  

9,324 

2,225 

2,398 

  

  

42,360 

12,848 

69,155 

Equity

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

1,799 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

70,954 

For the notes to this table refer to page 114.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           113 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

8 Financial instruments – classification continued 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Designated as  

 

  

  

Other financial  

  

  

  

  

at fair value  

 

  

  

instruments  

Non financial  

  

  

Held-for-    

 through  

Hedging  

Available  

Loans and  

 (amortised  

 assets/ 

   

trading  

profit or loss  

derivatives  

-for-sale  

receivables  

cost)  

liabilities  

Total  

2011 

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

Assets

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Cash and balances at central banks

— 

— 

  

— 

12,609 

  

  

12,609 

Loans and advances to banks (1,8)

2,166 

— 

  

— 

23,751 

  

  

25,917 

Loans and advances to customers (2,8) 

966 

— 

  

— 

28,612 

  

  

29,578 

Amounts due from ultimate holding company

  

  

  

  

1,136 

  

  

1,136 

Debt securities (3)

4,553 

152 

  

34,393 

547 

  

  

39,645 

Equity shares

2,558 

238 

  

297 

  

  

  

3,093 

Settlement balances

— 

— 

  

— 

2,608 

  

  

2,608 

Derivatives (8) 

18,743 

  

395 

  

  

  

  

19,138 

Deferred taxation

  

  

  

  

  

  

444 

444 

Prepayments, accrued income and other assets

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

  

5,913 

5,913 

Assets of disposal groups

  

  

  

  

  

  

6,695 

6,695 

  

28,986 

390 

395 

34,690 

69,263 

— 

13,052 

146,776 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Liabilities

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits by banks (4,8) 

1,248 

— 

  

  

  

45,272 

  

46,520 

Customer accounts (5,8)

1,017 

— 

  

  

  

38,584 

  

39,601 

Debt securities in issue (6, 7)

65 

10,720 

  

  

  

6,929 

  

17,714 

Settlement balances and short positions

564 

— 

  

  

  

2,845 

  

3,409 

Derivatives (8) 

17,571 

  

2,297 

  

  

  

  

19,868 

Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities

— 

— 

  

  

  

— 

3,895 

3,895 

Deferred taxation

  

  

  

  

  

  

201 

201 

Subordinated liabilities

— 

523 

  

  

  

6,336 

— 

6,859 

Liabilities of disposal groups

  

  

  

  

  

  

5,293 

5,293 

  

20,465 

11,243 

2,297 

  

  

99,966 

9,389 

143,360 

Equity

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

3,416 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

146,776 

 

Notes:

(1)    Includes reverse repurchase agreements of €53 million (2012 - €68 million; 2011 - €9,100 million).

(2)    Includes reverse repurchase agreements of €2 million (2012 - €5 million; 2011 - €283 million).

(3)    Includes treasury bills, similar securities and other eligible bills of €84 million (2012 - €486 million; 2011 - €3,147 million).

(4)    Includes repurchase agreements of €11,710 million (2012 - €12,624 million; 2011 - €16,532 million).

(5)    Includes repurchase agreements of €33 million (2012 - €18 million; 2011 - €759 million).

(6)    Includes bonds and medium term notes of €1,319 million (2012 - €2,468 million; 2011 - €13,825 million) and certificates of deposit and other commercial paper of nil (2012 - €116 million; 2011 - €3,889 million).

(7)    €89 million (2012 - €865 million; 2011 - €1,290 million) has been recognised in profit or loss for changes in credit risk associated with debt securities in issue designated as at fair value through profit or loss measured as the change in fair value from movements in the period in the credit risk premium payable by RBSH Group.

(8)    Includes the following intergroup balances:

§          Loans and advances to banks of €2,858 million (2012 - €8,938 million; 2011 - €13,722 million).

§          Loans and advances to customers of €42 million (2012 and 2011 - nil).

§          Derivative assets of €2,569 million (2012 - €4,624 million; 2011 - €11,062 million).

§          Bank deposits of €17,652 million (2012 - €28,458 million; 2011 - €33,258 million).

§          Customer accounts of nil (2012 - nil; 2011 - €1,146 million).

§          Derivative liabilities of €3,806 million (2012 - €6,970 million; 2011 - €11,714 million).

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           114 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

8 Financial instruments – classification continued 

  

  

  

Amounts included in the consolidated income statement:

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m

€m 

(Losses)/gains on financial assets/liabilities designated as at fair value through profit or loss

(28)

94 

1,259 

(Losses)/gains on disposal or settlement of loans and receivables

(28)

(35)

10 

 

 

The tables below present information on financial assets and liabilities that are offset in the balance sheet under IFRS or subject to enforceable master netting agreement together with financial collateral received or given.

 

  

  

  

  

Effect of  

 

Net amount  

2013 

  

  

 

master netting  

 

after the effect of 

 

IFRS  

 

agreement/similar  

Financial  

netting arrangements 

Gross 

offset  

Balance sheet  

agreements  

collateral  

and related collateral 

€m 

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m   

Financial assets

  

  

  

  

  

  

Derivatives

3,459 

— 

3,459 

(1,907)

(889)

663 

Loans and advance to customers

1,543 

(1,543)

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

5,002 

(1,543)

3,459 

(1,907)

(889)

663 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Financial liabilities

  

  

  

  

  

  

Derivatives

55 

— 

55 

(38)

(17)

  

Customer accounts

1,543 

(1,543) 

— 

— 

— 

  

  

1,598 

(1,543) 

55 

(38)

(17)

  

 

2012

 

 

 

 

 

 

Financial assets

  

  

  

  

  

  

Derivatives

1,072  

(35)                                                                               

 1,037 

 (171) 

       (807)

59  

Loans and advance to customers

1,790  

(1,790)

 —  

  —  

     —  

  —  

  

2,862  

(1,825)

1,037 

    (171)

      (807)

      59  

  

 

 

 

 

 

 

Financial liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivatives

311  

(35)  

276  

(171)

(49)

56  

Customer accounts

1,790  

(1,790)  

  

  

  

  

  

2,101  

(1,825)  

276  

(171)

(49)

56  

 

2011

 

 

 

 

 

   

Financial assets

  

  

  

  

  

  

Derivatives

1,644  

  

1,644  

(1,644)

  

  

  

 

 

 

 

 

 

Financial liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivatives

1,644  

  

1,644  

(1,644)

  

  

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           115 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

9 Financial instruments - valuation

Valuation of financial instruments carried at fair value

Control environment

Common valuation policies, procedures, frameworks and models apply across the RBS Group. Therefore for the most part, discussions on these aspects below reflect those in the RBS Group as relevant for businesses and operations in the RBSH Group.

 

RBSH Group's control environment for the determination of the fair value of financial instruments includes formalised protocols for the review and validation of fair values independent of the businesses entering into the transactions. There are specific controls to ensure consistent pricing policies and procedures, incorporating disciplined price verification. RBSH Group ensures that appropriate attention is given to bespoke transactions, structured products, illiquid products and other instruments which are difficult to price.

 

A key element of the control environment is the independent price verification (IPV) process. Valuations are first performed by the business which entered into the transaction. Such valuations may be directly from available prices, or may be derived using a model and variable model inputs. These valuations are reviewed, and if necessary amended, by a team independent of those trading the financial instruments, in light of available pricing evidence.

 

A new IPV quality hierarchy was implemented with detailed classifications linked to the fair value hierarchy principles as laid out in IFRS 13 ‘Fair value measurement’. The new hierarchy classifies IPV differences into fair value levels 1, 2 and 3 with the valuation uncertainty risk increasing as the levels rise from 1 to 3. These differences are then further classified into high, medium, low and indicative depending on the quality of the independent data available to validate the prices. Valuations are revised if they are outside agreed thresholds for each of the levels.

 

IPV is performed at a frequency to match the availability of independent data. For liquid instruments, the standard is to perform IPV daily. The minimum frequency of review in RBSH Group is monthly for exposures in the regulatory trading book and quarterly for exposures in the regulatory banking book. Monthly meetings are held between the business and the support functions to discuss the results of the IPV and reserves process in detail. The IPV control includes formalised reporting and escalation of any valuation differences in breach of established thresholds. The RBS Group Global Pricing Unit (GPU) determines IPV policy, monitors adherence to that policy and performs additional independent reviews on highly subjective valuation issues for Markets and Non-Core.

 

In 2013, RBSH Group has made a significant and ongoing investment into enhancing its already robust control environment. This included continuing investment in global IPV and reserving tools which partly automated the IPV and reserves process into a single central portal. System developments included implementing a rules based approach which ensures consistency across portfolios and the use of hierarchy of independent data inputs.

 

Valuation models are subject to a review process which requires different levels of model documentation, testing and review, depending on the complexity of the model and the size of RBSH Group's exposure. A key element of the control environment for model use is a Modelled Product Review Committee, made up of valuations experts from several functions within RBS Group. This committee sets the policy for model documentation, testing and review, and prioritises models with significant exposure for review by RBS Group's Quantitative Research Centre (QuaRC). Potential valuation uncertainty is a key input in determining model review priorities at these meetings. The QuaRC team within RBS Group Risk, which is independent of the trading businesses, assesses the appropriateness of the application of the model to the product, the mathematical robustness of the model, and where appropriate, considers alternative modelling approaches.

 

The RBS Group Management Valuation Control Committees meet formally on a monthly basis to discuss independent pricing, reserving and valuation issues relating to both Markets and Non-Core exposures. All material methodology changes require review and ratification by these committees. The committees, which include valuation specialists representing several independent review functions, comprise Market Risk, QuaRC, Finance and senior business representatives.

 

The RBS Group Executive Valuation Committee discusses the issues escalated by the Modelled Product Review Committee, Markets and Non-Core Management Valuations Control Committees and other relevant issues. This committee covers key material and subjective valuation issues within the trading businesses and provides a ratification to the appropriateness of areas with high levels of residual valuation uncertainty. Committee members include RBS Group Finance Director, RBS Group Chief Accountant, RBS Group Head of Market Risk, the Markets Chief Financial Officer, the Non-Core Chief Financial Officer, the Head of QuaRC, the Head of GPU and representation from Front Office Trading and Finance.

 

 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           116 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

9 Financial instruments - valuation continued  

Valuation issues, adjustments and reserves are reported to the Risk and Audit Committee of RBSH Group. Key judgmental issues are described in reports submitted to the Audit Committee.

 

New products

RBSH Group has formal review procedures owned by Group Operational Risk within RBS Group to ensure that new products, asset classes and risk types are appropriately reviewed to ensure, amongst other things that valuation is appropriate. The scope of this process includes new business, markets, models, risks and structures.

 

Valuation hierarchy

There is a process to review and control the classification of financial instruments into the three level hierarchy established by IFRS 13. Some instruments may not easily fall into a level of the fair value hierarchy and judgment may be required as to which level the instrument is classified.

 

Initial classification of a financial instrument is carried out by the Business Unit Control team following the principles in IFRS. The Business Unit Control team base their judgment on information gathered during the IPV process for instruments which include the sourcing of independent prices and model inputs. The quality and completeness of the information gathered in the IPV process gives an indication as to the liquidity and valuation uncertainty of an instrument.

 

These initial classifications are reviewed and challenged by GPU and are also subject to senior management review. Particular attention is paid to instruments crossing from one level to another, new instrument classes or products, instruments that are generating significant profit and loss and instruments where valuation uncertainty is high.

 

Valuation techniques

RBSH Group derives fair value of its instruments differently depending on whether the instrument is a modelled or non-modelled product.

 

Non-modelled products

Non-modelled products are valued directly from a price input and are typically valued on a position by position basis and include cash, equities and most debt securities.

 

Modelled products

Modelled products are those that are valued using a pricing model and ranging in complexity from comparatively vanilla products such as interest rate swaps and options (e.g. interest rate caps and floors) through to more complex derivatives. The valuation of modelled products requires an appropriate model and inputs into this model. Sometimes models are also used to derive inputs (e.g. to construct volatility surfaces). RBSH Group uses a number of modelling methodologies.

 

Inputs to valuation models

Values between and beyond available data points are obtained by interpolation and extrapolation. When utilising valuation techniques, the fair value can be significantly affected by the choice of valuation model and by underlying assumptions concerning factors such as the amounts and timing of cash flows, discount rates and credit risk. The principal inputs to these valuation techniques are as follows:

 

·         Bond prices - quoted prices are generally available for government bonds, certain corporate securities and some mortgage-related products.

·         Credit spreads - where available, these are derived from prices of credit default swaps or other credit based instruments, such as debt securities. For others, credit spreads are obtained from pricing services.

·         Interest rates - these are principally benchmark interest rates such as the London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR), Overnight Index Swaps rate (OIS) and other quoted interest rates in the swap, bond and futures markets.

·         Foreign currency exchange rates - there are observable markets both for spot and forward contracts and futures in the world's major currencies.

·         Equity and equity index prices - quoted prices are generally readily available for equity shares listed on the world's major stock exchanges and for major indices on such shares.

·         Commodity prices - many commodities are actively traded in spot and forward contracts and futures on exchanges in London, New York and other commercial centres.

·         Price volatilities and correlations - volatility is a measure of the tendency of a price to change with time. Correlation measures the degree which two or more prices or other variables are observed to move together. If they move in the same direction there is positive correlation; if they move in opposite directions there is negative correlation. Volatility is a key input in valuing options and the valuation of certain products such as derivatives with more than one underlying variable that are correlation-dependent. Volatility and correlation values are obtained from broker quotations, pricing services or derived from option prices.

·         Prepayment rates - the fair value of a financial instrument that can be prepaid by the issuer or borrower differs from that of an instrument that cannot be prepaid. In valuing prepayable instruments that are not quoted in active markets, RBSH Group considers the value of the prepayment option.

·         Counterparty credit spreads - adjustments are made to market prices (or parameters) when the creditworthiness of the counterparty differs from that of the assumed counterparty in the market price (or parameters).

·         Recovery rates/loss given default - these are used as an input to valuation models and reserves for asset-backed securities and other credit products as an indicator of severity of losses on default. Recovery rates are primarily sourced from market data providers or inferred from observable credit spreads.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           117 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

9 Financial instruments - valuation continued  

RBSH Group may use consensus prices for the source of independent pricing for some assets. The consensus service encompasses the equity, interest rate, currency, commodity, credit, property, fund and bond markets, providing comprehensive matrices of vanilla prices and a wide selection of exotic products. Markets and Non-Core contribute to consensus pricing services where there is a significant interest either from a positional point of view or to test models for future business use.

Data sourced from consensus pricing services is used for a combination of control processes including direct price testing, evidence of observability and model testing. In practice this means that the Group submits prices for all material positions for which a service is available. Data from consensus services are subject to the same level of quality review as other inputs used for IPV process

 

In order to determine a reliable fair value, where appropriate, management applies valuation adjustments to the pricing information gathered from the above sources. The sources of independent data are reviewed for quality and are applied in the IPV processes using formalised input quality hierarchy. These adjustments reflect RBSH Group's assessment of factors that market participants would consider in setting a price. Furthermore, on an ongoing basis, RBSH Group assesses the appropriateness of any model used. To the extent that the price provided by internal models does not represent the fair value of the instrument, for instance in highly stressed market conditions, RBSH Group makes adjustments to the model valuation to calibrate to other available pricing sources.

 

Where unobservable inputs are used, RBSH Group may determine a range of possible valuations derived from differing stress scenarios to determine the sensitivity associated with the valuation. When establishing the fair value of a financial instrument using a valuation technique, RBSH Group considers certain adjustments to the modelled price which market participants would make when pricing that instrument. Such adjustments include the credit quality of the counterparty and adjustments to compensate for any known model limitations.

 

Valuation reserves

When valuing financial instruments in the trading book, adjustments are made to mid-market valuations to cover bid-offer spread, liquidity and credit risk. The valuation framework used to determine the fair value of uncollateralised derivative exposures was refined during the year in line with market developments. The weightings applied to the expected losses and gains in the credit valuation adjustments (CVA) and own credit adjustments (OCA) calculations have been removed. Funding valuation adjustments (FVA) now reflect the counterparty contingent nature of the exposures. FVA is also now considered the primary adjustment applied to liabilities; the extent to which OCA and FVA overlap is eliminated from OCA. The following table shows CVA and other valuation reserves.

 

Credit valuation adjustments

Credit valuation adjustments represent an estimate of the adjustment to fair value that a market participant would make to incorporate the counterparty credit risk inherent in counterparty derivative exposures.

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

  €m 

€m 

Credit valuation adjustments (CVA):

  

  

  

Monoline insurers

13 

222 

Other counterparties

38 

151 

221 

  

45 

164 

443 

Bid-offer and liquidity reserves

20 

61 

Valuation reserves

46 

184 

504 

 

 

Monoline insurers

The RBSH Group’s exposure to monolines is predominately credit default swaps (CDSs) referencing ABS held directly or synthetically.

 

For the majority of trades the gross mark-to-market of the monoline protection is determined directly from the fair value price of the underlying reference instrument. However, for the remainder of the trades the gross mark-to-market is determined using industry standard models.

 

The CVA methodology uses market implied probability of defaults and internally assessed recovery rates to determine the level of expected loss on monoline exposures of different maturities. The probability of default is calculated with reference to market observable credit spreads and recovery levels. CVA is calculated at a trade level by applying the expected loss corresponding to each trade’s expected maturity, to the gross mark-to-market of the monoline protection. The expected maturity of each trade reflects the scheduled notional amortisation of the underlying reference instruments and whether payments due from the monoline are received at the point of default or over the life of the underlying reference instruments.

 

Other counterparties

The CVA for all other counterparties is calculated on a portfolio basis reflecting an estimate of the amount a third party would charge to assume the credit risk.

 

Where a positive exposure exists to a counterparty that is considered to be close to default, the CVA is calculated by applying expected losses to the current level of exposure. Otherwise, expected losses are applied to estimated potential future positive exposures which are modelled to reflect the volatility of the market factors which drive the exposures and the correlation between those factors.

 

Potential future positive exposures arising from vanilla products (including interest rate and foreign exchange derivatives) are modelled using the Group's core counterparty risk systems. The majority of the RBSH Group's CVA held in relation to other counterparties arises on these vanilla products together with exposures to counterparties which are considered to be close to default. The exposures arising from all other product types are modelled and assessed separately. The potential future positive exposure to each counterparty is the aggregate of the exposures arising on the underlying product types.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           118 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

9 Financial instruments - valuation: Valuation reserves continued 

Expected losses are determined from market implied probabilities of default and internally assessed recovery levels. The probability of default is calculated with reference to observable credit spreads and observable recovery levels. For counterparties where observable data do not exist, the probability of default is determined from the credit spreads and recovery levels of similarly rated entities. Weightings that were previously applied in the expected losses calculation were removed during 2013 in line with market developments.

 

The correlation between exposure and counterparty risk is also incorporated within the CVA calculation where this risk is considered significant. The risk primarily arises on credit derivative trades where the default risk of the referenced entity is correlated with the counterparty risk. The risk also arises on trades with emerging market counterparties where the gross mark-to-market value of the trade, and therefore the counterparty exposure, increases as the strength of the local currency declines.

 

Collateral held under a credit support agreement is factored into the CVA calculation. In such cases where the Group holds collateral against counterparty exposures, CVA is held to the extent that residual risk remains.

 

The correlation between exposure and counterparty risk is also incorporated within the CVA calculation where this risk is considered significant. The risk primarily arises on credit derivative trades where the default risk of the referenced entity is correlated with the counterparty risk. The risk also arises on trades with emerging market counterparties where the gross mark-to-market value of the trade, and therefore the counterparty exposure, increases as the strength of the local currency declines.

 

Collateral held under a credit support agreement is factored into the CVA calculation. In such cases where RBSH Group holds collateral against counterparty exposures, CVA is held to the extent that residual risk remains.

 

Bid-offer, liquidity and other reserves

Fair value positions are adjusted to bid or offer levels, by marking individual cash based positions directly to bid or offer or by taking bid-offer reserves calculated on a portfolio basis for derivatives exposures. The bid-offer approach is based on current market spreads and standard market bucketing of risk.

 

Risk data are used as the primary sources of information within bid-offer calculations and are aggregated when they are more granular than market standard buckets. Bid-offer adjustments for each risk factor (including delta (the degree to which the price of an instrument changes in response to a change in the price of the underlying), vega (the degree to which the price of an instrument changes in response to the volatility in the price of the underlying), correlation (the degree to which prices of different instruments move together) and others) are determined by aggregating similar risk exposures arising on different products. Additional basis bid-offer reserves are taken where these are charged in the market. Risk associated with non-identical underlying exposures is not netted down unless there is evidence that the cost of closing the combined risk exposure is less than the cost of closing on an individual basis.

Bid-offer spreads vary by maturity and risk type to reflect different spreads in the market. For positions where there is no observable quote, the bid-offer spreads are widened in comparison to proxies to reflect reduced liquidity or observability. Bid-offer methodologies may also incorporate liquidity triggers whereby wider spreads are applied to risks above pre-defined thresholds.

 

As permitted by IFRS 13, netting is applied on a portfolio basis to reflect the level at which RBSH Group believes it could exit the portfolio, rather than the sum of exit costs for each of the portfolio’s individual trades. This is applied where the desk manages the asset and liability positions as a portfolio for risk and reporting purposes. For example, netting is applied where long and short risk in two different maturity buckets can be closed out in a single market transaction at less cost than by way of two separate transactions (calendar netting). This reflects the fact that to close down the portfolio, the net risk can be settled rather than each long and short trade individually.

 

Vanilla risk on exotic products is typically reserved as part of the overall portfolio based calculation e.g. delta and vega risk on exotic products are included within the delta and vega bid-offer calculations. Aggregation of risk arising from different models is in line with RBSH Group's risk management practices; the model review control process considers the appropriateness of model selection in this respect.

 

Product related risks such as correlation risk, attract specific bid-offer reserves. Additional reserves are provided for exotic products to ensure overall reserves match market close-out costs. These market close-out costs inherently incorporate risk decay and cross-effects (taking into account how moves in one risk factor may affect other inputs rather than treating all risk factors independently) that are unlikely to be adequately reflected in a static hedge based on vanilla instruments. Where there is limited bid-offer information for a product, the pricing approach and risk management strategy are taken into account when assessing the reserve.

 

The discount rates applied to derivative cash-flows in determining fair value reflect any underlying collateral agreements. Collateralised derivatives are generally discounted at the relevant OIS rates at an individual trade level. Uncollateralised derivatives are discounted with reference to funding levels by applying a funding spread over benchmark interest rates on a portfolio basis (funding valuation adjustment).

 

Amounts deferred on initial recognition

On initial recognition of financial assets and liabilities valued using valuation techniques incorporating information other than observable market data, any difference between the transaction price and that derived from the valuation technique is deferred. Such amounts are recognised in profit or loss over the life of the transaction; when market data becomes observable; or when the transaction matures or is closed out as appropriate.

 

Own credit

RBSH Group takes into account the effect of its own credit standing when valuing financial liabilities recorded at fair value in accordance with IFRS. Own credit spread adjustments are made to issued debt held at fair value, including issued structured notes, and derivatives. An own credit adjustment is applied to positions where it is believed that counterparties would consider RBSH Group's creditworthiness when pricing trades.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           119 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

9 Financial instruments - valuation continued 

For issued debt and structured notes this adjustment is based on debt issuance spreads above average inter-bank rates (at a range of tenors). Secondary senior debt issuance spreads are used in the calculation of the own credit adjustment applied to senior debt.

 

The fair value of the RBSH Group's derivative financial liabilities has also been adjusted to reflect RBSH Group's own credit risk (DVA). Expected gains are applied to estimated potential future negative exposures, the modelling of which is consistent with the approach used in calculation of CVA relating to Other counterparties. Expected gains are determined from market implied probabilities of default and recovery levels. Weightings that were previously applied in the expected gains calculation were removed during the period in line with market developments. FVA is also now considered the primary adjustment applied to derivative liabilities; the extent to which DVA and FVA overlap is eliminated from DVA.

 

The own credit adjustment for fair value does not alter cash flows, is not used for performance management, is disregarded for regulatory capital reporting processes and will reverse over time as the liabilities mature.

 

The reserve movement between periods will not equate to the reported profit or loss for own credit. The balance sheet reserves are stated by conversion of underlying currency balances at spot rates for each period whereas the income statement includes intra-period foreign exchange sell-offs and excludes the impact of the methodology refinements relating to derivative financial liabilities. The methodology refinements also related to other valuation adjustments, and the impact of the refinements was reported as part of the reported profit or loss for the other valuation adjustments.

 

The effect of change in credit spreads could reverse in future periods provided the liability is not repaid at a premium or a discount.

 

The cumulative own credit adjustments on own liabilities are set out below.

 

 

  

Debt securities 

  

  

in issue and 

  

  

  subordinated 

  

  

liabilities (1)

Derivatives   

Total  

Cumulative own credit adjustment

€m 

€m    

€m  

2013 

(230)

(13)

(243)

2012 

(344)

(24)

(368)

2011 

(1,303)

(70)

(1,373)

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Book values of underlying liabilities

€bn 

  

  

2013 

1.4 

  

  

2012 

2.2 

  

  

2011 

11.2 

  

  

 

Note:

(1)    Includes wholesale and retail note issuances.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           120 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

9 Financial instruments - valuation continued 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Valuation hierarchy

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

The tables below show financial instruments carried at fair value on RBSH Group’s balance sheet by hierarchy - level 1, level 2 and level 3 (1)

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

  

2012 

  

2011 

  

Total   

Level 1  

Level 2  

Level 3  

  

Total   

Level 1  

Level 2  

Level 3  

  

Total   

Level 1  

Level 2  

Level 3  

€bn  

€bn  

€bn  

€bn  

€bn  

€bn  

€bn  

€bn  

€bn  

€bn  

€bn  

€bn  

Assets

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Loans and advances

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  - banks

0.8 

— 

0.8 

— 

  

1.5 

— 

1.5 

— 

  

2.2 

— 

2.2 

— 

  - customers

0.4 

— 

0.4 

— 

  

0.4 

— 

0.4 

— 

  

1.0 

— 

1.0 

— 

Debt securities

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Government

6.0 

3.6 

2.4 

— 

  

8.0 

5.2 

2.8 

— 

  

19.0 

12.8 

6.2 

— 

  RMBS

8.3 

— 

8.3 

— 

  

13.0 

— 

13.0 

— 

  

15.6 

— 

15.6 

— 

  CDOs

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

0.1 

— 

0.1 

— 

  

0.2 

— 

0.2 

— 

  CLOs

0.1 

— 

0.1 

— 

  

0.1 

— 

0.1 

— 

  

0.3 

— 

0.3 

— 

  Other ABS

0.2 

— 

0.2 

— 

  

0.5 

— 

0.5 

— 

  

1.1 

— 

1.1 

— 

  Corporate

0.1 

— 

0.1 

— 

  

0.2 

— 

0.2 

— 

  

0.5 

— 

0.4 

0.1 

  Other (3) 

0.5 

— 

0.5 

— 

  

0.6 

— 

0.6 

— 

  

2.4 

0.2 

1.9 

0.3 

  

15.2 

3.6 

11.6 

— 

  

22.5 

5.2 

17.3 

— 

  

39.1 

13.0 

25.7 

0.4 

Equity shares

0.3 

— 

0.2 

0.1 

  

1.1 

0.7 

0.3 

0.1 

  

3.1 

2.1 

0.5 

0.5 

Derivatives

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Foreign exchange

1.1 

— 

0.9 

0.2 

  

1.7 

— 

1.4 

0.3 

  

6.5 

— 

6.5 

— 

  Interest rate

3.1 

— 

3.1 

— 

  

4.9 

— 

4.9 

— 

  

7.4 

— 

7.2 

0.2 

  Equities

0.4 

— 

0.4 

— 

  

0.8 

— 

0.7 

0.1 

  

4.2 

— 

3.8 

0.4 

  Commodities

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

0.5 

— 

0.5 

— 

  Credit

0.2 

— 

0.1 

0.1 

  

0.2 

— 

0.1 

0.1 

  

0.5 

— 

0.4 

0.1 

  

4.8 

— 

4.5 

0.3 

  

7.6 

— 

7.1 

0.5 

  

19.1 

— 

18.4 

0.7 

Total assets

21.5 

3.6 

17.5 

0.4 

  

33.1 

5.9 

26.6 

0.6 

  

64.5 

15.1 

47.8 

1.6 

Liabilities

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  - banks

1.0 

— 

1.0 

— 

  

1.3 

— 

1.2 

0.1 

  

1.3 

— 

1.3 

— 

  - customers

0.7 

— 

0.7 

— 

  

0.7 

— 

0.7 

— 

  

1.0 

— 

1.0 

— 

Debt securities in issue

0.8 

— 

0.7 

0.1 

  

1.6 

— 

1.6 

— 

  

10.7 

— 

10.2 

0.5 

Short positions

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

0.6 

0.3 

0.2 

0.1 

Derivatives

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Foreign exchange

1.3 

— 

1.1 

0.2 

  

1.7 

— 

1.6 

0.1 

  

6.1 

— 

6.1 

— 

  Interest rate

4.3 

— 

4.3 

— 

  

7.3 

— 

7.1 

0.2 

  

10.2 

— 

9.7 

0.5 

  Equities

0.2 

— 

0.2 

— 

  

0.4 

— 

0.4 

— 

  

2.6 

— 

2.6 

— 

  Commodities

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

0.5 

0.1 

0.4 

— 

  Credit

0.1 

— 

— 

0.1 

  

0.2 

— 

0.1 

0.1 

  

0.5 

— 

0.4 

0.1 

  

5.9 

— 

5.6 

0.3 

  

9.6 

— 

9.2 

0.4 

  

19.9 

0.1 

19.2 

0.6 

Subordinated liabilities

0.6 

— 

0.6 

— 

  

0.7 

— 

0.7 

— 

  

0.5 

— 

0.5 

— 

Total liabilities

9.0 

— 

8.6 

0.4 

  

13.9 

— 

13.4 

0.5 

  

34.0 

0.4 

32.4 

1.2 

 

For notes relating to this table refer to page 123.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           121 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

9 Financial instruments - valuation continued 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Valuation hierarchy continued

 

 

 

 

 

 

The following table analyses level 3 balances and related valuation sensitivities.

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

  

2012 

  

  

Sensitivity (2)

  

  

Sensitivity (2)

  

Balance  

Favourable  

Unfavourable  

  

Balance  

Favourable  

Unfavourable  

  

€m  

€m  

€m   

€m  

€m  

€m  

Assets

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Debt securities

27 

(2)

  

— 

— 

Equity shares

65 

12 

(9)

  

118 

(13)

Derivatives

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Credit

52 

(4)

  

144 

(14)

  Other

211 

(8)

  

323 

(36)

  

263 

11 

(12)

  

467 

(50)

Total assets at 31 December

355 

25 

(23)

  

592 

17 

(63)

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Total assets at 31 December 2011

  

  

  

  

1,630 

165 

(154)

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Liabilities

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits by banks

49 

(13)

  

84 

22 

— 

Debt securities in issue

74 

(8)

  

37 

15 

(12)

Derivatives

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  Credit

95 

(10)

  

46 

12 

(5)

  Other

196 

(4)

  

307 

18 

(47)

  

291 

13 

(14)

  

353 

30 

(52)

Total liabilities at 31 December

414 

25 

(35)

  

474 

67 

(64)

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Total liabilities at 31 December 2011

  

  

  

  

1,185 

138 

(56)

 

For notes relating to this table refer to next page.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           122 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

9 Financial instruments - valuation continued 

  

  

  

  

Amounts classified as available-for-sale

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

 

 

 

 

Level 3 sensitivity (2)

 

Total   

Level 1   

Level 2   

Level 3   

Favourable

Unfavourable

2013 

  €m    

  €m    

  €m    

  €m    

  €m    

  €m  

Debt securities

14,608 

3,566 

11,017 

25 

(2)

Equity shares

17 

— 

— 

17 

(2)

  

14,625 

3,566 

11,017 

42 

(4)

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2012 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Debt securities

21,612 

4,312 

17,300 

— 

— 

— 

Equity shares

45 

10 

31 

(4)

  

21,657 

4,316 

17,310 

31 

(4)

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2011 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Debt securities

34,393 

11,967 

22,386 

40 

(1)

Equity shares

297 

70 

222 

32 

(33)

  

34,690 

11,972 

22,456 

262 

33 

(34)

 

Notes:

(1)    Level 1: valued using unadjusted quoted prices in active markets, for identical financial instruments.


Level 2: valued using techniques based significantly on observable market data. Instruments in this category are valued using:

         (a)           quoted prices for similar instruments or identical instruments in markets which are not considered to be active; or

         (b)           valuation techniques where all the inputs that have a significant effect on the valuations are directly or indirectly based on observable market 

                      data.

 

The type of instruments that trade in markets that are not considered to be active, but are based on quoted market prices, banker dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency.

 

Level 3: instruments in this category have been valued using a valuation technique where at least one input which could have a significant effect on the instrument’s valuation, is not based on observable market data. Where inputs can be observed from market data without undue cost and effort, the observed input is used. Otherwise, RBSH Group determines a reasonable level for the input.

(2)    Sensitivity represents the favourable and unfavourable effect on the income statement or the statement of comprehensive income due to reasonably possible changes to valuations using reasonably possible alternative inputs to RBSH Group's valuation techniques or models. Totals for sensitivities are not indicative of the total potential effect on the income statement or the statement of comprehensive income. The level 3 sensitivities above are calculated at a trade or low level portfolio basis. They are not calculated on an overall portfolio basis and therefore do not reflect the likely overall potential uncertainty on the whole portfolio. The figures are aggregated and do not reflect the correlated nature of some of the sensitivities. In particular, for some of the portfolios the sensitivities may be negatively correlated where a downwards movement in one asset would produce an upwards movement in another, but due to the additive presentation of the above figures this correlation cannot be observed. The actual potential downside sensitivity of the total portfolio may be less than the non-correlated sum of the additive figures as shown in the above table.

(3)    Primarily includes debt securities issued by banks and building societies.

(4)    Transfers between levels are deemed to have occurred at the beginning of the quarter in which the instruments were transferred.

(5)   Improvements in IPV methodology resulted in €37 million assets and €36 million liabilities, principally derivatives transfers from level 3 to level 2. Transfers from level 2 to level 3 primarily resulted from unobservability of valuation inputs and market illiquidity and comprised: deposits (€156 million), debt securities in issue (€87 million) and derivatives (assets €18 million and liabilities €34 million). There were no significant transfers between level 1 and level 2.

 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           123 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

9 Financial instruments - valuation continued 

Valuation techniques

The table below shows a breakdown of valuation techniques and the ranges for those unobservable inputs used in valuation models and techniques that have a material impact on the valuation of Level 3 financial instruments. The table excludes unobservable inputs where the impact on valuation is less significant. Movements in the underlying input may have a favourable or unfavourable impact on the valuation depending on the particular terms of the contract and the exposure. For example an increase in the credit spread of a bond would be favourable for the issuer and unfavourable for the note holder. Whilst we indicate where we consider that there are significant relationships between the inputs, these inter-relationships will be affected by macro economic factors including interest rates, foreign exchange rates or equity index levels.

 

 

Level 3 (€bn)

 

 

Range

Financial instruments

Assets 

Liabilities 

Valuation technique

Unobservable inputs

Low 

High 

Equity shares

0.1

 

Discounted cash flow model (DCF)

Discount rate (1)

20%

100%

Debt securities in issue

 

0.1

DCF

Discount margin (2)

84bps

114bps

 

 

 

Option pricing

Volatility (3)

27%

30%

Derivatives

 

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign exchange

0.2

0.2

Option pricing

Correlation (4)

93%

107%

Credit

0.1

0.1

DCF

Discount margin (2)

16%

21%

 

Notes:

(1)    Discount rate: The rate at which future cash flows are discounted. A higher discount rate reduces the net present value of future cash flows.

(2)    Credit spreads and discount margins: Credit spreads and margins express the return required over a benchmark rate or index to compensate for the credit risk associated with a cash instrument. A higher credit spread would indicate that the underlying instrument has more credit risk associated with it. Consequently, investors require a higher yield to compensate for the higher risk. The discount rate comprises credit spread or margin plus the benchmark rate; it is used to value future cash flows.

(3)    Volatility: A measure of the tendency of a price to change with time.

(4)    Correlation: Measures the degree by which two prices or other variables are observed to move together. If they move in the same direction there is positive correlation; if they move in opposite directions there is negative correlation. Correlations typically include relationships between: default probabilities of assets in a basket (a group of separate assets), exchange rates, interest rates and other financial variables.

(5)    RBSH Group does not have any material liabilities measured at fair value that are issued with an inseparable third party credit enhancement.

 

 

 

Judgmental issues

The diverse range of products traded by RBSH Group results in a wide range of instruments that are classified into the three level hierarchy. Whilst the majority of these instruments naturally fall into a particular level, for some products an element of judgement is required. The majority of RBSH Group’s financial instruments carried at fair value are classified as level 2: inputs are observable either directly (i.e. as a price) or indirectly (i.e. derived from prices).

 

Active and inactive markets

A key input in the decision making process for the allocation of assets to a particular level is liquidity. In general, the degree of valuation uncertainty depends on the degree of liquidity of an input. For example, a derivative can be placed into level 2 or level 3 dependent upon its liquidity.

 

Where markets are liquid or very liquid, little judgement is required. However, when the information regarding the liquidity in a particular market is not clear, a judgement may need to be made. This can be made more difficult as assessing the liquidity of a market may not always be straightforward. For an equity traded on an exchange, daily volumes of trading can be seen, but for an-over-the-counter (OTC) derivative assessing the liquidity of the market with no central exchange can be more difficult.

 

A key related issue is where a market moves from liquid to illiquid or vice versa. Where this change is considered to be temporary, the classification is not changed. For example, if there is little market trading in a product on a reporting date but at the previous reporting date and during the intervening period the market has been considered to be liquid, the instrument will continue to be classified in the same level in the hierarchy. This is to provide consistency so that transfers between levels are driven by genuine changes in market liquidity and do not reflect short term or seasonal effects.

 

Interaction with the IPV process

The determination of an instrument’s level cannot be made at a global product level as a single product type can be in more than one level. For example, a single name corporate credit default swap could be in level 2 or level 3 depending on whether the reference counterparty is liquid or illiquid.

 

The breadth and depth of this data allows a good assessment to be made of market activity, liquidity and pricing uncertainty, which assists with the process of allocation to an appropriate level. Where suitable independent pricing information is not readily available the instrument will be considered to be level 3.

 

As part of RBSH Group’s IPV process, data is gathered at a trade level from market trading activity, trading systems, pricing services, consensus pricing providers, brokers and research material amongst other sources.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           124 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

9 Financial instruments - valuation continued   

Modelled products

For modelled products the market convention is to quote these trades through the model inputs or parameters as opposed to a cash price equivalent. A mark-to-market is derived from the use of the independent market inputs calculated using RBSH Group’s model.

 

The decision to classify a modelled asset as level 2 or 3 will be dependent upon the product/model combination, the currency, the maturity, the observability and quality of input parameters and other factors. All these need to be assessed to classify the asset.

 

An assessment is made of each input into a model. There may be multiple inputs into a model and each is assessed in turn for observability and quality. As part of the process of classifying the quality of IPV results the IPV quality classifications have been designed to follow the accounting level classifications, although with a further level of granualrity. For example there are a number of different IPV quality levels that equate to a level 2 classification and so on.

 

If an input fails the observability or quality tests then the instrument is considered to be in level 3 unless the input can be shown to have an insignificant effect on the overall valuation of the product.

 

The majority of derivative instruments are classified as level 2 as they are vanilla products valued using observable inputs. The valuation uncertainty on these is considered to be low and both input and output testing may be available. Examples of these products would be vanilla interest rate swaps, foreign exchange swaps and liquid single name credit derivatives.

 

Non-modelled products

Non-modelled products are generally quoted on a price basis and can therefore be considered for each of the 3 levels. This is determined by the market activity liquidity and valuation uncertainty of the instruments which is in turn measured from the availability of independent data used by the IPV process to allocate positions to IPV quality trends.

 

The availability and quality of independent pricing information is considered during the classification process. An assessment is made regarding the quality of the independent information. For example where consensus prices are used for non-modelled products, a key assessment of the quality of a price is the depth of the number of prices used to provide the consensus price. If the depth of contributors falls below a set hurdle rate, the instrument is considered to be level 3. This hurdle rate is that used in the IPV process to determine the IPV quality rating.  However, where an instrument is generally considered to be illiquid, but regular quotes from market participants exist, these instruments may be classified as level 2 depending on frequency of quotes, other available pricing and whether the quotes are used as part of the IPV process or not.

 

For some instruments with a wide number of available price sources, there may be differing quality of available information and there may be a wide range of prices from different sources. In these situations an assessment is made as to which source is the highest quality and this will be used to determine the classification of the asset. For example, a tradable quote would be considered a better source than a consensus price.

 

Instruments that cross levels

Some instruments will predominantly be in one level or the other, but others may cross between levels. For example, a cross currency swap may be between very liquid currency pairs where pricing is readily observed in the market and will therefore be classified as level 2. The cross currency swap may also be between two illiquid currency pairs in which case the swap would be placed into level 3. Defining the difference between liquid and illiquid may be based upon the number of consensus providers the consensus price is made up from and whether the consensus price can be supplemented by other sources.

 

Level 3 portfolios and sensitivity methodologies

For each of the portfolio categories shown in the above table, there follows a description of the types of products that comprise the portfolio and the valuation techniques that are applied in determining fair value, including a description of valuation techniques used for levels 2 and 3 and inputs to those models and techniques. Where reasonably possible alternative assumptions of unobservable inputs used in models would change the fair value of the portfolio significantly, the alternative inputs are indicated. Where there have been significant changes to valuation techniques during the year a discussion of the reasons for this are also included.

 

Overview of sensitivity methodologies

Reasonably possible alternative assumptions of unobservable inputs are determined based on a 95% confidence interval. The assessments recognise different favourable and unfavourable valuation movements where appropriate. Each unobservable input within a product is considered separately and sensitivity is reported on an additive basis.

  

Alternative assumptions are determined with reference to all available evidence including consideration of the following: quality of independent pricing information taking into account consistency between different sources, variation over time, perceived tradability or otherwise of available quotes; consensus service dispersion ranges; volume of trading activity and market bias (e.g. one-way inventory); day 1 P&L arising on new trades; number and nature of market participants; market conditions; modelling consistency in the market; size and nature of risk; length of holding of position; and market intelligence.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           125 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

9 Financial instruments - valuation continued   

The fair value of securities within each class of asset changes on a broadly consistent basis in response to changes in given market factors. However, the extent of the change, and therefore the range of reasonably possible alternative assumptions, may be either more or less pronounced, depending on the particular terms and circumstances of the individual security. The Group believes that probability of default was the least transparent input into Alt-A and prime RMBS modelled valuations (and most sensitive to variations).

 

Collateralised debt obligations (CDOs)

CDOs purchased from third parties are valued using independent, third party quotes or independent lead manager indicative prices.

 

For super senior CDOs which have been originated by RBSH Group no specific third party information is available. The valuation of these super senior CDOs therefore takes into consideration outputs from a proprietary model, market data and appropriate valuation adjustments. A collateral net asset value methodology using dealer buy side marks is used to determine an upper bound for super senior CDO valuations. An ABS index implied collateral valuation, is also used which provides a market calibrated valuation data point. Both the ABS index implied valuation and the collateral net asset value methodology apply an assumed immediate liquidation approach.

 

Asset-backed and corporate debt securities

Where observable market prices for a particular debt security are not available, the fair value will typically be determined with reference to observable market transactions in other related products, such as similar debt securities or credit derivatives. Assumptions are made about the relationship between the individual debt security and the available benchmark data. Where significant management judgement has been applied in identifying the most relevant related product, or in determining the relationship between the related product and the instrument itself, the instrument is classified as level 3.

 

Equity shares

Private equity investments include unit holdings and limited partnership interests primarily in corporate private equity funds, debt funds and fund of hedge funds. Externally managed funds are valued using recent prices where available. Where not available, the fair value of investments in externally managed funds is generally determined using statements or other information provided by the fund managers.

 

RBSH Group considers that valuations may rely significantly on the judgements and estimates made by the fund managers, particularly in assessing private equity components. Given the decline in liquidity in world markets, and the level of subjectivity, these are included in level 3.

 

Derivatives

Derivatives are priced using quoted prices for the same or similar instruments where these are available. However, the majority of derivatives are valued using pricing models. Inputs for these models are usually observed directly in the market, or derived from observed prices. However, it is not always possible to observe or corroborate all model inputs. Unobservable inputs used are based on estimates taking into account a range of available information including historic analysis, historic traded levels, market practice, comparison to other relevant benchmark observable data and consensus pricing data.

Credit derivatives

RBSH Group's other credit derivatives include vanilla and bespoke portfolio tranches, gap risk products and certain other unique trades.

 

Valuation of single name credit derivatives is carried out using industry standard models. Where single name derivatives have been traded and there is a lack of independent data or the quality of the data is weak, these instruments are classified into level 3. These assets will be priced using the Group’s standard credit derivative model using a proxy curve based upon a suitable alternative single name curve, a cash based product or a sector based curve. Where the sector based curve is used, the proxy will be chosen taking maturity, rating, seniority, geography and internal credit review on recoveries into account. Sensitivities for these instruments will be based upon the selection of reasonable alternative assumptions which may include adjustments to the credit curve and recovery rate assumptions.

 

Gap risk products are leveraged trades, with the counterparty's potential loss capped at the amount of the initial principal invested. Gap risk is the probability that the market will move discontinuously too quickly to exit a portfolio and return the principal to the counterparty without incurring losses, should an unwind event be triggered. This optionality is embedded within these portfolio structures and is very rarely traded outright in the market. Gap risk is not observable in the markets and, as such, these structures are deemed to be level 3 instruments.

 

Other unique trades are valued using a specialised model for each instrument and the same market data inputs as all other trades where applicable. By their nature, the valuation is also driven by a variety of other model inputs, many of which are unobservable in the market. Where these instruments have embedded optionality they are valued using a variation of the Black-Scholes option pricing formula, and where they have correlation exposure they are valued using a variant of the Gaussian Copula model. The volatility or unique correlation inputs required to value these products are generally unobservable and the instruments are therefore deemed to be level 3 instruments.

 

Equity derivatives

Equity derivative products are split into equity exotic derivatives and equity hybrids. Exotic equity derivatives have payouts based on the performance of one or more stocks, equity funds or indices. Most payouts are based on the performance of a single asset and are valued using observable market option data. Unobservable equity derivative trades are typically complex basket options on stocks. Such basket option payouts depend on the performance of more than one equity asset and require correlations for their valuation. Valuation is then performed using industry standard valuation models, with unobservable correlation inputs calculated by reference to correlations observed between similar underlyings.

 

Equity hybrids have payouts based on the performance of a basket of underlyings where underlyings are from different asset classes. Correlations between these different underlyings are typically unobservable with no market information on closely related assets available. Where no market for the correlation input exists, these inputs are based on historical time series.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           126 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

9 Financial instruments - valuation continued    

Interest rate derivatives

Interest rate derivatives provide a payout (or series of payouts) linked to the performance of one or more underlying, including interest rates, foreign exchange rates and commodities.

 

Exotic valuation inputs include the correlation between interest rates, foreign exchange rates and commodity prices. Correlations for more liquid rate pairs are valued using independently sourced consensus pricing levels. Where a consensus pricing benchmark is unavailable, these instruments are classified as level 3.

 

The carrying value of debt securities in issue is represented partly by underlying cash and partly through a derivative component. The classification of the amount in level 3 is driven by the derivative component and not by the cash element.

 

Other financial instruments

In addition to the portfolios discussed above, there are other financial instruments which are held at fair value determined from data which are not market observable, or incorporating material adjustments to market observed data.

Other considerations

Valuation adjustments

CVA applied to derivative exposures to other counterparties and own credit adjustments applied to derivative liabilities (DVA) are calculated on a portfolio basis. Whilst the methodology used to calculate each of these adjustments references certain inputs which are not based on observable market data, these inputs are not considered to have a significant effect on the net valuation of the related portfolios. The classification of the derivative portfolios which the valuation adjustments are applied to is not determined by the observability of the valuation adjustments, and any related sensitivity does not form part of the level 3 sensitivities presented.

 

Own credit - issued debt

For structured notes issued the own credit adjustment is based on debt issuance spreads above average inter-bank rates at the reporting date (at a range of tenors). Whilst certain debt issuance spreads are not based on observable market data, these inputs are not considered to have a significant effect on the valuation of individual trades. Neither the classification of structured notes issued nor any related valuation sensitivities are determined by the observability of the debt issuance

spreads.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           127 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

9 Financial instruments - valuation continued 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Level 3 movement  table

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Amounts recorded 

 

 

(Losses)/gains

Recorded in the

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

in the income 

 

 

 

 

 

Transfer to 

 

 

statement relating 

At 

 

 

 

 

disposal 

 

At 

to instruments 

 

1 January 

income 

 

 Level 3 transfers

 

 

groups 

Foreign 

31 December 

 

held at year end 

 

2013 

statement 

SOCI 

In 

Out 

Purchases 

Settlements 

and sales 

exchange 

2013 

 

- unrealised 

 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 

 €m 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

FVTPL (2)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Debt securities

7  

  

  

  

  

  

(4)

(1)

2  

 

  

Equity shares

87  

(2)

  

  

(2)

20

  

(53)

(2)

48  

 

  

Derivatives

467  

(105)  

  

18  

(35)

102

(56)

(116)

(12)

263  

 

(87)

FVTPL assets

561  

(107)

  

18  

(37)

122

(56)

(173)

(15)

313  

 

(87)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

AFS (3)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Debt securities

  

  

  

  

  

25

  

  

  

25  

 

  

Equity shares

31  

  

(5)

10  

  

7

  

(21)

(5)

17  

 

  

AFS assets

31  

  

(5)

10  

  

32

  

(21)

(5)

42  

 

  

 

592  

(107)

(5)

28  

(37)

154

(56)

(194)

(20)

355  

 

(87)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deposits

84  

(40)

  

156  

  

1  

  

(147)

(5)

49  

 

(33)

Debt securities in

37  

(44)

 

 

(3)

 

  

  

(3)

74  

 

(35)

  issue

  

87  

  

Short positions

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

 

— 

Derivatives

353  

81  

  

34  

(33)

47  

(57)

(123)

(11)

291  

 

83 

 

474  

(3)

  

277  

(36)

48  

(57)

(270)

(19)

414  

 

15 

                           

 

  

  

Gain/(losses)    

 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Amounts recorded    

  

  

  recorded    

 

  

  

  

  

  

  

 in the income    

  

At 

  in the income 

Level 3    

  

  

Transfer to    

 

At    

  

statement  relating    

1 January 

statement or 

transfers 

  

  

disposal groups   

Foreign    

31 December  

to instruments  

2012 

SOCI (1, 4)

 in/out  

Purchases  

Settlements  

and sales  

exchange  

2012 

held at year end    

  

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

  

 €m  

Assets

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

FVTPL (2) 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Debt securities

399 

11 

— 

(419)

10 

  

— 

Equity shares

277 

(11)

(70)

— 

(113)

87 

  

(3)

Derivatives

692 

(7)

158 

11 

(306)

(100)

19 

467 

  

(47)

FVTPL assets

1,368 

(7)

92 

14 

(306)

(632)

32 

561 

  

(50)

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

AFS (3) 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Debt securities

40 

31 

— 

— 

(4)

(67)

— 

— 

  

— 

Equity shares

222 

101 

70 

— 

(363)

— 

31 

  

52 

AFS assets

262 

132 

70 

(4)

(430)

— 

31 

  

52 

  

1,630 

125 

162 

15 

(310)

(1,062)

32 

592 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Liabilities

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits

— 

85 

— 

— 

— 

— 

(1)

84 

  

84 

Debt securities in issue

485 

(22)

— 

— 

(427)

— 

37 

  

(18)

Short positions

67 

(69)

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

— 

Derivatives

633 

(95)

(51)

34 

(33)

(153)

18 

353 

  

  

1,185 

(101)

(51)

34 

(460)

(153)

20 

474 

  

69 

 

For the notes relating to these tables refer to the following page.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           128 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

9 Financial instruments - valuation continued 

  

  

  

  

  

Level 3 movement table continued 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  

  

(Losses)/gains

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Amounts recorded 

  

  

  recorded

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

 in the income 

  

At 

  in the income 

Level 3

  

  

  

Transfer to

  

At

  

  statement  relating 

1 January 

statement or 

transfers 

  

  

  

disposal groups

Foreign

31 December

to instruments 

2011 

SOCI (1, 4)

 in/out  

Issuances

Purchases

Settlements

and sales

exchange

2011 

held at year end 

  

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

  

 €m 

Assets

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

FVTPL (2) 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Loans and advances

242 

(20)

— 

— 

59 

(229)

(59)

— 

  

— 

Debt securities

1,003 

(184)

(88)

— 

(1)

(364)

29 

399 

  

35 

Equity shares

354 

(32)

108 

— 

(85)

(86)

277 

  

(27)

Derivatives

632 

25 

(21)

359 

(71)

(255)

19 

692 

  

89 

FVTPL assets

2,231 

(211)

(1)

431 

(386)

(764)

64 

1,368 

  

97 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

AFS (3) 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Debt securities

52 

(1)

— 

— 

— 

(13)

— 

40 

  

— 

Equity shares

140 

37 

55 

— 

— 

(13)

222 

  

AFS assets

192 

36 

55 

— 

(13)

(13)

262 

  

  

2,423 

(175)

54 

432 

(399)

(777)

68 

1,630 

  

104 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Liabilities

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Debt securities in issue

2,284 

(183)

537 

— 

(1,020)

(1,149)

485 

  

(10)

Short positions

— 

65 

— 

— 

(2)

(2)

67 

  

— 

Derivatives

1,002 

(44)

92 

40 

(81)

(411)

30 

633 

  

72 

Other financial liabilities

26 

— 

(27)

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

  

— 

  

3,316 

(227)

139 

542 

40 

(1,103)

(1,562)

40 

1,185 

  

62 

 

Notes:

(1)    Net losses recognised in the income statement were €101 million (2012 - €66 million gains). Net losses of €72 million (2012 - €30 million) were included in income from trading activities. None of this relates to discontinued operations.

(2)    FVTPL: Fair value through profit or loss. 

(3)    AFS: Available-for-sale.

(4)    SOCI: Statement of comprehensive income.

 

Gains and losses recognised on assets held-for-trading and derivatives have been included in non-interest income from trading activities. Gains and losses on available-for-sale assets have been included in non-interest income and interest income.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           129 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

9 Financial instruments - valuation continued 

Fair value of financial instruments not carried at fair value

The following table shows the carrying value and fair value of financial instruments carried at amortised cost on the balance sheet.

 

 

Items where 

 

 

 

 

 

fair value 

 

 

 

 

 

approximates 

 

 

Fair value hierarchy level

 

carrying value 

Carrying value 

Fair value 

Level 2 

Level 3 

2013

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Financial assets

  

  

  

  

  

Cash and balances at central banks

3,193 

  

  

  

  

Loans and advances to banks

  

4,894 

4,896 

2,187 

2,709 

Loans and advances to customers

  

3,406 

3,249 

298 

2,951 

Amount due from ultimate holding company

  

2,820 

3,279 

3,279 

— 

Debt securities

  

39 

40 

— 

40 

Settlement balances

10 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Financial liabilities

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits by banks

  

  

  

  

  

  - items in the course of transmission to other banks

  

  

  

  

  - other deposits by banks

  

17,916 

17,922 

13,147 

4,775 

Customer accounts

  

  

  

  

  

  - demand deposits

1,878 

  

  

  

  

  - other customer deposits

  

1,579 

1,578 

629 

949 

Debt securities in issue

  

489 

501 

501 

— 

Settlement balances

83 

  

  

 

 

Subordinated liabilities

  

4,339 

3,649 

3,649 

— 

 

 

 

2012 

2012 

2011 

2011 

 

 Carrying value 

Fair value 

 Carrying value 

 Fair value 

 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Financial assets

 

 

 

 

Cash and balances at central banks

2,294  

2,294  

12,609  

12,609  

Loans and advances to banks

10,685  

10,697  

23,751  

23,720  

Loans and advances to customers

5,932  

5,617  

28,612  

27,684  

Amounts due from ultimate holding company

2,949  

2,949  

1,136  

1,136  

Debt securities

133  

133  

547  

547  

Settlement balances

31  

31  

2,608  

2,608  

 

 

 

 

 

Financial liabilities

 

 

 

 

Deposits by banks

33,160  

33,160  

45,272  

45,242  

Customer accounts

1,972  

1,972  

38,584  

38,584  

Debt securities in issue

1,028  

997  

6,929  

6,923  

Settlement balances

73  

73  

2,845  

2,845  

Subordinated liabilities

6,127  

5,700  

6,336  

4,225  

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           130 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

9 Financial instruments - valuation continued 

The fair value is the price that would be received to sell  an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. Quoted market values are used where available; otherwise, fair values have been estimated based on discounted expected future cash flows and other valuation techniques. These techniques involve uncertainties and require assumptions and judgments covering prepayments, credit risk and discount rates.  Furthermore there is a wide range of potential valuation techniques. Changes in these assumptions would significantly affect estimated fair values. The fair values reported would not necessarily be realised in an immediate sale or settlement.

 

The fair values of intangible assets, such as core deposits, credit card and other customer relationships are not included in the calculation of these fair values as they are not financial instruments.

 

The assumptions and methodologies underlying the calculation of fair values of financial instruments at the balance sheet date are as follows:

 

For certain short-term financial instruments: cash and balances at central banks, items in the course of collection from other banks, settlement balances, items in the course of transmission to other banks, customer demand deposits and notes in circulation, fair value approximates to carrying value.

 

Loans and advances to banks and customers

In estimating the fair value of loans and advances to banks and customers measured at amortised cost, RBSH Group’s loans are segregated into appropriate portfolios reflecting the characteristics of the constituent loans. Two principal methods are used to estimate fair value:

 

(a)   contractual cash flows are discounted using a market discount rate that incorporates the current spread for the borrower or where this is not observable, the spread for borrowers of a similar credit standing. This method is used for the majority of Markets and International Banking’s portfolios where most counterparties have external ratings.

(b)   expected cash flows (unadjusted for credit losses) are discounted at the current offer rate for the same or similar products. This approach is adopted for lending portfolios reflecting the more homogeneous nature of these portfolios. 

  

Debt securities

Fair values are determined using discounted cash flow valuation techniques.

 

Deposits by banks and customer accounts

Fair values of deposits are estimated using discounted cash flow valuation techniques.

 

Debt securities in issue and subordinated liabilities

Fair values are determined using quoted prices where available or by reference to valuation techniques and adjusting for own credit spreads where appropriate.

.

 

 

10 Financial instruments - maturity analysis

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Remaining maturity

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

The following table shows the residual maturity of financial instruments, based on contractual date of maturity.

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

  

2012 

  

2011 

  

Less than  

More than  

  

  

Less than 

More than 

  

  

Less than 

More than 

  

12 months  

 12 months  

Total  

12 months 

12 months 

Total 

 12 months 

12 months 

Total 

  

€m  

€m  

€m  

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

Assets

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Cash and balances at central banks

3,193 

— 

3,193 

  

2,294 

— 

2,294 

  

12,609 

— 

12,609 

Loans and advances to banks

5,245 

450 

5,695 

  

10,147 

2,059 

12,206 

  

24,006 

1,911 

25,917 

Loans and advances to customers

2,036 

1,748 

3,784 

  

2,444 

3,936 

6,380 

  

16,796 

12,782 

29,578 

Amounts due from ultimate holding company

20 

2,800 

2,820 

  

131 

2,818 

2,949 

  

10 

1,126 

1,136 

Debt securities

1,376 

13,912 

15,288 

  

1,326 

21,329 

22,655 

  

8,644 

31,001 

39,645 

Equity shares

— 

295 

295 

  

— 

1,127 

1,127 

  

— 

3,093 

3,093 

Settlement balances

10 

— 

10 

  

29 

31 

  

2,605 

2,608 

Derivatives

658 

4,124 

4,782 

  

1,464 

6,091 

7,555 

  

4,988 

14,150 

19,138 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Liabilities

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits by banks

18,541 

402 

18,943 

  

30,083 

4,382 

34,465 

  

44,762 

1,758 

46,520 

Customer accounts

3,147 

1,004 

4,151 

  

1,550 

1,088 

2,638 

  

37,726 

1,875 

39,601 

Debt securities in issue

196 

1,123 

1,319 

  

561 

2,041 

2,602 

  

5,598 

12,116 

17,714 

Settlement balances and short positions

105 

— 

105 

  

79 

28 

107 

  

3,310 

99 

3,409 

Derivatives

828 

5,034 

5,862 

  

1,568 

8,076 

9,644 

  

5,226 

14,642 

19,868 

Subordinated liabilities

— 

4,951 

4,951 

  

11 

6,840 

6,851 

  

61 

6,798 

6,859 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           131 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

10 Financial instruments - maturity analysis continued 

Assets and liabilities by contractual cash flow maturity

The tables below and on the following page show the contractual undiscounted cash flows receivable and payable, up to a period of twenty years, including future receipts and payments of interest of on-balance sheet assets by contractual maturity. The balances in the table below do not agree directly with the consolidated balance sheet, as the table includes all cash flows relating to principal and future coupon payments, presented on an undiscounted basis. The tables have been prepared on the following basis:

 

Financial assets have been reflected in the time band of the latest date on which they could be repaid, unless earlier repayment can be demanded by the RBSH Group. Financial liabilities are included at the earliest date on which the counterparty can require repayment, regardless of whether or not such early repayment results in a penalty.

 

If the repayment of a financial instrument is triggered by, or is subject to, specific criteria such as market price hurdles being reached, the asset is included in the time band that contains the latest date on which it can be repaid, regardless of early repayment. The liability is included in the time band that contains the earliest possible date on which the conditions could be fulfilled, without considering the probability of the conditions being met.

For example, if a structured note is automatically prepaid when an equity index exceeds a certain level, the cash outflow will be included in the less than three months period, whatever the level of the index at the year end. The settlement date of debt securities in issue, issued by certain securitisation vehicles consolidated by the RBSH Group, depends on when cash flows are received from the securitised assets. Where these assets are prepayable, the timing of the cash outflow relating to securities assumes that each asset will be prepaid at the earliest possible date. As the repayments of assets and liabilities are linked, the repayment of assets in securitisations is shown on the earliest date that the asset can be prepaid, as this is the basis used for liabilities.

 

The principal amounts of financial assets and liabilities that are repayable after twenty years or where the counterparty has no right to repayment of the principal are excluded from the table, as are interest payments after twenty years.

 

Held-for-trading assets and liabilities - held-for-trading derivative assets and liabilities amounting to €4.6 billion (assets) and €4.5 billion (liabilities) (2012 - €0.2 billion assets and €2.4 billion liabilities; 2011 - €18.7 billion assets and €17.6 billion liabilities) have been excluded from the tables below in view of their short-term nature.

 

  

0 - 3 

3 - 12 

1 – 3 

3 - 5 

5 - 10 

10 - 20 

 months 

 months 

years 

years 

years 

years 

2013 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Assets by contractual maturity

  

  

  

  

  

  

Cash and balances at central banks

3,193 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Loans and advances to banks

4,292 

448 

765 

29 

23 

— 

Amounts due from ultimate holding company

42 

143 

372 

372 

1,023 

1,781 

Debt securities

379 

1,230 

2,073 

5,957 

2,621 

1,144 

Settlement balances

10 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Total maturing assets

7,916 

1,821 

3,210 

6,358 

3,667 

2,925 

Loans and advances to customers

1,684 

462 

419 

264 

504 

250 

Derivatives held for hedging

69 

34 

32 

— 

— 

  

9,669 

2,317 

3,661 

6,629 

4,171 

3,175 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Liabilities by contractual maturity

  

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits by banks

13,310 

5,071 

314 

34 

33 

— 

Debt securities in issue

95 

129 

567 

49 

50 

511 

Subordinated liabilities

49 

218 

1,289 

1,235 

1,094 

1,991 

Settlement balances and other liabilities

105 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Total maturing liabilities

13,559 

5,418 

2,170 

1,318 

1,177 

2,502 

Customer accounts

2,020 

1,070 

404 

356 

106 

10 

Derivatives held for hedging

95 

226 

507 

255 

216 

135 

  

15,674 

6,714 

3,081 

1,929 

1,499 

2,647 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Maturity gap

(5,643)

(3,597)

1,040 

5,040 

2,490 

423 

Cumulative maturity gap

(5,643)

(9,240)

(8,200)

(3,160)

(670)

(247)

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           132 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

10 Financial instruments - maturity analysis continued 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

0 - 3 

3 - 12 

1 – 3 

3 - 5 

5 - 10 

10 - 20 

 months 

 months 

years 

years 

years 

years 

2012 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Assets by contractual maturity

  

  

  

  

  

  

Cash and balances at central banks

2,294 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Loans and advances to banks

9,926 

185 

433 

150 

412 

433 

Amounts due from ultimate holding company

— 

119 

— 

34 

102 

2,841 

Debt securities

691 

1,314 

3,838 

5,956 

6,412 

1,207 

Settlement balances

30 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Total maturing assets

12,941 

1,618 

4,271 

6,140 

6,926 

4,481 

Loans and advances to customers

1,465 

1,773 

998 

555 

598 

682 

Derivatives held for hedging

77 

31 

35 

20 

— 

  

14,483 

3,422 

5,304 

6,715 

7,527 

5,163 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Liabilities by contractual maturity

  

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits by banks

18,619 

11,663 

4,247 

81 

239 

325 

Debt securities in issue

142 

380 

608 

607 

134 

850 

Subordinated liabilities

29 

895 

3,148 

489 

1,633 

1,741 

Settlement balances and other liabilities

106 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Total maturing liabilities

18,896 

12,938 

8,003 

1,177 

2,006 

2,916 

Customer accounts

1,398 

326 

231 

78 

269 

Derivatives held for hedging

56 

244 

668 

449 

317 

171 

  

20,350 

13,508 

8,902 

1,704 

2,592 

3,093 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Maturity gap

(5,955)

(11,320)

(3,732)

4,963 

4,920 

1,565 

Cumulative maturity gap

(5,955)

(17,275)

(21,007)

(16,044)

(11,124)

(9,559)

 

2011 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Assets by contractual maturity

  

  

  

  

  

  

Cash and balances at central banks

12,607 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Loans and advances to banks

24,041 

— 

456 

106 

309 

580 

Amounts due from ultimate holding company

54 

— 

77 

1,200 

— 

— 

Debt securities

5,108 

3,794 

7,808 

5,745 

11,619 

2,731 

Settlement balances

2,595 

10 

— 

— 

— 

— 

Total maturing assets

44,405 

3,806 

8,341 

7,051 

11,928 

3,311 

Loans and advances to customers

11,539 

5,657 

5,822 

3,902 

2,986 

1,349 

Derivatives held for hedging

37 

54 

206 

116 

19 

12 

  

55,981 

9,517 

14,369 

11,069 

14,933 

4,672 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Liabilities by contractual maturity

  

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits by banks

43,741 

1,067 

694 

860 

204 

25 

Debt securities in issue

3,737 

2,104 

4,855 

4,444 

2,734 

1,344 

Subordinated liabilities

54 

177 

256 

2,981 

1,514 

1,006 

Settlement balances and other liabilities

3,209 

16 

14 

70 

99 

Total maturing liabilities

50,741 

3,364 

5,819 

8,355 

4,551 

2,376 

Customer accounts

36,929 

843 

595 

524 

691 

30 

Derivatives held for hedging

197 

309 

948 

517 

390 

202 

  

87,867 

4,516 

7,362 

9,396 

5,632 

2,608 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Maturity gap

(6,336)

442 

2,522 

(1,304)

7,377 

935 

Cumulative maturity gap

(6,336)

(5,894)

(3,372)

(4,676)

2,701 

3,636 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           133 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

10 Financial instruments - maturity analysis continued 

  

Assets and liabilities by contractual cash flow maturity continued 

  

  

  

Guarantees and commitments notional amount

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Guarantees (1) 

6,884 

10,070 

19,901 

Commitments (2)

972 

5,706 

22,378 

  

7,856 

15,776 

42,279 

 

Notes:

(1)    RBSH Group is only called upon to satisfy a guarantee when the guaranteed party fails to meet its obligations. RBSH Group expects most guarantees it provides to expire unused.

(2)    RBSH Group has given commitments to provide funds to customers under undrawn formal facilities, credit lines and other commitments to lend subject to certain conditions being met by the counterparty. RBSH Group does not expect all facilities to be drawn, and some may lapse before drawdown.

 

11 Financial assets - impairments

  

  

  

  

  

  

The following table shows the movement in the provision for impairment losses for loans and advances.

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Individually 

Collectively 

  

Total 

Total 

Total 

assessed 

assessed 

Latent 

2013 

2012 

2011 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

At 1 January

306 

— 

35 

341 

1,572 

1,572 

Transfers to/(from) disposal groups

(42)

78 

— 

36 

(171)

— 

Currency translation and other adjustments

(14)

50 

41 

(87)

68 

Disposals

(4)

(87)

— 

(91)

(562)

(45)

Amounts written-off

(98)

(5)

— 

(103)

(453)

(397)

Recoveries of amounts previously written-off

— 

12 

22 

Charged/(credited) to the income statement - continuing operations

26 

(72)

(38)

30 

360 

Unwind of discount (recognised in interest income)

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

(8)

At 31 December

182 

— 

13 

195 

341 

1,572 

 

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

Impairment losses charged to the income statement

€m 

€m 

€m 

Loans and advances to banks

— 

15 

— 

Loans and advances to customers

(38)

15 

360 

  

(38)

30 

360 

Recoveries/(recharge) to RBS plc under credit protection arrangements

46 

(13)

(58)

Debt securities

34 

48 

1,463 

  

42 

65 

1,765 

 

The following tables analyse impaired financial assets.

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

  

2012 

  

2011 

 

  

  

Carrying 

 

  

  

Carrying 

 

  

  

Carrying 

 

Cost 

Provision 

value 

 

Cost 

Provision 

value 

 

Cost 

Provision 

value 

 

€m 

€m 

€m 

 

€m 

€m 

€m 

 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Loans and advances to banks (1) 

— 

  

— 

— 

— 

  

52 

45 

Loans and advances to customers (2) 

310 

181 

129 

  

506 

306 

200 

  

1,878 

1,421 

457 

  

311 

182 

129 

  

506 

306 

200 

  

1,930 

1,466 

464 

 

 

Notes:

(1)    Impairment provisions individually assessed.

(2)    All impairment provisions were individually assessed in 2013 and 2012. Impairment provisions were individually assessed on balances of €1,711 million in 2011.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           134 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

11 Financial assets - impairments continued 

  

  

  

  

Carrying 

Carrying 

Carrying 

value 

 value 

value 

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Debt securities

39 

133 

515 

 

RBSH Group holds collateral in respect of certain loans and advances to banks and to customers that are past due or impaired. Such collateral includes mortgages over property; charges over business assets such as plant, inventories and trade debtors; and guarantees of lending from parties other than the borrower.

 

Loans that have been renegotiated in the past 12 months that would otherwise have been past due or impaired amounted to nil as at 31 December 2013 (2012 - nil; 2011 - €194 million).

 

 

 

 

12 Derivatives

Companies in RBSH Group transact derivatives as principal either as a trading activity or to manage balance sheet foreign exchange, interest rate and credit risks.

 

RBSH Group enters into fair value hedges, cash flow hedges and hedges of net investments in foreign operations. The majority of RBSH Group's interest rate hedges relate to the management of RBSH Group's non-trading interest rate risk. RBSH Group manages this risk within approved limits. Residual risk positions are hedged with derivatives principally interest rate swaps. Suitable larger ticket financial instruments are fair value hedged; the remaining exposure, where possible, is hedged by derivatives documented as cash flow hedges and qualifying for hedge accounting. The majority of RBSH Group's fair value hedges involve interest rate swaps hedging the interest rate risk in recognised financial assets and financial liabilities. Cash flow hedges relate to exposures to the variability in future interest payments and receipts on forecast transactions and on recognised financial assets and financial liabilities. RBSH Group hedges its net investments in foreign operations with currency borrowings and forward foreign exchange contracts.

 

For cash flow hedge relationships of interest rate risk, the hedged items are actual and forecast variable interest rate cash flows arising from financial assets and financial liabilities with interest rates linked to LIBOR and EURIBOR. The financial assets are customer loans and the financial liabilities are customer deposits and LIBOR linked medium-term notes and other issued securities.

 

For cash flow hedging relationships, the initial and ongoing prospective effectiveness is assessed by comparing movements in the fair value of the expected highly probable forecast interest cash flows with movements in the fair value of the expected changes in cash flows from the hedging interest rate swap or by comparing the respective changes in the price value of a basis point. Prospective effectiveness is measured on a cumulative basis i.e. over the entire life of the hedge relationship. The method of calculating hedge ineffectiveness is the hypothetical derivative method. Retrospective effectiveness is assessed by comparing the actual movements in the fair value of the cash flows and actual movements in the fair value of the hedged cash flows from the interest rate swap over the life to date of the hedging relationship.

 

For fair value hedge relationships of interest rate risk, the hedged items are typically government bonds, large corporate fixed-rate loans, fixed-rate finance leases, fixed-rate medium-term notes or preference shares classified as debt.

 

The initial and ongoing prospective effectiveness of fair value hedge relationships is assessed on a cumulative basis by comparing movements in the fair value of the hedged item attributable to the hedged risk with changes in the fair value of the hedging interest rate swap or by comparing the respective changes in the price value of a basis point. Retrospective effectiveness is assessed by comparing the actual movements in the fair value of the hedged items attributable to the hedged risk with actual movements in the fair value of the hedging derivative over the life to date of the hedging relationship.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           135 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

12 Derivatives continued 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

The following table shows the notional amounts and fair values of RBSH Group's derivatives.

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

  

2012 

  

2011 

 

Notional

  

  

 

Notional

  

  

 

Notional

  

  

 

amounts

Assets

Liabilities

 

amounts

Assets

Liabilities

 

amounts

Assets

Liabilities

 

€m

€m

€m

 

€m

€m

€m

 

€m

€m

€m

Exchange rate contracts

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Spot, forwards and futures

21,253 

382 

343 

  

31,204 

521 

366 

  

104,888 

2,585 

2,671 

Currency swaps

26,107 

636 

794 

  

94,278 

1,039 

1,313 

  

81,318 

3,696 

3,234 

Options purchased

1,538 

86 

— 

  

1,664 

118 

— 

  

5,065 

252 

— 

Options written

1,241 

— 

62 

  

1,779 

— 

114 

  

4,409 

— 

180 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Interest rate contracts

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Interest rate swaps

32,073 

3,140 

4,265 

  

137,077 

4,809 

7,230 

  

292,228 

6,880 

9,854 

Options purchased

104 

— 

  

1,456 

82 

— 

  

6,815 

301 

Options written

172 

— 

26 

  

1,549 

— 

27 

  

5,497 

— 

238 

Futures and forwards

— 

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

— 

  

873 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Credit derivatives

786 

135 

157 

  

2,748 

197 

133 

  

11,315 

713 

650 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Equity and commodity contracts

907 

401 

215 

  

1,706 

789 

461 

  

18,739 

4,709 

3,037 

  

  

4,782 

5,862 

  

  

7,555 

9,644 

  

  

19,138 

19,868 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

 

Included above are derivatives held for hedging purposes as follows:

  

2013 

  

2012 

  

2011 

 

Assets

Liabilities

 

Assets

Liabilities

 

Assets

Liabilities

 

€m

€m

 

€m

€m

 

€m

€m

Fair value hedging

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Interest rate contracts

63 

1,375 

  

104 

2,372 

  

362 

2,731 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Cash flow hedging

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Interest rate contracts

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

  

— 

17 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Net investment hedging

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Exchange rate contracts

78 

16 

  

82 

26 

  

33 

171 

 

 

Hedge ineffectiveness recognised in other operating income comprised:

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Fair value hedging

  

  

  

(Losses)/gains on the hedged items attributable to the hedged risk

(562)

354 

570 

Gains/(losses) on the hedging instruments

556 

(371)

(571)

Fair value ineffectiveness

(6)

(17)

(1)

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           136 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

13 Debt securities

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

US 

Other 

  

  

  

  

  

central 

central 

Bank and 

  

  

  

  

and local 

and local 

building 

  

Other financial 

  

Of which 

government 

government 

society 

Corporate 

  institutions 

Total 

ABS (1)

2013 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Held-for-trading

285 

207 

12 

— 

511 

— 

Designated as at fair value through profit or loss

— 

125 

— 

— 

130 

— 

Available-for-sale

1,711 

3,864 

4,135 

45 

4,853 

14,608 

8,644 

Loans and receivables

— 

— 

— 

— 

39 

39 

— 

  

1,718 

4,274 

4,342 

57 

4,897 

15,288 

8,644 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Available-for-sale

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Gross unrealised gains

188 

407 

81 

63 

742 

117 

Gross unrealised losses

— 

(8)

(245)

— 

(165)

(418)

(410)

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2012 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Held-for-trading

— 

506 

228 

16 

95 

845 

— 

Designated as at fair value through profit or loss

— 

— 

— 

65 

— 

65 

— 

Available-for-sale

1,871 

5,557 

5,097 

143 

8,944 

21,612 

13,777 

Loans and receivables

— 

— 

— 

133 

— 

133 

— 

  

1,871 

6,063 

5,325 

357 

9,039 

22,655 

13,777 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Available-for-sale

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Gross unrealised gains

284 

740 

48 

13 

83 

1,168 

124 

Gross unrealised losses

— 

(14)

(609)

— 

(894)

(1,517)

(1,503)

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2011 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Held-for-trading

1,036 

1,857 

695 

326 

639 

4,553 

— 

Designated as at fair value through profit or loss

— 

152 

— 

— 

— 

152 

— 

Available-for-sale

2,485 

13,592 

8,181 

186 

9,949 

34,393 

17,362 

Loans and receivables

— 

— 

341 

174 

32 

547 

— 

  

3,521 

15,601 

9,217 

686 

10,620 

39,645 

17,362 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Available-for-sale

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Gross unrealised gains

411 

574 

30 

10 

36 

1,061 

56 

Gross unrealised losses

— 

(203)

(911)

(1)

(908)

(2,023)

(1,813)

 

Note:

(1)    Includes asset-backed securities issued by US federal agencies and government sponsored entities, and covered bonds.

 

Net losses of €70 million (2012 – €153 million losses; 2011 - €16 million gains) were realised on the sale of available-for-sale debt securities.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           137 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

13 Debt securities continued 

The following table analyses RBSH Group's available-for-sale debt securities and the related yield (based on weighted averages) by remaining maturity and issuer.

 

  

Within 1 year

  

After 1 but within 5 years

  

After 5 but within 10 years

  

After 10 years

  

Total

  

Amount

Yield

  

Amount

Yield

  

Amount

Yield

  

Amount

Yield

  

Amount

Yield

2013 

€m

%

  

€m

%

  

€m

%

  

€m

%

  

€m

%

US central and local government

— 

— 

  

1,711 

4.01 

  

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

  

1,711 

4.01 

Other central and local  government

198 

3.97 

  

1,680 

4.56 

  

565 

3.9 

  

1,421 

3.88 

  

3,864 

4.18 

Bank and building society

691 

0.72 

  

2,809 

1.36 

  

488 

3.7 

  

147 

1.53 

  

4,135 

1.54 

Other financial institutions

31 

3.82 

  

682 

2.32 

  

1,120 

4.18 

  

3,020 

1.66 

  

4,853 

2.35 

Corporate

— 

— 

  

15 

3.72 

  

30 

3.12 

  

— 

— 

  

45 

3.32 

  

920 

1.53 

  

6,897 

2.90 

  

2,203 

3.99 

  

4,588 

2.34 

  

14,608 

2.80 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Of which ABS (1) 

426 

0.97 

  

3,444 

1.53 

  

1,607 

4.04 

  

3,167 

1.65 

  

8,644 

2.01 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2012 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

US central and local government

— 

— 

  

1,871 

4.52 

  

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

  

1,871 

4.52 

Other central and local  government

79 

0.56 

  

1,716 

3.31 

  

2,213 

4.12 

  

1,549 

4.63 

  

5,557 

3.93 

Bank and building society

461 

0.55 

  

2,495 

3.16 

  

2,005 

0.97 

  

136 

1.41 

  

5,097 

1.95 

Other financial institutions

85 

3.24 

  

1,694 

3.17 

  

1,065 

4.12 

  

6,100 

0.60 

  

8,944 

1.52 

Corporate

2.07 

  

109 

3.47 

  

33 

3.33 

  

— 

— 

  

143 

3.43 

  

626 

0.91 

  

7,885 

3.48 

  

5,316 

2.75 

  

7,785 

1.23 

  

21,612 

2.38 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Of which ABS (1) 

455 

0.54 

  

4,025 

3.21 

  

3,062 

2.02 

  

6,235 

0.62 

  

13,777 

1.66 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2011 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

US central and local government

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

  

2,485 

4.53 

  

— 

— 

  

2,485 

4.53 

Other central and local  government

3,311 

1.67 

  

5,101 

3.79 

  

3,505 

5.31 

  

1,675 

5.87 

  

13,592 

3.80 

Bank and building society

1,689 

1.67 

  

3,935 

3.31 

  

2,081 

2.20 

  

476 

5.11 

  

8,181 

2.76 

Other financial institutions

182 

2.25 

  

1,555 

3.47 

  

1,207 

3.82 

  

7,005 

1.77 

  

9,949 

2.29 

Corporate

1.51 

  

153 

3.68 

  

28 

3.48 

  

— 

— 

  

186 

3.59 

  

5,187 

1.68 

  

10,744 

3.53 

  

9,306 

4.06 

  

9,156 

2.60 

  

34,393 

3.15 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Of which ABS (1) 

1,588 

1.28 

  

5,019 

3.34 

  

3,288 

2.77 

  

7,467 

1.80 

  

17,362 

2.40 

 

Note:

(1)    Includes asset-backed securities issued by US federal agencies and government sponsored entities.

 

14 Equity shares

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

  

2012 

  

2011 

  

Listed 

Unlisted

Total 

  

Listed 

Unlisted 

Total 

  

Listed 

Unlisted 

Total 

  

€m 

€m

€m 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

Held-for-trading

229 

— 

229 

  

998 

31 

1,029 

  

2,558 

— 

2,558 

Designated as at fair value 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  through profit or loss

48 

49 

  

49 

53 

  

43 

195 

238 

Available-for-sale

15 

17 

  

16 

29 

45 

  

14 

283 

297 

  

232 

63 

295 

  

1,018 

109 

1,127 

  

2,615 

478 

3,093 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Available-for-sale

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Gross unrealised gains

  

  

155 

157 

Gross unrealised losses

— 

— 

— 

  

(1)

— 

(1)

  

(2)

— 

(2)

 

Net gains of €17 million (2012 - €99 million; 2011 - €16 million) were realised on the sale of available-for-sale equity shares.

 

Dividend income from available-for-sale equity shares was €0.2 million (2012 - €4 million; 2011 - €2 million).

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           138 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

15 Prepayments, accrued income and other assets

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

Prepayments and deferred expenses

69 

97 

649 

Current tax

123 

103 

444 

Pension schemes in net surplus (see Note 4)

— 

— 

80 

Intangible assets

49 

115 

Property, plant & equipment

14 

15 

152 

Other assets (1) 

1,640 

1,269 

4,473 

  

1,853 

1,533 

5,913 

Note:

(1)    Includes interests in associates - see below.

 

Interests in associates

The RBSH Group has one significant associate, Saudi Hollandi Bank (SHB) which is incorporated and has its principal place of business in the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia. The RBSH Group holds 40% of SHB’s shares. It is accounted for using the equity method.

 

2013

 

2012

 

2011

  

Carrying value 

Fair value 

 

Carrying value  

Fair value  

 

Carrying value  

Fair value  

  

€m 

€m 

 

€m  

€m  

 

€m  

€m  

SHB

721 

1,269 

 

707 

880 

 

628 

634 

Other associates

64 

 

 

27 

 

 

— 

 

  

785 

 

 

734 

 

 

628 

 

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

SHB

€m 

€m 

€m 

Financial assets

15,278 

13,572 

11,436 

Property, plant and equipment

98 

99 

101 

Other assets

200 

190 

246 

Total assets

15,576 

13,861 

      11,783  

  

  

  

 

Financial liabilities

13,354 

11,794 

9,847 

Other liabilities

401 

387 

410 

Total liabilities

13,755 

12,181 

10,257 

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Total income

512 

460 

384 

Total expenses

218 

200 

190 

Profit before tax

294 

260 

194 

 

 

 

 

Share of profit after tax

57 

93 

62 

 

16 Discontinued operations and assets and liabilities of disposal groups

(a) Profit from discontinued operations, net of tax

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

Total income

34 

36 

48 

Operating expenses

(3)

(3)

(4)

Impairment (losses)/recoveries

— 

(5)

Operating profit before tax

31 

28 

53 

Tax

(12)

(11)

(13)

Profit after tax

19 

17 

40 

 

All Dutch State acquired businesses are classified as discontinued operations. Following the successful demerger of the majority of the Dutch State acquired businesses into the new ABN AMRO Bank on 6 February 2010, these businesses met the IFRS requirements of a disposal group held for sale.

Legal separation of the new ABN AMRO Bank occurred on 1 April 2010 through a sale of the shares in that entity by RBS Holdings N.V. to a holding company called ABN AMRO Group N.V., a newly incorporated entity owned by the Dutch State. The gain on sale for the Dutch State acquired businesses was included within the distribution paid to RFS Holdings, in favour of the Dutch State. This disposal group represented a major line of business and therefore results for the period are presented as results from discontinued operations as a single line item in the consolidated income statement with prior period amounts re-presented. Profits from discontinued operations include the related operating results and if applicable the gain on sale.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           139 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

16 Discontinued operations and assets and liabilities of disposal groups continued 

  

  

  

(b) Assets and liabilities of disposal groups

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

  

  

  

Transfers (1) 

Other (2) 

 Total 

2012 

2011 

 €m 

 €m 

 €m 

€m 

 €m 

Assets of disposal groups

  

  

  

  

  

Cash and balances at central banks

3,565 

306 

Loans and advances to banks

76 

58 

134 

1,278 

987 

Loans and advances to customers

29 

1,299 

1,328 

3,240 

2,440 

Debt securities and equity shares

161 

218 

379 

2,909 

1,502 

Derivatives

154 

— 

154 

1,932 

739 

Other assets

44 

47 

880 

721 

  

426 

1,622 

2,048 

13,804 

6,695 

Liabilities of disposal groups

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits by banks

— 

— 

— 

865 

445 

Customer accounts

106 

99 

205 

7,468 

2,826 

Derivatives

127 

— 

127 

1,902 

1,052 

Other liabilities

67 

75 

791 

970 

  

300 

107 

407 

11,026 

5,293 

 

Notes:

(1)    These assets and liabilities relate largely to businesses which will be transferred to entities outside RBSH Group but within the RBS Group.

(2)    Other assets and liabilities relate to businesses transferring outside of the RBS Group.

 

 

 

As at 31 December 2013 the assets and liabilities of disposal groups related mainly to the Thai business; other assets and liabilities related to certain loan portfolios in the Latin American region, remaining Private Equity portfolios within the Non-Core segment, and the remaining Dutch State acquired businesses.

 

In accordance with the classification of financial instruments in IAS 39, cash and balances at central banks, loans and advances to banks and to customers, deposits by banks and customer accounts and settlement balances included within assets and liabilities of disposal groups are classified as financial instruments at amortised cost.  Derivatives included within assets and liabilities of disposal groups are classified as held-for-trading and measured at fair value. The majority of debt securities and equity shares within assets of disposal groups are either classified as held-for-trading €29 million (2012 - €618 million; 2011 - €1,215 million) or as available-for-sale €161 million (2012 - €1,433 million; 2011 - €110 million) and are measured at fair value. The majority of financial instruments carried at fair value within assets and liabilities of disposal groups at 31 December 2013, 2012 and 2011 are classified as level 2.

 

As at 31 December 2012 the assets and liabilities of disposal groups represented balances of a number of businesses in the Asian region, loan portfolios in the Latin American region and remaining Private Equity portfolios within the Non-Core segment, as well as the remaining Dutch State acquired businesses.

 

As at 31 December 2011 the assets and liabilities of disposal groups represented balances of a number of businesses in the Asian, EMEA and Latin American regions and remaining Private Equity portfolios within the Non-Core segment, as well as the remaining Dutch State acquired businesses. In addition, they included assets and liabilities relating largely to businesses in Singapore, Australia and Kazakhstan, which were transferred to RBS plc during the first half of 2012.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           140 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

 

17 Settlement balances and short positions

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Settlement balances (amortised cost)

83 

73 

2,845 

Short positions (held-for-trading):

  

  

  

  Debt securities

  

  

  

    - Government

— 

— 

42 

    - Other issuers

18 

23 

229 

  Equity shares

11 

293 

  

105 

107 

3,409 

 

18 Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Current taxation

41 

211 

285 

Accruals

42 

42 

199 

Deferred income

110 

111 

835 

Retirement benefit liabilities

20 

— 

62 

Other liabilities

852 

1,418 

2,514 

  

1,065 

1,782 

3,895 

 

Included in other liabilities are the following provisions for liabilities and charges:

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Other 

 

Litigation 

Restructuring 

 Provisions 

 

€m 

€m 

€m 

 

At 1 January 2013

107 

— 

181 

 

Reclassification related to disposal groups/discontinued operations

— 

— 

(4)

 

Currency translation and other movements

(2)

— 

(63)

 

Acquisitions/disposals

— 

— 

(29)

 

Charge to income statement

56 

19 

32 

 

Releases to income statement

(9)

— 

(49)

 

Provisions utilised

(23)

(10)

(15)

 

At 31 December 2013

129 

53 

 

                 

 

Other provisions include tax provisions and other provisions arising in the normal course of business.

 

Arising out of its normal business operations, RBSH Group is party to legal proceedings in the Netherlands, United Kingdom, the United States of America and other jurisdictions. Litigation provisions at 31 December 2013 related to numerous proceedings; no individual provision is material. Detailed descriptions of the Group’s legal proceedings and discussion of the associated uncertainties are given in Note 25.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           141 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

19 Deferred taxation

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Deferred tax asset

(40)

(420)

(444)

Deferred tax liability

63 

40 

201 

Net deferred tax liability/(asset)

23 

(380)

(243)

 

  

  

Accelerated

  

  

Available

  

  

Tax losses

  

  

  

  

capital

  

Revaluations/

-for-sale

  

Cash flow 

 carried 

  

  

  

Pension 

  allowances 

Provisions 

 deferred gains 

 financial assets 

Intangibles 

 hedging 

 forward (1) 

Other 

Total 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

At 1 January 2012

(30)

(2)

(62)

85 

(8)

(5)

(200)

(27)

(243)

Transfers to disposal groups

24 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

(93)

(58)

(Disposal)/acquisition of subsidiaries

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

17 

33 

Charge/(credit) to income statement

47 

(50)

— 

— 

(44)

(20)

(61)

Charge/(credit) to other comprehensive

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

   income

— 

— 

— 

— 

(5)

— 

— 

— 

— 

Currency translation and other

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  adjustments

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

(55)

(51)

At 1 January 2013

(1)

(1)

(3)

35 

— 

— 

(392)

(19)

(380)

Transfers to/from disposal groups

(21)

— 

(27)

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

(43)

(Disposal)/acquisition of subsidiaries

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

(9)

(6)

Settlements with RBS Group

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

311 

— 

311 

Charge/(credit) to income statement

— 

29 

— 

— 

— 

66 

22 

125 

Charge/(credit) to other comprehensive

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

   income

— 

— 

— 

— 

(1)

— 

— 

— 

— 

(1)

Currency translation and other

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  adjustments

— 

(2)

— 

— 

— 

15 

(4)

17 

At 31 December 2013 (2)

(12)

(1)

(21)

62 

— 

— 

— 

— 

(5)

23 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Notes:

(1)    Predominantly relates to losses incurred on UK businesses which were transferred to RBS plc. Under UK tax rules the associated tax losses move to RBS plc as the businesses transfer. RBS Group reimbursed RBSH Group for the value of the losses attached and the transferring businesses. During 2013 €1.4 billion of tax losses transferred – nil during 2012 and €13 billion during 2011.

(2)    Other deferred tax assets are recognised, that depend on the availability of future taxable profits in excess of profits arising from the reversal of other temporary differences. Tax losses in the Netherlands can be carried forward for up to nine years, however business projections prepared for impairment review indicate it is probable that insufficient future taxable income will be available against which to offset these recognised deferred tax assets in respect of the unused tax losses. Therefore these tax assets have been fully impaired. For the remaining deferred tax assets, business projections prepared for impairment reviews indicate that it is probable that sufficient future taxable income will be available against which to offset these recognised deferred tax assets. In jurisdictions where doubt exists over the availability of future taxable profits, deferred tax assets of €2,492 million (2012 - €2,930 million; 2011 - €4,034 million) have not been recognised in respect of tax losses carried forward of €10,052 million (2012 - €11,796 million; 2011 - €17,158 million). Of these losses, €54 million will expire within one year, €1,757 million within five years and €7,064 million thereafter. The balance of tax losses carried forward has no time limit.

 

20 Subordinated liabilities

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

                     €m 

                     €m 

Dated loan capital

2,586 

4,417 

4,526 

Undated loan capital

2,365 

2,434 

2,333 

  

4,951 

6,851 

6,859 

 

On 26 November 2009, RBS Group entered into a State Aid Commitment Deed with HM Treasury of the United Kingdom government (HM Treasury) containing commitments and undertakings given by RBS Group to HM Treasury that are designed to ensure that HM Treasury is able to comply with the commitments given by it to the European Commission for the purpose of obtaining approval for the State Aid provided to RBS Group.

 

As part of these commitments, RBS Group agreed that RBSH Group would not pay investors any coupons on, or exercise any call rights in relation to, existing hybrid capital instruments, unless in any such case there is a legal obligation to do so, for an effective period of two years. The two-year distribution restriction period in relation to the affected securities commenced on 1 April 2011 and ended on 1 April 2013.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           142 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

20 Subordinated liabilities continued 

The following tables analyse the remaining maturity of subordinated liabilities by the final redemption date; and the next call date.

 

  

  

2014 

2015 

2016 - 2018 

2019 - 2023 

Thereafter 

Perpetual 

Total 

2013 - final redemption

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

US dollars

  

— 

409 

407 

227 

110 

2,365 

3,518 

Euro

  

— 

420 

39 

273 

212 

— 

944 

Other

  

— 

— 

489 

— 

— 

— 

489 

Total

  

— 

829 

935 

500 

322 

2,365 

4,951 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Currently 

2014 

2015 

2016 - 2018 

2019 - 2023 

Thereafter 

Perpetual 

Total 

2013 - call date

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

US dollars

2,365 

409 

— 

407 

227 

110 

— 

3,518 

Euro

— 

420 

— 

39 

273 

212 

— 

944 

Other

— 

489 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

489 

Total

2,365 

1,318 

— 

446 

500 

322 

— 

4,951 

 

  

  

2013 

2014 

2015 - 2017   

2018 - 2022  

Thereafter  

Perpetual  

Total  

2012 - final redemption

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

US dollars

  

— 

— 

1,100 

610 

— 

2,434 

4,144 

Euro

  

— 

— 

1,633 

256 

218 

— 

2,107 

Other

  

— 

— 

— 

600 

— 

— 

600 

Total

  

— 

— 

2,733 

1,466 

218 

2,434 

6,851 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Currently  

2013 

2014 

2015 - 2017  

2018 - 2022  

Thereafter  

Perpetual  

Total  

2012 - call date

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

US dollars

3,534 

— 

— 

— 

610 

— 

— 

4,144 

Euro

1,504 

88 

— 

41 

256 

218 

— 

2,107 

Other

— 

600 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

600 

Total

5,038 

688 

— 

41 

866 

218 

— 

6,851 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  

  

2012 

2013 

2014 - 2016  

2017 - 2021  

Thereafter  

Perpetual  

Total  

2011 - final redemption

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

US dollars

  

— 

— 

1,121 

597 

228 

2,333 

4,279 

Euro

  

— 

— 

1,547 

264 

113 

— 

1,924 

Other

  

— 

— 

— 

656 

— 

— 

656 

Total

  

— 

— 

2,668 

1,517 

341 

2,333 

6,859 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Currently  

2012 

2013 

2014 - 2016  

2017 - 2021  

Thereafter  

Perpetual  

Total  

2011 - call date

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

US dollars

3,454 

— 

— 

— 

597 

228 

— 

4,279 

Euro

1,506 

110 

— 

41 

171 

96 

— 

1,924 

Other

— 

— 

606 

— 

50 

— 

— 

656 

Total

4,960 

110 

606 

41 

818 

324 

— 

6,859 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           143 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

20 Subordinated liabilities continued 

 

Dated loan capital

  

  

  

  

  

Capital

2013 

2012 

2011 

treatment

€m 

€m 

€m 

€250 million floating rate subordinated notes 2019

Lower Tier 2

259 

244 

163 

€100 million 5.13% flip flop Bermudan callable subordinated notes 2017 (redeemed July 2013)

Lower Tier 2

88 

93 

€13 million zero coupon subordinated notes (redeemed July 2013)

Lower Tier 2

13 

17 

€170 million floating rate sinkable subordinated notes 2041

Lower Tier 2

212 

204 

96 

€15 million CMS linked floating rate subordinated notes 2020

Lower Tier 2

14 

13 

€415 million (2012 and 2011 - €1,500 million) floating rate Bermudan subordinated notes 2015

 

 

 

 

  (callable quarterly from June 2010; partially redeemed June 2013)

Lower Tier 2

415 

1,499 

1,501 

€5 million floating rate Bermudan callable subordinated notes 2015 (callable quarterly from October 2010)

Lower Tier 2

US$120 million (2011 - US$165 million) 6.14% subordinated notes 2019

Lower Tier 2

85 

92 

91 

US$72 million 5.98% subordinated notes 2019

Lower Tier 2

42 

70 

56 

US$500 million 4.65% subordinated notes 2018

Lower Tier 2

406 

448 

450 

US$564 million (2012 and 2011 - US$1,500 million) floating rate Bermudan callable subordinated notes 2015

 

 

 

 

  (callable quarterly from March 2010; partially redeemed June 2013)

Lower Tier 2

409 

1,100 

1,121 

AUD575 million floating rate Bermudan subordinated notes 2018 (callable quarterly from May 2013)

Lower Tier 2

375 

462 

468 

AUD175 million floating rate Bermudan subordinated notes 2018 (callable quarterly from May 2013)

Lower Tier 2

114 

138 

138 

€26 million 7.42% subordinated notes 2016

Lower Tier 2

31 

32 

32 

€7 million 7.38% subordinated notes 2016

Lower Tier 2

US$136 million (2011 - US$ 250 million) 7.75% fixed rate subordinated notes 2023 (1)

Lower Tier 2

100 

108 

US$150 million 7.13% fixed rate subordinated notes 2093 (1) 

Lower Tier 2

110 

120 

MYR200 million 4.15% subordinated notes 2017 (2) 

Lower Tier 2

50 

  

  

2,586 

4,417 

4,526 

 

 

 

Notes:

(1)   Transferred to liabilities of disposal groups as at 31 December 2012 and from liabilities of disposal groups as at 31 December 2013.

(2)   Transferred to RBS plc during 2012.

 

 

Undated loan capital

 

Capital

2013 

2012 

2011 

treatment

€m 

€m 

€m 

US$1,285 million 5.90% 2049 (callable any time from July 2008)

Tier 1

931 

952 

913 

US$200 million 6.25% 2033 (callable any time from September 2008)

Tier 1

145 

148 

142 

US$1,800 million 6.08% 2033 (callable any time from February 2009)

Tier 1

1,289 

1,334 

1,278 

  

  

2,365 

 2,434 

 2,333 

 

Notes:

(1)    Issued to limited partnerships that have in turn issued partnership preferred securities to trusts that have issued trust preferred securities to investors.  On maturity, the partnerships are required to reinvest in eligible capital instruments issued by the RBSH Group.

(2)    Dividends are non-cumulative. They cannot be declared if RBS Holdings N.V. has not paid dividends on any parity securities. Distributions must be made if RBS Holdings N.V. pays a dividend on its ordinary shares or on its parity securities or redeems or repurchases such securities.

(3)    The trust preferred securities were subject to restrictions on coupon payments as agreed with the European Commission until 1 April 2013 (see page 142).

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           144 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

21 Share capital

 

  

  

  

  

  

Movement in issued and fully paid ordinary shares

Number 

€m 

At 1 January and 31 December 2011

3,306,843,332 

1,852 

Transferred to share premium

(3,306,754,046)

(1,852)

Share issue as a result of the Dutch Scheme

— 

At 31 December 2012 and 2013

89,287 

— 

  

  

  

 

 

The Company’s authorised share capital amounts to €224,000. It is divided into 400,000 ordinary shares, each with a nominal value of €0.56. All issued ordinary shares have been fully paid.

 

The General Meeting of the Shareholders of RBS Holdings N.V. approved on the 29 February 2012 and executed on 21 June 2012, a reduction of the issued capital to €50,000 through a purchase of 3,306,754,046 shares from its shareholder for no consideration followed by a cancellation of those shares, and to reduce its authorised share capital to €224,000.

 

Each ordinary share entitles the holder to cast one vote. Subject to certain exceptions provided for by law or in the articles of association, resolutions are passed by an absolute majority of the votes cast. When shares are issued, each holder of shares shall have pre-emptive right, in proportion to the aggregate amount of their shares, except in the case of an issue of shares for a consideration other than in cash.

 

In the event of the dissolution and liquidation of RBS Holdings N.V., the assets remaining after payment of all debts will be distributed to the holders of ordinary shares on a pro-rata basis.

 

22 Reserves

Share premium reserve

During 2013, the share premium reserve was reduced by €0.2 billion as a result of a cross border merger.

 

During 2012 the capital reduction described in Note 21 increased share premium by €1.9 billion.  It was then reduced by €0.9 billion as a result of the Dutch Scheme.

 

As a part of the Dutch Scheme one share was issued against the share premium account.

 

Ordinary shares carry certain pre-emption rights and rank equally in voting, dividend and liquidation rights.

 

Dutch law prescribes that only the freely distributable reserves of the company are taken into account for the purpose of making distributions and in determining the permissible applications of the share premium account. RBSH Group optimises capital efficiency by maintaining reserves in subsidiaries, including regulated entities. The remittance of reserves to the company or the redemption of capital by regulated entities may be subject to maintaining the capital resources required by the relevant regulator.

 

23 Structured entities and asset transfers

Structured entities

A structured entity (SE) is an entity that has been designed such that voting or similar rights are not the dominant factor in deciding who controls the entity, for example when any voting rights relate to administrative tasks only and the relevant activities are directed by means of contractual arrangements. SEs are usually established for a specific, limited purpose, they do not carry out a business or trade and typically have no employees. They take a variety of legal forms - trusts, partnerships and companies - and fulfil many different functions. As well as being a key element of securitisations, SEs are also used in fund management activities to segregate custodial duties from the fund management advice.

 

RBSH Group applies IFRS 10 ‘Consolidated Financial Statements’ in determining whether or not to consolidate an SE. Entities, including SEs, are consolidated where RBSH Group has power over the investee; exposure, or rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the entity; and the ability to use its power over the entity to affect the amount of RBSH Group’s returns.

 

Consolidated structured entities

Securitisations

In a securitisation, assets, or interests in a pool of assets, are transferred generally to a SE which then issues liabilities to third party investors. The majority of securitisations are supported through liquidity facilities or other credit enhancements. RBSH Group arranges securitisations to facilitate client transactions such as commercial paper conduits and undertakes own asset securitisations to sell or to fund portfolios of financial assets. RBSH Group also acts as an underwriter and depositor in securitisation transactions in both client and proprietary transactions.

 

RBSH Group’s involvement in client securitisations takes a number of forms. It may: sponsor or administer a securitisation programme; provide liquidity facilities or programme-wide credit enhancement; and purchase securities issued by the vehicle.

 

Own asset securitisations

In own-asset securitisations, the pool of assets held by the SE is either originated by RBSH Group, or (in the case of whole loan programmes) purchased from third parties.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           145 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

23 Structured entities and asset transfers continued

Synthetic securitisations

RBSH Group’s securitisations portfolio comprised own originated programs as well as sponsor and investor positions. The legacy, own originated ‘Basel I’ programs were structured to provide Basel I related capital relief. Since June 2010, under Basel II, these programs no longer provide any relief. Most of the legacy programs were unwound in the course of 2010 and 2011. There were no synthetic securitisations in 2013 or 2012 (2011 - €0.3 billion).

 

Unconsolidated structured entities

RBSH Group’s interests in unconsolidated structured entities are analysed below.

 

 

 

 

 

 

Asset backed 

 

 

 

2013

Securitisation  

 

 

 

vehicles - 

Investment 

 

 

not sponsored 

funds 

Other 

Total 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Held-for-trading

 

 

 

 

Loans and advances to customers

— 

— 

Debt securities

— 

— 

125 

125 

Equity shares

— 

41 

— 

41 

Derivaitive assets

— 

— 

66 

66 

Derivatives liabilities

— 

— 

(5)

(5)

Total

— 

41 

192 

233 

 

 

 

 

 

Other than held-for-trading

 

 

 

 

Loans and advances to customers

— 

31 

— 

31 

Debt securities

5,758 

— 

52 

5,810 

Total

5,758 

31 

52 

5,841 

 

 

 

 

 

Total exposure

5,758 

72 

244 

6,074 

 

Notes:

(1)    Income from interests in unconsolidated structured entities includes interest receivable, changes in fair value, and other income less impairments that may be required.

(2)    A sponsored entity is a structured entity, established by RBSH Group where RBSH Group provides liquidity and/or credit enhancements or provides ongoing services to the entity. RBSH Group can act as sponsor for its own or for customers’ transactions.

 

 

Transfers that do not qualify for derecognition

Asset transfers

Under IAS 39 a financial asset is transferred if RBSH Group either (a) transfers the contractual rights to receive the asset's cash flows; or (b) retains the right to the asset's cash flows but assumes a contractual obligation to pay those cash flows to a third party. Following a transfer the financial asset will be derecognised; not derecognised and retained in full on RBSH Group’s balance sheet; continue to be recognised on the balance sheet to the extent of RBSH Group’s continuing involvement.

 

Securities repurchase agreements and lending transactions

RBSH Group enters into securities repurchase agreements and securities lending transactions under which it transfers securities in accordance with normal market practice.

 

Generally, the agreements require additional collateral to be provided if the value of the securities falls below a predetermined level. Under standard terms for repurchase transactions in the UK and US markets, the recipient of collateral has an unrestricted right to sell or repledge it, subject to returning equivalent securities on settlement of the transaction.

 

Securities sold under such repurchase transactions are not derecognised if RBSH Group retains substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership. The fair value (and carrying value) of debt securities transferred under repurchase transactions included on the balance sheet was €12.4 billion (2012 - €10.9  billion; 2011 - €17.3 billion). Securities received as collateral under reverse repurchase agreements amounted to €0.1 billion (2012 - €0.1 billion; 2011 - €9.4 billion), of which €0.1 billion (2012 - €0.1 billion; 2011 - €8.9 billion) had been sold or repledged as collateral of RBSH Group’s own transactions.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           146 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

23 Structured entities and asset transfers continued

Assets pledged as collateral

RBSH Group pledges collateral with its counterparties in respect of bank and other borrowings. This primarily relates to assets pledged for bank and other borrowings.

 

Assets pledged against liabilities

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Loans and advances to banks

804 

1,510 

1,986 

Loans and advances to customers

954 

1,428 

1,266 

Debt securities

246 

9,648 

329 

 

2,004

12,586

3,581

  

  

  

  

Liabilities secured by assets

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Deposits by banks

— 

3,557 

28 

Debt securities in issue

501 

867 

636 

Derivatives

5,824 

9,473 

          19,055 

 

              6,325

            13,897

             19,719

 

24 Capital resources

  

  

  

RBSH Group's regulatory capital resources were as follows:

  

  

  

Composition of regulatory capital

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Tier 1

  

  

  

Controlling interests

2,942 

1,799 

3,395 

Non-controlling interests

— 

— 

21 

Adjustment for:

  

  

  

  - Goodwill and other intangible assets

(1)

(4)

(10)

  - Unrealised losses on available-for-sale debt securities

883 

2,492 

3,066 

  - Unrealised gains on available-for-sale equities

(3)

(19)

(148)

  - Other regulatory adjustments

(260)

(442)

(1,298)

Core Tier 1 capital

3,561 

3,826 

5,026 

Innovative/hybrid Tier 1 securities

2,365 

2,470 

2,511 

Less deductions from Tier 1 capital

(1,887)

(1,757)

(475)

Total Tier 1 capital

4,039 

4,539 

7,062 

  

  

  

  

Tier 2

  

  

  

Unrealised gains on available-for-sale equities

19 

148 

Subordinated debt

1,552 

3,218 

3,699 

Less deductions from Tier 2 capital

(1,061)

(1,303)

(639)

Total Tier 2 capital

494 

1,934 

3,208 

  

  

  

  

Total regulatory capital

4,533 

6,473 

10,270 

 

It is RBSH Group’s policy to maintain an appropriate capital base, to expand it as appropriate and to utilise it efficiently throughout its activities to optimise the return to shareholders, while maintaining a prudent relationship between the capital base and the underlying risks of the business. In carrying out this policy, RBSH Group has regard to the supervisory requirements of DNB. DNB uses Capital Ratios as a measure of capital adequacy in the Dutch banking sector, comparing a bank’s capital resources with its risk-weighted assets (RWAs) (the assets and off-balance sheet exposures are weighted to reflect the inherent credit and other risks). RBSH Group has complied with it’s capital requirements during the year.

 

A number of subsidiaries and sub-groups within the RBSH Group are subject to various individual regulatory capital requirements in the UK and overseas. Furthermore, the payment of dividends by subsidiaries and the ability of members of the RBSH Group to lend money to other members of the RBSH Group may be subject to restrictions such as local regulatory or legal requirements, the availability of reserves and financial and operating performance.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           147 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

25 Memorandum items

Contingent liabilities and commitments

The amounts shown in the table below are intended only to provide an indication of the volume of business outstanding at 31 December 2013. Although RBSH Group is exposed to credit risk in the event of non-performance of the obligations undertaken by customers, the amounts shown do not, and are not intended to, provide any indication of RBSH Group's expectation of future losses.

 

  

  

More than 

More than 

  

  

  

  

  

1 year but 

3 years but 

  

  

  

  

Less than 

less than 

less than 

Over 

  

  

  

1 year 

3 years 

5 years 

5 years 

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Contingent liabilities:

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Guarantees and assets pledged as collateral security

947 

466 

1,408 

4,063 

6,884 

10,070 

20,903 

Other contingent liabilities

423 

11 

1,138 

— 

1,572 

1,009 

2,294 

  

1,370 

477 

2,546 

4,063 

8,456 

11,079 

23,197 

Commitments:

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Undrawn formal standby facilities, credit lines

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  and other commitments to lend

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  - less than one year

497 

— 

— 

— 

497 

1,990 

2,918 

  - one year and over

— 

250 

64 

36 

350 

3,004 

19,359 

Other commitments

116 

— 

125 

712 

101 

  

613 

251 

72 

36 

972 

5,706 

22,378 

 

 

 

Banking commitments and contingent obligations, which have been entered into on behalf of customers and for which there are corresponding obligations from customers, are not included in assets and liabilities. RBSH Group's maximum exposure to credit loss, in the event of non-performance by the other party and where all counterclaims, collateral or security proves valueless, is represented by the contractual nominal amount of these instruments included in the table above. These commitments and contingent obligations are subject to RBSH Group's normal credit approval processes.

 

Contingent liabilities

Guarantees – RBSH Group gives guarantees on behalf of customers. A financial guarantee represents an irrevocable undertaking that RBSH Group will meet a customer's obligations to third parties if the customer fails to do so. The maximum amount that RBSH Group could be required to pay under a guarantee is its principal amount as disclosed in the table above. RBSH Group expects most guarantees it provides to expire unused.

 

Other contingent liabilities – these include standby letters of credit, supporting customer debt issues and contingent liabilities relating to customer trading activities such as those arising from performance and customs bonds, warranties and indemnities. In the normal course of business, liabilities and contingent liabilities arise in respect of RBSH Group’s tax position in the various jurisdictions in which it operates. RBSH Group makes provision for any liabilities in accordance with its accounting policy for provisions (see page 98). Estimating the financial effect of certain contingent tax liabilities, for which the possibility of any outflow in settlement is remote and not probable, is not practicable.

 

Also included within contingent liabilities as at 31 December 2013 is €4.0 billion (2012 - €4.0 billion) which relates to RBSH Group’s obligations over liabilities held within the Dutch State acquired businesses included in the new ABN AMRO Bank N.V. On the division of an entity by demerger, Dutch law establishes a cross liability between surviving entities in respect of the creditors at the time of the demerger. RBSH Group’s cross liability is limited by law to the lower of its equity and the eligible debts of ABN AMRO Bank N.V. on 6 February 2010. The likelihood of any cross liability crystallising is considered remote.

 

Commitments

Commitments to lend - under a loan commitment RBSH Group agrees to make funds available to a customer in the future. Loan commitments, which are usually for a specified term may be unconditionally cancellable or may persist, provided all conditions in the loan facility are satisfied or waived. Commitments to lend include commercial standby facilities and credit lines, liquidity facilities to commercial paper conduits and unutilised overdraft facilities.

 

Other commitments - these include documentary credits, which are commercial letters of credit providing for payment by RBSH Group to a named beneficiary against presentation of specified documents, forward asset purchases, forward deposits placed and undrawn note issuance and revolving underwriting facilities, and other short-term trade related transactions.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           148 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

25 Memorandum items continued 

  

  

  

Contractual obligations for future expenditure not provided in the accounts

  

  

  

The following table shows contractual obligations for future expenditure not provided for in the accounts at the year end.

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Operating leases

  

  

  

Minimum rentals payable under non-cancellable leases (1) 

  

  

  

Within 1 year

27 

29 

81 

After 1 year but within 5 years

36 

48 

154 

After 5 years

26 

30 

272 

Total

89 

107 

507 

 

Note:

(1)    Predominantly property leases.

 

 

 

Litigation, investigations and reviews

Arising out of their normal business operations, RBS Group and certain RBS Group members are party to legal proceedings and the subject of investigation and other regulatory and governmental action in the Netherlands, the United Kingdom, the United States and other jurisdictions.

 

RBSH Group recognises a provision for a liability in relation to these matters when it is probable that an outflow of economic benefits will be required to settle an obligation resulting from past events, and a reliable estimate can be made of the amount of the obligation. While the outcome of the legal proceedings, investigations and regulatory and governmental matters in which RBSH Group is involved is inherently uncertain, the directors believe that, based on the information available to them, appropriate provisions have been made in respect of legal proceedings, investigations and regulatory and governmental matters as at 31 December 2013 (see Note 18).  The future outflow of resources in respect of any matter may ultimately prove to be substantially greater than or less than the aggregate provision that RBSH Group has recognised.

 

In many proceedings, it is not possible to determine whether any loss is probable or to estimate the amount of any loss. Numerous legal and factual issues may need to be resolved, including through potentially lengthy discovery and determination of important factual matters, and by addressing novel or unsettled legal questions relevant to the proceedings in question, before a liability can be reasonably estimated for any claim. The RBS Group cannot predict if, how, or when such claims will be resolved or what the eventual settlement, fine, penalty or other relief, if any, may be, particularly for claims that are at an early stage in their development or where claimants seek substantial or indeterminate damages.

 

There are also situations where the RBS Group may enter into a settlement agreement. This may occur in order to avoid the expense, management distraction or reputational implications of continuing to contest liability, even for those matters for which the RBS Group believes it has credible defences and should prevail on the merits. The uncertainties inherent in all such matters affect the amount and timing of any potential outflows for both matters with respect to which provisions have been established and other contingent liabilities. RBSH Group may not be directly involved in all of the following litigation, investigations and reviews but due to the potential implications to the RBS Group of such litigation, investigations and reviews, if a final outcome is adverse to RBS Group it may also have an adverse effect on RBSH Group

 

Other than those discussed below, no member of the RBSH Group is or has been involved in governmental, legal or regulatory proceedings (including those which are pending or threatened) that are material individually or in aggregate.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           149 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

25 Memorandum items continued 

Litigation

Madoff

In December 2010, Irving Picard, as trustee for the bankruptcy estates of Bernard L. Madoff and Bernard L. Madoff Investment Securities LLC, filed a clawback claim against RBS N.V. in New York bankruptcy court.  In the operative complaint, filed in August 2012, the trustee seeks to recover US$75.8 million in redemptions that RBS N.V. allegedly received from certain Madoff feeder funds and US$162.1 million that RBS N.V. allegedly received from its swap counterparties at a time when RBS N.V. allegedly ‘knew or should have known of Madoff’s possible fraud.’ The Trustee alleges that those transfers were preferences or fraudulent conveyances under the US bankruptcy code and New York law and he asserts the purported right to claw them back for the benefit of Madoff’s estate. A further claim, for US$21.8 million, was filed in October 2011.  

  

London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR)

Certain members of RBS Group have been named as defendants in a number of class actions and individual claims filed in the US with respect to the setting of LIBOR and certain other benchmark interest rates. The complaints are substantially similar and allege that certain members of RBS Group and other panel banks individually and collectively violated various federal laws, including the US commodities and antitrust laws, and state statutory and common law, as well as contracts, by manipulating LIBOR and prices of LIBOR-based derivatives in various markets through various means.

 

Most of the USD LIBOR-related actions in which RBS Group companies are defendants, including all purported class actions relating to USD LIBOR, have been transferred to a coordinated proceeding in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York.  In the coordinated proceeding, consolidated class action complaints were filed on behalf of (1) exchange-based purchaser plaintiffs, (2) over-the-counter purchaser plaintiffs, and (3) corporate debt purchaser plaintiffs. On 29 March 2013, the Court dismissed plaintiffs' antitrust claims, claims under RICO (Racketeer Influenced and Corrupt Organizations Act), and certain state law claims, but declined to dismiss certain other claims.  Discovery is stayed.  Over 35 other USD LIBOR-related actions involving RBS Group have been stayed pending further order from the Court.

 

Certain members of RBS Group have also been named as defendants in class actions relating to (i) JPY LIBOR and Euroyen TIBOR (the "Yen action") and (ii) Euribor (the "Euribor action"), both of which are pending in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York. On 28 March 2014, the court in the Yen action dismissed the plaintiffs’ antitrust claims, but refused to dismiss their claims under the Commodity Exchange Act for price manipulation.

  

World Online

In November 2009, the Supreme Court in the Netherlands issued a declaratory judgment against World Online International N.V. (World Online), Goldman Sachs International and ABN AMRO Bank N.V. (now RBS N.V.) in relation to claims arising out of the World Online initial public offering of 2000. It held that these defendants had committed certain wrongful acts in connection with the initial public offering. The judgment did not establish liability or the amount of any loss. The defendant banks have paid settlement sums to certain investors and are in discussions regarding claims of other investors. A potential claim brought to RBSH Group's attention in December 2011 on behalf of a group of individuals linked to a company acquired by World Online in 2000. RBSH Group does not believe that such settlements or any final liability or loss will have a material adverse effect on RBSH Group's financial position or profitability.

 

Complex Systems

RBS N.V. is a defendant in an action pending in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York filed by Complex Systems, Inc (CSI). The plaintiff alleges that RBS N.V. has since late 2007 been using the plaintiff's back-office trade finance processing software without a valid licence, in violation of the US Copyright Act. On 17 October 2013, the Court granted summary judgment to CSI on the issue of liability. The plaintiff was seeking in excess of US$ 300 million in alleged profits that the plaintiff claimed was attributable to RBS N.V’s use of the disputed software, but on 8 November 2013, the Court barred the plaintiff from recovering any such profits although the plaintiff continues to seek actual damages of an unspecified amount. On 25 October 2013, the plaintiff filed a motion for a permanent injunction against RBS N.V.’s further use of the software, and a hearing on that motion, which RBS N.V. opposes, took place on 14 March 2014 and 7 April 2014.

 

CPDO Litigation

CPDO claims have been served on RBS N.V. in England, the Netherlands and Australia relating to the sale of a type of structured financial product known as a constant proportion debt obligation (CPDO). In November 2012, the Federal Court of Australia issued a judgment against RBS N.V. and others in one such case.  It held that RBS N.V. and others committed certain wrongful acts in connection with the rating and sale of the CPDO.  In March 2013, RBS N.V. was ordered to pay A$19.7 million.  RBS N.V. has appealed this decision and the appeal was heard in March 2014.  Judgment is awaited. The judgment may potentially have significance to the other claims served and to any future similar claims.

 

RiverCity

In 2005 RBS Group (Australia) Pty Ltd (“RBSGA”), previously ABN AMRO Australia Pty Limited,  a member of the RBSH Group, was a member of a consortium that appointed AECOM Australia Pty Ltd (formerly known as Maunsell Australia Pty Ltd) ("AECOM") to forecast traffic for the Clem7 Tunnel in Brisbane, Australia. Three sets of proceedings have been brought against AECOM.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           150 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

25 Memorandum items continued 

The first (Hopkins v AECOM) is a class action relating to the initial public offer of units to retail investors in the RiverCity Motorway Group, which operated the Clem7 Tunnel. The claim relates to allegations that the IPO disclosure was defective, particularly in relation to traffic volume forecasts by AECOM. The second and third proceedings (RiverCity v AECOM and Portigon v AECOM), involve claims of negligent misstatement and misleading or deceptive conduct in the issuance of traffic forecasts. In all three proceedings AECOM has filed a number of cross-claims for contribution in the event it is found liable, including against RBSGA. 

 

Credit Default Swap Antitrust Litigation

Certain members of RBS Group, as well as a number of other financial institutions, are defendants in a consolidated antitrust class action pending in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York.  The plaintiffs generally allege that defendants violated the U.S. antitrust laws by restraining competition in the market for credit default swaps through various means and thereby causing inflated bid-ask spreads for credit default swaps. 

 

Investigations and reviews

RBSH Group’s businesses and financial condition can be affected by the fiscal or other policies and actions of various governmental and regulatory authorities in the Netherlands, the United Kingdom, the European Union, the United States and elsewhere. RBSH Group has engaged, and will continue to engage, in discussions with relevant governmental and regulatory authorities, including in the United Kingdom, the European Union, the United States and elsewhere,  on an ongoing and regular basis regarding operational, systems and control evaluations and issues including those related to compliance with applicable anti-bribery, anti-money laundering and sanctions regimes. It is possible that any matters discussed or identified may result in investigatory or other action being taken by governmental and regulatory authorities, increased costs being incurred by RBSH Group, remediation of systems and controls, public or private censure, restriction of RBSH Group’s business activities or fines. Any of the events or circumstances mentioned below could have a material adverse effect on RBSH Group, its business, authorisations and licences, reputation, results of operations or the price of securities issued by it.

 

RBSH Group is co-operating fully with the investigations and reviews described below.

 

LIBOR, other trading rates and foreign exchange trading

On 6 February 2013 RBS Group announced settlements with the Financial Services Authority in the United Kingdom, the United States Commodity Futures Trading Commission and the United States Department of Justice (DOJ) in relation to investigations into submissions, communications and procedures around the setting of the London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR).  RBS Group agreed to pay penalties of £87.5 million, US$325 million and US$150 million to these authorities respectively to resolve the investigations. As part of the agreement with the DOJ, RBS plc entered into a Deferred Prosecution Agreement in relation to one count of wire fraud relating to Swiss Franc LIBOR and one count for an antitrust violation relating to Yen LIBOR.  In addition, on 12 April 2013, RBS Securities Japan Limited entered a plea of guilty to one count of wire fraud relating to Yen LIBOR and on 6 January 2014, the US District Court for the District of Connecticut entered a final judgment in relation to the conviction of RBS Securities Japan Limited pursuant to the plea agreement.  On 12 April 2013, RBS Securities Japan Limited received a business improvement order from Japan’s Financial Services Agency requiring RBS to take remedial steps to address certain matters, including inappropriate conduct in relation to Yen LIBOR.  RBS Securities Japan Limited is taking steps to address the issues raised in compliance with that order.  In June 2013, RBS plc was listed amongst the 20 banks found by the Monetary Authority of Singapore (MAS) to have deficiencies in the governance, risk management, internal controls and surveillance systems relating to benchmark submissions following a finding by the MAS that certain traders made inappropriate attempts to influence benchmarks in the period 2007 – 2011.  RBS plc was ordered at that time to set aside additional statutory reserves with MAS of SGD1-1.2 billion and to formulate a remediation plan.  RBS plc has submitted its remediation plan to the MAS.

 

RBS Group is co-operating with investigations and new and ongoing requests for information by various other governmental and regulatory authorities, including in the UK, US and Asia, into its submissions, communications and procedures relating to a number of trading rates, including LIBOR and other interest rate settings, ISDAFIX and non-deliverable forwards. RBS Group is also under investigation by competition authorities in a number of jurisdictions stemming from the actions of certain individuals in the setting of LIBOR and other trading rates, as well as interest rate-related trading. 

 

In February 2014, RBS Group paid settlement penalties of approximately EUR 260 million and EUR 131 million to resolve investigations by the European Commission into Yen LIBOR competition infringements and EURIBOR competition infringements respectively. 

 

In addition, various governmental and regulatory authorities have commenced investigations into foreign exchange trading activities apparently involving multiple financial institutions.  RBS Group has received enquiries from certain of these authorities including the FCA.  RBS Group is reviewing communications and procedures relating to certain currency exchange benchmark rates as well as foreign exchange trading activity. At this stage, RBS Group cannot estimate reliably what effect, if any, the outcome of the investigation may have on RBS Group or RBSH Group.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           151 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

25 Memorandum items continued 

Governance and risk management consent order

On 27 July 2011, RBS Group agreed with the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, the New York State Banking Department, the Connecticut Department of Banking, and the Illinois Department of Financial and Professional Regulation to enter into a consent Cease and Desist Order (the Order) to address deficiencies related to governance, risk management and compliance systems and controls in RBS plc and RBS N.V. branches.  In the Order, RBS Group agreed to create the following written plans or programmes: 

 

·           a plan to strengthen board and senior management oversight of the corporate governance, management, risk management, and operations of RBS Group’s U.S. operations on an enterprise-wide and business line basis,

·         an enterprise-wide risk management programme for RBS Group’s U.S. operations,

·         a plan to oversee compliance by RBS Group’s U.S. operations with all applicable U.S. laws, rules, regulations, and supervisory guidance,

·         a Bank Secrecy Act/anti-money laundering compliance programme for the RBS plc and RBS N.V. branches in the U.S. (the U.S. Branches) on a consolidated basis,

·         a plan to improve the U.S. Branches’ compliance with all applicable provisions of the Bank Secrecy Act and its rules and regulations as well as the requirements of Regulation K of the Federal Reserve,

·         a customer due diligence programme designed to reasonably ensure the identification and timely, accurate, and complete reporting by the U.S. Branches of all known or suspected violations of law or suspicious transactions to law enforcement and supervisory authorities, as required by applicable suspicious activity reporting laws and regulations, and

·         a plan designed to enhance the U.S. Branches’ compliance with OFAC requirements. 

 

The Order (which is publicly available) identified specific items to be addressed, considered, and included in each proposed plan or programme.  RBS Group also agreed in the Order to adopt and implement the plans and programmes after approval by the regulators, to fully comply with the plans and programmes thereafter, and to submit to the regulators periodic written progress reports regarding compliance with the Order.  RBS Group has created, submitted, and adopted plans and/or programmes to address each of the areas identified above.  In connection with RBS Group's efforts to implement these plans and programmes, it has, among other things, made investments in technology, hired and trained additional personnel, and revised compliance, risk management, and other policies and procedures for RBS Group's U.S. operations.  RBS Group continues to test the effectiveness of the remediation efforts undertaken by RBS Group to ensure they are sustainable and meet regulators' expectations.  Furthermore, RBS Group continues to work closely with the regulators in its efforts to fulfil its obligations under the Order, which will remain in effect until terminated by the regulators.

 

RBS Group may become subject to formal and informal supervisory actions and may be required by its US banking supervisors to take further actions and implement additional remedial measures with respect to these and additional matters. RBS Group's activities in the United States may be subject to significant limitations and/or conditions.

 

US dollar processing consent order

RBS Group’s operations include businesses outside the United States that are responsible for processing US dollar payments.  On 11 December 2013 RBS Group and RBS plc announced that they had reached a settlement with the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (Fed), the New York State Department of Financial Services (DFS), and the Office of Foreign Assets Control (OFAC) with respect to RBS plc's historical compliance with US economic sanction regulations outside the US.  In settlement with the above authorities, RBS plc agreed to pay US$100 million in total, including US$50 million to the Fed, of which US$33 million was deemed to satisfy the OFAC penalty, and US$50 million to DFS. 

 

As part of the settlement, RBS Group and RBS plc entered into a consent Cease and Desist Order with the Fed (the Order) indicating, among other things, that: (a) RBS Group and RBS plc lacked adequate risk management and legal review policies and procedures to ensure that activities conducted outside the United States comply with applicable OFAC regulations; (b) from at least 2005 to 2008, certain business lines within RBS plc developed and implemented policies and procedures for processing U.S. dollar-denominated funds transfers through unaffiliated U.S. financial institutions involving parties subject to OFAC Regulations that omitted relevant information from payment messages necessary for the U.S. financial institutions to determine whether these transactions were carried out in a manner consistent with U.S. law; and (c) RBS Group continues to implement improvements in its oversight and compliance programme for activities involving offices outside the United States that impact the ability of U.S. financial institutions to comply with applicable OFAC sanctions.  In the Order (which is publicly available), RBS Group agreed to create an OFAC compliance programme to ensure compliance with OFAC regulations by the RBS Group's global business lines outside of the United States, and to adopt, implement, and comply with the programme.  The programme has now been submitted to the Federal Reserve Bank of Boston (Reserve Bank) for approval. 

 

Sixty days after approval of the programme, RBS Group is to complete a global OFAC risk assessment and submit it to the Reserve Bank and the FCA.  RBS Group also agreed in the Order to hire an independent consultant (subject to approval by the Reserve Bank and the FCA) to conduct an annual OFAC compliance review involving a review of compliance policies and their implementation and an appropriate risk-focused sampling of U.S. dollar payments.  The Order further requires RBS Group to submit quarterly written progress reports to the Reserve Bank detailing the form and manner of all actions taken to secure compliance with the Order.

 

It was also announced that the US Department of Justice and the New York County District Attorney’s Office had concluded their parallel criminal investigations and do not intend to take any action against RBS plc.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           152 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

26 Changes in operating assets and liabilities

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Decrease in loans and advances to banks and customers

5,885 

31,865 

7,945 

Decrease in securities

789 

4,796 

20,289 

(Increase)/decrease in other assets

(32)

6,644 

5,540 

Decrease in derivative assets

4,464 

10,402 

8,395 

Changes in operating assets

11,106 

53,707 

42,169 

(Decrease)/increase in deposits by banks and customers

(12,418)

(40,615)

918 

Decrease in debt securities in issue

(1,337)

(14,175)

(35,697)

Decrease in other liabilities

(289)

(1,065)

(2,784)

Decrease in derivative liabilities

(5,328)

(9,366)

(14,753)

Decrease in settlement balances and short positions

(7)

(3,662)

(1,400)

Changes in operating liabilities

(19,379)

(68,883)

(53,716)

Charges in operating assets and liabilities

(8,273)

(15,176)

(11,547)

 

27 Interest received and paid

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Interest received

502 

1,320 

2,589 

Interest paid

(582)

(1,162)

(1,930)

  

(80)

158 

659 

 

28 Analysis of cash and cash equivalents

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

At 1 January

  

  

  

  - cash

8,660 

17,252 

17,203 

  - cash equivalents

1,370 

9,792 

9,855 

  

10,030 

27,044 

27,058 

Net cash outflow

(4,672)

(17,014)

(14)

At 31 December

5,358 

10,030 

27,044 

  

  

  

  

Comprising:

  

  

  

Cash and balances at central banks

3,199 

5,859 

12,915 

Loans and advances to banks (1)

2,145 

4,132 

11,711 

Treasury bills and debt securities

14 

39 

2,418 

Cash and cash equivalents

5,358 

10,030 

27,044 

 

Note:

(1)    Includes cash collateral posted with bank counterparties in respect of derivative liabilities of €804 million (2012 - €1,510 million).

 

 

RBSH Group had mandatory reserve deposits with central banks of €73 million (2012 - €165 million; 2011 - €1,439 million).

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           153 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

29 Segmental analysis

(a) Divisions

The directors manage RBSH Group by class of business and present the segmental analysis on that basis. This includes the review of net interest income for each class of business - interest receivable and payable for all reportable segments is therefore presented net. Segments charge market prices for services rendered to other parts of RBSH Group. The segment measure is operating profit/(loss).

 

RBSH Group's reportable segments are as follows:

 

Markets is an origination, sales and trading business across debt finance, fixed income and currencies. The division offers a unified service to RBSH Group’s corporate and institutional clients. The Markets’ origination, sales and research teams build strong ongoing client partnerships, provide market perspective and access, and work with the division’s trading and structuring teams to meet the client’s objectives across financing, risk management, investment, securitisation and liquidity.

 

International Banking provides financing, transaction services and risk management. It serves as the delivery channel for Markets products to international corporate clients.

 

Central Functions comprises RBSH Group and corporate functions, such as treasury, finance, risk management, legal, communications and human resources. The Centre manages RBSH Group’s capital resources and provides services to the operating divisions.

 

Non-Core managed separately assets that RBSH Group intended to run off or dispose of. It also includes the remaining assets and liabilities in RBS N.V. that have not yet been sold, wound down or transferred to the Consortium Members, referred to as 'Shared Assets', in which each of the consortium shareholders has a joint and indirect interest.

 

 

2013 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Operating 

Net interest 

Non-interest 

Total 

Operating 

Depreciation and 

Impairment 

 profit/(loss) 

 income 

 income 

 income 

 expenses 

  amortisation 

 losses 

before tax 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Markets

35 

239 

274 

(189)

(4)

(58)

23 

International Banking

77 

87 

164 

(176)

(12)

(18)

Central items

(12)

(233)

(245)

(68)

— 

(46)

(359)

Core

100 

93 

193 

(433)

(16)

(98)

(354)

Non-Core

138 

106 

244 

(83)

(5)

56 

212 

  

238 

199 

437 

(516)

(21)

(42)

(142)

 

2012 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Markets

142 

70 

212 

(668)

(12)

(35)

(503)

International Banking

280 

444 

724 

(533)

(33)

24 

182 

Central items

(34)

(396)

(430)

(82)

— 

(23)

(535)

Core

388 

118 

506 

(1,283)

(45)

(34)

(856)

Non-Core

217 

(15)

202 

(194)

(8)

(31)

(31)

  

605 

103 

708 

(1,477)

(53)

(65)

(887)

 

2011 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Markets

66 

2,589 

2,655 

(1,199)

(61)

(53)

1,342 

International Banking

490 

548 

1,038 

(665)

(80)

(212)

81 

Central items

(110)

407 

297 

(104)

— 

(1,463)

(1,270)

Core

446 

3,544 

3,990 

(1,968)

(141)

(1,728)

153 

Non-Core

242 

(226)

16 

(291)

(27)

(37)

(339)

  

688 

3,318 

4,006 

(2,259)

(168)

(1,765)

(186)

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           154 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

29 Segmental analysis continued 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

  

2012 

  

2011 

 

External 

Inter segment 

Total 

 

External 

Inter segment 

Total 

 

External 

Inter segment 

Total 

Total income

€m 

€m 

€m 

 

€m 

€m 

€m 

 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Markets

320 

(46)

274 

  

35 

177 

212 

  

2,689 

(34)

2,655 

International Banking

255 

(91)

164 

  

752 

(28)

724 

  

1,102 

(64)

1,038 

Central items

(376)

131 

(245)

  

(319)

(111)

(430)

  

139 

158 

297 

Core

199 

(6)

193 

  

468 

38 

506 

  

3,930 

60 

3,990 

Non-Core

238 

244 

  

240 

(38)

202 

  

76 

(60)

16 

  

437 

— 

437 

  

708 

— 

708 

  

4,006 

— 

4,006 

 

 

2013 

  

2012 

  

2011 

Total assets

  

  

Cost to  

  

  

  

Cost to 

  

  

  

Cost to 

  

  

acquire fixed  

  

  

acquire fixed 

  

  

acquire fixed 

  

  

assets and  

  

  

assets and 

  

  

assets and 

  

  

intangible  

  

  

intangible 

  

  

intangible 

Assets  

Liabilities  

 assets    

Assets 

Liabilities 

   assets 

Assets 

Liabilities 

   assets 

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Markets

14,801 

14,585 

  

30,363 

30,363 

14 

  

71,665 

71,645 

53 

International Banking

1,586 

1,863 

  

4,312 

4,312 

33 

  

23,900 

23,899 

18 

Central items

16,106 

13,567 

  

28,492 

26,693 

— 

  

38,648 

35,884 

27 

Core

32,493 

30,015 

  

63,167 

61,368 

47 

  

134,213 

131,428 

98 

Non-Core

6,717 

6,379 

— 

  

7,179 

7,179 

  

12,034 

11,552 

  

39,210 

36,394 

  

70,346 

68,547 

54 

  

146,247 

142,980 

107 

Reconciling items

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Dutch State acquired businesses/private equity

598 

472 

— 

  

608 

608 

— 

  

529 

380 

— 

  

39,808 

36,866 

  

70,954 

69,155 

54 

  

146,776 

143,360 

107 

                         

 

(b) Geographical segments

The geographical analyses in the tables below have been compiled on the basis of location of office where the transactions are recorded.

 

2013 

Netherlands 

UK 

RoW

Total 

€m 

€m 

€m

€m 

Net interest income

(1)

237 

238 

Net fees and commissions

(24)

18 

76 

70 

Income from trading activities

(127)

33 

140 

46 

Other operating (loss)/income

(115)

29 

169 

83 

Total income

(267)

82 

622 

437 

  

  

  

  

  

Operating (loss)/profit before tax

(363)

11 

210 

(142)

Total assets

17,704 

6,183 

15,921 

39,808 

Total liabilities

14,762 

6,183 

15,921 

36,866 

Net assets attributable to equity owners

2,942 

— 

— 

2,942 

Contingent liabilities and commitments

7,024 

59 

2,345 

9,428 

Cost to acquire property, plant and equipment and intangible assets

— 

— 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           155 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

29 Segmental analysis continued 

  

  

  

  

2012 

Netherlands 

UK 

RoW

Total 

€m 

€m 

€m

€m 

Net interest income

36 

(6)

575 

605 

Net fees and commissions

(58)

321 

271 

Income from trading activities

(51)

14 

86 

49 

Other operating (loss)/income

(89)

(446)

318 

(217)

Total income

(96)

(496)

1,300 

708 

  

  

  

  

  

Operating (loss)/profit before tax

(531)

(484)

128 

(887)

Total assets

37,138 

16,723 

17,093 

70,954 

Total liabilities

35,339 

16,723 

17,093 

69,155 

Net assets attributable to equity owners

1,799 

— 

— 

1,799 

Contingent liabilities and commitments

6,953 

11 

9,821 

16,785 

Cost to acquire property, plant and equipment and intangible assets

14 

— 

40 

54 

 

2011 

  

  

  

  

Net interest income

(185)

40 

833 

688 

Net fees and commissions

39 

632 

672 

Income from trading activities

62 

362 

222 

646 

Other operating income

503 

1,321 

176 

2,000 

Total income

381 

1,762 

1,863 

4,006 

  

  

  

  

  

Operating (loss)/profit before tax

(1,224)

1,242 

(204)

(186)

Total assets

57,087 

37,569 

52,120 

146,776 

Total liabilities

53,692 

37,569 

52,099 

143,360 

Net assets attributable to equity owners and non-controlling interests

3,395 

— 

21 

3,416 

Contingent liabilities and commitments

17,927 

396 

27,252 

45,575 

Cost to acquire property, plant and equipment and intangible assets

41 

28 

38 

107 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           156 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

30 Remuneration of the Managing and Supervisory Board of RBS Holdings N.V.

Remuneration of Managing Board

The table below provides information on the remuneration of the Managing Board. The Managing Board throughout the year comprised of the following members:

 

(1) J. de Ruiter

(2) J. Kremers (resigned 1 April 2014)

(3) R. Hemsley (resigned 1 September 2013)

(4) M. Geslak

(5) P. van der Harst (resigned 18 July 2013)

(6) C. Visscher (appointed 18 July 2013)

 

All current members of the Managing Board also perform roles in their respective fields elsewhere within RBS Group. As a consequence the following table only summarises total remuneration of the members of the Managing Board paid directly by RBS Holdings N.V. in respect of their functions in RBS Holdings N.V. The total remuneration has increased due to termination benefits. All other remuneration items have decreased reflecting the reduced time spent by the members on matters relating to RBS Holdings N.V. following the transfers to RBS plc from 2011 onwards and the reduction of the average pay of the Board members .

 

The remuneration of the Managing Board is presented in aggregate. RBSG and its subsidiaries adhere to relevant statutory requirements and RBS Group discloses individual remuneration of RBS Group executive directors, compliant with the UK PRA Remuneration Code.

  

2013 

2012 

  

€000 

€000 

Salaries and short-term benefits

722 

1,285 

Pensions

231 

233 

Termination benefits (4) 

1,177 

— 

Profit sharing and bonus payments

196 

559 

Long term incentive plan (5)

255 

375 

Total

2,581 

2,452 

 

Notes:

(1) There are no loans from RBSH Group to the Managing Board members.

(2) RBS Holdings N.V. is no longer a Dutch open N.V.

(3) One of the tax measures introduced by the Dutch Government is the Dutch wage tax of 16% (‘crisisheffing’), payable by the employer for taxable wages above €150,000 per employee.

      This wage tax amounted to a total of €105,000 for the Managing Board members.

(4) This includes the termination benefits for Mr van der Harst and Mr Kremers.  The benefits are in line with the requirements of the Dutch Banking Code.

(5)  Long-Term Incentive Plans: the vesting of awards in the form of shares in RBS Group, will normally be subject to the satisfaction of performance conditions which will be set by the RBS Group Performance and Remuneration Committee for each award. In addition, awards will only vest if the Committee is satisfied that risk management during the performance period has been effective and that financial and non-financial performance has been satisfactory, in line with RBS Group's Strategic Plan.

 

Remuneration of Supervisory Board

The table below provides information on the remuneration of the Supervisory Board and related committees. Members of the Supervisory Board are not entitled to emoluments in the form of RBS Group shares or options on RBS Group shares. 

 

The Supervisory Board throughout the year consisted of the following members:

 

(1)   B. Van Saun (resigned 30 September 2013)

(2)   R. Teerlink (resigned 30 September 2013)

(3)   C. Campbell

(4)   S. Hepkema (resigned with effect from 1 May 2014)

(5)   H. Rottinghuis (resigned with effect from 1 May 2014)

(6)   N. Bostock (appointed 30 September 2013)

(7)   J. Cummins (appointed 30 September 2013)

 

The Board included some members employed elsewhere within RBS Group. The Supervisory Board members from RBS Group were not remunerated for time spent on matters relating to RBS Holdings N.V.

 

The table below presents the total remuneration of the Supervisory Board in aggregate.

 

2013 

2012 

  

€000 

€000 

Remuneration

140 

170 

 

Notes:

(1) There are no loans from RBSH Group to the Supervisory Board members.

(2) RBS Holdings N.V. is no longer a Dutch open N.V.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           157 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

31 Related parties

RBSH Group has a related party relationship with associates, joint ventures, key management and shareholders of its parent company, RFS Holdings. The shareholders of RFS Holdings are RBSG, Santander and the Dutch State. The UK Government became a shareholder of RBSG on 1 December 2008. As RBSG is the ultimate consolidating company of RBSH Group, both the UK Government and the Dutch State are therefore related parties.

 

Parties are considered to be related if one party has the ability to control or exercise significant influence over the other party in making financial or operational decisions. RBSH Group enters into a number of banking transactions with related parties in the normal course of business. These transactions, which include loans, deposits and foreign currency transactions, have taken place on an arm’s length basis. These transactions are carried out on commercial terms and at market rates. Employees are offered preferential terms for certain banking products. No allowances for loan losses have been recognised in respect of loans to related parties in 2013, 2012 and 2011.

 

Balances with Consortium Members

The transfer of eligible business carried out in the UK, including certain securities issued by RBS N.V. was completed during the last quarter of 2011, the 'UK Transfer', pursuant to Part VII of the UK Financial Services and Markets Act 2000. The UK Transfer moved a large part of the UK Equities & Structured Retail, Markets, Lending and the former GTS businesses as well as part of the UK Non-Core portfolio.

 

In the first half of 2012, assets and liabilities largely relating to businesses in Singapore, Hong Kong and Kazakhstan were transferred to RBS plc by a combination of local schemes of arrangement, novations and subsidiary share sales.  

 

On 8 August 2012 the Court of Session in Scotland approved the planned transfer of eligible RBS N.V. businesses, including the transfers of certain securities issued by RBS N.V., in the Netherlands and certain EMEA countries to RBS plc on 10 September 2012. The transfer was executed by way of a Dutch statutory demerger (the Demerger) from RBS N.V. into RBS II B.V. (the acquiring company); then onto RBS plc by way of a cross-border merger from RBS II B.V. into RBS plc (the Merger, and together with the Demerger, the Dutch Scheme), after which RBS II B.V. ceased to exist. The Dutch Scheme related largely to Transaction Services business and Lending deals. The Markets business included most Dutch, German and Italian law governed Securitised Products and a number of Over the Counter transactions (OTCs).

 

Also in the later half of 2012, other eligible businesses in the Netherlands and certain EMEA countries, and businesses in Malaysia, Turkey and the United Arab Emirates were transferred via novations, market mechanisms and subsidiary share sales.

 

In 2013, assets and liabilities relating to businesses in Russia, Romania, Korea and North America were transferred to RBS plc by a combination of local schemes of arrangement, cross-border merger novations and subsidiary share sales.

 

RBSH Group has also entered into two agreements with RBS plc under which it has bought credit protection over the exposures held by RBSH Group that were subject to RBS Group’s Asset Protection Scheme agreement with HM Treasury (HMT). These agreements cover 100% of losses on these assets. One agreement provides protection over a portfolio that includes significant exposure in the form of derivatives; the other covers assets that are measured at amortised cost. The former agreement is accounted for as a credit derivative. The second agreement meets the definition of a financial guarantee contract and is accounted for as such. RBS exited the APS effective 18 October 2012. The agreements are not impacted by RBS plc’s exit from APS and as a result, there has been no change to these agreements for the year ended the 31 December 2013. 

 

With effect from 1 January 2013, the Managing Board of RBS Holdings N.V. agreed with RBS plc to reduce the number of covered assets included in the agreements as a result of the progress made with the transfers to RBS plc during 2011 and 2012. Unamortised fees relating to the assets previously covered will be reimbursed by RBS plc. The assets covered under the agreement at 31 December 2013 was €1.0 billion (2012 - €2.4 billion; 2011 - €10.9 billion), with an average remaining maturity of four years. At 31 December 2013 the carrying value of the prepaid fee for the financial guarantee contract was €20 million (2012-€145 million; 2011 - €323 million).

 

Financial assets and liabilities positions held-for-trading with RBS Group include positions of which risks have been transferred to RBS plc. The assets and liabilities can not be offset under IFRS, however master netting agreements are in place that reduce the credit risk in the assets.

 

  

RBS 

Santander 

RBS 

Santander 

RBS 

Santander 

  

2013 

2013 

2012 

2012 

2011 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Securities and derivatives

2,569 

— 

4,624 

— 

11,384 

— 

Loans and advances

5,603 

33 

11,887 

41 

14,858 

49 

Other assets

42 

— 

12 

— 

4,006 

— 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Derivatives

3,806 

— 

6,970 

— 

11,713 

— 

Due to banks

17,688 

33 

28,458 

41 

34,404 

— 

Other liabilities

122 

— 

531 

— 

2,944 

— 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Contingent liabilities and commitments

1,361 

— 

1,974 

— 

1,270 

— 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           158 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

31 Related parties continued

Balances with the Dutch State

Transactions conducted directly with the Dutch State and UK Government are limited to normal banking transactions, taxation and other administrative relationships with the exception of the mandatory convertible securities and guarantee of the Dutch State. In addition RBSH Group participates in the Dutch State treasuries market and utilises the liquidity support made available to all banks regulated by DNB.

 

There may be other significant transactions with entities under the common control of or subject to significant influence by the Dutch and/or the UK Government. These would include, amongst others, loans, deposits, guarantees, fee based relationships, or equity holdings. Disclosure is made of any significant transactions with these entities.

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

 €m 

Assets

  

  

  

Balances at central banks

2,007 

2,064 

9,161 

Debt securities

668 

714 

763 

  

  

  

  

Liabilities

  

  

  

Deposits by banks

— 

3,573 

136 

 

 

32 Post balance sheet events

There have been no other significant events between the year end and the date of approval of these accounts which would require a change to or disclosure in the accounts.

 

33 Condensed consolidating financial information

RBS N.V. is a 100% owned subsidiary of RBS Holdings N.V. and is able to offer and sell certain securities in the US from time to time pursuant to a registration statement on Form F-3 filed with the SEC. RBS Holdings N.V. has fully and unconditionally guaranteed the obligations of RBS N.V. that have been incurred: this guarantee includes all securities issued by RBS N.V.

 

RBS N.V. utilises an exemption in Rule 3-10 of regulation S-X and therefore does not file its financial statements with SEC. In accordance with the requirement to qualify for the exception, presented in the tables below is condensed consolidating financial information for:

 

RBS Holdings N.V. on a standalone basis as guarantor;

 

 

RBS N.V. on a standalone basis as issuer;

 

 

other subsidiaries of RBS Holdings N.V. on a combined basis;

 

 

consolidation adjustments; and

 

 

RBSH Group consolidated amounts.

 

The condensed consolidated financial information is prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as adopted by the EU and IFRS as issued by the IASB, where RBSH Group has applied Rule 3-10 of Regulation S-X which requires a company to account for its investments in subsidiaries using the equity method, differing from IAS 27 which requires RBSH Group to account for investments in their subsidiaries at cost subject to impairment.

 

The following consolidating information presents condensed balance sheets at 31 December 2013, 2012 and 2011 and condensed income statements, statements of comprehensive income and cash flow statements for the years ended 31 December 2013, 2012 and 2011 of RBSH, RBS N.V. and its subsidiaries.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           159 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

33 Condensed consolidating financial information continued 

  

  

  

  

Condensed consolidating income statement for the year ended 31 December 2013

  

  

  

  

  

  

Consolidation 

  

  

RBSH 

RBS N.V. 

Subsidiaries 

adjustments 

RBSH Group 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Net interest income

— 

102 

136 

— 

238 

Results from Group undertakings

(152)

58 

— 

94 

— 

Non-interest income

— 

(18)

217 

— 

199 

Total income

(152)

142 

353 

94 

437 

Operating expenses

(2)

(376)

(161)

(537)

Impairment recoveries/(losses)

— 

45 

(87)

— 

(42)

Operating (loss)/profit before tax

(154)

(189)

105 

96 

(142)

Tax credit/(charge)

— 

35 

(47)

— 

(12)

(Loss)/profit from continuing operations

(154)

(154)

58 

96 

(154)

Profit from discontinued operations, net of tax

19 

19 

— 

(19)

19 

(Loss)/profit for the year

(135)

(135)

58 

77 

(135)

Attributable to:

  

  

  

  

  

Controlling interests

(135)

(135)

58 

77 

(135)

 

 

Condensed consolidating statement of comprehensive income for the year ended 31 December 2013

  

  

  

  

  

Consolidation 

  

  

RBSH 

RBS N.V.  

Subsidiaries 

adjustments 

RBSH Group 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Loss for the year

(135)

(135)

58 

77 

(135)

Group undertakings reserve

1,448 

55 

— 

(1,503)

— 

Available-for-sale financial assets

— 

1,596 

(5)

— 

1,591 

Currency translation

— 

(69)

— 

(67)

Tax credit

— 

— 

— 

Other comprehensive income after tax

1,448 

1,583 

(3)

(1,503)

1,525 

Total comprehensive income after tax   

1,313 

1,448 

55 

(1,426)

1,390 

Attributable to:

  

  

  

  

  

Controlling interests

1,313 

1,448 

55 

(1,426)

1,390 

 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Condensed consolidated income statement for the year ended 31 December 2012

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Consolidation 

  

  

RBSH  

RBS N.V.  

Subsidiaries 

adjustments

RBSH Group 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Net interest income

— 

407 

198 

— 

605 

Results from Group undertakings

(1,016)

(16)

— 

1,032 

— 

Non-interest income

— 

(289)

392 

— 

103 

Total income

(1,016)

102 

590 

1,032 

708 

Operating expenses

— 

(1,145)

(385)

— 

(1,530)

Impairment losses

— 

(34)

(31)

— 

(65)

Operating (loss)/profit before tax

(1,016)

(1,077)

174 

1,032 

(887)

Tax credit/(charge)

— 

61 

(190)

— 

(129)

Loss from continuing operations

(1,016)

(1,016)

(16)

1,032 

(1,016)

Profit from discontinued operations, net of tax

17 

17 

— 

(17)

17 

Loss for the year

(999)

(999)

(16)

1,015 

(999)

Attributable to:

  

  

  

  

  

Controlling interests

(999)

(999)

(16)

1,015 

(999)

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           160 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

33 Condensed consolidating financial information continued 

  

  

  

  

  

Condensed consolidating statement of comprehensive income for the year ended 31 December 2012

  

  

  

  

  

Consolidation 

  

  

RBSH  

RBS N.V.  

Subsidiaries 

adjustments

RBSH Group 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Loss for the year

(999)

(999)

(16)

1,015 

(999)

Group undertakings reserve

275 

— 

(281)

— 

Available-for-sale financial assets

— 

448 

— 

— 

448 

Cash flow hedges

— 

20 

— 

22 

Currency translation

— 

(195)

— 

(192)

Tax (charge)/credit

— 

(4)

— 

(3)

Other comprehensive income after tax

275 

275 

(281)

275 

Total comprehensive loss after tax   

(724)

(724)

(10)

734 

(724)

Attributable to:

  

  

  

  

  

Controlling interests

(724)

(724)

(10)

734 

(724)

 

Condensed consolidating income statement for the year ended 31 December 2011

  

  

  

  

  

  

Consolidation 

  

  

RBSH  

RBS N.V.  

Subsidiaries 

adjustments

RBSH Group 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Net interest income

— 

501 

187 

— 

688 

Results from Group undertakings

(635)

(119)

— 

754 

— 

Non-interest income

— 

3,013 

305 

— 

3,318 

Total income

(635)

3,395 

492 

754 

4,006 

Operating expenses

— 

(1,830)

(597)

— 

(2,427)

Impairment losses

— 

(1,740)

(25)

— 

(1,765)

Operating loss before tax

(635)

(175)

(130)

754 

(186)

Tax (charge)/credit

— 

(460)

11 

— 

(449)

Loss from continuing operations

(635)

(635)

(119)

754 

(635)

Profit from discontinued operations, net of tax

40 

40 

— 

(40)

40 

Loss for the year

(595)

(595)

(119)

714 

(595)

Attributable to:

  

  

  

  

  

Controlling interests

(595)

(595)

(119)

714 

(595)

 

Condensed consolidating statement of comprehensive income for the year ended 31 December 2011

  

  

  

  

  

Consolidation 

  

  

RBSH  

RBS N.V.  

Subsidiaries 

adjustments

RBSH Group 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Loss for the year

(595)

(595)

(119)

714 

(595)

Group undertakings reserve

(963)

(33)

— 

996 

— 

Available-for-sale financial assets

— 

287 

(13)

— 

274 

Cash flow hedges

— 

— 

Currency translation

— 

(442)

(31)

— 

(473)

Tax (charge)/credit

— 

(781)

— 

(776)

Other comprehensive loss after tax

(963)

(963)

(36)

996 

(966)

Total comprehensive loss after tax   

(1,558)

(1,558)

(155)

1,710 

(1,561)

Attributable to:

  

  

  

  

  

Non-controlling interests

— 

— 

(3)

— 

(3)

Controlling interests

(1,558)

(1,558)

(152)

1,710 

(1,558)

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           161 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

33 Condensed consolidating financial information continued 

  

  

  

  

Condensed consolidating balance sheet as at 31 December 2013

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Consolidation 

  

  

RBSH 

RBS N.V. 

Subsidiaries 

adjustments 

RBSH Group 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Assets

  

  

  

  

  

Cash and balances at central banks

— 

2,946 

247 

— 

3,193 

Loans and advances to banks

35 

8,328 

3,954 

(6,622)

5,695 

Loans and advances to customers

— 

2,708 

1,076 

— 

3,784 

Amounts due from ultimate holding company

— 

2,820 

— 

— 

2,820 

Debt securities

— 

13,982 

1,306 

— 

15,288 

Equity shares

— 

236 

59 

— 

295 

Settlement balances

— 

— 

10 

Derivatives

— 

5,067 

109 

(394)

4,782 

Deferred taxation

— 

28 

12 

— 

40 

Prepayments, accrued income and other assets

2,939 

2,257 

1,513 

(4,856)

1,853 

Assets of disposal groups

— 

1,006 

1,042 

— 

2,048 

Total assets

2,974 

39,385 

9,321 

(11,872)

39,808 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Liabilities and equity

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits by banks

32 

20,880 

4,653 

(6,622)

18,943 

Customer accounts

— 

2,885 

1,266 

— 

4,151 

Debt securities in issue

— 

818 

501 

— 

1,319 

Settlement balances and short positions

— 

105 

— 

— 

105 

Derivatives

— 

5,725 

531 

(394)

5,862 

Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities

— 

736 

329 

— 

1,065 

Deferred taxation

— 

62 

— 

63 

Subordinated liabilities

— 

4,951 

— 

— 

4,951 

Liabilities of disposal groups

— 

345 

62 

— 

407 

Controlling interests

2,942 

2,939 

1,917 

(4,856)

2,942 

Total liabilities and equity

2,974 

39,385 

9,321 

(11,872)

39,808 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           162 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

33 Condensed consolidating financial information continued 

  

  

  

  

Condensed consolidating balance sheet as at 31 December 2012

  

  

  

  

 

 

 

 

 

 

  

 

 

  

Consolidation 

  adjustments 

 

  

 RBSH 

RBS N.V. 

Subsidiaries 

RBSH Group 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Assets

  

  

  

  

  

Cash and balances at central banks

— 

2,068 

226 

— 

2,294 

Loans and advances to banks

35 

17,920 

7,827 

(13,576)

12,206 

Loans and advances to customers

— 

3,793 

2,587 

— 

6,380 

Amounts due from ultimate holding company

— 

2,949 

— 

— 

2,949 

Debt securities

— 

20,678 

1,977 

— 

22,655 

Equity shares

— 

1,065 

62 

— 

1,127 

Settlement balances

— 

26 

— 

31 

Derivatives

— 

8,268 

63 

(776)

7,555 

Deferred taxation

— 

409 

11 

— 

420 

Prepayments, accrued income and other assets

1,796 

3,321 

507 

(4,091)

1,533 

Assets of disposal groups

— 

10,904 

2,900 

— 

13,804 

Total assets

1,831 

71,401 

16,165 

(18,443)

70,954 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Liabilities and equity

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits by banks

32 

41,271 

6,738 

(13,576)

34,465 

Customer accounts

— 

1,667 

971 

— 

2,638 

Debt securities in issue

— 

1,672 

930 

— 

2,602 

Settlement balances and short positions

— 

107 

— 

— 

107 

Derivatives

— 

9,586 

834 

(776)

9,644 

Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities

— 

1,487 

295 

— 

1,782 

Deferred taxation

— 

36 

— 

40 

Subordinated liabilities

— 

4,417 

2,434 

— 

6,851 

Liabilities of disposal groups

— 

9,362 

1,664 

— 

11,026 

Controlling interests

1,799 

1,796 

2,295 

(4,091)

1,799 

Total liabilities and equity

1,831 

71,401 

16,165 

(18,443)

70,954 

  

  

  

  

  

  

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           163 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

33 Condensed consolidating financial information continued 

  

  

  

  

Condensed consolidating balance sheet as at 31 December 2011

  

  

  

  

 

 

 

 

 

 

  

  

  

  

 Consolidation 

  

 

RBSH

RBS N.V.

Subsidiaries 

adjustments 

RBSH Group 

 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Assets

  

  

  

  

  

Cash and balances at central banks

— 

11,812 

797 

— 

12,609 

Loans and advances to banks

— 

52,614 

29,684 

(56,381)

25,917 

Loans and advances to customers

— 

24,979 

4,599 

— 

29,578 

Amounts due from ultimate holding company

— 

1,136 

— 

— 

1,136 

Debt securities

— 

38,211 

1,697 

(263)

39,645 

Equity shares

— 

2,955 

138 

— 

3,093 

Settlement balances

— 

2,576 

32 

— 

2,608 

Derivatives

— 

18,606 

532 

— 

19,138 

Deferred taxation

— 

395 

49 

— 

444 

Prepayments, accrued income and other assets

3,401 

7,848 

928 

(6,264)

5,913 

Assets of disposal groups

— 

4,264 

2,431 

— 

6,695 

Total assets

3,401 

165,396 

40,887 

(62,908)

146,776 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Liabilities and equity

  

  

  

  

  

Deposits by banks

76,911 

25,985 

(56,381)

46,520 

Customer accounts

— 

33,469 

6,132 

— 

39,601 

Debt securities in issue

— 

17,473 

504 

(263)

17,714 

Settlement balances and short positions

— 

3,386 

23 

— 

3,409 

Derivatives

— 

19,323 

545 

— 

19,868 

Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities

2,996 

898 

— 

3,895 

Deferred taxation

— 

132 

69 

— 

201 

Subordinated liabilities

— 

4,449 

2,410 

— 

6,859 

Liabilities of disposal groups

— 

3,856 

1,437 

— 

5,293 

Controlling interests

3,395 

3,401 

2,863 

(6,264)

3,395 

Non-controlling interests

— 

— 

21 

— 

21 

Total liabilities and equity

3,401 

165,396 

40,887 

(62,908)

146,776 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           164 

 


 

 

 

Notes on the consolidated accounts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

 

33 Condensed consolidating financial information continued 

  

  

  

  

  

Condensed consolidating cash flow statement for the year ended 31 December 2013

  

  

  

  

  

  

Consolidation 

  

  

RBSH 

RBS N.V. 

Subsidiaries 

adjustments 

RBSH Group 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Total net cash flows from operating activities

— 

(5,747)

(2,049)

(63)

(7,859)

Net cash flows from investing activities

— 

3,626 

1,640 

— 

5,266 

Net cash flows from financing activities

— 

(2,119)

(63)

63 

(2,119)

Effects of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

— 

31 

— 

40 

Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents

— 

(4,209)

(463)

— 

(4,672)

Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the year

— 

8,893 

1,137 

— 

10,030 

Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the year

— 

4,684 

674 

— 

5,358 

 

Condensed consolidating cash flow statement for the year ended 31 December 2012

  

  

  

  

  

  

Consolidation 

  

  

RBSH 

RBS N.V. 

Subsidiaries 

adjustments 

RBSH Group 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Total net cash flows from operating activities

— 

(15,663)

(1,519)

(142)

(17,324)

Net cash flows from investing activities

— 

374 

280 

— 

654 

Net cash flows from financing activities

— 

(190)

(298)

142 

(346)

Effects of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

— 

13 

(11)

— 

Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents

— 

(15,466)

(1,548)

— 

(17,014)

Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the year

— 

24,359 

2,685 

— 

27,044 

Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the year

— 

8,893 

1,137 

— 

10,030 

 

Condensed consolidating cash flow statement for the year ended 31 December 2011

  

  

  

  

  

  

Consolidated 

  

  

RBSH 

RBS N.V. 

Subsidiaries 

adjustments 

RBSH Group 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Total net cash flows from operating activities

— 

(8,085)

(752)

(311)

(9,148)

Net cash flows from investing activities

— 

8,625 

724 

— 

9,349 

Net cash flows from financing activities

— 

(248)

(403)

311 

(340)

Effects of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

— 

148 

(23)

— 

125 

Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

— 

440 

(454)

— 

(14)

Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the year

— 

23,919 

3,139 

— 

27,058 

Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the year

— 

24,359 

2,685 

— 

27,044 

 

Other information

The parent company financial statements are included in this condensed consolidating footnote. The number of ordinary shares in issue at 31 December 2013 was 89,287 (2012 - 89,287; 2011 - 3,306,843,332). The total number of authorised ordinary shares amounts to 400,000.

 

Proposed profit appropriation of RBS Holdings N.V., pursuant to articles 37.2 and 37.3 of the articles of association, is as follows:

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

  €m 

Release from reserves 

(135)

(999)

(595)

 

Trust preferred securities

The Group has issued trust preferred securities through trusts (RBS Capital Funding Trust V, RBS Capital Funding Trust VI, RBS Capital Funding Trust VII), 100% owned by The Royal Bank of Scotland N.V. a wholly owned subsidiary of RBS Holdings N.V., which meet the definition in Regulation S-X, Rule 3-10 of a finance subsidiary. The securities represent undivided beneficial interests in the assets of the trusts, which consist of preferred securities issued by Delaware limited liability companies (LLCs). RBS Holdings NV has provided subordinated guarantees for the benefit of the holders of the trust preferred securities and the LLC preferred securities. Under the terms of the guarantees, the Group has fully and unconditionally guaranteed on a subordinated basis, payments on such trust preferred securities and the LLC preferred securities, to the extent they are due to be paid and have not been paid by, or on behalf of the trusts and the LLCs, as the case may be. Following implementation of IFRS 10 the trusts and LLCs are no longer consolidated by the Group.  The Group’s outstanding instruments with the trusts are classified as subordinated liabilities.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           165 

 


 

 

Other information                                                                                                                              

 

 

 

167

Report of independent registered public accounting firm

169

Articles of association

170

Relations with shareholders

170

Post balance sheet events

170

Incorporation and registration

170

Code of conduct

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           166 

 


 

 

Other information                                                                                                                              

Report of independent registered public accounting firm

 

To: the Shareholder, Supervisory Board and Managing Board of RBS Holdings N.V.

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of RBS Holdings N.V. and subsidiaries (the "RBSH Group") as of 31 December 2013 and the related consolidated income statement, consolidated statement of comprehensive income, consolidated statement of change in equity and consolidated cash flow statement for the year ended 31 December 2013, the notes 1 to 33 and the audited sections of the Business review: Risk and balance sheet management on pages 25 to 77. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. The RBSH Group is not required to have, nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal control over financial reporting. An audit includes consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the RBSH Group’s internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, such consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of RBS Holdings N.V. and subsidiaries at 31 December 2013, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for the period ended 31 December 2013, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.

 

 

/s/ Deloitte LLP

 

 

30 April 2014

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           167 

 


 

 

Other information                                                                                                                              

Report of independent registered public accounting firm

 

To: the Shareholder, Supervisory Board and Managing Board of RBS Holdings N.V.

 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of RBS Holdings N.V. and subsidiaries (the "RBSH Group") as of 31 December 2012 and 2011, and the related consolidated income statements, consolidated statements of comprehensive income, consolidated statements of changes in equity and consolidated cash flow statements for each of the two years in the period ended 31 December 2012 and the notes 1 to 37 and the audited sections of the Business review: Risk and balance sheet management on pages 25 to 77. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. The RBSH Group is not required to have, nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal control over financial reporting. An audit includes consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the RBSH Group’s internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

In our opinion, such consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of RBS Holdings N.V. and subsidiaries at 31 December 2012 and 2011, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the two years in the period ended 31 December 2012, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.

 

As discussed in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements, the accompanying consolidated financial statements for the years ended 31 December 2012 and 2011 have been retrospectively adjusted for the implementation of International Financial Reporting Standards 10, Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

 

 

/s/ Deloitte Accountants B.V.

 

Amsterdam

 

27 March 2013 

 

(30 April 2014 as to note 2)

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           168 

 


 

 

Other information                                                                                                                              

 

Articles of association 

The description set out below is a summary of the material information relating to the Company’s share capital, including summaries of certain provisions of the Articles of Association and applicable Dutch law in effect at the relevant date. The Articles of Association of RBS Holdings N.V. were last amended by a notarial deed executed by Mr B.J. Kuck, civil law notary in Amsterdam on 5 April 2013, under register entry number 33220369.

 

As stated in the Articles of Association the object of the Company is:

 

·         The participation in, collaboration with and financing, administration and management of other enterprises and companies and the performance of all acts, activities and services which are related or may be conducive thereto.

 

·         The engagement in banking and stockbroking activities, the management of third party assets, acting as trustee, administrator, executor of wills and executive director, non-executive director or liquidator of companies or other organisations, the provision of insurances and the performance of all other acts and activities which are related or may be conducive thereto, all in the broadest possible sense.

 

·         The fostering of the direct and indirect interests of all those who are involved in any way in the Company and the safeguarding of the continuity of the Company and its affiliated enterprise(s).

 

Profit appropriation

Profit is appropriated in accordance with article 37 of the articles of association. The main stipulations with respect to shares currently in issue are as follow:

 

The Managing Board may decide to make appropriations to reserves, subject to the approval of the Supervisory Board (article 37.2.a.).

 

The allocation of the amount remaining after these appropriations shall be determined by the General Meeting of Shareholders. The Managing Board, subject to the approval of the Supervisory Board, shall make a proposal to that effect. A proposal to pay a dividend shall be dealt with as a separate agenda item at the General Meeting of Shareholders (article 37.2.a.).

 

RBS Holdings’ policy on reserves and dividends shall be determined and can be amended by the Supervisory Board, upon the proposal of the Managing Board. The adoption of and each subsequent amendment to the policy on reserves and dividends shall be discussed and accounted for at the General Meeting of Shareholders under a separate agenda item (article 37.2.b.).

 

Subject to approval of the Supervisory Board, the Managing Board may make the dividend or interim dividend on the shares payable, at the discretion of the holders, either in cash or, provided it is authorised to issue shares, partly or wholly in shares in the Company’s capital or in a combination thereof, such combination to be determined by the Managing Board (article 37.3.).

 

Subject to the approval of the Supervisory Board, the Managing Board shall be authorised, in so far as such is permitted by the profit as evidenced by an interim balance sheet drawn up with due observance of the provisions of Section 105, Subsection 4 of Book 2 of the Netherlands Civil Code, to make payable an interim dividend on the shares once or more frequently in the course of any financial year and prior to the approval of the Annual Accounts by the General Meeting of Shareholders (article 37.4.).

 

Subject to the approval of the Supervisory Board, the Managing Board may decide on a distribution charged against reserves in cash or, if the Board is authorised to issue shares, in the form of shares (article 37.5.).

 

Proposed profit appropriation

Appropriation of net profit pursuant to articles 37.2 and 37.3 of the articles of association:

 

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

  

€m

€m

€m

Release from reserves

(135)

(999)

(595)

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           169 

 


 

 

Other information                                                                                                                              

Shares and voting rights

Each ordinary share of €0.56 face value in the capital of the Company entitles the holder to cast one vote (art 32.1). Subject to certain exceptions provided for by law or in the Articles of Association, resolutions are passed by an absolute majority of the votes cast (art. 32.4).

 

When shares are issued, each holder of shares shall have pre-emptive right, in proportion to the aggregate amount of their shares, except in the case of an issue of shares for a consideration other than in cash or an issue of shares to employees of the company or of a group company (art.9).

 

In the event of the dissolution and liquidation of the Company, the assets remaining after payment of all debts will be distributed to the shareholders of ordinary shares on a pro-rata basis (art 39.3).

 

Relations with shareholders

Rights of shareholders

Any resolution to amend the Articles of Association or dissolve RBS Holdings may only be passed by the General Meeting of Shareholders following a proposal by the Managing Board which has been approved by the Supervisory Board. A copy of the proposal containing the literal text of the proposed amendments shall be made available for inspection by the holders of shares of RBS Holdings at the offices of RBS Holdings and at the offices stated in the convocation to the meeting, from the day of convocation to the end of the Meeting. Each Shareholder may obtain a full copy of the proposal free of charge.

 

Meetings of shareholders and convocation

General meetings of shareholders shall be held in Amsterdam, or in The Hague, Rotterdam, Utrecht or Haarlemmermeer (Schiphol). Annual General Meeting of Shareholders must be held within six months of the end of each financial year. In addition, General meetings of shareholders shall be held as frequently as deemed necessary by the Managing Board or the Supervisory Board and when required by law or by the Articles of Association. General meetings of shareholders shall be convened by the Managing Board or the Supervisory Board, without prejudice to the provisions of Sections 110, 111 and 112 of Book 2 of the Netherlands Civil Code. Convocation shall take place not later than on the fifteenth day prior to the day of the meeting. Convocation shall state the items to be discussed or alternatively notice shall be given that such items may be inspected at the company’s offices.

 

Proposals to amend the Articles of Association or proposals relating to a reduction of the company’s capital shall always be included in the actual convocation.

 

Post balance sheet events

There have been no significant events between the year end and the date of approval of these accounts which would require a change to or disclosure in the accounts.

 

Incorporation and registration

RBS Holdings N.V. is the parent company of the RBS Holdings N.V. consolidated group of companies. RBS Holdings is a public limited liability company, incorporated under Dutch law on 30 May 1990, and registered at Gustav Mahlerlaan 350, 1082 ME Amsterdam, the Netherlands and is entered in the Trade Register of the Amsterdam Chamber of Commerce under no. 33220369.

 

Code of conduct

The code of conduct applies to everyone who works for RBSH Group.

 

It promotes honest and ethical conduct, including the handling of actual or apparent conflicts of interest between personal and professional relationships. RBSH Group recognises that personal conduct, business integrity and the Group’s security are crucial, and the code of conduct serves to inform those who work for us of the Group’s expectations of their behaviour and practices.

 

The code of conduct is available on the RBS Group’s website www.rbs.com  and will be provided to any person without charge, upon request, by contacting Company Secretariat at the telephone number listed on page 204.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           170 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

 

 

 

172

Financial summary

180

Exchange rates

181

Economic and monetary environment

181

Supervision

184

Major shareholders

184

Material contracts

185

Off-balance sheet arrangements

186

Risk factors

196

Iran sanctions and related disclosures

197

Documents on display

198

Glossary of terms

204

Important addresses

206

Signatures

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           171 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Financial summary

RBSH Group's financial statements are prepared in accordance with IFRS. Selected data under IFRS for each of the last five years ended 31 December are presented below.

 

Summary consolidated income statement

2013 

2012 

2011 

2010 

2009 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Net interest income

238 

605 

688 

1,427 

1,834 

Non-interest income

199 

103 

3,318 

2,463 

(437)

Total income

437 

708 

4,006 

3,890 

1,397 

Operating expenses

(537)

(1,530)

(2,427)

(3,380)

(4,621)

(Loss)/profit before impairment losses

(100)

(822)

1,579 

510 

(3,224)

Impairment losses

(42)

(65)

(1,765)

(67)

(1,623)

Operating (loss)/profit before tax

(142)

(887)

(186)

443 

(4,847)

Tax

(12)

(129)

(449)

(310)

465 

(Loss)/profit from continuing operations

(154)

(1,016)

(635)

133 

(4,382)

Profit/(loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax

19 

17 

40 

985 

(18)

(Loss)/profit for the year

(135)

(999)

(595)

1,118 

(4,400)

  

  

  

  

  

  

(Loss)/profit attributable to:

  

  

  

  

  

Non-controlling interests

— 

— 

— 

(2)

(1)

Controlling interests

(135)

(999)

(595)

1,120 

(4,399)

 

Summary consolidated balance sheet

2013 

2012 

2011 

2010 

2009 

€m 

€m  

€m    

€m    

€m  

Loans and advances

12,299 

21,535 

56,631 

71,201 

257,677 

Debt securities and equity shares

15,583 

23,782 

42,738 

74,894 

102,036 

Derivatives and settlement balances

4,792 

7,586 

21,746 

31,845 

60,790 

Other assets

7,134 

18,051 

25,661 

22,517 

48,842 

Total assets

39,808 

70,954 

146,776 

200,457 

469,345 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Controlling interests

2,942 

1,799 

3,395 

4,958 

18,880 

Non-controlling interests

— 

— 

21 

24 

36 

Subordinated liabilities

4,951 

6,851 

6,859 

6,894 

14,666 

Deposits

23,094 

37,103 

86,121 

86,890 

246,046 

Derivatives, settlement balances and short positions

5,967 

9,751 

23,277 

40,875 

70,462 

Other liabilities

2,854 

15,450 

27,103 

60,816 

119,255 

Total liabilities and equity

39,808 

70,954 

146,776 

200,457 

469,345 

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

2010 

2009 

Other financial data

Dividend payout ratio (1) 

— 

  

  

1,389.4 

  

Return on average total assets (2) 

— 

  

  

0.4 

  

Return on average ordinary shareholders' equity (3) 

— 

  

  

17.8 

  

Average owners' equity as a percentage of average total assets

10.9 

3.3 

2.4 

2.2 

3.0 

Capital ratio – Tier 1

23.2 

13.9 

12.0 

11.0 

19.9 

Total

26.1 

19.8 

17.5 

15.8 

25.5 

Ratio of earnings to fixed charges only (4) 

  

  

  

  

  

  – including interest on deposits

0.81 

0.13 

0.89 

1.27 

  

  – excluding interest on deposits

0.35 

  

0.57 

1.89 

  

 

Notes:

(1)    Dividend payout ratio represents dividends paid and current year final dividends proposed as a percentage of net profit attributable to ordinary shareholders.

(2)    Return on average total assets represents profit for the year as a percentage of average total assets. Negative ratios have been excluded.

(3)    Return on average ordinary shareholders' equity represents profit attributable to ordinary shareholders expressed as a percentage of average ordinary shareholders' equity. Negative ratios have been excluded.

(4)    For this purpose, earnings consist of income before tax plus fixed charges. Fixed charges consist of total interest expense, including or excluding interest on deposits. Deposits include banks and total customer accounts.  The coverage deficiency for total fixed charges excluding interest on deposits for the year ended 31 December 2013 is €142 million (31 December 2012 - €887 million and 31 December 2011 - €186 million). The earnings for the year ended 31 December 2009 was inadequate to cover total fixed charges excluding interest on deposits and total fixed charges including interest on deposits. 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           172 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Financial summary continued 

Analysis of loans and advances to customers

The following table analyses loans and advances to customers before impairment provisions by remaining maturity, geographical area and type of customer.

 

  

  

After 1

  

  

  

  

  

  

Within

but within

After

2013 

  

  

  

  

1 year

5 years

5 years

Total 

2012 

2011 

2010 

2009 

€m

€m

€m

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Netherlands

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Central and local government

— 

— 

53 

53 

58 

120 

372 

1,659 

Manufacturing

— 

10 

11 

233 

806 

1,745 

7,437 

Construction

— 

— 

— 

— 

19 

551 

388 

865 

Finance

174 

— 

15 

189 

174 

1,190 

1,668 

12,506 

Service industries and business activities

18 

85 

148 

251 

891 

2,201 

3,640 

16,788 

Agriculture, forestry and fishing

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

65 

4,951 

Property

— 

— 

— 

— 

301 

290 

3,949 

Other business activities

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

781 

1,148 

7,724 

Residential mortgages

37 

97 

89 

223 

282 

431 

449 

102,308 

Personal lending

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

— 

169 

Accrued interest

(4)

(1)

22 

73 

763 

Total domestic

226 

183 

317 

726 

1,672 

6,403 

9,844 

159,119 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Overseas

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

US

— 

28 

37 

— 

970 

1,668 

4,357 

Rest of the World

2,002 

584 

629 

3,215 

5,049 

23,732 

34,511 

62,118 

Loans and advances to customers - gross

2,228 

795 

955 

3,978 

6,721 

31,105 

46,023 

225,594 

Loan impairment provisions

  

  

  

(194)

(341)

(1,527)

(1,527)

(5,636)

Loans and advances to customers - net

  

  

  

3,784 

6,380 

29,578 

44,496 

219,958 

 

Note:

(1)    RBSH Group provides credit facilities at variable rates to its corporate customers and retail customers. Variable rate credit extended to RBSH Group’s corporate and commercial customers includes bullet and instalment loans, finance lease agreements and overdrafts; interest is generally charged at a margin over a bench mark rate such as EURIBOR, LIBOR or base rate. Interest on variable rate retail loans may also be based on EURIBOR, LIBOR or base rate.  RBSH Group does not provide interest only loans to its retail customers.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           173 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Financial summary continued 

Loan impairment provisions

For a discussion of the factors considered in determining the amount of the provisions, refer to ‘Impairment of financial assets’ on pages 99 and 100 and ‘Critical Accounting policies and key sources of estimation uncertainty’ on pages 103 and 104. The following table shows the movements in loan impairment provisions.

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

2010 

2009 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Provisions at the beginning of the year

  

  

  

  

  

Domestic

155 

242 

223 

4,085 

2,792 

Foreign

186 

1,330 

1,349 

1,626 

1,772 

  

341 

1,572 

1,572 

5,711 

4,564 

Transfer from/(to) disposal groups

  

  

  

  

  

Domestic

29 

— 

— 

(2,155)

994 

Foreign

(171)

— 

(222)

(238)

  

36 

(171)

— 

(2,377)

756 

Currency translation and other adjustments  

  

  

  

  

  

Domestic

46 

— 

78 

(261)

183 

Foreign

(5)

(74)

49 

335 

(32)

  

41 

(74)

127 

74 

151 

(Disposals)/acquisitions of businesses  

  

  

  

  

  

Domestic

(38)

(50)

— 

— 

Foreign

(53)

(512)

(50)

— 

(73)

  

(91)

(562)

(45)

— 

(73)

Amounts written-off

  

  

  

  

  

Domestic

(70)

(50)

(43)

(1,506)

(543)

Foreign

(33)

(403)

(354)

(437)

(732)

  

(103)

(453)

(397)

(1,943)

(1,275)

Recoveries of amounts previously written-off

  

  

  

  

  

Domestic

— 

21 

Foreign

22 

38 

  

12 

22 

59 

10 

Charged to income statement continuing operations (1)

  

  

  

  

  

Domestic

(35)

(20)

39 

651 

Foreign

(3)

11 

322 

21 

970 

  

(38)

17 

302 

60 

1,621 

Unwind of discount (recognised in interest income)

  

  

  

  

  

Foreign

— 

— 

(8)

(12)

(43)

  

— 

— 

(8)

(12)

(43)

Provisions at the end of the year (2) 

  

  

  

  

  

Domestic

88 

155 

242 

223 

4,085 

Foreign

107 

186 

1,330 

1,349 

1,626 

  

195 

341 

1,572 

1,572 

5,711 

Gross loans and advances to customers

  

  

  

  

  

Domestic

726 

1,672 

6,403 

9,844 

159,119 

Foreign

3,252 

5,049 

24,702 

36,179 

66,475 

  

3,978 

6,721 

31,105 

46,023 

225,594 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           174 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

 

Financial summary continued 

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

2010 

2009 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Closing customer provisions as a % of gross loans and advances

  

  

  

  

  

  to customers (3)

  

  

  

  

  

Domestic

12.1% 

9.3%  

3.8%  

2.3%  

2.6%  

Foreign

3.3% 

3.7%  

5.4%  

3.6%  

2.3%  

Total

4.9% 

5.1%  

4.9%  

3.3%  

2.5%  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Customer charge to income statement for continuing operations

  

  

  

  

  

  as a % of gross loans and advances to customers

Domestic

(4.8%)

0.4%  

(0.3%)

0.4%  

0.4%  

Foreign

(0.1%)

(0.1%)

1.3%  

0.1%  

1.5%  

Total

(0.9%)

0.2%  

1.0%  

0.1%  

0.7%  

 

Notes:

(1)    Includes nil relating to loans and advances to banks (2012 - €2 million; 2011 - nil; 2010 - €(15) million; 2009 - €30 million). Net of recoveries/recharges under the APS back-to-back agreement.

(2)    Includes provisions against loans and advances to banks - see table below.

(3)    Excludes provisions against loans and advances to banks.

 

The following table shows additional information in respect of the loan impairment provisions.

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

2010 

2009 

 €m 

 €m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Loan impairment provisions at end of year:

  

  

  

  

  

Customers

194 

341 

1,527 

1,527 

5,636 

Banks

— 

45 

45 

75 

  

195 

341 

1,572 

1,572 

5,711 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Average loans and advances to customers (gross)

6,476 

18,913 

38,564 

135,809 

251,311 

  

  

  

  

  

  

As a % of average loans and advances to customers during the year:

  

  

  

  

  

Total customer provisions charged to income statement

— 

1.0%

0.1%

1.1%

Amounts written-off (net of recoveries) - customers

1.6%

2.2%

1.1%

1.5%

0.5%

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           175 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

 

Financial summary continued 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Analysis of closing customer loan impairment provisions

  

  

  

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The following table analyses loan impairment provisions by geographical area and type of domestic customer.

 

 

 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

  

2012 

  

2011 

  

2010 

  

2009 

  

  

% of loans 

  

  

% of loans 

  

  

% of loans 

  

  

% of loans 

  

  

% of loans 

  

Closing 

to total 

  

Closing 

to total 

  

Closing 

to total 

  

Closing 

to total 

  

Closing 

to total 

  

provision 

loans 

  

provision 

loans 

  

provision 

loans 

  

provision 

loans 

  

provision 

loans 

  

€m 

  

€m 

  

€m 

  

€m 

  

€m 

Domestic

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Central and local government

— 

1.3 

  

— 

0.9 

  

— 

0.4 

  

— 

0.8 

  

0.7 

Manufacturing

— 

0.3 

  

(3)

3.5 

  

— 

4.4 

  

— 

3.8 

  

1,967 

3.3 

Construction

— 

— 

  

— 

0.3 

  

— 

1.8 

  

— 

0.8 

  

17 

0.4 

Finance

14 

4.8 

  

14 

2.6 

  

32 

3.8 

  

119 

3.6 

  

643 

5.5 

Service industries and business activities

53 

6.3 

  

118 

13.3 

  

126 

7.1 

  

43 

10.4 

  

775 

10.9 

Agriculture, forestry and fishing

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

  

— 

— 

  

— 

0.1 

  

137 

2.2 

Property

— 

— 

  

— 

0.1 

  

68 

1.0 

  

45 

0.6 

  

110 

1.8 

Individuals

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  – home mortgages

22 

5.6 

  

24 

4.2 

  

21 

2.5 

  

21 

1.0 

  

— 

45.4 

  – other

— 

— 

  

— 

  

1.4 

  

45 

— 

  

— 

0.1 

Accrued interest

— 

— 

  

— 

0.1 

  

— 

0.1 

  

— 

0.2 

  

— 

0.3 

Total domestic

89 

18.3 

  

160 

24.9 

  

250 

22.5 

  

273 

21.3 

  

3,650 

70.6 

Foreign

92 

81.7 

  

146 

75.1 

  

1,216 

77.5 

  

1,183 

78.7 

  

1,466 

29.4 

Impaired book provisions

181 

100.0 

  

306 

100.0 

  

1,466 

100.0 

  

1,456 

100.0 

  

5,116 

100.0 

Latent book provisions

13 

  

  

35 

  

  

106 

  

  

116 

  

  

595 

  

Total provisions

194 

  

  

341 

  

  

1,572 

  

  

1,572 

  

  

5,711 

  

 

Analysis of write-offs

  

  

  

  

  

The following table analyses amounts written-off by geographical area and type of domestic customer.

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

2010 

2009 

  

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Domestic

  

  

  

  

  

Central and local government

— 

— 

— 

— 

12 

Manufacturing

— 

— 

1,469 

185 

Construction

— 

— 

— 

  

13 

Finance

— 

32 

31 

Service industries and business activities

63 

10 

11 

208 

Agriculture, forestry and fishing

— 

— 

— 

— 

14 

Property

— 

39 

— 

— 

17 

Personal lending

— 

— 

— 

— 

59 

Finance leases and instalment credit

— 

— 

— 

— 

29 

Total domestic

70 

50 

43 

1,506 

543 

Foreign

33 

403 

354 

437 

732 

Total write-offs

103 

453 

397 

1,943 

1,275 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           176 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

 

Financial summary continued 

  

  

  

  

  

Analysis of recoveries

  

  

  

  

  

The following table analyses recoveries of amounts written-off by geographical area and type of domestic customer.

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

2010 

2009 

  

€m 

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

Domestic

  

  

  

  

  

Manufacturing

Service industries and business activities

Personal lending

21 

Total domestic

21 

Foreign

22 

38 

Total recoveries

12 

22 

59 

10 

 

Renegotiated loans

The table below shows loans whose terms were renegotiated during the year that are unimpaired: either the loan was performing both before and after the renegotiation or it was non-performing before renegotiation and subsequently transferred to the performing book. Renegotiated loans with impairment provisions continue to be reported as impaired loans.

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

2010 

2009 

€m 

€m    

€m    

€m    

€m    

Renegotiated loans (1) 

194 

438 

101 

 

Note:

(1)    Renegotiated loans data include only those arrangements above thresholds set individually by the divisions, ranging from nil to €10 million.

 

Risk elements in lending and potential problem loans

Risk elements in lending (REIL) comprises impaired loans and accruing loans past due 90 days or more as to principal or interest.

 

Impaired loans are all loans (including renegotiated loans and forbearance loans) for which an impairment provision has been established; for collectively assessed loans, impairment loss provisions are not allocated to individual loans and the entire portfolio is included in impaired loans.

 

Accruing loans past due 90 days or more comprise loans past due 90 days where no impairment loss is expected and those awaiting individual assessment. A latent loss provision is established for the latter.

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

2010 

2009 

€m 

€m    

€m    

€m  

€m  

Impaired loans (1) 

  

  

  

  

  

  Domestic

178 

253 

339 

445 

5,398 

  Foreign

132 

253 

1,591 

1,719 

2,691 

Total

310 

506 

1,930 

2,164 

8,089 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Accruing loans which are contractually overdue 90 days or more as to

  

  

  

  

  

  principal or interest

  Domestic

— 

— 

78 

51 

92 

  Foreign

— 

— 

89 

61 

Total

— 

— 

167 

60 

153 

Total risk elements in lending

310 

506 

2,097 

2,224 

8,242 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Closing provisions for impairment as a % of total risk elements in lending

62.6%

67.4%

75.0%

70.7%

69.3%

Risk elements in lending as a % of gross lending to customers

7.9%

7.5%

6.8%

4.8%

3.7%

 

Note:

(1)    The write off of impaired loans affects the closing provisions for impairment as a % of total risk elements in lending (the coverage ratio). The coverage ratio reduces if the loan written off carries a higher than average provision and increases if the loan written off carries a lower than average provision. Impaired loans at 31 December 2013 whose terms were renegotiated were nil (31 December 2012 - €27 million).

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           177 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Financial summary continued 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

         €m 

         €m 

€m 

Gross income not recognised but which would have been recognised under

  

  

  

  the original terms of impaired loans

  Domestic

24 

20 

80 

  Foreign

22 

34 

85 

  

46 

54 

165 

  

  

  

  

Interest on impaired loans included in net interest income

  

  

  

  Domestic

— 

— 

69 

  Foreign

— 

— 

32 

  

— 

— 

101 

 

Potential problem loans

Potential problem loans (PPL) are loans for which an impairment event has taken place but no impairment loss is expected. This category is used for advances which are not past due 90 days or revolving credit facilities where identification as 90 days overdue is not feasible.

 

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

2010 

2009 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Potential problem loans

27 

220 

133 

532 

 

Both REIL and PPL are reported gross and take no account of the value of any security held which could reduce the eventual loss should it occur, nor of any provision marked. Therefore impaired assets which are highly collateralised, such as mortgages, will have a low coverage ratio of provisions held against the reported impaired balance.

 

Cross border exposures

Cross border exposures are loans and advances including finance leases and instalment credit receivables and other monetary assets, such as debt securities and net derivatives, including non-local currency claims of overseas offices on local residents.

 

RBSH Group monitors the geographical breakdown of these exposures based on the country of domicile of the borrower or guarantor of ultimate risk. Cross border exposures exclude exposures to local residents in local currencies.

 

The table below sets out RBSH Group’s cross border exposures greater than 0.5% of RBSH Group’s total assets.

 

  

2013 

  

  

Government  

Banks  

Other  

Total  

2012 

2011 

  

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m  

€m 

€m 

Spain

52 

3,524 

1,596 

5,172 

6,143 

8,615 

United States

1,711 

173 

442 

2,326 

2,703 

13,986 

United Kingdom

— 

1,001 

579 

1,580 

2,019 

— 

Germany

400 

493 

20 

913 

2,805 

7,008 

France

305 

241 

268 

814 

1,582 

4,322 

Austria

340 

57 

214 

611 

661 

726*

India

— 

585 

590 

1,088 

5,876 

Italy

514 

13 

62 

589 

736 

2,492 

Belgium

531 

— 

534 

1,084 

1,656 

Brazil

253 

— 

83 

336 

810 

1,223 

Ireland

168 

56 

89 

313 

478 

595*

Indonesia

53 

14 

163 

230 

262*

583*

Qatar

— 

— 

205 

205 

299*

456*

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

* Less than 0.5% of Group total assets.

  

  

  

  

  

  

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           178 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

 

Financial summary continued 

  

  

  

Analysis of deposits – product analysis

  

  

  

The following table shows the distribution of RBSH Group's deposits by type and geographical area.

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Netherlands

  

  

  

Demand deposits – interest-free

366 

478 

388 

                             – interest-bearing

86 

68 

13,195 

Time deposits       – other

16,463 

26,552 

14,266 

Total domestic offices

16,915 

27,098 

27,849 

Overseas

  

  

  

Demand deposits – interest-free

1,894 

2,502 

7,643 

                             – interest-bearing

1,417 

4,919 

30,488 

Time deposits       – savings

— 

629 

                             – other

2,868 

2,583 

19,512 

Total overseas offices

6,179 

10,005 

58,272 

Total deposits

23,094 

37,103 

86,121 

  

  

  

  

Held for trading

1,718 

1,971 

2,265 

Amortised cost

21,376 

35,132 

83,856 

Total deposits

23,094 

37,103 

86,121 

  

  

  

  

Overseas

  

  

  

US

482 

773 

7,075 

Rest of the World

5,697 

9,232 

51,197 

Total overseas offices

6,179 

10,005 

58,272 

 

Certificates of deposit and other time deposits

  

  

  

  

  

The following table shows details of RBSH Group's certificates of deposit and other time deposits over $100,000 or equivalent by remaining maturity.

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Over 3

Over 6

  

  

  

  

 months 

 months 

  

  

  

Within

but within

but within

Over

  

  

3 months

6 months

12 months

12 months

Total

2013 

€m

€m

€m

€m

€m

Domestic

  

  

  

  

  

Other time deposits

392 

3,311 

274 

233 

4,210 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Overseas

  

  

  

  

  

Other time deposits

1,199 

460 

154 

160 

1,973 

  

1,591 

3,771 

428 

393 

6,183 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           179 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Financial summary continued 

Short-term borrowings

The table below shows details of RBSH Group's short-term borrowings. Short-term borrowings comprise repurchase agreements, commercial paper and certificates of deposit.

  

Repurchase 

Commercial  

Certificates of 

Total 

Total 

Total 

agreements 

 paper  

 deposit 

2013 

2012 

2011 

At year end

  

  

  

  

  

  

  - balance (€bn)

12 

12 

13 

21 

  - weighted average interest rate

0.1%

  

  

0.1%

0.5%

0.8%

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

During the year

  

  

  

  

  

  

  - maximum balance (€bn)

15 

15 

22 

46 

  - average balance (€bn)

12 

12 

11 

18 

  - weighted average interest rate

0.1%

0.4%

5.6%

0.3%

0.6%

0.9%

 

Balances are generally based on monthly data. Average interest rates during the year are computed by dividing total interest expense by the average amount borrowed. Average interest rates at year end are average rates for a single day and as such may reflect one-day market distortions, which may not be indicative of generally prevailing rates.

 

Other contractual cash obligations

  

  

  

  

  

  

The table below summarises RBSH Group's other contractual cash obligations by payment date.

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

0 – 3 

3 – 12 

1 – 3 

3 – 5 

5 – 10 

10 – 20 

  

months 

months 

years 

years 

years 

years 

2013 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

€m 

Operating leases

19 

21 

15 

26 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2012 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Operating leases

21 

33 

16 

29 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

 

RBSH Group's undrawn formal facilities, credit lines and other commitments to lend were €847 million (2012 - €4,994 million; 2011 - €22,277 million). While RBSH group has given commitments to provide these funds, some facilities may be subject to certain conditions being met by the counterparty. RBSH group does not expect all facilities to be drawn, and some may lapse before drawdown.

 

Exchange rates

Except as stated, the following tables show, for the dates or periods indicated, the Noon Buying Rate in New York for cable transfers in euro as certified for customs purposes by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York.

  

March 

February 

January 

December 

November 

October 

US dollars per €1

2014 

2014 

2014 

2013 

2013 

2013 

Noon Buying Rate

  

  

  

  

  

  

High

1.39 

1.38 

1.37 

1.38 

1.36 

1.38 

Low

1.37 

1.35 

1.35 

1.36 

1.34 

1.35 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

2013 

2012 

2011 

2010 

2009 

Noon Buying Rate

  

  

  

  

  

  

Period end rate

  

1.38 

1.32 

1.30 

1.33 

1.43 

Average rate for the period (1)

  

1.33 

1.29 

1.40 

1.32 

1.39 

  

  

  

  

  

  

  

Consolidation rate (2) 

  

  

  

  

  

  

Period end rate

  

1.38 

1.32 

1.29 

1.34 

1.44 

Average rate for the period

  

1.33 

1.29 

1.39 

1.33 

1.39 

 

Notes:

(1)    The average of the Noon Buying Rates on the last business day of each month during the period.

(2)    The rates used by RBSH Group for translating US dollars into euro in the preparation of its financial statements.

(3)    On 25 April 2014, the Noon Buying Rate was €1.00 = $1.38.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           180 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Economic and monetary environment 

It has been noted before that when economies are emerging from recessions rooted in high levels of debt and stresses in the financial system, growth is slower than in the typical recovery. That was the experience again in 2013 in the major markets in which RBSH Group operates.

 

Total economic activity in the Netherlands as measured by gross domestic product (GDP) was 1.3% lower in the year to the third quarter of 2013 than in the year to the third quarter of 2012. The falls in investment (-7.3%) and household consumption (-2.3%) were especially steep. The unemployment rate increased from 7.2% to 8.5%.  Inflation fell sharply, from 3.2% at the start of the year to 1.4% at the end. Owner occupied house prices declined by 6.4%. However, the consumer confidence index improved during the year, from -36 to -12, although that was still below its long-run average. According to Consensus Economics, GDP will grow by 0.5% in 2014.

 

In the UK, performance improved. Total economic activity, as measured by GDP, grew by 1.9% compared with growth of 0.3% in 2012. At the start of the year, expectations had been for an increase of only 1.0%. Consumption led the way, despite falling real wages. There were more people in work and households drew down savings to fund spending.

 

Unemployment fell, from around 7.9% at the start of the year to 7.0% at its end.

 

Housing market activity accelerated sharply, prompted in part by measures to encourage house purchase such as Help to Buy. According to the Halifax house price index, the average price of a house in the UK increased by 5.8% during the year. Other indices reported stronger price growth. Prices look to have risen in all parts of the UK but inflation was strongest in London, where prices rose by more than 10%.

 

Inflation ended the year at the 2.0% target having averaged 2.6% for the year as a whole. The Bank of England continued its ultra-loose monetary policy stance. The Bank Rate remained at 0.5%, although market rates increased towards the end of the year on expectations of tighter monetary policy in the United States. There were no additions to the stock of assets purchased through the quantitative easing programme. In August 2013, the Monetary Policy Committee began offering ‘forward guidance’ on its intentions. It said that it will not consider changing the Bank Rate or the stock of assets purchased until the unemployment rate reaches 7.0%, unless inflation threatens to take off or there are concerns about financial stability.

 

The Funding for Lending Scheme was adjusted during the course of the year to enhance the incentives to banks to lend to small firms and later to withdraw that support for lending to individuals. The Bank of England’s Credit Conditions Survey suggested that the supply of credit had expanded towards the end of the year.

 

In the face of considerable fiscal austerity and continuing disputes about the public finances, which led to a government shutdown in the autumn, GDP growth in the United States was 1.9% compared with 2.8% in 2012. There was encouraging news on the job market, where unemployment had fallen to 6.7% in December 2013, although part of the fall was accounted for by people leaving the job market rather than finding work. The housing market again performed strongly, with prices up 14% in the year to November.

 

In December, the Federal Reserve took the first formal steps towards tightening monetary policy. It announced that it would reduce the amount of assets purchased under its quantitative easing programme by $10 billion each month, with the programme likely to be ended in the second half of 2014. It maintained its guidance that the Fed Funds Target Rate would remain at 0.25% until the unemployment rate reaches 6.5%.

 

Entering 2013, the greatest economic concern was how problems related to sovereign debt in the euro zone would be managed. With the exception of Cyprus, there were none of the episodes of concern that had marked previous years. Markets were generally convinced that the European Central Bank would indeed ‘do what it takes’ to sustain the single currency. Further steps were taken towards a banking union. Nevertheless, the region’s economy remained weak. Unemployment averaged 12.1%, a record, and inflation fell to 0.8% at the end of the year.

 

Supervision

Netherlands

RBSH Group is regulated in the Netherlands by De Nederlandsche Bank (DNB) and the Netherlands Authority for the Financial Markets (Autoriteit Financiële Markten (AFM).

 

RBSH Group’s regulatory system in the Netherlands is a comprehensive system based on the provisions of the Financial Supervision Act which came into effect on 1 January 2007. The Financial Supervision Act has replaced, amongst others, the Act on the Supervision of the Credit System 1992 without affecting the existing supervisory system.

 

The Financial Supervision Act sets out rules regarding prudential supervision by DNB and supervision of conduct by the AFM. Prudential supervision focuses on the solidity of financial undertakings and contributes to the stability of the financial sector. Supervision of

conduct focuses on orderly and transparent financial market processes, clear relations between market participants and due care in the treatment of clients (including supervision of the securities and investment businesses).

 

Prudential supervision

Prudential supervision of credit institutions in the Netherlands is performed by DNB under the Financial Supervision Act. No enterprise or institution established in the Netherlands may pursue the business of a credit institution unless it has obtained prior authorisation from DNB.

 

Its supervisory activities under the Financial Supervision Act focus on supervision of solvency, liquidity and administrative organisation, including risk management and internal control.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           181 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Supervision continued

If, in the opinion of DNB, a credit institution fails to comply with the rules and regulations regarding the above mentioned subjects, DNB will notify the credit institution and may instruct the credit institution to behave in a certain manner. If the credit institution does not respond to any such instructions to the satisfaction of DNB, DNB is allowed to exercise additional supervisory measures that may include the imposition of fines.

 

Prudential supervision also oversees calculation of significant intra-group agreements, adjusted solvency, calculation of capital adequacy and significant risk concentrations. It also determines the models used by the financial undertakings to report the calculations to DNB. Finally, the regulation lays down reporting rules, for example reporting deadlines and reporting frequency.

 

Conduct of business supervision

The body responsible for carrying out this supervision in the Netherlands is the AFM.

 

Conduct of business supervision focuses on ensuring orderly and transparent financial market processes, proper relationships between market participants and the exercise of due care by financial undertakings in dealing with clients.

 

The Financial Supervision Act provides that each supervised credit institution must submit periodic reports to DNB. In accordance with this requirement RBSH Group files quarterly and monthly reports with DNB.

 

At least one submission for each given year must be certified by an external auditor. The report to be certified is selected by an external auditor at his or her discretion.

 

On 1 July 2008 a decree pursuant to the Financial Supervision Act was extended to incorporate the requirements for eligibility of covered bonds. Dutch issuers of covered bonds now have the facility to register their programs with DNB. The new legislation is designed to protect the interest of covered bond holders through special supervision by DNB of the recognised covered bond programs. An issuer must comply with several conditions when submitting a program for recognition and demonstrate compliance to these conditions through the provision of specific documentation and information. Once a program is registered, the issuer will have ongoing administration and reporting obligations to adhere to.

 

Solvency supervision

Capital adequacy framework (Basel)

In 2004, the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision endorsed the publication of the ‘International Convergence of Capital Measurement and Capital Standards: a Revised Framework’, commonly referred to as Basel II. The Capital Requirements Directive, representing the translation of Basel II to EU legislation and replacing the Capital Adequacy Directive, was approved by the European Parliament in 2005. This acceptance by the European Parliament cleared the way in Europe for the implementation of the Capital Requirements Directive, with a published compliance date of 1 January 2008.

 

The implementation process of Basel II into Dutch legislation (Financial Supervision Act) and regulation was completed in December 2006 when DNB published its supervisory rules. The compliance date in the European Union was 1 January 2008.

 

Basel II provides three approaches of increasing sophistication to the calculation of credit risk capital: the Standardised Approach, the Internal Ratings Based Foundation Approach, and the Internal Ratings Based Advanced Approach. Basel II also introduces capital requirements for operational risk for the first time. Basel II is structured around the three following ‘pillars’.

 

Pillar 1 sets out minimum regulatory capital requirements, that is, the minimum amount of capital banks must hold against credit, operational and market risks.

Pillar 2 sets out the key principles for supervisory review of an institution’s risk management framework and, ultimately, its capital adequacy. It sets out specific oversight responsibilities for the Board and senior management, thus reinforcing principles of internal control and other corporate governance practices. Pillar 2 requires that the institutions conduct an internal capital adequacy assessment process.

 

Pillar 3 aims to bolster market discipline through enhanced disclosure by banks.

With effect from 30 June 2010, RBSH Group migrated to Basel II status. For the majority of credit risk, RBSH Group uses the advanced internal ratings based approach for calculating RWAs. For operational risk, RBSH Group uses the basic indicator approach, which calculates operational risk capital charge RWA equivalent on the average operating income for three years times a fixed percentage of 15%.

 

In addition to the calculation of minimum capital requirements for credit, market and operational risk, banks are required to undertake an Individual Capital Adequacy Assessment Process (ICAAP) for other risks. RBSH Group’s ICAAP, in particular, focuses on concentration risk, stress VaR, pension fund risk, interest rate risk in the banking book, FX translation risk together with stress tests to assess the adequacy of capital over two  years.

 

RBSH Group is consolidated for regulatory reporting within the RBS Group. Pillar 3 information for RBSH Group is included within the RBS Group Pillar 3 disclosures. RBS Group publishes its Pillar 3 (Market disclosures) on its website www.rbs.com, providing a range of additional information relating to Basel II risk, liquidity and capital management across the RBS Group. The disclosures focus on capital resources and adequacy, discuss a range of credit risk approaches and their associated RWAs under various Basel II approaches. Detailed disclosures are also made on credit risk mitigation, counterparty credit risk, interest rate risk in the banking book, provisions, equity, securitisation, operational and market risk.

 

RBSH Group operates in multiple jurisdictions and is subject to a number of regulatory regimes. 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           182 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Supervision continued

RBSH Group's lead regulator in the Netherlands is DNB. RBSH Group are direct and indirect subsidiaries of the RBS Group whose lead regulatory in the UK is the Prudential Regulation Authority (PRA). In the US, RBSH Group’s operations are required to meet liquidity requirements set out by the US Federal Reserve Bank, Office of the Comptroller of the Currency, Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation and Financial Industry Regulatory Authority.

 

Exposure supervision

DNB has issued specific rules with respect to large exposures to a single borrower or group of interconnected borrowers, or in relation to certain other businesses that involve a concentration of risk. Large exposures generally include all assets and off-balance sheet items of a credit institution with respect to a single borrower or group of interconnected borrowers which exceed 10% of a credit institution’s total capital. Large exposures must be reported once every quarter to DNB.

 

There is a limit of 25% of total capital for a single large exposure as part of the banking book. Trading book positions may exceed this limit subject to additional solvency requirements.

 

Liquidity supervision

Banks are required to report on a consolidated level on their liquidity position to DNB monthly, on the basis of the liquidity supervision directive. The liquidity directive seeks to ensure that banks are in a position to cope with an acute short term liquidity shortage under the assumption that banks would remain solvent. In principle, DNB liquidity directive covers all direct domestic and foreign establishments (subsidiaries/branches), including majority participations. The regulatory report also takes into consideration the liquidity effects of derivatives and the potential drawings under committed facilities.

 

The directive places emphasis on the short term in testing the liquidity position over a period of up to one month with a separate test of the liquidity position in the first week. For observation purposes, several additional maturity bands are included in the liquidity report (one to three months, three to six months, six months to one year and beyond one year).

 

Available liquidity must always exceed required liquidity. Available liquidity and required liquidity are calculated by applying weighting factors to the relevant on- and off-balance sheet items, i.e. irrevocable commitments. The liquidity test includes all currencies. A surplus in a non convertible or non transferable currency however needs to be ignored or explicitly taken out. Compliance reports concerning liquidity requirements of foreign subsidiaries are submitted to the appropriate foreign regulatory authorities as required. At a consolidated level, and in every country in which RBSH Group operates, RBSH Group adheres to the liquidity standards imposed by the applicable regulatory authorities.

 

In accordance with the principles of the European Banking Authority (EBA) and the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (BCBS) and as articulated in DNB's Liquidity Policy Rule (Beleidsregel liquiditeit Wft 2011) RBSH Group is required to regularly carry out an Internal Liquidity Adequacy Assessment Process (ILAAP). The ILAAP covers RBSH Group's assessment of liquidity risks under the severe ILAAP stress test scenarios, the adequacy of liquidity resources and liquidity management systems and controls. The liquidity risks run by RBSH Group are quantified through severe but plausible stress testing scenarios. Key to the ILAAP stress testing process is the benefit of actual experience during the financial crisis and the access to historic data to support the ILAAP outflow assumptions which are key inputs into the ‘Quantitative Liquidity Stress Testing’ (QLST) process. QLST is an essential part of RBSH Group’s risk management process and enables RBSH Group to model the impact of the different stress scenarios on the liquidity position.

 

Structural supervision

Pursuant to the Financial Supervision Act, banks are prohibited to hold, acquire or increase a qualifying holding or exercise any control relating to a qualifying holding in a bank in the Netherlands, except if it has obtained a Declaration of No Objection (DNO) from DNB (or in certain specified cases from the Dutch Minister of Finance). Qualifying holding means a participation of at least 10% in the issued share capital of the related voting rights or similar influence. The DNO would be issued unless the qualifying holding in the bank concerned would lead to an influence which might jeopardise sound and prudent operations or the qualifying holding could or would lead to an undesirable development of the financial sector.

 

DNB or the Dutch Minister of Finance can, on request, grant so-called bandwidths, umbrella and group-DNOs in respect of qualifying holdings. A DNO is not required in case of a qualifying holding by a bank in a company whose assets consist of more than 90% liquid assets.

 

According to Dutch regulation, a DNO will not be issued regarding qualifying holding by a bank in a non-financial institution if the value of the equity participation would exceed 15% of a bank’s regulatory capital and if the participation would cause the value of the bank’s aggregate qualifying holdings in non-financial institutions to exceed 60% of its regulatory capital. Certain types of participations will be approved in principle, although in certain circumstances a DNO will have a limited period of validity, such as in the case of a debt rescheduling or rescue operation or when the participation is acquired and held as part of an issue underwriting operation. Generally the approval will be given where the value of the non-financial institution concerned or the value of the participation does not exceed certain threshold amounts.

 

Supervision of the securities and investment businesses

RBSH Group is also subject to supervision of its activities in the securities business. The Financial Supervision Act, which has replaced the Act on the Supervision of the Securities Trade 1995 together with the decrees and regulations promulgated thereunder, provides a comprehensive framework for the conduct of securities trading in or from the Netherlands. The AFM is charged by the Dutch Minister of Finance with supervision of the securities industry.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           183 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Supervision continued

United States

RBSH is both a bank holding company and a financial holding company within the meaning of the US Bank Holding Company Act of 1956. As such, it is subject to the regulation and supervision of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (’the Federal Reserve’). Among other things, RBSH Group's direct and indirect activities and investments in the United States are limited to those that are 'financial in nature' or 'incidental' or 'complementary' to a financial activity, as determined by the Federal Reserve.

 

RBSH Group is also required to obtain the prior approval of the Federal Reserve before acquiring directly or indirectly, the ownership or control of more than 5% of any class of the voting shares of any US bank or holding company. Under current Federal Reserve policy, RBSH Group is required to act as a source of financial strength for its US bank subsidiaries. Among other things, this source of strength obligation could require RBSH Group to inject capital into any of its US bank subsidiaries if any of them became undercapitalised.

 

Anti-money laundering, anti-terrorism and economic sanctions regulations are a major focus of the US government for financial institutions and are rigorously enforced by US government agencies.

 

United Kingdom

The PRA is the consolidated supervisor of RBS Group. In the UK, RBS Group is subject to extensive regulations that impose obligations on financial institutions to maintain appropriate policies, procedures and controls to ensure compliance with the rules and regulations to which they are subject.

 

Other jurisdictions

RBSH Group operates in over 12 countries through a network of branches, local banks and non-bank subsidiaries and these activities are subject to supervision in most cases by a local regulator or central bank.

 

Major shareholders

On 17 October 2007, RFS Holdings B.V. (RFS Holdings), a company incorporated by RBS Group, Fortis and Santander acquired 85.6% of RBS Holdings N.V. Through subsequent purchases RFS Holdings increased its stake in RBSH Group to 99.3% as at 31 December 2007. RFS Holdings started squeeze-out proceedings in order to acquire the remainder of the shares in RBSH Group from minority shareholders and this procedure was completed on 22 September 2008. As a result RFS Holdings is from that date the sole shareholder of RBS Holdings N.V. RFS Holdings is controlled by The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc, which is incorporated in the UK and registered at 36 St. Andrew Square, Edinburgh, Scotland and The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc is the ultimate parent company of RBSH Group Holding N.V.

 

On 3 October 2008, the Dutch State fully acquired all Fortis’ businesses in the Netherlands, including the Fortis share in RFS Holdings. On 24 December 2008, the Dutch State purchased from Fortis Bank Nederland (Holding) N.V. its investment in RFS Holdings, to become a direct shareholder in RFS Holdings. On 31 December 2010, RBS Group increased its shareholding in RFS Holdings to 97.72%. As of that date, the Dutch State has a 1.25% shareholding and Santander has a 1.03% shareholding. On 7 November 2012 the Dutch State transferred its investment to Stichting Administratiekantoor Beheer Financiële Instellingen.

 

Stock exchange listings

None of the shares in RBSH Group are listed.

 

Issued share capital

The issued share capital of RBS Holdings N.V. consists of 89,287 ordinary shares with a nominal value of €0.56 each.

 

Material contracts

RBSH Group are party to various contracts in the ordinary course of business. Material contracts include the following:

 

Participation in UK Government’s Asset Protection Scheme

In 2009, RBS plc, entered into an agreement (the Asset Protection Scheme (APS)) with HM Treasury (HMT), acting on behalf of the UK Government, under which it purchased credit protection over a portfolio of specified assets and exposures (covered assets) from HMT

 

Although the portfolio of covered assets included assets recorded on RBSH Group’s balance sheet, RBSH Group was not entitled to benefit under this contract. 

 

However, RBSH Group entered into credit protection agreements in 2009 in the form of a financial guarantee contract and a credit derivative contract with RBS plc that provides full principal protection over those covered assets attributable to RBSH Group for their remaining life. 

 

Under the terms of these contracts on impairment of a covered asset RBSH Group is entitled to receive from RBS plc the present value of the difference between contractual and expected cash flows from the asset; subsequent reductions in the estimated lost cash flows are paid by RBSH Group to RBS plc and increases paid by RBS plc to RBSH Group. 

 

Although the RBS Group’s participation in the APS ceased in October 2012, these arrangements between RBSH Group and RBS plc remain in place.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           184 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

 

Material contracts continued

EC Remedy

On 26 November 2009, RBS Group entered into a State Aid Commitment Deed with HM Treasury of the United Kingdom government, containing commitments and undertakings given by RBS Group to HM Treasury that are designed to ensure that HM Treasury is able to comply with the commitments given by it to the European Commission for the purpose of obtaining approval for the State aid provided to RBS Group. As part of these commitments, RBS Group agreed that RBS Holdings would not pay investors any coupons on, or exercise any call rights in relation to, the hybrid capital instruments issued by RBS N.V. listed below, unless in any such case there was a legal obligation to do so, for an effective period of two years.

 

The two-year distribution restriction period in relation to the hybrid capital instruments commenced on 1 April 2011 and ended on 1 April 2013.

 

·         5.90% Non-cumulative Guaranteed Trust Preferred Securities of Funding Trust V (US74928K2087)

 

·         6.25% Non-cumulative Guaranteed Trust Preferred Securities of RBS Capital Funding Trust VI (US74928M2044)

 

·         6.08% Non-cumulative Guaranteed Trust Preferred Securities of RBS Capital Funding Trust VII (US74928P2074)

 

RBSH Group was also subject to restrictions on the exercise of call rights in relation to its other hybrid capital instruments.  

 

Dividends

RBSH Group's policy is to pay dividends on ordinary shares taking account the capital position and prospects. For further information on the payment of dividends, see page 111.

 

Off-balance sheet arrangements

RBSH Group has no off-balance sheet exposures that have or are reasonably likely to have an adverse effect on its financial condition, changes in financial condition, revenues or expenses, results of operations, liquidity, capital expenditures or capital resources.

 

For a discussion of the impact of off-balance sheet commitments and contingent liabilities see Note 25 to the Financial Statements.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           185 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Risk factors

Set out below are  risk factors which could have a material adverse effect on the business, operations, financial condition or prospects of RBSH Group and cause RBSH Group’s future results to be materially different from expected results. RBSH Group’s results could also be affected by competition and other factors. RBSH Group is a principal subsidiary of RBSG and accordingly, risk factors which relate to RBSG and RBS Group will also be of relevance to RBSH Group. The factors discussed in this report should not be regarded as a complete and comprehensive statement of all potential risks and uncertainties.

 

RBSH Group is reliant on the RBS Group

RBSH Group is part of the RBS Group and receives capital, liquidity and funding support from the RBS Group. At 31 December 2013, RBSH Group funding included €17.7 billion (2012 - €28.5 billion) due to companies in the RBS Group of which €11.7 billion (2012 - €12.6 billion) was secured. RBSH Group also obtained capital support through its credit protection agreements with RBS. At 31 December 2013, these agreements reduced RBSH Group’s regulatory capital requirement by €238 million (2012 - €338 million). In 2009, in connection with the agreement (the Asset Protection Scheme (APS)) between RBS and HM Treasury (HMT), acting on behalf of the UK Government, under which RBS purchased credit protection over a portfolio of specified assets and exposures (covered assets) from HMT, including certain assets recorded on RBSH Group’s balance sheet, RBSH Group entered into back-to-back credit protection agreements with RBS (the Contracts) that provide full principal protection over those covered assets attributable to RBSH Group for their remaining life. In addition, much of RBSH Group’s banking operations function on the RBS Group's integrated global infrastructure. These operations include: sales and marketing; customer recognition; transaction processing and execution; recordkeeping; settlement services; compliance monitoring; risk management; treasury management; accounting and financial reporting; taxation advice; information technology services; purchasing; office accommodation and administration; human resources management; and internal audit.

 

The reduction or cessation of the ability of the RBS Group, pursuant to the Contracts or otherwise, to provide intra-group funding, capital injections, liquidity or other support directly or indirectly to RBSH Group may result in funding or capital pressures and liquidity stress for RBSH Group and may have a material adverse effect on the operations, financial condition and results of operations of RBSH Group. As a result of the transfers of a substantial part of the business activities from RBS N.V. to RBS as discussed in the risk factor below headed ‘The execution and/or any delay in the execution (or non-completion) of the approved proposed transfers of a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. to RBS may have a material adverse effect on RBSH Group; the residual Group will become more reliant on the RBS Group for capital, liquidity and funding support than it is currently. Accordingly, risk factors which relate to RBSG or the RBS Group will also be of relevance to prospective investors.

 

RBSH Group is subject to a number of legal and regulatory actions and investigations. Unfavourable outcomes in such actions and investigations could have a material adverse effect on RBSH Group’s operating results or reputation

RBSH Group’s operations are diverse and complex and it operates in legal and regulatory environments that expose it to potentially significant litigation, regulatory and governmental investigations and other regulatory risk. As a result, RBSH Group is, and may in the future be, involved in a number of legal and regulatory proceedings and investigations in the Netherlands, the United Kingdom, other parts of the EU, the United States and other jurisdictions.

 

RBSH Group is involved in ongoing class action litigation, continuing rate setting related litigation and investigations, securitisation and securities related litigation, and anti-money laundering, sanctions and compliance related investigations, in addition to a number of other matters. For more detail on RBSH Group’s ongoing legal and regulatory proceedings, see pages 149 to 152. In addition to these ongoing legal and regulatory proceedings, RBS Group has recently settled a number of legal and regulatory investigations including a settlement reached on 6 February 2013, with the Financial Services Authority, the Commodity Futures Trading Association and the United States Department of Justice and on 4 December 2013 in respect of the LIBOR investigations. In addition, RBSG and the Royal Bank reached a settlement with the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, the New York State Department of Financial Services and the Office of Foreign Assets Control with respect to the Royal Bank’s historical compliance with US economic sanction regulations outside the United States. RBS Group continues to cooperate with these and other governmental and regulatory authorities in connection with ongoing investigations and the probable outcome is that it will incur additional financial penalties which may be material. Legal, governmental and regulatory proceedings and investigations are subject to many uncertainties, and their outcomes, including the timing and amount of fines or settlements, which may be material, are often difficult to predict, particularly in the early stages of a case or investigation.

 

Adverse regulatory proceedings or adverse judgments in litigation could result in restrictions or limitations on RBSH Group’s operations or have a significant effect on RBSH Group’s reputation, results of operations and capital position. It is expected that RBSH Group will continue to have a material exposure to legacy litigation and regulatory matter proceedings in the medium term.

 

RBSH Group may be required to increase provisions in relation to ongoing legal proceedings, investigations and regulatory matters. Significant increases in provisions may harm RBSH Group’s reputation and may have an adverse effect on RBSH Group’s financial condition and results of operations.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           186 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Risk factors continued

RBSH Group, like many other financial institutions, has come under greater regulatory scrutiny in recent years and expects that environment to continue for the foreseeable future, particularly as it relates to compliance with historical, new and existing corporate governance, employee compensation, conduct of business, anti-money laundering and anti-terrorism laws and regulations, as well as the provisions of applicable sanctions programmes. Past or current failure to comply with any one or more of these laws or regulations could have a significant adverse effect on RBSH Group’s reputation, financial condition and results of operations.

 

RBSH Group could fail to attract or retain senior management, which may include members of RBSH Group’s Supervisory Board and Managing Board, or other key employees, and it may suffer losses if it does not maintain good employee relations

RBSH Group’s ability to implement its strategy and its future success depends on its ability to attract, retain and remunerate highly skilled and qualified personnel, including its senior management, which include members of RBSH Group’s Supervisory Board and Managing Board or other key employees, competitively with its peers. This cannot be guaranteed, particularly in light of heightened regulatory oversight of banks and heightened scrutiny of, and (in some cases) restrictions placed upon, management and employee compensation arrangements, in particular those in receipt of Government support (such as the RBS Group).

 

In addition to the effects of such measures on RBSH Group’s ability to retain senior management and other key employees, the marketplace for skilled personnel is more competitive, which means the cost of hiring, training and retaining skilled personnel may continue to increase. The failure to attract or retain a sufficient number of appropriately skilled personnel could place RBSH Group at a significant competitive disadvantage and prevent RBSH Group from successfully implementing its strategy, which could have a material adverse effect on RBSH Group’s financial condition and results of operations.

 

A number of the members of senior management of the RBS Group are also members of RBSH Group’s supervisory board. During 2013, the RBS Group replaced its Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and Chief Risk Officer and in October 2013 its newly appointed Chief Financial Officer resigned. A new CFO was appointed with effect from 19 May 2014. Because of the overlap between the members of RBS Group management and RBSH’s supervisory board, these changes impacted RBSH, resulting in successive changes of the chairman of the supervisory board. The lack of continuity of senior management and the loss of important personnel within RSBG could have an adverse impact on the implementation of RBSH’s strategic objectives and regulatory commitments.

 

In addition, certain of RBSH Group’s employees in Europe and other jurisdictions in which RBSH Group operates are represented by employee representative bodies, including works councils and trade unions. Engagement with its employees and such bodies is important to RBSH Group and a breakdown of these relationships could adversely affect RBSH Group’s business, reputation and results of operations.

 

The execution and/or any delay in the execution (or non-completion) of the approved transfers of a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. to RBS plc may have a material adverse effect on RBSH Group

As part of the restructuring of the RBS Group businesses, operations and assets, on 19 April 2011, the RBS Group announced the proposed transfers of a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. to RBS plc (the Transfers). The Transfers have been carried out through 2011, 2012 and 2013 with the transfer of the eligible UK businesses completed during the last quarter of 2011, transfers relating to businesses in Singapore, Hong Kong and Kazakhstan, RBS N.V. businesses and other eligible businesses in the Netherlands, certain EMEA countries, Malaysia, Turkey and the United Arab Emirates completed in 2012 and transfers of businesses in Russia, Romania, Korea and North America completed in 2013. RBSH concluded that it would not be possible to transfer its businesses in China, India, Thailand and Indonesia during 2013. The intention is to transfer the remainder of these businesses to RBS plc.

 

The process for implementing the Transfers has been and is complex and any failure to satisfy any conditions or complete any preliminary steps to each Transfer may cause a delay in its completion (or result in its non-completion). If any of the remaining Transfers are further delayed (or are not completed) for any reason, such as a failure to secure required regulatory approvals, it is possible that the relevant regulatory authorities could impose sanctions which could adversely impact the minimum regulatory requirements for capital and liquidity of RBS N.V. A delay in implementation of (or any failure to implement) any of the Transfers may therefore adversely impact RBS N.V.’s capital and liquidity resources and requirements, with consequential adverse impacts on its funding resources and requirements, resulting in an increase in its reliance on the RBS Group.

 

Operational risks are inherent in RBSH Group’s businesses

Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems, or from external events. RBSH Group has complex and geographically diverse operations and operational risk and losses can result from internal and external fraud, errors by employees or third parties, failure to document transactions properly or to obtain proper authorisation, failure to comply with applicable regulatory requirements and conduct of business rules (including those arising out of anti-bribery, anti-money laundering and anti-terrorism legislation, as well as the provisions of applicable sanctions regimes), equipment failures, business continuity and data security system failures, natural disasters or the inadequacy or failure of systems and controls, including those of RBSH Group’s suppliers or counterparties. Although RBSH Group has implemented risk controls and loss mitigation actions, and substantial resources are devoted to developing efficient procedures, to identify and rectify weaknesses in existing procedures and to train staff, it is not possible to be certain that such actions have been or will be effective in controlling each of the operational risks faced by RBSH Group. Ineffective management of operational risks could have a material adverse effect on RBSH Group’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           187 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Risk factors continued

RBSH Group operates in markets that are highly competitive and its business and results of operations may be adversely affected

The competitive landscape for banks and other financial institutions in the Netherlands, the United Kingdom, the United States and throughout the rest of Europe is subject to rapid change and recent regulatory and legal changes are likely to result in new market participants and changed competitive dynamics in certain key areas. In order to compete effectively, certain financial institutions may seek to consolidate their businesses or assets with other parties.

 

This consolidation, in combination with the introduction of new entrants into the markets in which RBSH Group operates, is likely to increase competitive pressures on RBSH Group.

 

In addition, certain competitors may have stronger and more efficient operations, including better IT systems, allowing them to implement innovative technologies for delivering services to their customers, and may have access to lower cost funding and/or be able to attract deposits on more favourable terms than RBSH Group. Furthermore, RBSH Group’s competitors may be better able to attract and retain clients and key employees, which may have a negative impact on RBSH Group’s relative performance and future prospects. In addition, recent and future disposals and restructurings by RBSH Group and the compensation structure and restrictions imposed on RBSH Group may also have an impact on its ability to compete effectively. These and other changes to the competitive landscape could adversely affect RBSH Group’s business, margins, profitability, financial condition and prospects.

 

RBSH Group’s businesses and performance can be negatively affected by actual or perceived global economic and financial market conditions

RBSH Group’s businesses and performance are affected by local and global economic conditions, perceptions of those conditions and future economic prospects. The outlook for the global economy over the near to medium-term is for steady growth. Risks to growth and stability stem mainly from continued imbalances – among and within countries – and from uncertainty about how economies will respond as the extraordinary monetary policy measures implemented during the crisis are unwound. RBSH Group’s businesses and performance are also affected by financial market conditions. Capital and credit markets around the world have been relatively stable since 2012. Although the risk of sovereign default relating to certain EU member states diminished during 2013, a number of EU countries had their credit ratings downgraded, and the lingering risk of a sovereign default continues to pose a threat to capital and credit markets. In addition, in response to actions of central banks, in particular the US Federal Reserve’s actions with respect to tapering of its debt purchase program, there have been short periods of rapid movements in interest rates and significant sharp falls on equity markets and further market volatility is likely as tapering continues.

 

Challenging economic and market conditions create a difficult operating environment for RBSH Group’s businesses, which is characterised by:

 

·         reduced activity levels, additional write-downs and impairment charges and lower profitability, which may restrict the ability of RBSH Group to access funding and liquidity;

·         central bank actions to engender economic growth which have resulted in a prolonged period of low interest rates constraining, through margin compression and low returns on assets, the interest income earned on RBSH Group’s interest earning assets; and

·         the risk of increased volatility in yields and asset valuations as central banks start/accelerate the process of tightening or unwinding historically unprecedented loose monetary policy or extraordinary measures. The resulting environment of uncertainty for the market and consumers will lead to challenging trading and market conditions.

 

In particular, should economic recovery stagnate, particularly in RBSH Group’s key markets, or the scope and severity of the adverse economic conditions currently experienced by a number of EU member states and elsewhere, worsen the risks faced by RBSH Group would be exacerbated. Developments relating to the current economic conditions and the risk of a return to a volatile financial environment, including those discussed above, could have a material adverse effect on RBSH Group’s business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects.

 

RBSH Group has significant exposure to a weakening of the nascent economic recovery in Europe

In Europe, countries such as Ireland, Italy, Greece, Portugal and Spain have been particularly affected by the recent macroeconomic and financial conditions. Although the risk of sovereign default continued to decline in 2013 due to the continuing actions of the European Central Bank (ECB) and the EU, the risk of default remains and yields on the sovereign debt of many EU member states have remained well above pre-crisis levels. This default risk raises concerns, and the possibility remains that the contagion effect spreads to other EU economies, that the euro could be abandoned as a currency by one or more countries that have already adopted its use, or in an extreme scenario, that the abandonment of the euro could result in the dissolution of the European Monetary Union (“EMU”). This would lead to the re-introduction of individual currencies in one or more EMU member states.

 

The effects on the European and global economies of any potential dissolution of the EMU, exit of one or more EU member states from the EMU and the redenomination of financial instruments from the euro to a different currency, are impossible to predict fully. However, if any such events were to occur they would likely:

 

·         result in significant market dislocation;

·         heighten counterparty risk;

·         result in downgrades of credit ratings for European borrowers, giving rise to increases in credit spreads and decreases in security values;

 

·         disrupt and adversely affect the economic activity of European markets; and

·         adversely affect the management of market risk and in particular asset and liability management due, in part, to redenomination of financial assets and liabilities and the potential for mismatch.

 

The occurrence of any of these events would have a material adverse effect on RBSH Group’s financial condition, results of operations and prospects.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           188 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Risk factors continued

RBSH Group is subject to other global risks

By virtue of RBSH Group’s global presence, RBSH Group is exposed to risks arising out of geopolitical events, such as the existence of trade barriers, the implementation of exchange controls and other measures taken by sovereign governments that can hinder economic or financial activity levels. Furthermore, unfavourable political, military or diplomatic events, armed conflict, pandemics and terrorist acts and threats, and the response to them by governments could also adversely affect levels of economic activity and have an adverse effect upon RBSH Group’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

RBSH Group’s business performance could be adversely affected if its capital is not managed effectively or as a result of changes to capital adequacy and liquidity requirements

Effective management of RBSH Group’s capital is critical to its ability to operate its businesses and to pursue its strategy. RBSH Group is required by regulators in the Netherlands and other jurisdictions in which it undertakes regulated activities to maintain adequate capital resources. The maintenance of adequate capital is also necessary for RBSH Group’s financial flexibility in the face of continuing turbulence and uncertainty in the global economy.

 

The Basel Committee on Banking Supervision’s package of reforms to the regulatory capital framework raises the quantity and quality of capital required to be held by a financial institution with an emphasis on common equity Tier 1 (“CET1”) capital and introduces an additional requirement for both a capital conservation buffer and a countercyclical buffer to be met with CET1 capital. The Basel Committee also has proposed that global systemically important banks (“GSIBs”) be subject to an additional CET1 capital requirement, depending on a bank’s systemic importance.

 

The RBS Group has been identified by the Financial Stability Board (“FSB”) as a GSIB. The FSB list of G-SIBs is updated annually, based on new data and changes to methodology. The November 2013 update placed the RBS Group in the second from bottom bucket of G-SIBs, subjecting to more intensive oversight and supervision and requiring it to have additional loss absorption capacity of 1.5% in CET1, to be phased in from the beginning of 2016.

 

The Basel III rules are dependent on local implementation. The EU legislative package of proposals to implement the changes with a new Directive and Regulation (collectively known as “CRD IV”) was finalised in June 2013 paving the way for implementation of Basel III in the EU from 1 January 2014, subject to a number of transitional provisions and clarifications. A number of the requirements introduced under CRD IV will be further supplemented through the Regulatory and Implementing Technical Standards (RTSs/ITSs) produced by the European Banking Authority (“EBA”) which are not yet finalised. The EU rules deviate from the Basel III rules in certain aspects (e.g. in imposing an additional systemic risk buffer), and provide national flexibility to apply more stringent prudential requirements than set in the EU (or Basel) framework. Since 1 January 2014, RBSH has been required to comply with the requirements of CRD IV, the EBA’s RTSs and ITSs.

 

In addition, RBS N.V. is among the selected banks that are subject to the comprehensive assessment conducted by the European Central Bank (ECB) and the national competent authorities. The comprehensive assessment is an essential element of the preparations for the Single Supervisory Mechanism (SSM), providing the necessary clarity on the banks that may be subject to the ECB’s direct supervision. The comprehensive assessment is expected to be concluded in October 2014 prior to the start of the SSM in November 2014. The outcome of the comprehensive assessment may lead to a range of follow-up actions, possibly including enhanced provisioning, as well as recapitalisation, asset separation and sales, and other measures.

 

The UK government’s implementation of the Independent Commission on Banking’s recommendations through the Financial Services (Banking Reform) Act 2013 (the “Banking Reform Act 2013”) which became law in the United Kingdom on 18 December 2013 and will be implemented through secondary legislation due to be completed by May 2015, will introduce mechanisms requiring systemically important UK banks and building societies to hold loss absorbing capacity, in addition to the capital held to satisfy their capital requirements under CRD IV, as implemented by the PRA. These requirements, as well as the other recommendations of the ICB, including ring-fencing and other customer protection measures, are to be established through secondary legislation and are expected to be phased in between 2015 and 2019. The US Federal Reserve has also proposed changes in how it will regulate the US operations of foreign banking operations such as RBSH Group that may affect the capital requirements of RBSH Group’s operations in the US. As the implementation of the ICB recommendations is the subject of secondary legislation not yet adopted and the Federal Reserve’s recent proposals are in a comment period, RBSH Group cannot predict the impact such rules will have on the RBS Group’s (including RBSH Group’s) overall capital requirements or how they will affect the RBS Group’s (including RBSH Group’s) compliance with applicable capital and loss absorbency requirements.

 

To the extent RBSH Group has estimated the indicative impact that CRD IV rules may have on its risk-weighted assets and capital ratios, such estimates are preliminary and subject to uncertainties and may change. In particular, the estimates assume mitigating actions will be taken by RBSH Group (such as deleveraging of legacy positions and securitisations, including the RBS Capital Resolution Group, as well as other actions being taken to de-risk market and counterparty exposures), which may not occur as anticipated, in a timely manner, or at all.

 

The Basel Committee changes and other future changes to capital adequacy and liquidity requirements in the Netherlands and in other jurisdictions in which RBSH Group operates, including any application of increasingly stringent stress case scenarios by the regulators in the Netherlands and other jurisdictions in which RBSH Group undertakes regulated activities, may require RBSH Group to raise additional Tier 1 (including CET1) and Tier 2 capital by way of further issuances of securities and may result in existing Tier 1 and Tier 2 securities issued by RBSH Group ceasing to count towards RBSH Group’s regulatory capital, either at the same level as at present or at all. If RBSH Group is unable to raise the requisite Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital, it may be required to reduce further the amount of its risk-weighted assets and engage in the disposal of certain additional core and non-core businesses and asset portfolios, which may not occur on a timely basis or achieve prices which would otherwise be attractive to RBSH Group.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           189 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

 

Risk factors continued

As at 31 December 2013, RBSH Group’s Tier 1 and Core Tier 1 capital ratios were 23.2 per cent. and 20.5 per cent., respectively, calculated in accordance with Dutch Central Bank (De Nederlandsche Bank N.V.) requirements.

 

Any change that limits RBSH Group’s ability to manage effectively its balance sheet and capital resources going forward (including, for example, reductions in profits and retained earnings as a result of write-downs or otherwise, increases in risk-weighted assets, regulatory changes, actions by regulators, delays in the disposal of certain assets or the inability to syndicate loans as a result of market conditions, a growth in unfunded pension exposures or otherwise), to implement its capital plan or to access funding sources, could have a material adverse effect on its financial condition and regulatory capital position.

 

An extensive restructuring and balance sheet reduction programme of the RBS Group is ongoing and may adversely affect RBSH Group’s business, results of operations, financial condition, capital ratios and liquidity

As part of the restructuring by RBSG of its businesses, operations and assets and RBSH Group’s refocus on its disposal programme, RBSH Group was restructured into core and non-core components. Following the creation of the RBS Capital Resolution Group in 2013 resulting from a review of RBSG carried out by HM Treasury, a number of RBSH Group’s businesses and asset portfolios previously managed as part of its non-core division were transferred to the RBS Capital Resolution Group. RBS Group has announced its aspiration to remove most if not all of these assets from its balance sheet in three years. RBSH Group expects to further run down or dispose substantially of the remainder of the businesses, assets and portfolios previously managed under its non-core division and not transferred to the RBS Capital Resolution Group.

 

Because the ability to dispose of businesses and assets and the price achieved for such disposals will be dependent on prevailing economic and market conditions, which remain challenging, there is no assurance that RBSH Group will be able to sell or run-down (as applicable) those remaining businesses it is seeking to exit or asset portfolios it is seeking to sell either on favourable economic terms to RBSH Group or at all. Material tax or other contingent liabilities could arise on the disposal of businesses or assets and there is no assurance that any conditions precedent agreed will be satisfied, or consents and approvals required will be obtained in a timely manner, or at all.

 

RBSH Group may be exposed to deterioration in businesses or portfolios being sold between the announcement of the disposal and its completion, which period may be lengthy and may span many months. In addition, RBSH Group may be exposed to certain risks until completion, including risks arising out of ongoing liabilities and obligations, breaches of covenants, representations and warranties, indemnity claims, transitional services arrangements and redundancy or other transaction-related costs.

 

The occurrence of any of the risks described above could negatively affect RBSH Group's ability to implement its strategic plan and could have a material adverse effect on RBSH Group’s business, results of operations, financial condition, capital ratios and liquidity.

 

RBSH Group’s borrowing costs, its access to the debt capital markets and its liquidity depend significantly on its credit ratings

The credit rating of RBS N.V. has been subject to change and may change in the future, which could impact its cost of, access to and sources of financing and liquidity. A number of European financial institutions, including RBS N.V. and other RBS Group members, have been downgraded multiple times during the last three years in connection with rating methodology changes, a review of systemic support assumptions incorporated into bank ratings and the likelihood, in the case of UK banks, that the UK Government is more likely in the future to make greater use of its resolution tools to allow burden sharing with debt holders, and in connection with a general review of rating agencies’ methodologies. Most recently credit ratings of RBSG, the Royal Bank, RBSH and other Group members were downgraded in connection with RBSG’s creation of the RBS Capital Resolution Group, coupled with concerns about execution risk, litigation risk and the potential for conduct related fines. Furthermore, subject to any mitigating factors, uncertainties resulting from an affirmative vote in favour of Scottish independence would be likely to have a negative impact on the credit ratings of RBSG and the Royal Bank, and therefore RBSH Group and RBS N.V.

 

Rating agencies continue to evaluate the rating methodologies applicable to UK and European financial institutions and any change in such rating agencies’ methodologies could materially adversely affect the credit ratings of Group companies. Were RBSG’s credit ratings to be further downgraded, this would likely result in a simultaneous downgrade of RBSH Group and RBS N.V. Any further reductions in the long-term or short-term credit ratings of RBS N.V. would increase RBSH Group’s borrowing costs, require RBSH Group to replace funding lost due to the downgrade, which may include the loss of customer deposits, and may also limit RBSH Group’s access to capital and money markets and trigger additional collateral requirements in derivatives contracts and other secured funding arrangements. At 31 December 2013, a simultaneous one notch long-term and associated short-term downgrade in the credit ratings of RBS N.V. by the three main rating agencies would have required RBSH Group to post estimated additional collateral of €239 million, without taking account of mitigating action by management.

 

The credit ratings of RBS N.V. are also important to RBSH Group when competing in certain markets. As a result, any further reductions in RBS N.V.’s long-term or short-term credit ratings could adversely affect RBSH Group’s access to liquidity and its competitive position, increase its funding costs and have a material adverse impact on RBSH Group’s earnings, cash flow and financial condition.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           190 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Risk factors continued

RBSH Group’s ability to meet its obligations including its funding commitments depends on RBSH Group’s ability to access sources of liquidity and funding

Liquidity risk is the risk that a bank will be unable to meet its obligations, including funding commitments, as they fall due. This risk is inherent in banking operations and can be heightened by a number of factors, including an over reliance on a particular source of wholesale funding (including, for example, short-term and overnight funding), changes in credit ratings or market-wide phenomena such as market dislocation and major disasters.

 

Credit markets worldwide, including interbank markets, have experienced severe reductions in liquidity and term-funding during prolonged periods in recent years. Although credit markets continued to improve during 2013 (in part as a result of measures taken by central banks around the world, including the ECB), and RBSH Group’s overall liquidity position remained strong, certain European banks, in particular from the peripheral countries of Spain, Portugal, Greece, Italy and Ireland, remained reliant on central banks as one of their principal sources of liquidity. Although the measures taken by central banks have had a positive impact, the risk of volatility returning to the global credit markets remains.

 

The market perception of bank credit risk has changed significantly as a result of the financial crisis and banks that are deemed by the market to be riskier have had to issue debt at a premium. Any uncertainty regarding the perception of credit risk across financial institutions may lead to reductions in levels of interbank lending and associated term maturities and may restrict RBSH Group’s access to traditional sources of funding or increase the costs of accessing such funding.

 

RBSH Group’s liquidity and funding management focuses, among other things, on maintaining a diverse and appropriate funding strategy for its assets in line with RBSH Group’s wider strategic plan. RBSH Group has, at times, been required to rely on shorter-term and overnight funding with a consequent reduction in overall liquidity, and to increase its recourse to liquidity schemes provided by central banks. Such schemes require the pledging of assets as collateral and changes to asset valuations or eligibility criteria can negatively impact the available assets and reduce available liquidity access particularly during periods of stress when such lines may be needed most. Although conditions have improved, there have been recent periods where corporate and financial institution counterparties have reduced their credit exposures to banks and other financial institutions, limiting the availability of these sources of funding. Under certain circumstances, RBSH Group may need to seek funds from alternative sources, potentially at higher costs than has previously been the case and/or with higher collateral or may be required to consider disposals of other assets not previously identified for disposal to reduce its funding commitments.

 

The occurrence of any of the risks described above could have a material adverse impact on RBSH Group’s financial condition and results of operations.

 

Each of RBSH Group’s businesses is subject to substantial regulation and oversight. Significant regulatory developments and changes in the approach of RBSH Group’s key regulators has had and is likely to continue to have a material adverse effect on how RBSH Group conducts its business and on its results of operations and financial condition

RBSH Group is subject to extensive financial services laws, regulations, corporate governance requirements, administrative actions and policies in each jurisdiction in which it operates. All of these have been changing and are subject to further change, particularly in the current regulatory and market environment, where there have been unprecedented levels of government intervention (including nationalisations and injections of capital), changes to the regulations governing financial institutions and reviews of the industry in the UK, in many other European countries, the US and at the EU level.

 

As a result of the environment in which RBSH Group operates, increasing regulatory focus in certain areas and ongoing and possible future changes in the financial services regulatory landscape (including requirements imposed by virtue of the RBS Group’s participation in government or regulator-led initiatives), RBSH Group is facing greater regulation and scrutiny in the Netherlands, the United Kingdom, the United States and other countries in which it operates (including in relation to compliance with anti-bribery, anti-money laundering, anti-terrorism and other similar sanctions regimes).

 

Although it is difficult to predict with certainty the effect that all of the recent regulatory changes, developments and heightened levels of public and regulatory scrutiny will have on RBSH Group, the enactment of legislation and regulations in the Netherlands and other jurisdictions in which RBSH Group operates (such as new liquidity rules in the Netherlands in anticipation of the implementation of, and other changes required by, the EU Capital Requirements Directives, the bank levy and Banking Reform Act 2013 in the United Kingdom, the RRD and CRD IV or the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act in the United States) has resulted in increased capital and liquidity requirements, changes in other regulatory requirements and increased operating costs and has impacted, and will continue to impact, products offerings and business models. Such changes may also result in an increased number of regulatory investigations and proceedings. Any of these developments could have an impact on how RBSH Group conducts its business, applicable authorisations and licences, the products and services it offers, its reputation, the value of its assets, and a material adverse effect on its funding costs and its results of operations and financial condition.

 

Areas in which, and examples of where, governmental policies, regulatory and accounting changes and increased public and regulatory scrutiny could have an adverse impact (some of which could be material) on RBSH Group include those set out above as well as the following:

 

·         the monetary, fiscal, interest rate and other policies of central banks and other governmental or regulatory bodies;

·         requirements to separate retail banking from investment banking;

·         restrictions on proprietary trading and similar activities within a commercial bank and/or a group which contains a commercial bank;

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           191 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

 

Risk factors continued

·         restructuring certain of non-retail banking activities in order to satisfy local capital, liquidity and other prudential requirements;

 

·         the design and potential implementation of government mandated recovery, resolution or insolvency regimes;

 

·         the imposition of government imposed requirements and/or related fines and sanctions with respect to lending to small and medium sized businesses and larger commercial and corporate entities and residential mortgage lending;

 

·         requirements to operate in a way that prioritises objectives other than shareholder value creation;

 

·         changes to financial reporting standards (including accounting standards), corporate governance requirements, corporate structures and conduct of business rules;

 

·         the imposition of restrictions on RBSH Group’s ability to compensate its senior management and other employees;

 

·         regulations relating to, and enforcement of, anti-bribery, anti-money laundering, anti-terrorism or other similar sanctions regimes;

 

·         rules relating to foreign ownership, expropriation, nationalisation and confiscation of assets;

 

·         other requirements or policies affecting RBSH Group’s profitability, such as the imposition of onerous compliance obligations, further restrictions on business growth, capital, liquidity or pricing;

 

·         the introduction of, and changes to, taxes, levies or fees applicable to RBSH Group’s operations (such as the imposition of a financial transaction tax and changes in tax rates that reduce the value of deferred tax assets); and

 

·         the regulation or endorsement of credit ratings used in the EU (whether issued by agencies in EU member states or in other countries, such as the United States).

 

Changes in laws, rules or regulations, or in their interpretation or enforcement, or the implementation of new laws, rules or regulations, including contradictory laws, rules or regulations by key regulators in different jurisdictions, may have a material adverse effect on RBSH Group’s business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, uncertainty and lack of international regulatory coordination as enhanced supervisory standards are developed and implemented may adversely affect RBSH Group’s ability to engage in effective business, capital and risk management planning.

 

RBSH Group’s operations are highly dependent on its information technology systems

RBSH Group’s operations are dependent on the ability to process a very large number of transactions efficiently and accurately while complying with applicable laws and regulations where it does business. The proper functioning of RBSH Group’s payment systems, financial and sanctions controls, risk management, credit analysis and reporting, accounting, customer service and other information technology systems, as well as the communication networks between its branches and main data processing centres, are critical to RBSH Group’s operations. Critical system failure, any prolonged loss of service availability or any material breach of data security, particularly involving confidential customer data, could cause serious damage to RBSH Group’s ability to service its clients, could result in a loss of customers and significant compensation costs, could breach regulations under which RBSH Group operates and could cause long term damage to RBSH Group’s business and brand. For example, failure to protect RBSH Group’s operations from cyber attacks could result in the loss of customer data or other sensitive information. Although RBSH has been implementing measures to improve its resilience to the increasing intensity and sophistication of cyber-attacks, RBSH expects to be the target of cyber-attacks in the future and there can be no assurance that RBSH will be able to prevent all threats.

 

RBSH Group’s operations have inherent reputational risk

Reputational risk, meaning the risk of brand damage and/or financial loss due to a failure to meet stakeholders’ expectations of RBSH’s conduct and performance, is inherent in RBSH’s business. Stakeholders include customers, investors, rating agencies, employees, suppliers, government, politicians, regulators, special interest groups, consumer groups, media and the general public. Brand damage can be detrimental to the business of RBSH in a number of ways, including its ability to build or sustain business relationships with customers, low staff morale, regulatory censure or reduced access to, or an increase in the cost of, funding. In particular, negative public opinion resulting from the actual or perceived manner in which RBSH Group conducts its business activities, RBSH Group’s financial performance, the level of direct and indirect government support or actual or perceived practices in the banking and financial industry may adversely impact RBSH’s ability to keep and attract customers, and in particular, corporate and retail depositors. Modern technologies, in particular online social networks and other broadcast tools which facilitate communication with large audiences in short time frames and with minimal costs, may significantly enhance and accelerate the impact of damaging information and allegations. RBSH Group cannot ensure that it will be successful in avoiding damage to its business from reputational risk, which may result in a material adverse effect on RBSH Group’s financial condition, results of operations and prospects.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           192 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Risk factors continued

RBSH Group may suffer losses due to employee misconduct

RBSH Group’s businesses are exposed to risk from potential non-compliance with policies, employee misconduct or negligence and fraud, which could result in regulatory sanctions and serious reputational or financial harm to RBSH Group. In recent years, a number of multinational financial institutions have suffered material losses due to the actions of employees. It is not always possible to deter employee misconduct and the precautions RBSH Group takes to prevent and detect this activity may not always be effective.

 

The financial performance of RBSH Group has been, and continues to be, materially affected by counterparty credit quality and deteriorations could arise due to prevailing economic and market conditions and legal and regulatory developments

RBSH Group has exposure to many different industries and counterparties, and risks arising from actual or perceived changes in credit quality and the recoverability of monies due from borrowers and counterparties are inherent in a wide range of RBSH Group’s businesses. In particular, RBSH Group has significant exposure to certain individual counterparties in weakened business sectors and geographic markets and also has concentrated country exposure in a limited number of countries in Europe, the United States and Asia. For a discussion of RBSH Group’s exposure to country risk, see pages 57 to 62.

 

The credit quality of RBSH Group’s borrowers and counterparties is impacted by prevailing economic and market conditions and by the legal and regulatory landscape in their respective markets. A further deterioration in economic and market conditions or changes to legal or regulatory landscapes could worsen borrower and counterparty credit quality and also impact RBSH Group’s ability to enforce contractual security rights. In addition, RBSH Group’s credit risk is exacerbated when the collateral it holds cannot be realised or is liquidated at prices not sufficient to recover the full amount of the loan or derivative exposure that is due to RBSH Group, which is most likely to occur during periods of illiquidity and depressed asset valuations, such as those experienced in recent years. Any such losses could have an adverse effect on RBSH Group’s results of operations and financial condition.

 

Concerns about, or a default by, one financial institution could lead to significant liquidity problems and losses or defaults by other financial institutions, as the commercial and financial soundness of many financial institutions may be closely related as a result of credit, trading, clearing and other relationships. Even the perceived lack of creditworthiness of, or questions about, a counterparty may lead to market-wide liquidity problems and losses for or defaults by RBSH Group. This ‘systemic’ risk may adversely affect financial intermediaries, such as clearing agencies, clearing houses, banks, securities firms and exchanges with which RBSH Group interacts on a daily basis, all of which could have a material adverse effect on RBSH Group’s access to liquidity or could result in losses which could have a material adverse effect on RBSH Group’s financial condition, results of operations and prospects.

 

The EU, the ECB, the International Monetary Fund and various national authorities have proposed and implemented certain measures intended to address systemic financial stresses in the Eurozone, including the creation of a European Banking Union which, through a Single Resolution Mechanism (SRM) will apply the substantive rules of bank recovery and resolution set out in the Recovery and Resolution Directive (RRD). Current expectations are that the RRD, which is intended to provide supervisory authorities with common tools and powers to address banking crises pre-emptively in order to safeguard financial stability and minimize taxpayers’ exposure to losses, will be finalized early in 2014. The effectiveness of these and other actions proposed and implemented at both the EU and national level to address systemic stresses in the Eurozone is not assured.

 

The trends and risks affecting borrower and counterparty credit quality have caused, and in the future may cause, RBSH Group to experience further and accelerated impairment charges, increased repurchase demands, higher costs, additional write-downs and losses for RBSH Group and an inability to engage in routine funding transactions.

 

Changes in interest rates, foreign exchange rates, credit spreads, bond, equity and commodity prices, basis, volatility and correlation risks and other market factors have significantly affected and will continue to affect RBSH Group’s business and results of operations

Some of the most significant market risks RBSH Group faces are interest rate, foreign exchange, credit spread, bond, equity and commodity prices and basis, volatility and correlation risks. Changes in interest rate levels (or extended periods of low interest rates such as experienced over the past several years), yield curves (which remain depressed) and spreads may affect the interest rate margin realised between lending and borrowing costs, the effect of which may be heightened during periods of liquidity stress. Changes in currency rates, particularly in the euro-sterling and euro-US dollar exchange rates, affect the value of assets, liabilities, income and expenses denominated in non-euro currencies and the reported earnings of RBS Holding’s non-eurozone incorporated subsidiaries and may affect RBS Holdings’ reported consolidated financial condition or RBSH Group’s income from foreign exchange dealing. For accounting purposes, RBSH Group values some of its issued debt, such as debt securities, at the current market price. Factors affecting the current market price for such debt, such as the credit spreads of RBSH Group, may result in a change to the fair value of such debt, which is recognised in the income statement as a profit or loss.

 

The performance of financial markets affects bond, equity and commodity prices, which has caused, and may in the future cause, changes in the value of RBSH Group’s investment and trading portfolios. As part of its ongoing derivatives operations, RBSH Group also faces significant basis, volatility and correlation risks, the occurrence of which are also impacted by the factors noted above. While RBSH Group has implemented risk management methods to mitigate and control these and other market risks to which it is exposed, it is difficult to predict with accuracy changes in economic or market conditions and to anticipate the effects that such changes could have on RBSH Group’s financial performance and business operations.

 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           193 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

 

Risk factors continued

The value of certain financial instruments recorded at fair value is determined using financial models incorporating assumptions, judgements and estimates that may change over time or may ultimately not turn out to be accurate

Under International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the EU (IFRS), RBSH Group recognises at fair value: (i) financial instruments classified as ‘held for trading’ or ‘designated as at fair value through profit or loss’; (ii) financial assets classified as ‘available-for-sale’; and (iii) derivatives. Generally, to establish the fair value of these instruments, RBSH Group relies on quoted market prices or, where the market for a financial instrument is not sufficiently active, internal valuation models that utilise observable market data.

 

In certain circumstances, the data for individual financial instruments or classes of financial instruments utilised by such valuation models may not be available or may become unavailable due to prevailing market conditions. In such circumstances, RBSH Group’s internal valuation models require RBSH Group to make assumptions, judgements and estimates to establish fair value, which are complex and often relate to matters that are inherently uncertain. These assumptions, judgements and estimates will need to be updated to reflect changing facts, trends and market conditions. The resulting change in the fair values of the financial instruments has had and could continue to have a material adverse effect on RBSH Group’s earnings and financial condition.

 

RBSH Group’s earnings and financial condition have been, and its future earnings and financial condition may continue to be, materially affected by depressed asset valuations resulting from poor market conditions

Severe market events have resulted in RBSH Group recording large write-downs on its credit market exposures in recent years. Any deterioration in economic and financial market conditions or continuing weak economic growth could lead to further impairment charges and write-downs. Moreover, market volatility and illiquidity (and the assumptions, judgements and estimates in relation to such matters that may change over time and may ultimately not turn out to be accurate) make it difficult to value certain of RBSH Group’s exposures. Valuations in future periods, reflecting, among other things, then prevailing market conditions and changes in the credit ratings of certain of RBSH Group’s assets, may result in significant changes in the fair values of RBSH Group’s exposures, including in respect of exposures, such as credit market exposures, for which RBSH Group has previously recorded write-downs. In addition, the value ultimately realised by RBSH Group may be materially different from the current or estimated fair value. As part of the RBSH Group’s strategy it has materially reduced the size of its balance sheet mainly through the sale and run-off of non-core assets. In addition, certain of RBSH Group’s assets that were part of its non-core division together with additional assets identified as part of a HM Treasury review in 2013, form part of RBS Capital Resolution Group as of 1 January 2014. In connection with the establishment of RBS Capital Resolution Group, the RBS Group has indicated its clear aspiration to remove the vast majority, if not all of these assets within three years which has led to increased impairments of £4.5 billion which were recognised in Q4 2013, none of which related to RBSH Group. Despite these impairments, these assets may be difficult to sell and could be subject to further write-downs or, when sold, realised losses. Any of these factors could require RBSH Group to recognise further significant write-downs or realise increased impairment charges, which may have a material adverse effect on its financial condition, results of operations and capital ratios.

 

In addition, steep falls in perceived or actual asset values have been accompanied by a severe reduction in market liquidity, as exemplified by losses in recent years arising out of asset-backed collateralised debt obligations, residential mortgage-backed securities and the leveraged loan market. In dislocated markets, hedging and other risk management strategies may not be as effective as they are in normal market conditions due in part to the decreasing credit quality of hedge counterparties.

 

The regulatory capital treatment of certain deferred tax assets recognised by RBSH Group depends on there being no adverse changes to regulatory requirements

While there was no restriction on the recognition of deferred tax assets at 31 December 2013, the Capital Requirements Regulation, which took effect from 1 January 2014, requires the deduction in full from CET1 capital of deferred tax assets that rely on future profitability and do not arise from temporary differences (for example, deferred tax assets related to trading losses). Other deferred tax assets which rely on future profitability and arise from temporary differences are subject to a threshold test and only the amount in excess of the threshold is deducted from CET1 capital. The Dutch regulator has adopted transitional provisions in relation to the change in the treatment of deferred tax assets. This entails that starting in 2014, a 20% discount will be applied to the deferred tax assets on future profits. Starting from 1 January 2014, deferred tax assets will be fully deducted.

 

The recoverability of certain deferred tax assets recognised by RBSH Group depends on RBSH Group’s ability to generate sufficient future taxable profits and there being no adverse changes to tax legislation or accounting standards

In accordance with IFRS, RBSH Group has recognised deferred tax assets on losses available to relieve future profits from tax only to the extent that it is probable that they will be recovered. The deferred tax assets are quantified on the basis of current tax legislation and accounting standards and are subject to change in respect of the future rates of tax or the rules for computing taxable profits and allowable losses. Failure to generate sufficient future taxable profits or changes in tax legislation or accounting standards may reduce the recoverable amount of the recognised deferred tax assets.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           194 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

 

Risk factors continued

The legal demerger of ABN AMRO Bank N.V. (as it was then named) has resulted in a cross liability that changes the legal recourse available to investors

On 6 February 2010, ABN AMRO Bank N.V. (as it was then named) was demerged into two entities, being RBS N.V. (the former ABN AMRO Bank N.V.) and the new ABN AMRO Bank.

 

In principle, investors now only have recourse to the entity to which the relevant assets and liabilities have been transferred for payments in respect of the appropriate securities. Under the Dutch Civil Code, however, each entity remains liable to creditors for the monetary obligations of the other entity that existed at the date of the legal demerger in the event that the other entity cannot meet its obligations to those creditors. In each case, the liability relates only to obligations existing at the date of the legal demerger.

 

The liability of RBS N.V. is limited to the equity retained at legal demerger. At the time of the legal demerger, this liability amounted to €4.0 billion and this liability will reduce over time. The liability of the new ABN AMRO Bank N.V. is limited to the amount of equity acquired at legal demerger, which amounted to €1.8 billion, which will also reduce over time.

 

RBS N.V. has made arrangements to mitigate the risks of liability to the creditors which transferred to the new ABN AMRO Bank upon legal demerger. The new ABN AMRO Bank has also made arrangements to mitigate the risks of liability to the creditors that remain in RBS N.V. Both of these entities hold the level of regulatory capital agreed upon with the Dutch Central Bank for purposes of covering any residual risks.

 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           195 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Iran sanctions and related disclosures

 

Disclosure pursuant to section 13(r) of the Securities Exchange Act

Section 219 of the Iran Threat Reduction and Syria Human Rights Act of 2012 added a new Section 13(r) to the Exchange Act, requiring an issuer to disclose in its annual or quarterly reports, as applicable, whether, during the period covered by the report, it or any of its affiliates knowingly engaged in specified activities or transactions relating to Iran or with individuals or entities designated under Executive Order 13382 or 13224. Disclosure is required of certain activities conducted outside the United States by non-U.S. entities in compliance with local law, whether or not the activities are sanctionable under U.S. law.  In order to comply with this requirement, the following activities of our affiliate RBSG Group are disclosed in response to section 13(r).

 

Licensed Payments

During 2013, in full compliance with applicable sanctions and under applicable licenses granted by appropriate authorities, RBS Group facilitated a small number of payments that were remitted by a financial institution designated under Executive Order 13382. The payments related to amounts due to a provider for the provision of medical supplies to a non-designated entity.

 

RBS Group also facilitated several payments from or to frozen accounts of Iranian government-owned financial institutions and/or financial institutions designated under Executive Order 13382 or 13224 maintained at other financial institutions. These payments related to amounts due to third parties for legal services and IT services provided to such entities, and the refund of payments made following the termination of services.  All payments were made or received in full compliance with applicable sanctions and under applicable licences.

 

During 2013, RBS Group also received a number of payments related to entities identified as part of the Government of Iran and/or entities designated under Executive Order 13382 or 13324. These payments related to amounts due to providers for legal services provided to such entities.  All such payments were received in compliance with applicable laws and regulations, and where appropriate, RBS Group made or obtained the required notification, authorisation and/or licence from the applicable regulator.

 

The transactions described in the above paragraphs resulted in less than the equivalent of £30 in gross revenue to RBS Group for each such transaction. RBS Group intends to continue to engage in transactions similar to those described in this paragraph as long as such transactions are licensed by the proper authorities.

 

Account Closure Payments

During 2013, RBS Group maintained a banking relationship with an entity in the UK that became designated under Executive Order 13382 in 2013.  Following the designation of the entity, RBS Group terminated the banking relationship and paid the balance of the account to a non-RBS Group account held by the customer. The closure and subsequent payment were made in compliance with applicable rules and regulations.  The transactions described in the above resulted in less than the equivalent of £30 in gross revenue to RBS Group for each such transaction.

 

 

Legacy Guarantees

In 2013, in full compliance with applicable sanctions and under general license from the appropriate authorities, RBS Group exited two legacy guarantees (performance bonds) that were originally entered into in 2003 and 2007 in compliance with applicable law.  In connection with exiting these guarantees, RBS Group made a payment into a frozen account of one Iranian government-owned financial institution that is designated under Executive Order 13382 maintained at another financial institution. The other guarantee was exited without any payment as the Iranian Government-owned financial institution agreed to waive an existing charge under the guarantee. 

 

Under appropriate license from the applicable authorities, RBS Group holds eight additional legacy guarantees entered into between 1995 and 2005 which support arrangements entered into lawfully by RBS Group customers with Iranian counterparties. These performance bonds are in favour of Iranian government-owned financial institutions that are also designated under Executive Order 13382. RBS Group has made considerable efforts to exit and formally cancel the guarantees. It has been unable to do so to date but intends to terminate these legacy guarantees if changes to the applicable law are made to allow it to terminate them.  One of these legacy guarantees was disclosed in RBS Group’s Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2012.  The other seven guarantees were only recently identified as part of a migration of RBS Holdings NV business to the books of another Group affiliate. The affiliate that originally held these guarantees previously sought permission from its regulator to exit these guarantees, but has not yet received a license to do so.

 

RBS Group received revenue of £3018 in the reporting period in respect of these legacy guarantees. No other payments were made under these guarantees in 2013. If any payments are required to be made under the performance bonds while the beneficiaries remain the targets of EU sanctions, RBS Group intends to make the payments under applicable licence into frozen bank accounts.

 

Clearing System

RBS Group participates in local government-run clearing and settlement exchange systems in a number of countries in compliance with applicable laws and regulations. Iranian government-owned banks, including certain banks designated under Executive Order 13382 or 13224, also participate in some of these clearing systems, which creates the risk that RBS Group could participate in transactions in which such Iranian banks are involved. Where legally permissible, RBS Group has instituted procedures to screen and halt any outgoing and incoming payments to and from Iranian banks in these clearing systems prior to settlement. RBS Group has obtained a license from Her Majesty’s Treasury to participate in local payment and settlement systems in the United Arab Emirates (UAE). RBS Group intends to continue to participate in the clearing and settlement exchange systems in various countries and will continue to seek to limit the risk of participating in transactions involving Iranian government-owned financial institutions in accordance with applicable laws and regulations. It intends to participate in transactions involving such entities only pursuant to licenses from the appropriate authorities. 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           196 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Documents on Display

We are subject to the information requirements of the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, except that as a foreign issuer, we are not subject to the proxy rules or the short-swing profit disclosure rules of the Exchange Act. In accordance therewith, we file or furnish reports and other information with the SEC. For further information about RBSH Group, we refer you to the filings we have made with the SEC. Statements contained in this Annual Report concerning the contents of any document are not necessarily complete. If a document has been filed as an exhibit to any filing we have made with the SEC, we refer you to the copy of the document that has been filed. Each statement in this Annual Report relating to a document filed as an exhibit is qualified in all respects by the filed exhibit.

 

Reports and other information filed or furnished by us with the SEC may be inspected and copied at the public reference facilities maintained by the SEC at Room 1024, 100 F Street, N.E., Washington D.C. 20549, and at the SEC’s regional offices at 233 Broadway, New York, New York 10279 and Northwestern Atrium Center, 500 West Madison Street, Suite 1400, Chicago, Illinois 60661-2511. Copies of these materials can also be obtained by mail at prescribed rates from the Public Reference Section of the SEC, 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549, or by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. In addition, the SEC maintains a website that contains information filed electronically with the SEC, which can be accessed at www.sec.gov. Some, but not all, of our registration statements and reports are available at the SEC’s website.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           197 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Glossary of terms

Arrears - the aggregate of contractual payments due on a debt that have not been met by the borrower. A loan or other financial asset is said to be 'in arrears' when payments have not been made.

 

Asset-backed securities (ABS) - securities that represent interests in specific portfolios of assets. They are issued by a special purpose entity following a securitisation. The underlying portfolios commonly comprise residential or commercial mortgages but can include any class of asset that yields predictable cash flows. Payments on the securities depend primarily on the cash flows generated by the assets in the underlying pool and other rights designed to assure timely payment, such as guarantees or other credit enhancements. Collateralised bond obligations, collateralised debt obligations, collateralised loan obligations, commercial mortgage backed securities and residential mortgage backed securities are all types of ABS.

 

Asset quality (AQ) band – probability of default banding for all counterparties on a scale of 1 to 10.

 

Back-testing - statistical techniques that assess the performance of a model, and how that model would have performed had it been applied in the past.

 

Basel II - the capital adequacy framework issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision in June 2006 in the form of the ‘International Convergence of Capital Measurement and Capital Standards’.

 

Basel III - in December 2010, the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision issued final rules: ‘Basel III: A global regulatory framework for more resilient banks and banking systems’ and ‘Basel III: International framework for liquidity risk measurement, standards and monitoring’.

 

Basis point - one hundredth of a per cent i.e. 0.01 per cent. 100 basis points is 1 per cent. Used when quoting movements in interest rates or yields on securities.

 

Capital requirements regulation (CRR) - see CRD IV.

 

Certificates of deposit (CDs) - bearer negotiable instruments acknowledging the receipt of a fixed term deposit at a specified interest rate.

 

Collateralised debt obligations (CDOs) - asset-backed securities for which the underlying asset portfolios are debt obligations: either bonds (collateralised bond obligations) or loans (collateralised loan obligations) or both. The credit exposure underlying synthetic CDOs derives from credit default swaps. The CDOs issued by an individual vehicle are usually divided in different tranches: senior tranches (rated AAA), mezzanine tranches (AA to BB), and equity tranches (unrated). Losses are borne first by the equity securities, next by the junior securities, and finally by the senior securities; junior tranches offer higher coupons (interest payments) to compensate for their increased risk.

 

Collateralised loan obligations (CLOs) - asset-backed securities for which the underlying asset portfolios are loans, often leveraged loans.

 

Collectively assessed loan impairment provisions - impairment loss provisions in respect of impaired loans, such as credit cards or personal loans, that are below individual assessment thresholds. Such provisions are established on a portfolio basis, taking account of the level of arrears, security, past loss experience, credit scores and defaults based on portfolio trends.

 

Commercial mortgage backed securities (CMBS) - asset-backed securities for which the underlying asset portfolios are loans secured on commercial real estate.

 

Commercial paper (CP) - unsecured obligations issued by a corporate or a bank directly or secured obligations (asset-backed CP), often issued through a commercial paper conduit, to fund working capital. Maturities typically range from two to 270 days. However, the depth and reliability of some CP markets means that issuers can repeatedly roll over CP issuance and effectively achieve longer term funding. CP is issued in a wide range of denominations and can be either discounted or interest-bearing.

 

Commercial paper conduit - a structured entity that issues commercial paper and uses the proceeds to purchase or fund a pool of assets. The commercial paper is secured on the assets and is redeemed either by further commercial paper issuance, repayment of assets or liquidity drawings.

 

Commercial real estate - freehold and leasehold properties used for business activities. Commercial real estate includes office buildings, industrial property, medical centres, hotels, retail stores, shopping centres, agricultural land and buildings, warehouses, garages etc.

 

Common Equity Tier 1 capital - the highest quality form of regulatory capital under Basel III comprising common shares issued and related share premium, retained earnings and other reserves excluding the cash flow hedging reserve, less specified regulatory adjustments.

 

Contractual maturity - the date in the terms of a financial instrument on which the last payment or receipt under the contract is due for settlement.

 

Core Tier 1 capital - called-up share capital and eligible reserves plus equity non-controlling interests, less intangible assets and other regulatory deductions.

 

Core Tier 1 capital ratio - core Tier 1 capital as a percentage of risk-weighted assets.

 

Cost:income ratio - operating expenses as a percentage of total income.

 

Counterparty credit risk - the risk that a counterparty defaults before the maturity of a derivative or sale and repurchase contract. In contrast to non-counterparty credit risk, the exposure to counterparty credit risk varies by reference to a market factor (e.g. interest rate, exchange rate, asset price)

 

Coverage ratio - impairment provisions as a percentage of impaired loans.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           198 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

 

Glossary of terms continued     

CRD IV - the European Union has implemented the Basel III capital proposals through the Capital Requirements Regulation (CRR) and the Capital Requirements Directive (CRD), collectively known as CRD IV. CRD IV was implemented on 1 January 2014. The European Banking Authority’s technical standards are still to be finalised through adoption by the European Commission.

 

Credit default swap (CDS) - a contract where the protection seller receives premium or interest-related payments in return for contracting to make payments to the protection buyer upon a defined credit event in relation to a reference financial asset or portfolio of financial assets. Credit events usually include bankruptcy, payment default and rating downgrades.

 

Credit derivative product company (CDPC) - a structured entity that sells credit protection under credit default swaps or certain approved forms of insurance policies. Sometimes they can also buy credit protection. CDPCs are similar to monoline insurers. However, unlike monoline insurers, they are not regulated as insurers.

 

Credit derivatives - contractual agreements that provide protection against a credit event on one or more reference entities or financial assets. The nature of a credit event is established by the protection buyer and protection seller at the inception of a transaction, and such events include bankruptcy, insolvency or failure to meet payment obligations when due. The buyer of the credit derivative pays a periodic fee in return for a payment by the protection seller upon the occurrence, if any, of a credit event. Credit derivatives include credit default swaps, total return swaps and credit swap options.

 

Credit enhancements - techniques that improve the credit standing of financial obligations; generally those issued by a structured entity in a securitisation. External credit enhancements include financial guarantees and letters of credit from third-party providers. Internal enhancements include excess spread - the difference between the interest rate received on the underlying portfolio and the coupon on the issued securities; and over-collateralisation - on securitisation, the value of the underlying portfolio is greater than the securities issued.

 

Credit grade - a rating that represents an assessment of the credit worthiness of a customer. It is a point on a scale representing the probability of default of a customer.

 

Credit risk - the risk of financial loss due to the failure of a customer, or counterparty, to meet its obligation to settle outstanding amounts.

 

Credit risk assets - loans and advances (including overdraft facilities), instalment credit, finance lease receivables and other traded instruments across all customer types.

 

Credit risk mitigation - reducing the credit risk of an exposure by application of techniques such as netting, collateral, guarantees and credit derivatives.

 

Credit risk spread - the yield spread between securities with the same currency and maturity structure but with different associated credit risks, with the yield spread rising as the credit rating worsens.  It is the premium over the benchmark or risk-free rate required by the market to take on a lower credit quality.

 

Credit valuation adjustments (CVA) - the CVA is the difference between the risk-free value a portfolio of trades and its market value, taking into account the counterparty’s risk of default.  It represents the market value of counterparty credit risk, or an estimate of the adjustment to fair value that a market participant would make to reflect the creditworthiness of its counterparty.

 

Currency swap - an arrangement in which two parties exchange specific principal amounts of different currencies at inception and subsequently interest payments on the principal amounts. Often, one party will pay a fixed rate of interest, while the other will pay a floating rate (though there are also fixed-fixed and floating-floating arrangements). At the maturity of the swap, the principal amounts are usually re-exchanged.

 

Customer accounts - money deposited with RBSH Group by counterparties other than banks and classified as liabilities. They include demand, savings and time deposits; securities sold under repurchase agreements; and other short term deposits. Deposits received from banks are classified as deposits by banks.

 

Debt securities - transferable instruments creating or acknowledging indebtedness. They include debentures, bonds, certificates of deposit, notes and commercial paper. The holder of a debt security is typically entitled to the payment of principal and interest, together with other contractual rights under the terms of the issue, such as the right to receive certain information. Debt securities are generally issued for a fixed term and redeemable by the issuer at the end of that term. Debt securities can be secured or unsecured.

 

Debt securities in issue - unsubordinated debt securities issued by RBSH Group. They include commercial paper, certificates of deposit, bonds and medium-term notes.

 

Deferred tax asset - income taxes recoverable in future periods as a result of deductible temporary differences (temporary differences between the accounting and tax base of an asset or liability that will result in tax deductible amounts in future periods) and the carry-forward of tax losses and unused tax credits.

 

Deferred tax liability - income taxes payable in future periods as a result of taxable temporary differences (temporary differences between the accounting and tax base of an asset or liability that will result in taxable amounts in future periods).

 

Defined benefit obligation - the present value of expected future payments required to settle the obligations of a defined benefit plan resulting from employee service.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           199 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Glossary of terms continued     

Defined benefit plan/scheme - pension or other post-retirement benefit plan other than a defined contribution plan.

 

Defined contribution plan/scheme - pension or other post-retirement benefit plan where the employer's obligation is limited to its contributions to the fund.

 

Deposits by banks - money deposited with RBSH Group by banks and recorded as liabilities. They include money-market deposits, securities sold under repurchase agreements, federal funds purchased and other short term deposits. Deposits received from customers are recorded as customer accounts.

 

Derivative - a contract or agreement whose value changes with changes in an underlying index such as interest rates, foreign exchange rates, share prices or indices and which requires no initial investment or an initial investment that is smaller than would be required for other types of contracts with a similar response to market factors. The principal types of derivatives are: swaps, forwards, futures and options.

 

Discontinued operation - a component of RBSH Group that either has been disposed of or is classified as held for sale. A discontinued operation is either: a separate major line of business or geographical area of operations or part of a single co-ordinated plan to dispose of a separate major line of business or geographical area of operations; or a subsidiary acquired exclusively with a view to resale.

 

Dutch State - refers to the State of the Netherlands.

 

Economic capital - an internal measure of the capital required by the RBSH Group to support the risks to which it is exposed

 

Effective interest rate method - the effective interest method is a method of calculating the amortised cost of a financial asset or financial liability (or group of financial assets or liabilities) and of allocating the interest income or interest expense over the expected life of the asset or liability. The effective interest rate is the rate that exactly discounts estimated future cash flows to the instrument's initial carrying amount. Calculation of the effective interest rate takes into account fees payable or receivable that are an integral part of the instrument's yield, premiums or discounts on acquisition or issue, early redemption fees and transaction costs. All contractual terms of a financial instrument are considered when estimating future cash flows.

 

Encumbrance - an interest in an asset by another party. Encumbrance usually impacts the transferability of the asset and can restrict its free use until the encumbrance is removed.

 

Equity risk - the risk of changes in the market price of the equities or equity instruments arising from positions, either long or short, in equities or equity-based financial instruments.

 

Eurozone - the 17 European Union countries that have adopted the euro: Austria, Belgium, Cyprus, Estonia, Finland, France, Germany, Greece, Ireland, Italy, Luxembourg, Malta, The Netherlands, Portugal, Slovakia, Slovenia and Spain.

 

Expected loss (EL) - expected loss represents the anticipate loss on an exposure over one year. It is determined by multiplying probability of default, loss given default and exposure at default and can be calculated at individual, credit facility, customer and portfolio level.

 

Exposure - a claim, contingent claim or position which carries a risk of financial loss.

 

Forbearance - forbearance takes place when changes to the contractual payment terms of a retail loan are agreed in response to the borrower’s financial difficulties.

 

Forward contract - a contract to buy (or sell) a specified amount of a physical or financial commodity, at an agreed price, at an agreed future date.

 

Fully loaded Basel III basis - capital ratios based on the rules that will apply at the end of the Basel III transition period.

 

Futures contract - a contract which provides for the future delivery (or acceptance of delivery) of some type of financial instrument or commodity under terms established at the outset. Futures differ from forward contracts in that they are traded on recognised exchanges and rarely result in actual delivery; most contracts are closed out prior to maturity by acquisition of an offsetting position.

 

G10 - Group of Ten comprises the eleven industrial countries (Belgium, Canada, France, Germany, Italy, Japan, the Netherlands, Sweden, Switzerland, the United Kingdom and the United States) that have agreed to participate in the International Monetary Fund’s (IMF’s) General Arrangements to Borrow.

 

Gross yield - the interest rate earned on average interest-earning assets i.e. interest income divided by average interest-earning assets.

 

Hedge funds - pooled investment vehicles that are not widely available to the public; their assets are managed by professional asset managers who participate in the performance of the fund.

 

Impaired loans - all loans for which an impairment provision has been established; for collectively assessed loans, impairment loss provisions are not allocated to individual loans and the entire portfolio is included in impaired loans.

 

Impairment allowance - see Loan impairment provisions.

 

Impairment losses - (a) for impaired financial assets measured at amortised cost, impairment losses - the difference between carrying value and the present value of estimated future cash flows discounted at the asset's original effective interest rate - are recognised in profit or loss and the carrying amount of the financial asset reduced by establishing a provision (allowance) (b) for impaired available-for-sale financial assets, the cumulative loss that had been recognised directly in equity is removed from equity and recognised in profit or loss as an impairment loss.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           200 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Glossary of terms continued     

Individually assessed loan impairment provisions - impairment loss provisions for individually significant impaired loans assessed on a case-by-case basis, taking into account the financial condition of the counterparty and any guarantor and the realisable value of any collateral held.

 

Interest rate swap - a contract under which two counterparties agree to exchange periodic interest payments on a predetermined monetary principal, the notional amount.

 

Interest spread - the difference between the gross yield and the interest rate paid on average interest-bearing liabilities.

 

Internal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process (ICAAP) - RBSH Group’s own assessment, as part of Basel II requirements, of its risks,  how it intends to mitigate those risks and how much current and future capital is necessary having considered other mitigating factors. 

 

Internal funding of trading business - the internal funding of the trading book comprises net banking book financial liabilities that fund financial assets in RBSH Group’s trading portfolios.  Interest payable on these financial liabilities is charged to the trading book.

 

International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) - the independent standard-setting body of the IFRS Foundation. Its members are responsible for the development and publication of International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRSs) and for approving Interpretations of IFRS as developed by the IFRS Interpretations Committee.

 

International Swaps and Derivatives Association (ISDA) master agreement - a standardised contract developed by ISDA for bilateral derivatives transactions. The contract grants legal rights of set-off for derivative transactions with the same counterparty.

 

Investment grade - generally represents a risk profile similar to a rating of BBB-/Baa3 or better, as defined by independent rating agencies.

 

Key management - members of the Managing Board of RBSH Group.

 

Latent loss provisions - loan impairment provisions held against impairments in the performing loan portfolio that have been incurred as a result of events occurring before the balance sheet date but which have not been identified as impaired at the balance sheet date.

 

Level 1 - level 1 fair value measurements are derived from quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities that the entity can access at the measurement date.

 

Level 2 - level 2 fair value measurements use inputs, other than quoted prices included within Level 1, that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly.

 

Level 3 - level 3 fair value measurements use one or more unobservable inputs for the asset or liability.

 

Leverage ratio - a measure prescribed under Basel III. It is the ratio of tier 1 capital to total exposures. Total exposures include on-balance sheet items, off-balance sheet items and derivatives, and generally follow the accounting measure of exposure.

 

Leveraged finance - funding (leveraged finance) provided to a business resulting in an overall level of debt in relation to cash flow that exceeds that which would be considered usual for the business or for the industry in which it operates. Leveraged finance is commonly employed to achieve a specific, often temporary, objective: to make an acquisition, to effect a buy-out or to repurchase shares.

 

Liquidity and funding risk - the risk that RBSH Group does not have sufficient financial resources to meet its commitments when they fall due, or can secure them only at excessive cost.

 

Liquidity coverage ratio (LCR) - the ratio of the stock of high quality liquid assets to expected net cash outflows over the following 30 days. High-quality liquid assets should be unencumbered, liquid in markets during a time of stress and, ideally, be central bank eligible. These include, for example, cash and claims on central governments and central banks. The Basel III rules require this ratio to be at least 100% and it is expected to apply from 2015.

 

Liquidity enhancements - make funds available to ensure that the issuer of securities, usually a commercial paper conduit, can redeem the securities at maturity. They typically take the form of a committed facility from a third-party bank.

 

Loan-to-deposit ratio - the ratio of loans and advances to customers net of provision for impairment losses and excluding reverse repurchase agreements to customer deposits excluding repurchase agreements.

 

Loan impairment provisions - loan impairment provisions are established to recognise incurred impairment losses on a portfolio of loans classified as loans and receivables and carried at amortised cost. It has three components: individually assessed loan impairment provisions, collectively assessed loan impairment provisions and latent loss provisions.

 

Loan-to-value ratio - the amount of a secured loan as a percentage of the appraised value of the security e.g. the outstanding amount of a mortgage loan as a percentage of the property's value.

 

Loss given default (LGD) – an estimate of the amount that will not be recovered by the Group in the event of default, plus the cost of debt collection activities and the delay in cash recovery.

 

Market risk - the risk of loss arising from fluctuations in interest rates, credit spreads, foreign currency rates, equity prices, commodity prices and other risk-related factors such as market volatilities that may lead to a reduction in earnings, economic value or both.

 

Master netting agreement - an agreement between two counterparties that have multiple derivative contracts with each other that provides for the net settlement of all contracts through a single payment, in a single currency, in the event of default on, or termination of, any one contract.

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           201 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Glossary of terms continued     

Medium term notes (MTNs) - debt securities usually with a maturity of five to ten years, but the term may be less than one year or as long as 50 years. They can be issued on a fixed or floating coupon basis or with an exotic coupon; with a fixed maturity date (non-callable) or with embedded call or put options or early repayment triggers. MTNs are generally issued as senior unsecured debt.

 

Monolines insurers (monolines) - entities that specialise in providing credit protection against the notional and interest cash flows due to the holders of debt instruments in the event of default. This protection is typically in the form of derivatives such as credit default swaps.

 

Mortgage-backed securities - asset-backed securities for which the underlying asset portfolios are loans secured on property. See Residential mortgage backed securities and Commercial mortgage backed securities.

 

Net interest income - the difference between interest receivable on financial assets classified as loans and receivables or available-for-sale and interest payable on financial liabilities carried at amortised cost.

 

Net interest margin - net interest income as a percentage of average interest-earning assets.

 

Net stable funding ratio (NSFR) - the ratio of available stable funding to required stable funding over a one year time horizon, assuming a stressed scenario. Available stable funding includes items such as equity capital, preferred stock with a maturity of over one year and liabilities with an assessed maturity of over one year.

 

Operational risk - the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed processes, people, systems or from external events.

 

Option - an option is a contract that gives the holder the right but not the obligation to buy (or sell) a specified amount of the underlying physical or financial commodity, at a specific price, at an agreed date or over an agreed period. Options can be exchange-traded or traded over-the-counter.

 

Over-the-counter (OTC) derivatives - are derivatives with tailored terms and conditions negotiated bilaterally, in contrast to exchange traded derivatives that have standardised terms and conditions.

 

Own credit adjustment (OCA) - the effect of RBSH Group’s own credit standing on the fair value of financial liabilities.

 

Past due - a financial asset such as a loan is past due when the counterparty has failed to make a payment when contractually due.

 

Pillar 1 – the part of Basel II that sets out the process by which regulatory capital requirements should be calculated for credit, market and operational risk.

 

Pillar 2 – the part of the Basel II that sets out the process by which a bank should review its overall capital adequacy and the processes under which the supervisors evaluate how well financial institutions are assessing their risks and take appropriate actions in response to the assessments.

 

Pillar 3 - the part of Basel II that sets out the information banks must disclose about their risks, the amount of capital required to absorb them, and their approach to risk management. The aim is to strengthen market discipline.

 

Potential problem loans (PPL) - loans for which an impairment event has taken place but no impairment loss is expected. This category is used for advances which are not past due 90 days or revolving credit facilities where identification as 90 days overdue is not feasible.

 

Private equity investments - equity investments in operating companies not quoted on a public exchange. Capital for private equity investment is raised from retail or institutional investors and used to fund investment strategies such as leveraged buyouts, venture capital, growth capital, distressed investments and mezzanine capital.

 

Probability of default (PD) - the likelihood that a customer will fail to make full and timely repayment of credit obligations over a one year time horizon.

 

Regular way purchase or sale - a purchase or sale of a financial asset under a contract whose terms require delivery of the asset within the time frame established generally by regulation or convention in the marketplace concerned.

 

Regulatory capital - the amount of capital that RBSH Group holds, determined in accordance with rules established by the DNB for the RBSH Group and by local regulators for individual Group companies.

 

Repurchase agreement (Repo) - see Sale and repurchase agreements.

 

Residential mortgage - a loan to purchase a residential property where the property forms collateral for the loan. The borrower gives the lender a lien against the property and the lender can foreclose on the property if the borrower does not repay the loan per the agreed terms. Also known as a home loan.

 

Residential mortgage backed securities (RMBS) - asset-backed securities for which the underlying asset portfolios are residential mortgages.

 

Retail loans - loans made to individuals rather than institutions. The loans may be for car purchases, home purchases, medical care, home repair, holidays and other consumer uses.

 

Reverse repurchase agreement (Reverse repo) - see Sale and repurchase agreements.

 

Risk appetite - an expression of the maximum level of risk that RBSH Group is prepared to accept to deliver its business objectives.

 

Risk elements in lending (REIL) - impaired loans and accruing loans which are contractually overdue 90 days or more as to principal or interest.

 

Risk-weighted assets  (RWAs) - assets adjusted for their associated risks using weightings established in accordance with the Basel Capital Accord as implemented by the DNB. Certain assets are not weighted but deducted from capital.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           202 

 


 

 

Additional information                                                                                                                        

Glossary of terms continued     

Sale and repurchase agreements - in a sale and repurchase agreement one party, the seller, sells a financial asset to another party, the buyer, at the same time the seller agrees to reacquire and the buyer to resell the asset at a later date. From the seller's perspective such agreements are repurchase agreements (repos) and from the buyer's reverse repurchase agreements (reverse repos).

 

Securitisation - a process by which assets or cash flows are transformed into transferable securities. The underlying assets or cash flows are transferred by the originator or an intermediary, typically an investment bank, to a structured entity which issues securities to investors. Asset securitisations involve issuing debt securities (asset-backed securities) that are backed by the cash flows of income-generating assets (ranging from credit card receivables to residential mortgage loans).

 

Settlement balances - payables and receivables that result from purchases and sales of financial instruments recognised on trade date.  Asset settlement balances are amounts owed to RBSH Group in respect of sales and liability settlement balances are amounts owed by RBSH Group in respect of purchases.

 

Sovereign exposures - exposures to governments, ministries, departments of governments and central banks.

 

Standardised approach - a method used to calculate credit risk capital requirements under Pillar 1 of Basel II. In this approach the risk weights used in the capital calculation are determined by regulators. For operational risk, capital requirements are determined by multiplying three years’ historical gross income by a percentage determined by the regulator. The percentage ranges from 12 to 18%, depending on the type of underlying business being considered.

 

Standstill - is an agreement, usually for a specified period of time, not to enforce the Bank’s rights as a result of a customer breaching the terms and conditions of their facilities. This is a concession to the customer. A standstill is most commonly used in a complex restructuring of a company’s debts, where a group of creditors agree to delay enforcement action to give the company time to gather information and formulate a strategy with a view to establishing a formal restructuring.

 

Stress testing - a technique used to evaluate the potential effects on an institution’s financial condition of an exceptional but plausible event and/or movement in a set of financial variables.

 

Stressed value-at-risk (SVaR) - a VaR measure using historical data from a one year period of stressed market conditions. For the purposes of calculating regulatory SVaR, a time horizon of ten trading days is assumed at a confidence level of 99%. (Refer to Value-at-risk definition below).

 

Structured entity (SE) - an entity that has been designed such that voting or similar rights are not the dominant factor in deciding who controls the entity, for example when any voting rights relate to administrative tasks only and the relevant activities are directed by means of contractual arrangements. SEs are usually established for a specific, limited purpose, they do not carry out a business or trade and typically have no employees. They take a variety of legal forms - trusts, partnerships and companies - and fulfil many different functions.

 

Structured notes - securities that pay a return linked to the value or level of a specified asset or index. Structured notes can be linked to equities, interest rates, funds, commodities and foreign currency.

 

Subordinated liabilities - liabilities which, in the event of insolvency or liquidation of the issuer, are subordinated to the claims of depositors and other creditors of the issuer.

 

Super senior CDO - the most senior class of instrument issued by a CDO vehicle. They benefit from the subordination of all other instruments, including AAA rated securities, issued by the CDO vehicle.

 

Tier 1 capital - Core Tier 1 capital plus other Tier 1 securities in issue, less material holdings in financial companies.

 

Tier 1 capital ratio - Tier 1 capital as a percentage of risk-weighted assets.

 

Tier 2 capital – qualifying subordinated debt and other tier 2 securities in issue, eligible collective impairment allowances, unrealised available-for-sale equity gains and revaluation reserves less certain regulatory deductions.

 

Unaudited - financial information that has not been subjected to the audit procedures undertaken by RBSH Group's auditor to enable them to express an opinion on RBSH Group's financial statements.

 

US Federal Agencies - are independent bodies established by the US Government for specific purposes such as the management of natural resources, financial oversight or national security. A number of agencies, including, the Government National Mortgage Association, issue or guarantee publicly traded debt securities.

 

Value-at-risk (VaR) - a technique that produces estimates of the potential change in the market value of a portfolio over a specified time horizon at given confidence levels.

 

Wholesale funding - wholesale funding comprises Deposits by banks, Debt securities in issue and Subordinated liabilities.

 

Write-down - a reduction in the carrying value of an asset to record a decline in its fair value or value in use.

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           203 

 


 

 

Important addresses

 

Company Secretariat

Gustav Mahlerlaan 350

1082 ME Amsterdam

PO Box 12925

The Netherlands

Telephone: + 31 20 464 99 99

Investor Relations

280 Bishopsgate
London EC2M 4RB
Telephone: +44 (0)207 672 1758
Facsimile: +44 (0)207 672 1801
Email: investor.relations@rbs.com

 

Registered office

Gustav Mahlerlaan 350

1082 ME Amsterdam

PO Box 12925

The Netherlands

 

Website

www.rbs.nl

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           204 

 


 

 

INDEX TO EXHIBITS

 

Exhibit No.

 

Description

1.1 (1)

 

English translation of the amended Articles of Association of RBS Holdings N.V.

7.1

 

Explanation of ratio calculations

12.1

 

CEO certification required by Rule 13a-14(a)

12.2

 

CFO certification required by Rule 13a-14(a)

13.1

 

Certification required by Rule 13a-14(b)

15.1

 

Consent of Deloitte LLP, independent registered public accounting firm

15.2

 

Consent of Deloitte Accountants B.V., independent registered public accounting firm

15.3 (2)

 

Risk factors of The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc

____________________________

 

(1) Previously filed as exhibit 1.1 to our annual report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2010, filed on March 30, 2011 (File No 001-14624).

 

(2) Incorporated herein by reference to pages 513 to 526 of the annual report on Form 20-F of The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc for the year ended December 31, 2013, filed on April 30, 2014 (File No 001-10306).

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           205 

 


 

 

Signatures

 

The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this annual report on its behalf.


 

 

 

RBS HOLDINGS N.V.

(Registrant)

 

 

 

 

 

April 30, 2014

 

By:

/s/ Jan de Ruiter

 

 

 

 

 

Name:

Jan de Ruiter

 

 

 

 

 

Title:

Chairman of the Managing Board

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ Cornelis Visscher

 

 

 

 

 

Name:

Cornelis Visscher

 

 

 

 

 

Title:

Chief Financial Officer

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

RBS Holdings N.V.                                                                                                                                                                                                           206